OWNER’S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time
of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make
changes at any time so that our policy of continual product
improvement may be carried out.
This manual applies to all models of this vehicle and includes
descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard
equipment.
As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not
apply to your specific vehicle.
Please note that some models are equipped with Right-Hand
Drive (RHD). The explanations and illustrations for some
operations in RHD models are opposite of those written in this
manual.
Introduction
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR HYUNDAI
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering
the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations
established by the Department of Transportation and other government
agencies in your country.
TWO-WAY RADIO OR CELLULAR
TELEPHONE INSTALLATION
Your vehicle is equipped with electronic fuel injection and other electronic
components. It is possible for an improperly installed/adjusted two-way radio
or cellular telephone to adversely affect electronic systems. For this reason,
we recommend that you carefully follow the radio manufacturer’s instructions
or consult your HYUNDAI dealer for precautionary measures or special
instructions if you choose to install one of these devices.
F2
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and
NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in
death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
F3
Table of contents
Foreword / Hybrid system overview
1
Vehicle information
2
Safety system
3
Instrument cluster
4
Convenient features
5
Driving your vehicle
6
Emergency situations
7
Maintenance
8
Index
I
Introduction
FOREWORD
Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome
you to the growing number of discerning people who drive HYUNDAIs. We are very
proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of each HYUNDAI
we build.
Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new
HYUNDAI. To become familiar with your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it,
read this Owner’s Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle.
This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to
familiarize you with your vehicle’s controls and safety features so you can safely
operate your vehicle.
This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe
operation of the vehicle. It is recommended that all service and maintenance on your
car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. HYUNDAI dealers are prepared
to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance that may be
required.
This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and
should be kept in the vehicle so you can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay
with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with important operating, safety
and maintenance information.
HYUNDAI MOTOR COMPANY
CAUTION
Severe engine and transmission damage may result from the use of poor quality
fuels and lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications. You must always use
high quality fuels and lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 2-13 in
the Vehicle Specifications section of the Owner’s Manual.
Copyright 2019 HYUNDAI Motor Company. All rights reserved. No part of this
publication may be reproduced, stored in any retrieval system or transmitted in
any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI Motor
Company.
1-2
01
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
We want to help you get the greatest possible driving pleasure from your vehicle. Your
Owner’s Manual can assist you in many ways. We strongly recommend that you read
the entire manual. In order to minimize the chance of death or injury, you must read
the WARNING and CAUTION sections in the manual.
Illustrations complement the words in this manual to best explain how to enjoy your
vehicle. By reading your manual, you will learn about features, important safety
information, and driving tips under various road conditions.
The general layout of the manual is provided in the Table of Contents. Use the
index when looking for a specific area or subject; it has an alphabetical listing of all
information in your manual.
Sections: This manual has eight chapters plus an index. Each chapter begins with a
brief list of contents so you can tell at a glance if that section has the information you
want.
SAFETY MESSAGES
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. This Owner’s Manual provides
you with many safety precautions and operating procedures. This information alerts
you to potential hazards that may hurt you or others, as well as damage to your vehicle.
Safety messages found on vehicle labels and in this manual describe these hazards
and what to do to avoid or reduce the risks.
Warnings and instructions contained in this manual are for your safety. Failure to follow
safety warnings and instructions can lead to serious injury or death.
Throughout this manual DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and the SAFETY
ALERT SYMBOL will be used.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to potential physical injury
hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol to avoid possible
injury or death. The safety alert symbol precedes the signal words DANGER,
WARNING and CAUTION.
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, will
result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which,
if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
1-3
Introduction
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
Unleaded
For Europe
For the optimal vehicle performance, we recommend you use unleaded gasoline which
has an octane rating of RON (Research Octane Number) 95 / AKI (Anti Knock Index)
91 or higher. You may use unleaded gasoline with an octane rating of RON 91-94 / AKI
87-90 but it may result in slight performance reduction of the vehicle. (Do not use
methanol blended fuels)
Except Europe
Your new vehicle is designed to use only unleaded fuel having an Octane Rating of
RON (Research Octane Number) 91 / AKI (Anti-Knock Index) 87 or higher. (Do not use
methanol blended fuels)
Your new vehicle is designed to obtain maximum performance with UNLEADED FUEL,
as well as minimize exhaust emissions and spark plug fouling.
NOTICE
NEVER USE LEADED FUEL. The use of leaded fuel is detrimental to the catalytic
converter and will damage the engine control system’s oxygen sensor and affect
emission control.
Never add any fuel system cleaning agents to the fuel tank other than what has
been specified (We recommend that you consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
details.)
WARNING
• Do not “top off” after the nozzle automatically shuts off when refueling.
• Always check that the fuel cap is installed securely to prevent fuel spillage in the
event of an accident.
Leaded (if equipped)
For some countries, your vehicle is designed to use leaded gasoline. When you are
going to use leaded gasoline, we recommend that you ask an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Octane rating of leaded gasoline is same with unleaded one.
1-4
01
Gasoline containing alcohol and methanol
Gasohol, a mixture of gasoline and ethanol (also known as grain alcohol), and gasoline
or gasohol containing methanol (also known as wood alcohol) are being marketed
along with or instead of leaded or unleaded gasoline.
Do not use gasohol containing more than 10% ethanol, and do not use gasoline or
gasohol containing any methanol. Either of these fuels may cause drivability problems
and damage to the fuel system, engine control system and emission control system.
Discontinue using gasohol of any kind if drivability problems occur.
Vehicle damage or driveability problems may not be covered by the manufacturer’s
warranty if they result from the use of:
1. Gasohol containing more than 10% ethanol.
2. Gasoline or gasohol containing methanol.
3. Leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.
NOTICE
Never use gasohol which contains methanol. Discontinue use of any gasohol
product which impairs drivability.
Other fuels
Using fuel additives such as:
-- Silicone fuel additive
-- MMT (Magnanese, Mn) fuel additive
-- Ferrocene (iron-based) fuel additive
-- Other metallic-based fuel additives
may result in cylinder misfire, poor acceleration, engine stalling, damage to the
catalyst, or abnormal corrosion, and may cause damage to the engine resulting in a
reduction in the overall life of the powertrain.
NOTICE
Damage to the fuel system or performance problem caused by the use of these fuels
may not be covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
1-5
Introduction
Use of MTBE
HYUNDAI recommends avoiding fuels containing MTBE (Methyl Tertiary Butyl Ether)
over 15.0% vol. (Oxygen Content 2.7% weight) in your vehicle.
Fuel containing MTBE over 15.0% vol. (Oxygen Content 2.7% weight) may reduce
vehicle performance and produce vapor lock or hard starting.
NOTICE
Your New Vehicle Limited Warranty may not cover damage to the fuel system and
any performance problems that are caused by the use of fuels containing methanol
or fuels containing MTBE (Methyl Tertiary Butyl Ether) over 15.0% vol. (Oxygen
Content 2.7% weight.)
Do not use methanol
Fuels containing methanol (wood alcohol) should not be used in your vehicle. This type
of fuel can reduce vehicle performance and damage components of the fuel system,
engine control system and emission control system.
Fuel Additives
HYUNDAI recommends that you use unleaded gasoline which has an octane rating of
RON (Research Octane Number) 95 / AKI (Anti Knock Index) 91 or higher (for Europe)
or Octane Rating of RON (Research Octane Number) 91 / AKI (Anti-Knock Index) 87
or higher (except Europe). For customers who do not use good quality gasolines, and
have problems starting or the engine does not run smoothly, one bottle of additive
added to the fuel tank is recommended according to the maintenance schedule (refer
to chapter 8, “Normal Maintenance Schedule”).
Additives are available from your authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information
on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.
Operation in foreign countries
If you are going to drive your vehicle in another country, be sure to:
• Observe all regulations regarding registration and insurance.
• Determine that acceptable fuel is available.
1-6
01
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS
• This vehicle should not be modified. Modification of your vehicle could affect its
performance, safety or durability and may even violate governmental safety and
emissions regulations.
In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from any modification may
not be covered under warranty.
• If you use unauthorized electronic devices, it may cause the vehicle to operate
abnormally, wire damage, battery discharge and fire. For your safety, do not use
unauthorized electronic devices.
VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCESS
By following a few simple precautions for the first 1,000 km (600 miles) you may add to
the performance, economy and life of your vehicle.
• Do not race the engine.
• While driving, keep your engine speed (rpm, or revolutions per minute) between
2,000 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
• Do not maintain a single speed for long periods of time, either fast or slow. Varying
engine speed is needed to properly break-in the engine.
• Avoid hard stops, except in emergencies, to allow the brakes to seat properly.
RETURNING USED VEHICLES (FOR EUROPE)
HYUNDAI promotes an environmentally sound treatment for end of life vehicles and
offers to take back your HYUNDAI end of life vehicles in accordance with the European
Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
You can get detailed information from your national HYUNDAI homepage.
1-7
1. Hybrid system overview
HEV (Hybrid Electric Vehicle) system............................................................... 1-11
Driving the hybrid vehicle.................................................................................1-12
Starting the vehicle...................................................................................................... 1-12
Vehicles with remote key system............................................................................. 1-12
Vehicles with smart key system................................................................................ 1-12
Special features............................................................................................................ 1-13
Virtual Engine Sound System (VESS)........................................................................ 1-14
What does regenerative braking do?........................................................................ 1-14
Battery........................................................................................................................ 1-14
Hybrid system gauge................................................................................................... 1-15
Power gauge.............................................................................................................. 1-15
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge........................................................... 1-15
Warning and indicator lights....................................................................................... 1-16
Ready indicator.......................................................................................................... 1-16
EV mode indicator..................................................................................................... 1-16
Service warning light................................................................................................. 1-16
Regenerative brake warning light............................................................................. 1-16
LCD display messages................................................................................................. 1-17
Ready to start driving................................................................................................ 1-17
Check regenerative brakes....................................................................................... 1-17
Stop vehicle and check brakes................................................................................. 1-17
Check Hybrid system................................................................................................. 1-17
Stop safely and check Hybrid system...................................................................... 1-18
Check Hybrid system. Do not start engine.............................................................. 1-18
Stop safely and check power supply........................................................................ 1-18
Check virtual engine sound system......................................................................... 1-18
Refuel to prevent Hybrid battery damage............................................................... 1-19
Refill inverter coolant................................................................................................ 1-19
Park with engine On to charge battery.................................................................... 1-19
Start engine to avoid battery discharge................................................................... 1-19
Energy flow.................................................................................................................. 1-20
Vehicle stop............................................................................................................... 1-20
EV propulsion............................................................................................................ 1-20
Power assist.............................................................................................................. 1-20
Engine only propulsion............................................................................................. 1-20
Engine generation...................................................................................................... 1-21
Regeneration.............................................................................................................. 1-21
Engine brake.............................................................................................................. 1-21
Power reserve............................................................................................................ 1-21
Engine generation/motor drive................................................................................1-22
Engine generation/regeneration..............................................................................1-22
Engine brake/regeneration.......................................................................................1-22
1
Safety precautions for hybrid system.............................................................. 1-23
1
Hybrid vehicle components........................................................................................1-23
High voltage battery system.....................................................................................1-23
Service plug................................................................................................................. 1-26
Hybrid battery cooling duct....................................................................................... 1-26
If an accident occurs....................................................................................................1-27
When the hybrid vehicle shuts off............................................................................. 1-28
01
HEV (HYBRID ELECTRIC VEHICLE) SYSTEM
The HYUNDAI Hybrid Electric Vehicle (HEV) uses both the gasoline engine and the
electric motor for power. The electric motor is run by a high-voltage HEV battery.
Depending on the driving conditions, the HEV computer selectively operates between
the engine and the electric motor or even both at the same time.
Fuel efficiency increases when the engine is at idle, or when the vehicle is driven by the
electric motor with the HEV battery.
The HEV battery charge must be maintained, so at times the engine will come on even
at idle to act as a generator. Charging also occurs when decelerating or by regenerative
braking.
Electric motor
Startup/Low speed cruise
Electric motor + Engine
Acceleration
Engine
High speed cruise
Charging
Deceleration
Engine OFF
Stop
OOSHQ019001L
1-11
Hybrid system overview
DRIVING THE HYBRID VEHICLE
Starting the vehicle
Vehicles with remote key system
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
3. Depress the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition swich to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 senconds) until the “ ” indicator
comes on and release it.
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it
should be started without depressing
the accelerator.
After following the start procedures,
“ ” indicator on the instrument
cluster will turn on. For more details,
please check chapter 6.
Vehicles with smart key system
1. Carry the smart key or leave it inside
the vehicle.
2. Make sure the parking brake is firmly
applied.
3. Place the shift lever in P (Park). With
the shift lever in N (Neutral), you
cannot start the vehicle.
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
If the hybrid system starts, the “ ”
indicator will come on.
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it
should be started without depressing
the accelerator.
After following the start procedures,
“ ” indicator on the instrument
cluster will turn on. For more details,
please check chapter 6.
1-12
ECONOMICAL and SAFE OPERATION of
Hybrid system
• Drive smoothly. Accelerate at a
moderate rate and maintain a steady
cruising speed. Do not make “jackrabbit” starts. Do not race between
stoplights.
Avoid heavy traffic whenever possible.
Always maintain a safe distance
from other vehicles so you can
avoid unnecessary braking. This also
reduces brake wear out.
• The regenerative brake generates
energy when the vehicle decelerates.
• When the hybrid battery power is
low, the hybrid system automatically
recharges the hybrid battery.
• When the engine is running with the
shift lever in N (Neutral), the hybrid
system cannot generate electricity.
The hybrid battery cannot recharge
with the shift lever in N (Neutral).
Information
In the hybrid system, the engine
automatically runs and stops. When
the hybrid system operates, the “ ”
indicator is illuminated.
In the following situation, the engine may
operate automatically.
-- When the engine is ready to run
-- When the hybrid battery is being
charged
-- Depending on the temperature
condition of the hybrid battery
01
Special features
Hybrid vehicles sound different than
gasoline engine vehicles. When the
hybrid system operates, you may hear
a sound from the hybrid battery system
behind the rear seat. If you apply the
accelerator pedal rapidly, you may hear
an unconventional sound. When you
apply the brake pedal, you may hear
a sound from the regenerative brake
system. When the hybrid system is
turned off or on, you may hear a sound
in the engine compartment. If you
depress the brake pedal repeatedly
when the hybrid system is turned on,
you may hear a sound in the engine
compartment. None of these sounds
indicate a problem. These are normal
characteristics of hybrid vehicles.
If any of following occur, it’s a normal
condition if you hear a motor sound in
the engine compartment:
-- After turning off the hybrid system,
the brake pedal is released.
-- When the hybrid system is turned off,
the brake pedal is applied.
-- When the driver door is opened.
When the hybrid system is turned ON,
the gasoline engine may run or may not.
In this situation, you may feel a vibration.
This does not indicate a malfunction.
When the “ ” indicator illuminates, the
hybrid system is ready to begin driving.
Even if the engine is off, you can operate
the vehicle as long as the “ ” indicator
is illuminated.
NOTICE
The hybrid system contains many
electronic components. High voltage
components, such as cables and other
parts, may emit electromagnetic waves.
Even when the electromagnetic cover
blocks electromagnetic emissions,
electromagnetic waves may have an
effect on electronic devices. When your
vehicle is not used for a long period of
time, the hybrid system will discharge.
You need to drive the vehicle several
times a month. We recommend driving
at least for 1 hour or 16 km. When the
hybrid battery is discharged, or when it
is impossible to jump start the vehicle,
we recommend that you contact your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
• When you start the hybrid system
with the shift lever in P (Parking),
the “ ” indicator illuminates on
the instrument cluster. The driver
can drive the vehicle, even when the
gasoline engine is off.
• When you leave the vehicle, you
should turn OFF the hybrid system
or locate the shift lever in P (Park).
When you depress the accelerator
pedal by mistake, or when the shift
lever is not in P (Park), the vehicle
will abruptly move, possibly resulting
in serious injury or death.
1-13
Hybrid system overview
Virtual Engine Sound System (VESS)
What does regenerative braking do?
It uses an electric motor when
decelerating and when braking and
transforms kinetic energy to electrical
energy in order to charge the high
voltage battery.
Battery
OOSHQ019002L
The Virtual Engine Sound System
generates engine sound for pedestrians
to hear vehicle sound because there is
limited sound while motor power is used.
• The VESS may be turned ON or OFF
by pressing the VESS button.
• If the vehicle is moving at low speed,
the VESS will operate.
• When the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse), an additional warning
sound will be heard.
CAUTION
For safety reasons, do not turn off the
VESS system. If you are in a situation
that the system needs to be turned off,
check whether there are pedestrians
around the vehicle.
1-14
• The vehicle is composed of a high
voltage battery that drives the motor
and air conditioner, and an integrated
12V lithium ion polymer battery with
the HEV battery that drives the lamps,
wipers, and audio system.
• The integrated 12V battery is
automatically charged when the
vehicle is in the ready ( ) mode.
01
Hybrid system gauge
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge)
gauge
Power gauge
Type A
OOSH049007L
The hybrid system gauge indicates
whether the current driving condition is
fuel efficient or not.
• CHARGE:
Shows that the energy made by the
vehicle is being converted to electrical
energy. (Regenerated energy)
• ECO:
Shows that the vehicle is being driven
in an Eco-friendly manner.
• POWER:
Shows that the vehicle is exceeding
the Eco-friendly range.
Type B
OOSH049010L
OOSH049011L
This gauge indicates the remaining
hybrid battery power. If the SOC is near
the “0 or L (Low)” level, the vehicle
automatically operates the engine to
charge the battery.
However, if the Service Indicator ( )
and Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
( ) turn on when the SOC gauge is near
the “0 or L (Low)” level, we recommend
the vehicle be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
According to the hybrid system gauge
area, the “EV” indicator comes on or off.
-- “EV” indicator ON : Vehicle is driven
using the electric motor or the
gasoline engine is stopped.
-- “EV” indicator OFF : Vehicle is driven
using the gasoline engine.
1-15
Hybrid system overview
Warning and indicator lights
Service warning light
Ready indicator
This indicator illuminates:
When the vehicle is ready to be driven.
-- ON : Normal driving is possible.
-- OFF : Normal driving is not possible,
or a problem has occurred.
-- Blinking : Emergency driving.
When the ready indicator goes OFF
or blinks, there is a problem with the
system. If this occurs, we recommend
that you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
EV mode indicator
This indicator illuminates:
When the vehicle is driven by the electric
motor.
1-16
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The service warning light illuminates
for approximately 3 seconds and
then turns off when all checks have
been performed.
• When there is a problem with the
hybrid vehicle control system or
hardware.
When the warning light illuminates
while driving, or does not go OFF after
starting the vehicle, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Regenerative brake warning
light
(yellow)
This warning light illuminates:
When the regenerative brake does not
operate and the brake does not perform
well. This causes the Brake Warning
light (red) and Regenerative Brake
Warning Light (yellow) to illuminate
simultaneously.
If this occurs, drive safely and have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. The operation of the
brake pedal may be more difficult than
normal and the braking distance may
increase.
01
LCD display messages
Stop vehicle and check brakes
Ready to start driving
OOSHQ019006L
OOSHQ019003L
This message is displayed when the
vehicle is ready to be driven.
Check regenerative brakes
This message is displayed when a failure
occurs in the brake system.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a
safe location and we recommend that
you tow your vehicle to the nearest
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have the
vehicle inspected.
Check Hybrid system
OOSHQ019004L
This message is displayed when
the brake performance is low or the
regenerative brake does not work
properly due to a failure in the brake
system.
If this occurs, it may take longer for the
brake pedal to operate and the braking
distance may become longer.
OOSHQ019005L
This message is displayed when there is a
problem with the hybrid control system.
Refrain from driving when the warning
message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
1-17
Hybrid system overview
Stop safely and check Hybrid system
Stop safely and check power supply
OOSHQ019007L
OOSHQ019009L
This message is displayed when there
is a problem with the hybrid control
system. The “ ” indicator will blink
and a warning chime will sound until the
problem is solved. Refrain from driving
when the warning message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This message is displayed when a failure
occurs in the power supply system.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a safe
location and tow your vehicle to the
nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the vehicle inspected.
Check virtual engine sound system
Check Hybrid system. Do not start
engine
OOSHQ019010L
OOSHQ019008L
This message is displayed when the
hybrid battery power (SOC) level is low.
A warning chime will sound until the
problem is solved. Refrain from driving
when the warning message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
1-18
This message is displayed when there is
a problem with the Virtual Engine Sound
System (VESS).
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
01
Refuel to prevent Hybrid battery
damage
OOSHQ019011L
This message is displayed when the fuel
tank is nearly empty.
You should refill the fuel tank to prevent
hybrid battery damage.
Refill inverter coolant
Park with engine On to charge
battery
OOSHQ019013L
This message is displayed when the
hybrid battery power (SOC) level is low.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a safe
location and wait until the hybrid battery
is charged.
Start engine to avoid battery
discharge
OOSHQ019012L
This message is displayed when the
inverter coolant is nearly empty.
You should refill the inverter coolant.
OOSHQ019027L
This message is displayed to inform the
driver the 12V battery may be discharged
if the ignition switch is in ON position
indicator ON).
(without the
Set the vehicle to the ready ( ) mode
to prevent the 12V battery from being
discharged.
1-19
Hybrid system overview
Energy flow
Power assist
The hybrid system informs the drivers its
energy flow in various operating modes.
While driving, the current energy flow is
specified in 11 modes.
Vehicle stop
OOSHQ019016L
Both the motor and the engine power are
used to drive the vehicle.
(Battery & Engine → Wheel)
OOSHQ019014L
Engine only propulsion
The vehicle is stopped.
(No energy flow)
EV propulsion
OOSHQ019017L
Only the engine power is used to drive
the vehicle.
(Engine → Wheel)
OOSHQ019015L
Only the motor power is used to drive the
vehicle.
(Battery → Wheel)
1-20
01
Engine generation
Engine brake
OOSHQ019019L
OOSHQ019018L
When the vehicle is stopped, the highvoltage battery is charged up by the
engine.
(Engine → Battery)
Regeneration
The engine braking is used to decelerate
the vehicle.
(Wheel → Engine)
Power reserve
OOSHQ019021L
OOSHQ019020L
The high-voltage battery is charged up
by the regenerative brake system.
(Wheel → Battery)
The engine is simultaneously used to
drive the vehicle and to charge up the
high-voltage battery.
(Engine → Wheel & Battery)
1-21
Hybrid system overview
Engine generation/motor drive
OOSHQ019022L
The engine charges up the high-voltage
battery. The motor power is used to drive
the vehicle.
(Engine → Battery → Wheel)
Engine generation/regeneration
OOSHQ019023L
The engine and regenerative brake
system charges up the high-voltage
battery.
(Engine & Wheel → Battery)
1-22
Engine brake/regeneration
OOSHQ019024L
The engine braking is simultaneously
used to decelerate the vehicle and to
charge up the high-voltage battery.
(Wheel → Engine & Battery)
01
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR HYBRID SYSTEM
Hybrid vehicle components
High voltage battery system
HPCU (Hybrid Power Control Unit) *1
WARNING
Never touch orange colored or high
voltage labeled components, including
wires, cables, and connections. When
the insulators or covers are damaged or
removed, severe injury or death from
electrocution may occur.
WARNING
OAEPHQ016040L
High voltage battery system *2
While replacing the fuses in the
engine compartment, never touch the
HPCU. The HPCU carries high voltage.
Touching the HPCU may result in
electrocution, serious injury, or death.
WARNING
In the hybrid system, the hybrid battery
uses high voltage to operate the motor
and other components. This high
voltage hybrid battery system can be
very dangerous.
Never touch the hybrid system. When
you touch the hybrid battery system,
serious injury or death may occur.
OAEQ046019
Located in the engine compartment
*2 : Located under the rear seats
*1 :
1-23
Hybrid system overview
CAUTION
WARNING
• Do not pile up any items in an area
behind the high voltage battery. In
a crash, the battery may become
unstable, or its performance may
degrade.
• Do not apply strong force nor pile
up any items above the luggage
compartment. Such an attempt
may distort the high voltage battery
case, causing a safety problem or
degrading the performance.
• Be careful when loading flammable
liquid in the luggage compartment.
It could cause operational and safety
degradation if the liquid leaks and
flows in the high voltage battery.
Drive motor *3
OAEQ046017
*3 :
Located in the engine compartment
1-24
• Do not disassemble the high voltage
motor connector. The high voltage
motor connector may contain
residual high voltage. Coming in
contact with high voltage may result
in death or serious injury.
• Your vehicle’s hybrid system should
only be inspected or repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
• Do not disassemble or assemble
the high voltage battery system.
Doing so may result in electric shock,
causing death or serious injury.
• If you disassemble or assemble
hybrid system components
improperly, it may damage the
performance and reliability of your
vehicle.
• If electrolyte comes in contact
with your body, clothes or eyes,
immediately flush with a large
quantity of fresh tap water. Have
your eyes examined by a doctor as
soon as possible.
01
WARNING
Never assemble or disassemble the
high voltage battery system.
• If you assemble or disassemble the
high voltage battery system, the
durability and performance of the
vehicle may be damaged.
• When you want to check the high
voltage battery system, have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not touch the high voltage
battery and high voltage cable
connected to motor (orange color).
Severe burns and electric shock may
occur. For your safety, do not touch
the cover of electronic components
and electronic cable. Do not remove
the cover of electronic components
and electronic cable. In particular,
never touch the high voltage battery
system when the hybrid system in
operation. It may result in death or
serious injury.
WARNING
• Never use the package modules
(high voltage battery, inverter and
converter) for any other purpose.
• Do not use an unauthorized battery
charger to charge the high voltage
battery. Doing so may result in death
or serious injury.
• Never locate the high voltage system
near or in a fire.
• Never drill into or strike the package
module. Otherwise, it may be
damaged. An electric shock may
occur, resulting in serious injury or
death.
NOTICE
• When the vehicle is paint baked, do
not bake over 30 minutes in 70°C
(158°F) or 20 minutes in 80°C (176°F)
degree.
• Do not wash the engine
compartment, using water. Water
may cause an electric shock and
damage the electronic components.
WARNING
This hybrid vehicle uses the hybrid
battery system inverter and converter
to generate high voltage. High voltage
in the hybrid battery system is very
dangerous and may cause severe burns
and electric shock. This may result in
serious injury or death.
• For your safety, never touch,
replace, disassemble or remove the
hybrid battery system including
components, cables and connectors.
Severe burns or electric shock may
result in serious injury or death when
you fail to follow this warning.
• When the hybrid battery system
operates, the hybrid battery system
can be hot. Always be careful
because burns or electric shock may
be caused by high voltage.
• Do not spill liquid on the HPCU, HSG,
motor and fuses. If the hybrid system
components come in contact with
liquid, it may result in electric shock.
1-25
Hybrid system overview
Service plug
WARNING
DANGER
OOSHQ019025L
Never touch the service plug. The
service plug is attached to the high
voltage hybrid battery system. Touching
the service plug will result in death or
serious injury.
Service personnel should follow
procedure in the service manual.
Hybrid battery cooling duct
OOSHQ019026L
The hybrid battery cooling duct is
located on the left side of the rear seats.
The cooling duct cools down the hybrid
battery. When the hybrid battery cooling
duct is blocked, the hybrid battery may
be overheated.
Clean the cooling duct for the hybrid
battery with a dry cloth on a regular
basis.
1-26
• Never clean the cooling duct of the
hybrid battery with a wet cloth. If
any water enters the cooling duct
of the hybrid battery, the hybrid
battery may cause an electric shock,
resulting in a serious damage, an
injury or a death.
• The hybrid battery is composed of
lithium-ion polymer. If the hybrid
battery is improperly handled, it is
dangerous to the environment. Also
it may cause electrical shock and
severe burns, resulting in a serious
injury or a death.
• Do not spill liquid over the cooling
duct of the hybrid battery. Doing
so is very dangerous. It may cause
electric shock or serious injury.
• Do not cover the cooling duct with
objects.
• Do not put any objects into the
cooling duct of the hybrid battery.
Doing so may cause loss of cooling
duct volume to the hybrid battery.
When the cooling duct is blocked
with any objects, immediately
contact your HYUNDAI dealer.
• Never place a container of liquid on
or near the cooling duct. If the liquid
spills, the hybrid battery located in
the luggage compartment may be
damaged.
• Secure all loads in the luggage
compartment to prevent them from
being tossed about before driving.
When a sharp or heavy load strike
with a strong impact or pierce the
interior luggage compartment
wall, the hybrid battery system
may be damaged, deteriorating its
performance.
• Do not obstruct the cooling duct
with any other objects.
01
If an accident occurs
WARNING
• For your safety, do not touch the
high voltage cables, connectors
and package modules. High voltage
components are orange in color.
• Exposed cables or wires may be
visible inside or outside of the
vehicle. Never touch the wires or
cables, because an electrical shock,
an injury, or a death may occur.
• Any gas or electrolyte leakage from
your vehicle is not only poisonous
but also flammable. Upon witnessing
one of those, open the windows,
and remain a safe distance from the
vehicle out of the road.
Immediately call an emergency
services or contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and advise them
that a hybrid vehicle is involved.
• When the vehicle is severely
damaged, remain a safe distance
of 15 meter or more between
your vehicle and other vehicles/
flammables.
WARNING
If a fire occurs:
• If a small scale fire occurs, use a fire
extinguisher (ABC, BC) that is meant
for electrical fires.
If it is impossible to extinguish
the fire in the early stage, remain
a safe distance from the vehicle
and immediately call your local
fire emergency responders. Also,
advise them that a hybrid vehicle is
involved.
If the fire spreads to the high voltage
battery, large amount of water is
needed to put out the fire.
Using small amount of water or
fire extinguishers not meant for
electrical fires could cause serious
injury or death from electrical
shocks.
• Upon witnessing any sparks, gases,
flames, or fuel leakage of your
vehicle, immediately call emergency
services or contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. Also, advise them
that a hybrid vehicle is involved.
WARNING
When a submersion in water occurs:
When your vehicle is flooded in water, a
high-voltage battery may cause shock
or fires. Thus, turn the hybrid system
OFF, take the key in your possession and
escape to a safe place. Never attempt
physical contact with your flooded
vehicle.
Immediately contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and advise them that a
hybrid vehicle is involved.
1-27
Hybrid system overview
When the hybrid vehicle shuts
off
When the high voltage battery or 12 volt
battery is discharged, or when the fuel
tank is empty, the hybrid system may
not operate while driving. When the
Hybrid system does not operate, do the
followings:
1. Gradually reduce the vehicle speed.
Pull over your vehicle off the road in a
safe area.
2. Locate the shift lever in P (Park).
3. Turn ON the hazard warning flashers.
4. Turn OFF the vehicle, and try to
start the hybrid system again, while
depressing the brake pedal and
turning on the ignition switch.
5. When the hybrid system still does not
operate, refer to “If the 12 Volt Battery
Is Discharged” section in chapter 7.
Before jump-starting the vehicle,
check the fuel level and the exact
procedure to jump start. For further
details, refer to “If the 12 Volt Battery
Is Discharged” section in chapter
7. When the fuel level is low, do not
attempt to drive the vehicle only with
the battery power. The high voltage
battery may be discharged, and the
hybrid system will turn OFF.
1-28
2. Vehicle information
Exterior overview (I)............................................................................................2-2
Exterior overview (II)...........................................................................................2-3
Interior overview (I)........................................................................................... 2-4
Interior overview (II).......................................................................................... 2-5
Instrument panel overview (I)........................................................................... 2-6
Instrument panel overview (II)...........................................................................2-7
Engine compartment......................................................................................... 2-8
Dimensions......................................................................................................... 2-9
Engine................................................................................................................. 2-9
Bulb wattage.....................................................................................................2-10
Tires and wheels................................................................................................2-11
Load and speed capacity tires......................................................................... 2-12
Air conditioning system.................................................................................... 2-12
Vehicle weight and luggage volume............................................................... 2-12
Recommended lubricants and capacities...................................................... 2-13
Recommended engine oil...........................................................................................2-14
Recommended SAE viscosity number.......................................................................2-14
Vehicle identification number (VIN)................................................................ 2-15
Vehicle certification label................................................................................. 2-15
Tire specification and pressure label............................................................... 2-16
Engine number.................................................................................................. 2-16
Air conditioner compressor label.................................................................... 2-16
Refrigerant label............................................................................................... 2-16
Declaration of conformity................................................................................ 2-17
Fuel label........................................................................................................... 2-17
Gasoline engine............................................................................................................2-17
2
Vehicle information
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (I)
Front view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019001L
1. Hood....................................................... 5-33
6. Outside rearview mirror.........................5-23
2. Headlamp...............................................8-56
7. Sunroof................................................... 5-29
3. DRL (Daytime Running Light)...............8-56
8. Front windshield wiper blades..............8-31
4. Turn signal lamp....................................8-56
9. Windows.................................................5-25
5. Tires and wheels.................................... 8-33
2-2
02
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW (II)
Rear view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019002L
1. Door......................................................... 5-13
5. Tailgate................................................... 5-34
2. Fuel filler door........................................ 5-36
6. High mounted stop lamp...................... 8-67
3. Rear combination lamp........................8-65
7. Rear window wiper blades................... 8-32
4. Turn signal lamp, Rear fog lamp, Back-up
lamp........................................................8-65
8. Antenna...................................................5-91
2-3
Vehicle information
INTERIOR OVERVIEW (I)
Left-hand drive
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019003L
1. Inside door handle.................................. 5-14
10. Head-up display button........................ 5-39
2. Outside rearview mirror folding........... 5-24
11. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)....................6-84
3. Outside rearview mirror control........... 5-33
12. 12V battery reset switch...........................7-4
4. Central door lock switch........................ 5-15
13. ESC OFF button..................................... 6-34
5. Power window lock switch................... 5-28
6. Power window switches........................5-25
14. VESS (Vehicle Engine Sound System)
button.......................................................1-14
7. Headlight leveling device..................... 5-49
15. Hood release lever................................. 5-33
8. Instrument panel illumination control
switch....................................................... 4-5
16. Steering wheel tilt/telescopic lever..... 5-20
9. Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW).... 6-56
18. Seat........................................................... 3-3
2-4
17. Steering wheel........................................ 5-19
02
INTERIOR OVERVIEW (II)
Right-hand drive
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019003R
1. Inside door handle.................................. 5-14
10. Head-up display button........................ 5-39
2. Outside rearview mirror folding........... 5-24
11. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)....................6-84
3. Outside rearview mirror control........... 5-33
12. 12V battery reset switch...........................7-4
4. Central door lock switch........................ 5-15
13. ESC OFF button..................................... 6-34
5. Power window lock switch................... 5-28
6. Power window switches........................5-25
14. VESS (Vehicle Engine Sound System)
button.......................................................1-14
7. Headlight leveling device..................... 5-49
15. Hood release lever................................. 5-33
8. Instrument panel illumination control
switch....................................................... 4-5
16. Steering wheel........................................ 5-19
17. Seat........................................................... 3-3
9. Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW).... 6-56
2-5
Vehicle information
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW (I)
Left-hand drive
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019004L
1. Instrument cluster................................... 4-4
12. USB charger........................................... 5-83
2. Horn........................................................ 5-20
13. Power outlet........................................... 5-82
3. Driver’s front air bag.............................. 3-44
14. Dual clutch transmission shift lever......6-13
4. Key ignition switch/................................. 6-6
15. Seat warmer/Air ventilation seat...........3-16
Engine Start/Stop button........................ 6-9
16. Heated steering wheel........................... 5-21
5. Light control/Turn signals..................... 5-42
17. Reverse Parking Distance Warning
(PDW)/.................................................... 5-56
6. Wiper/Washer........................................ 5-52
7. Audio system......................................... 5-96
8. Hazard warning flasher switch................7-2
9. Automatic climate control system....... 5-63
10. Passenger’s front air bag...................... 3-44
11. Glove box................................................5-79
2-6
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning (PDW)...................................... 5-59
18. Steering wheel audio controls.............. 5-92
19. Speed limiter controls/........................6-103
Cruise controls......................................6-105
02
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW (II)
Right-hand drive
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OOSH019004R
1. Instrument cluster................................... 4-4
12. USB charger........................................... 5-83
2. Horn........................................................ 5-20
13. Power outlet........................................... 5-82
3. Driver’s front air bag.............................. 3-44
14. Dual clutch transmission shift lever......6-13
4. Key ignition switch/................................. 6-6
15. Seat warmer/Air ventilation seat...........3-16
Engine Start/Stop button........................ 6-9
16. Heated steering wheel........................... 5-21
5. Light control/Turn signals..................... 5-42
17. Reverse Parking Distance Warning
(PDW)/.................................................... 5-56
6. Wiper/Washer........................................ 5-52
7. Audio system......................................... 5-96
8. Hazard warning flasher switch................7-2
9. Automatic climate control system....... 5-63
10. Passenger’s front air bag...................... 3-44
11. Glove box................................................5-79
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning (PDW)...................................... 5-59
18. Steering wheel audio controls.............. 5-92
19. Speed limiter controls/........................6-103
Cruise controls......................................6-105
2-7
Vehicle information
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
1.6 GDI
The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OOSH089001L
1. Engine oil filler cap................................ 8-22
6. Brake fluid reservoir.............................. 8-26
2. Engine oil dipstick................................. 8-22
7. Air cleaner.............................................. 8-28
3. Engine coolant cap................................ 8-23
8. Windshield washer fluid reservoir.........8-27
4. Engine coolant reservoir....................... 8-23
9. Fuse box................................................. 8-45
5. Inverter coolant reservoir..................... 8-23
2-8
02
DIMENSIONS
Items
mm (in)
Overall length
4165 (163.97)
Overall width
1800 (70.86)
Overall height
1550 (61.02) / 1565 (61.61)*1
Front tread
Rear tread
205/60 R16
1575 (62.0)
225/45 ZR18
1559 (61.37)
205/60 R16
1584 (62.36)
225/45 ZR18
1568 (61.73)
Wheelbase
*1
2600 (102.36)
: with roof rack
ENGINE
Engine
Displacement
cc (cu. in)
Bore x Stroke
mm (in.)
Firing order
No. of cylinders
1.6 GDI
1580 (96.4)
72 X 97 (2.8 X 3.8)
1-3-4-2
In-line 4 cylinder
2-9
Vehicle information
BULB WATTAGE
Light bulb
Type A
Front
Type B
Headlamp
Headlamp
Bulb type
Wattage
Low
H7
55
High
H7
55
Low/High
LED
LED
H7
55
Static lamp (Low beam assist)
Turn signal lamp
PY21W
21
Daytime running light (DRL)/Position lamp
LED
LED
Side repeater lamp
LED
LED
P21W/5W
Tail: 5 / Stop: 21
Type A
W5W
5
Tail/Stop lamp
LED
LED
Turn signal lamp
P21W
21
Backup lamp
P21W
21
PR21W
21
Type B
Rear
Tail/Stop lamp
Tail lamp
Fog lamp
License plate lamp
W5W
5
High mounted stop lamp
LED
LED
Type A
W10W
10
Type B
W10W
10
Type A
FESTOON
8
Type B
FESTOON
10
Map lamp
Interior
2-10
Room lamp
Vanity mirror lamp
FESTOON
5
Luggage compartment lamp
FESTOON
10
02
TIRES AND WHEELS
Item
Tire size
Wheel
size
Inflation pressure
bar (kPa, psi)
Normal load
Front
Full size
tire
Compact
spare tire
205/60
R16
6.5J x 16
225/45
ZR18
7.5J x 18
T125/80
D16
4.0T x 16
Rear
2.5 (250, 36)
Maximum load
Front
Rear
2.5 (250, 36)
Wheel lug nut
torque
kgf·m (lbf·ft,
N·m)
11~13
(79~94,107~127)
4.2 (420, 60)
NOTICE
• It is permissible to add 20 kPa (3 psi) to the standard tire pressure specification if
colder temperatures are expected soon. Tires typically lose 7 kPa (1 psi) for every
7°C (12°F) temperature drop. If extreme temperature variations are expected,
recheck your tire pressure as necessary to keep them properly inflated.
• An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above
sea level. Thus, if you plan to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures in
advance. If necessary, inflate them to a proper level (Air inflation per altitude: +10
kPa/1 km (+2.4 psi/1 mile)).
• Must do not exceed maximum inflation pressure shown on equipped tire
sidewall.
CAUTION
When replacing tires, ALWAYS use the same size, type, brand, construction and
tread pattern supplied with the vehicle. If not, it can damage the related parts or
make it work irregularly.
2-11
Vehicle information
LOAD AND SPEED CAPACITY TIRES (FOR EUROPE)
Item
Full size tire
Compact
spare tire
*1
*2
Tire size
Wheel size
205/60 R16
Load capacity
Speed capacity
LI *1
kg
SS *2
km/h
6.5J x 16
92
630
H
210
225/45 ZR18
7.5J x 18
91
615
W
270
T125/80 D16
4.0T x 16
97
730
M
130
LI : LOAD INDEX
SS : SPEED SYMBOL
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Items
Refrigerant
Compressor lubricant
Weight of volume
Classification
500±25 g (17.63±0.88 oz.)
R-1234yf
475±25 g (16.75±0.88 oz.)
R-134a
120±10 g (4.23±0.35 oz.)
POE
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.
VEHICLE WEIGHT AND LUGGAGE VOLUME
Gross vehicle weight
1880 kg
Luggage volume
Min.
Max.
361 ℓ
1143 ℓ
Min : Behind rear seat to upper edge of the seat back.
Max : Behind front seat to roof.
2-12
02
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance and durability, use only
lubricants of the proper quality. The correct lubricants also help promote engine
efficiency that results in improved fuel economy.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant
Volume
Classification
Recommends
Engine oil *1 *2
(drain and refill)
Dual clutch transmission fluid
Engine clutch actuator fluid
3.8 ℓ
(4.0 US qt.)
1.6 ~ 1.7 ℓ
(1.69 ~ 1.80 US qt.)
API LATEST or ACEA A5/B5
SAE: 5W-30
SAE 70W, API GL-4
HK D DCTF TGO-10 (SK)
SPIRAX S6 GHDE 70W DCTF
(H.K.SHELL)
7 DCTF HKM (S-OIL)
100 ± 20 cc
SAE J1703, FMVSS116 DOT3 or
(0.105 ± 0.021 US qt.) DOT4
Mixture of antifreeze and water
(Phosphate-based Ethylene glycol
coolant for aluminum radiator)
Engine coolant
6.0 ℓ (6.3 US qt.)
Inverter coolant
2.4 ℓ (2.5 US qt.)
Brake fluid*3
required amount
SAE J1704 DOT-4 LV, FMVSS 116
DOT-4, ISO4925 CLASS-6
38 ℓ (40 US qt.)
Refer to “Fuel requirements” in
chapter 1.
Fuel
Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on the next page.
Engine oils labeled Energy Conserving Oil are now available. Along with other additional
benefits, they contribute to fuel economy by reducing the amount of fuel necessary
to overcome engine friction. Often, these improvements are difficult to measure in
everyday driving, but in a year’s time, they can offer significant cost and energy savings.
*3 : To maintain the best braking performance and ABS/ESC performance, we recommend
that you use genuine brake fluid that conform to specifications.
*1 :
*2 :
2-13
Vehicle information
Recommended engine oil (For Europe)
Supplier
Product
Helix Ultra AH 5W30
Shell
Helix Ultra A5/B5 0W30
Recommended SAE viscosity number
CAUTION
Always be sure to clean the area around any filler plug, drain plug, or dipstick before
checking or draining any lubricant. This is especially important in dusty or sandy
areas and when the vehicle is used on unpaved roads. Cleaning the plug and dipstick
areas will prevent dirt and grit from entering the engine and other mechanisms that
could be damaged.
Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an effect on fuel economy and cold weather
operating (engine start and engine oil flowability). Lower viscosity engine oils can
provide better fuel economy and cold weather performance, however, higher viscosity
engine oils are required for satisfactory lubrication in hot weather. Using oils of any
viscosity other than those recommended could result in engine damage.
When choosing an oil, consider the range of temperature your vehicle will be operated
in before the next oil change. Proceed to select the recommended oil viscosity from
the chart.
Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers
Temperature
°C
(°F)
-30
-20
-10
-10
0
0
20
10
20
40
60
30
80
20W-50
Gasoline Engine Oil
15W-40
10W-30
0/5W-30, 5W-40
2-14
40
50
100
120
02
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER (VIN)
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION
LABEL
Frame number
OOSH019020L
The vehicle identification number (VIN)
is the number used in registering your
vehicle and in all legal matters pertaining
to its ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the right front seat. To check the
number, open the cover.
OOSH019022L
The vehicle certification label attached
on the driver’s (or front passenger’s)
side center pillar gives the vehicle
identification number (VIN).
VIN label (if equipped)
OOSH019021L
The VIN is also on a plate attached to
the top of the left side dashboard. The
number on the plate can easily be seen
through the windshield from outside.
2-15
Vehicle information
TIRE SPECIFICATION AND
PRESSURE LABEL
AIR CONDITIONER
COMPRESSOR LABEL
OOSH019023L
The tires supplied on your new
vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar gives the tire pressures
recommended for your vehicle.
REFRIGERANT LABEL
(IF EQUIPPED)
ENGINE NUMBER
OOSH019024L
The engine number is stamped on the
engine block as shown in the drawing.
2-16
OOSH019027L
A compressor label informs you the type
of compressor your vehicle is equipped
with such as model, supplier part
number, production number, refrigerant
(1) and refrigerant oil (2).
OOSH019026L
The refrigerant label provides
information such as refrigerant type and
amount.
The label is located on the underside of
the hood.
02
DECLARATION OF
CONFORMITY (IF EQUIPPED)
FUEL LABEL (IF EQUIPPED)
Gasoline engine
The fuel label is attached on the fuel filler
door.
Example
CE0678
The radio frequency components of the
vehicle comply with requirements and
other relevant provisions of Directive
1995/5/EC.
Further information including the
manufacturer’s declaration of conformity
is available on HYUNDAI web site as
follows;
http://service.hyundai-motor.com
OOSH019025L
A. Octane rating of unleaded gasoline
1. RON/ROZ : Research Octane
Number
2. (R+M)/2, AKI : Anti Knock Index
B. Identifiers for Petrol-type fuels
ÃÃ This symbol means usable fuel. Do
not use any other fuel.
C. For further details, refer to the “Fuel
Requirement” in the Introduction
chapter.
2-17
3. Safety system
Important safety precautions............................................................................3-2
Always wear your seat belt........................................................................................... 3-2
Restrain all children....................................................................................................... 3-2
Air bag hazards.............................................................................................................. 3-2
Driver distraction........................................................................................................... 3-2
Control your speed........................................................................................................ 3-2
Keep your vehicle in safe condition............................................................................. 3-2
Seats................................................................................................................... 3-3
Safety precautions........................................................................................................3-5
Front seats.....................................................................................................................3-6
Rear seats.................................................................................................................... 3-10
Headrest.......................................................................................................................3-12
Seat warmers and air ventilation seats...................................................................... 3-16
Seat belts...........................................................................................................3-19
Seat belt safety precautions....................................................................................... 3-19
Seat belt warning light................................................................................................3-20
Seat belt restraint system........................................................................................... 3-22
Additional seat belt safety precautions.....................................................................3-26
Care of seat belts........................................................................................................3-28
Child Restraint System (CRS).......................................................................... 3-29
Our recommendation: Children always in the rear...................................................3-29
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS)..................................................................3-30
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)..................................................................3-32
Air bag - supplemental restraint system.........................................................3-41
Where are the air bags?............................................................................................. 3-44
How does the air bags system operate?................................................................... 3-49
What to expect after an air bag inflates....................................................................3-52
Why didn’t my air bag go off in a collision?...............................................................3-53
SRS care.......................................................................................................................3-58
Additional safety precautions....................................................................................3-59
Air bag warning labels................................................................................................3-59
3
Safety system
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout this
section, and throughout this manual.
The safety precautions in this section are
among the most important.
Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all
types of accidents. Air bags are designed
to supplement seat belts, not replace
them. So even though your vehicle is
equipped with air bags, ALWAYS make
sure you and your passengers wear your
seat belts, and wear them properly.
Restrain all children
All children under age 13 should ride
in your vehicle properly restrained in a
rear seat, not the front seat. Infants and
small children should be restrained in
an appropriate Child Restraint System.
Larger children should use a booster
seat with the lap/shoulder belt until they
can use the seat belt properly without a
booster seat.
Air bag hazards
While air bags can save lives, they can
also cause serious or fatal injuries to
occupants who sit too close to them, or
who are not properly restrained. Infants,
young children, and short adults are at
the greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating air bag. Follow all instructions
and warnings in this manual.
Driver distraction
Driver distraction presents a serious and
potentially deadly danger, especially for
inexperienced drivers. Safety should be
the first concern when behind the wheel
and drivers need to be aware of the wide
array of potential distractions, such as
drowsiness, reaching for objects, eating,
personal grooming, other passengers,
and using cellular phones.
3-2
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel to
focus on activities other than driving.
To reduce your risk of distraction and an
accident:
• ALWAYS set up your mobile devices
(i.e., MP3 players, phones, navigation
units, etc.) when your vehicle is
parked or safely stopped.
• ONLY use your mobile device when
allowed by laws and conditions permit
safe use. NEVER text or email while
driving. Most countries have laws
prohibiting drivers from texting. Some
countries and cities also prohibit
drivers from using handheld phones.
• NEVER let the use of a mobile device
distract you from driving. You have a
responsibility to your passengers and
others on the road to always drive
safely, with your hands on the wheel
as well as your eyes and attention on
the road.
Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash
injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but
serious injuries can also occur at lower
speeds. Never drive faster than is safe
for current conditions, regardless of the
maximum speed posted.
Keep your vehicle in safe
condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical
failure can be extremely hazardous. To
reduce the possibility of such problems,
check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly
scheduled maintenance.
03
SEATS
Left-hand drive
OOSH039001L
Front seat
(1) Forward and backward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion height *
(4) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*
(5) Seat warmer*/Air ventilation seat*
(6) Headrest
Rear seat
(7) Armrest*
(8) Seatback folding
(9) Headrest
* : if equipped
3-3
Safety system
Right-hand drive
OOSH039001R
Front seat
(1) Forward and backward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion height *
(4) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*
(5) Seat warmer*/Air ventilation seat*
(6) Headrest
3-4
Rear seat
(7) Armrest*
(8) Seatback folding
(9) Headrest
* : if equipped
03
Safety precautions
Seat belts
Adjusting the seats so that you are sitting
in a safe, comfortable position plays an
important role in driver and passenger
safety, together with seat belts and air
bags, in an accident.
Always fasten your seat belt before
starting any trip. At all times, passengers
should sit upright and be properly
restrained. Infants and small children
must be restrained in appropriate Child
Restraint Systems. Children who have
outgrown a booster seat and adults must
be restrained using the seat belts.
WARNING
Do not use a cushion that reduces
friction between the seat and the
passenger. The passenger’s hips may
slide under the lap portion of the seat
belt during an accident or a sudden
stop.
Serious or fatal internal injuries could
result because the seat belt cannot
operate properly.
Air bags
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air bag.
Sitting too close to an air bag greatly
increases the risk of injury in the event
the air bag inflates. Move your seat as
far back as possible from front air bags,
while still maintaining control of the
vehicle.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat belt:
• NEVER use one seat belt for more
than one occupant.
• Always position the seatback upright
with the lap portion of the seat belt
snug and low across the hips.
• NEVER allow children or small infants
to ride on a passenger’s lap.
• Do not route the seat belt across your
neck, across sharp edges, or reroute
the shoulder strap away from your
body.
• Do not allow the seat belt to become
caught or jammed.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating air bag, take the
following precautions:
• Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the
rear as possible maintaining the
ability to control the vehicle.
• Adjust the front passenger seat as far
to the rear as possible.
• Hold the steering wheel by the rim
with hands at the 9 o’clock and 3
o’clock positions to minimize the risk
of injuries to your hands and arms.
• NEVER place anything or anyone
between you and the air bag.
• Do not allow the front passenger to
place feet or legs on the dashboard
to minimize the risk of leg injuries.
3-5
Safety system
Front seats
The front seat can be adjusted by using
the control lever (or knob) or switches
located on the outside of the seat
cushion. Before driving, adjust the seat
to the proper position so that you can
easily control the steering wheel, foot
pedals and controls on the instrument
panel.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat:
• NEVER attempt to adjust the seat
while the vehicle is moving. The seat
could respond with unexpected
movement and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
• Do not place anything under the
front seats. Loose objects in the
driver’s foot area could interfere
with the operation of the foot pedals,
causing an accident.
• Do not allow anything to interfere
with the normal position and proper
locking of the seatback.
• Do not place a cigarette lighter on
the floor or seat. When you operate
the seat, gas may exit out of the
lighter causing a fire.
• Use extreme caution when picking
up small objects trapped under the
seats or between the seat and the
center console. Your hands might be
cut or injured by the sharp edges of
the seat mechanism.
• If there are occupants in the rear
seats, be careful while adjusting the
front seat position.
• Make sure that the seat is locked in
place after the adjustment. If not,
the seat might move unexpectedly
resulting in an accident.
3-6
CAUTION
To prevent injury:
• Do not adjust your seat while
wearing your seat belt. Moving the
seat cushion forward may cause
strong pressure on your abdomen.
• Do not allow your hands or fingers to
get caught in the seat mechanisms
while the seat is moving.
Manual adjustment (if equipped)
OOSH039002L
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Pull up the seat slide adjustment lever
and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure
forward and rearward without using
locked properly.
03
OOSH039003L
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Lean forward slightly and lift up the
seatback lever.
2. Carefully lean back on the seat and
adjust the seatback to the position
you desire.
3. Release the knob and make sure the
seatback is locked in place.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly. When
the seatback is reclined, the shoulder
belt cannot do its job because it will not
be snug against your chest. Instead,
it will be in front of you. During an
accident, you could be thrown into the
seat belt, causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder
belt.
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts
and/or air bags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seatback.
WARNING
OOSH039004L
Seat cushion height (for driver’s seat)
To change the height of the seat cushion:
• Push down the lever several times, to
lower the seat cushion.
• Pull up the lever several times, to raise
the seat cushion.
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal
injuries in the event of a collision or
sudden stop.
Drivers and passengers should ALWAYS
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks upright.
3-7
Safety system
Power adjustment (if equipped)
WARNING
NEVER allow children in the vehicle
unattended. The power seats are
operable when the vehicle is turned off.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seats:
• Always stop adjusting the seats when
the seat has been adjusted as far
forward or rearward as possible.
• Do not adjust the seats longer than
necessary when the vehicle is turned
off. This may result in unnecessary
battery drain.
• Do not operate two or more seats at
the same time. This may result in an
electrical malfunction.
OOSH039006L
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seatback
reaches the desired position.
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts and
air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining
your seatback.
WARNING
OOSH039005L
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
3-8
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal
injuries in the event of a collision or
sudden stop.
Driver and passengers should ALWAYS
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks upright.
03
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly. When
the seatback is reclined, the shoulder
belt cannot do its job because it will not
be snug against your chest. Instead,
it will be in front of you. During an
accident, you could be thrown into the
seat belt, causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder
belt.
OOSH039008L
Lumbar support
(for driver’s seat, if equipped)
To adjust the lumbar support:
1. Press the front portion of the switch
(1) to increase support or the rear
portion of the switch (2) to decrease
support.
2. Release the switch once it reaches the
desired position.
Seatback pocket (if equipped)
OOSH039007L
Seat cushion tilt (1, if equipped)
To change the angle of the front part of
the seat cushion:
Push the front portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower the
front part of the seat cushion.
Release the switch once the seat reaches
the desired position.
Seat cushion height (2, if equipped)
To change the height of the seat cushion:
Push the rear portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower the
height of the seat cushion.
Release the switch once the seat reaches
the desired position.
OOSH039009L
The seatback pocket is provided on the
back of the front seatbacks.
CAUTION
Do not put heavy or sharp objects in the
seatback pockets. In an accident they
could come loose from the pocket and
injure occupants.
3-9
Safety system
Rear seats
Folding the rear seat
The rear seatbacks can be folded to
facilitate carrying long items or to
increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
WARNING
• Never allow passengers to sit on top
of the folded down seatback while
the vehicle is moving. This is not a
proper seating position and no seat
belts are available for use. This could
result in serious injury or death in
case of an accident or sudden stop.
• Objects carried on the folded down
seatback should not extend higher
than the top of the front seatbacks.
This could allow cargo to slide
forward and cause injury or damage
during sudden stops.
OOSH039011L
3. Locate the seatbelt toward the
outboard position before folding
down the seatback. If not, the seatbelt
system may be interfered by the
seatback.
OOSH039012L
OOSH039010L
To fold down the rear seatback:
1. Set the front seatback to the upright
position and if necessary, slide the
front seat forward.
2. Lower the rear headrests to the lowest
position by pushing and holding the
release button (1) and pushing down
on the headrest (2).
3-10
OOSH039013L
4. Remove the belt from the guide (1)
and pull up the seatback folding lever
(2), then fold the seat toward the front
of the vehicle.
03
WARNING
Make sure the engine is off, the shift
lever is in P (Park), and the parking
brake is securely applied whenever
loading or unloading cargo. Failure to
take these steps may allow the vehicle
to move if the shift lever is inadvertently
moved to another position.
OOSH039014L
5. To use the rear seat, lift and push the
seatback rearward.
Push the seatback firmly until it clicks
into place. Make sure the seatback is
locked in place.
Return the belt in the guide.
WARNING
When returning the rear seatback from
a folded to an upright position, hold the
seatback and return it slowly. Ensure
that the seatback is completely locked
into its upright position by pushing on
the top of the seatback. In an accident
or sudden stop, the unlocked seatback
could allow cargo to move forward with
great force and enter the passenger
compartment, which could result in
serious injury or death.
NOTICE
• Be careful when loading cargo
through the rear passenger seats
to prevent damage to the vehicle
interior.
• When cargo is loaded through the
rear passenger seats, ensure the
cargo is properly secured to prevent
it from moving while driving.
WARNING
Cargo should always be secured to
prevent it from being thrown about the
vehicle in a collision and causing injury
to the vehicle occupants. Do not place
objects in the rear seats, since they
cannot be properly secured and may hit
the front seat occupants in a collision.
Armrest (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not place objects in the rear seats,
since they cannot be properly secured
and may hit vehicle occupants in a
collision causing serious injury or death.
OOSH039015L
The armrest is located in the center of
the rear seat. Pull the armrest down by
using the strap from the seatback to use
it.
3-11
Safety system
NOTICE
Headrest
The vehicle’s front and rear seats have
adjustable headrests. The headrests
provide comfort for passengers, but
more importantly they are designed to
help protect passengers from whiplash
and other neck and spinal injuries during
an accident, especially in a rear impact
collision.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death in an accident, take the following
precautions when adjusting your
headrests:
• Always properly adjust the headrests
for all passengers BEFORE starting
the vehicle.
• NEVER let anyone ride in a seat with
the headrest removed or reversed.
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull
on the headrests.
CAUTION
When there is no occupant in the rear
seats, adjust the height of the headrest
to the lowest position. The rear seat
headrest can reduce the visibility of the
rear area.
Front seat headrests
OOSH039016L
The driver’s and front passenger’s seats
are equipped with adjustable headrests
for the passengers safety and comfort.
OHI039190N
• Adjust the headrests so the middle of
the headrest is at the same height as
the height of the top of the eyes.
• NEVER adjust the headrest position
of the driver’s seat when the vehicle
is in motion.
• Adjust the headrest as close to the
passenger’s head as possible. Do
not use a seat cushion that holds the
body away from the seatback.
• Make sure the headrest locks into
position after adjusting it.
3-12
03
NOTICE
OOSH039017L
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the headrest:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the headrest:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the headrest support.
2. Lower the headrest to the desired
position (3).
OHI038136
If you recline the seatback towards
the front with the headrest and seat
cushion raised, the headrest may come
in contact with the sunvisor or other
parts of the vehicle.
OOSH039018L
Forward and rearward adjustment
The headrest may be adjusted forward
to 3 different positions by pulling the
headrest forward to the desired detent.
To adjust the headrest to it’s furthest
rearwards position, pull it fully forward to
the farthest position and release it.
3-13
Safety system
Type A
Type A
OOSH039019L
Type B
OOSH039021L
Type B
OOSH039020L
OOSH039022L
Removal/Reinstall
To remove the headrest:
1. Recline the seatback (2) with using
the seatback angle lever or switch (1).
2. Raise the headrest as far as it can go.
3. Press the headrest release button (3)
while pulling the headrest up (4).
To reinstall the headrest :
1. Recline the seatback.
2. Put the headrest poles (2) into the
holes while pressing the release
button (1).
3. Adjust the headrest to the appropriate
height.
4. Recline the seatback (4) the seatback
angle lever or switch (3).
WARNING
NEVER allow anyone to travel in a seat
with the headrest removed.
3-14
WARNING
Always make sure the headrest locks
into position after reinstalling and
adjusting it properly.
03
Rear seat headrests
OOSH039024L
OOSH039023L
The rear seats are equipped with
headrests in all the seating positions for
the passenger’s safety and comfort.
CAUTION
• Adjust the headrests so the middle of
the headrest is at the same height as
the height of the top of the eyes.
Adjusting the height up and down
To remove the headrest:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the headrest:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the headrest support.
2. Lower the headrest to the desired
position (3).
• When sitting on the rear seat, do not
adjust the height of the headrest to
the lowest.
OOSH039025L
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the headrest:
1. Raise the headrest as far as it can go.
2. Press the headrest release button (1)
while pulling the headrest up (2).
To reinstall the headrest:
1. Put the headrest poles into the holes
(3) while pressing the release button
(1).
2. Adjust the headrest to the appropriate
height.
3-15
Safety system
Seat warmers and air ventilation
seats
Front seat warmers (if equipped)
Seat warmers are provided to warm the
seats during cold weather.
WARNING
The seat warmers can cause a SERIOUS
BURN, even at low temperatures and
especially if used for long periods of
time.
Passengers must be able to feel if the
seat is becoming too warm so they can
turn it off, if needed.
People who cannot detect temperature
change or pain to the skin should
use extreme caution, especially the
following types of passengers:
• Infants, children, elderly or disabled
persons, or hospital outpatients.
• People with sensitive skin or who
burn easily.
• Fatigued individuals.
• Intoxicated individuals.
• People taking medication that can
cause drowsiness or sleepiness.
WARNING
NEVER place anything on the seat
that insulates against heat when the
seat warmer is in operation, such as a
blanket or seat cushion. This may cause
the seat warmer to overheat, causing a
burn or damage to the seat.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seat warmers
and seats:
• Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline
to clean the seats.
• Do not place heavy or sharp objects
on seats equipped with seat
warmers.
• Do not change the seat cover. It may
damage the seat warmer.
OOSH039026L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
While the vehicle is in the ready ( )
mode, push either of the switches
to warm the driver’s seat or front
passenger’s seat.
3-16
03
During mild weather or under conditions
where the operation of the seat warmer
is not needed, keep the switches in the
OFF position.
• Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows :
OFF → HIGH (
) → MIDDLE (
) → LOW (
Rear seat warmers (if equipped)
)
• When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the seat warmer
operating, the seat warmer will turn
OFF.
• The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position whenever the ignition switch
is placed to the ON position.
Information
With the seat warmer switch in the ON
position, the heating system in the seat
turns off or on automatically depending on
the seat temperature.
OOSH039027L
While the vehicle is in the ready ( )
mode, push either of the switches to
warm the rear seat. During mild weather
or under conditions where the operation
of the seat warmer is not needed, keep
the switches in the OFF position.
Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows :
OFF → HIGH (
) → LOW (
)
The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position whenever the ignition switch is
in the ON position.
Information
With the seat warmer switch in the ON
position, the heating system in the seat
turns off or on automatically depending on
the seat temperature.
3-17
Safety system
NOTICE
Front air ventilation seat
(if equipped)
OOSH039028L
The air ventilation seats are provided
to cool the front seats by blowing air
through small vent holes on the surface
of the seat cushions and seatbacks.
When the operation of the air ventilation
seat is not needed, keep the switches in
the OFF position.
While the vehicle is in the ready ( )
mode, push the switch to cool the
driver’s seat or the front passenger’s
seat.
• Each time you push the switch, the
airflow changes as follows:
OFF → HIGH (
) → MIDDLE (
) → LOW (
• When pressing the switch for
more than 1.5 seconds with the
air ventilation seat operating, the
operation will turn OFF.
• The air ventilation seats defaults
to the OFF position whenever the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position.
3-18
)
To prevent damage to the air ventilation
seat:
• Use the air ventilation seat ONLY
when the climate control system
is on. Using the air ventilation seat
for prolonged periods of time with
the climate control system off could
cause the air ventilation seat to
malfunction.
• Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline
to clean the seats.
• Avoid spilling liquids on the surface
of the front seats and seatbacks;
this may cause the air vent holes
to become blocked and not work
properly.
• Do not place materials such as
plastic bags or newspapers under
the seats. They may block the air
intake causing the air vents to not
work properly.
• Do not change the seat covers. It may
damage the air ventilation seat.
• If the air vents do not operate, restart
the vehicle. If there is no change,
we recommend that you have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
03
SEAT BELTS
This section describes how to use the
seat belts properly. It also describes
some of the things not to do when using
seat belts.
Seat belt safety precautions
Always fasten your seat belt and make
sure all passengers have fastened their
seat belts before starting any trip. Air
bags are designed to supplement the
seat belt as an additional safety device,
but they are not a substitute. Most
countries require all occupants of a
vehicle to wear seat belts.
WARNING
Seat belts must be used by ALL
passengers whenever the vehicle is
moving. Take the following precautions
when adjusting and wearing seat belts:
• Children under the age of 13 should
be properly restrained in the rear
seats.
• Never allow children to ride in the
front passenger seat, unless the air
bag is deactivated. If a child is seated
in the front passenger seat, move
the seat as far back as possible and
properly restrain them in the seat.
• NEVER allow an infant or child to be
carried on an occupant’s lap.
• NEVER ride with the seatback
reclined when the vehicle is moving.
• Do not allow children to share a seat
or seat belt.
• Do not wear the shoulder belt under
your arm or behind your back.
• Never wear a seat belt over fragile
objects. If there is a sudden stop or
impact, the seat belt can damage it.
• Do not use the seat belt if it is
twisted. A twisted seat belt will not
protect you properly in an accident.
• Do not use a seat belt if the webbing
or hardware is damaged.
• Do not latch the seat belt into the
buckles of other seats.
• NEVER unfasten the seat belt
while driving. This may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
• Make sure there is nothing in the
buckle interfering with the seat belt
latch mechanism. This may prevent
the seat belt from fastening securely.
• No modifications or additions
should be made by the user which
will either prevent the seat belt
adjusting devices from operating to
remove slack, or prevent the seat
belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
WARNING
Damaged seat belts and seat belt
assemblies will not operate properly.
Always replace:
• Frayed, contaminated, or damaged
webbing.
• Damaged hardware.
• The entire seat belt assembly after it
has been worn in an accident, even
if damage to webbing or assembly is
not apparent.
3-19
Safety system
Seat belt warning light
Seat belt warning
Instrument cluster
OOSH039030L
OOSH039029L
Driver’s seat belt warning
As a reminder to the driver, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds each time you
turn the ignition switch ON regardless of
belt fastening.
If the seat belt is not fastened when the
ignition switch is turned ON or if it is
disconnected after the ignition switch
is turned ON, the seat belt warning light
will illuminate until the belt is fastened.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding warning light will
continue to illuminate until you fasten
the seat belt.
If you continue to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive over 20 km/h (12
mph), the seat belt warning chime will
sound for approximately 100 seconds
and the corresponding warning light will
blink.
3-20
Front passenger’s seat belt warning
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger’s seat belt warning
light will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch ON regardless of belt fastening.
If the seat belt is not fastened when the
ignition switch is turned ON or if it is
disconnected after the ignition switch
is turned ON, the seat belt warning light
will illuminate until the belt is fastened.
If you start to drive without the seat belt
fastened or you unfasten the seat belt
when you drive under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding warning light will
continue to illuminate until you fasten
the seat belt.
If you continue to drive without the seat
belt fastened or you unfasten the seat
belt when you drive over 20 km/h (12
mph), the seat belt warning chime will
sound for approximately 100 seconds
and the corresponding warning light will
blink.
03
WARNING
Riding in an improper position
adversely affects the front passenger’s
seat belt warning system. It is important
for the driver to instruct the passenger
to properly be seated as instructed in
this manual.
Information
• You can find the front passenger’s seat
belt warning light on the center fascia
panel.
• Although the front passenger seat is not
occupied, the seat belt warning light
will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.
• The front passenger’s seat belt warning
may operate when luggage is placed on
the front passenger seat.
OOSH039031L
Rear passenger’s seat belt warning
As a reminder to the rear passengers,
the rear passenger’s seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you turn the ignition
switch ON regardless of belt fastening.
And then, the rear corresponding seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 70 seconds if the rear seat
belt is not fastened.
If the rear seatbelt is unfasten when
vehicle speed is under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding seatbelt warning light
will illuminate for 70 seconds.
If the rear seatbelt is unfasten when
vehicle speed is over 20 km/h (12 mph),
the corresponding seatbelt warning light
will blink and warning chime will sound
for 35 seconds.
However, if the rear door is opened when
vehicle speed is under 20 km/h (12 mph),
the seatbelt warning light and chime will
not operate when vehicle speed is over
20 km/h (12 mph).
3-21
Safety system
NOTICE
Seat belt restraint system
Lap/shoulder belt
If you are not able to smoothly pull
enough of the seat belt out from the
retractor, firmly pull the seat belt out
and release it. After release, you will be
able to pull the belt out smoothly.
WARNING
OHI038140
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull it out of the retractor and insert the
metal tab (1) into the buckle (2). There
will be an audible “click” when the tab
locks into the buckle.
OHI038182L
OHI038137
You should place the lap belt (1) portion
across your hips and the shoulder belt (2)
portion across your chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to the
proper length after the lap belt portion
is adjusted manually so that it fits snugly
around your hips. If you lean forward in
a slow, easy motion, the belt will extend
and move with you.
If there is a sudden stop or impact, the
belt will lock into position. It will also lock
if you try to lean forward too quickly.
3-22
Improperly positioned seat belts may
increase the risk of serious injury
in an accident. Take the following
precautions when adjusting the seat
belt:
• Position the lap portion of the seat
belt as low as possible across your
hips, not on your waist, so that it
fits snugly. This allows your strong
pelvic bones to absorb the force of
the crash, reducing the chance of
internal injuries.
• Position one arm under the shoulder
belt and the other over the belt, as
shown in the illustration.
• Always position the shoulder belt
anchor into the locked position at the
appropriate height.
• Never position the shoulder belt
across your neck or face.
03
Height adjustment
You can adjust the height of the shoulder
belt anchor to one of the four different
positions for maximum comfort and
safety.
The shoulder portion should be adjusted
so it lies across your chest and midway
over your shoulder nearest the door, not
over your neck.
Front seat
OHI038142
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the locking
buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen, check
the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then
try again.
OOSH039032L
To adjust the height of the seat belt
anchor, lower or raise the height adjuster
into an appropriate position.
To raise the height adjuster, pull it up
(1). To lower it, push it down (3) while
pressing the height adjuster button (2).
Release the button to lock the anchor
into position. Try sliding the height
adjuster to make sure that it has locked
into position.
3-23
Safety system
Rear center seatbelt
(3-point rear center seat belt)
Pre-tensioner seat belt
OHI038143L
OOSH039033L
When using the rear center seat belt, the
buckle with the “CENTER” mark must be
used.
Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety
belt from the retractor, firmly pull the belt
out and release it. After release, you will be
able to pull the belt out smoothly.
WARNING
Make sure that the seatback is locked in
place when using the rear center seat
belt.
If not, the seatback may move when
there is a sudden stop or collision,
which could result in serious injury.
3-24
Your vehicle is equipped with driver’s and
front passenger’s and rear passengers
Pre-tensioner Seat Belts (Retractor
Pre-tensioner). The purpose of the pretensioner is to make sure the seat belts
fit tightly against the occupant’s body
in certain frontal or side collision(s).
The pre-tensioner seat belts may be
activated in crashes where the frontal
or side collision(s) is severe enough,
together with the air bags.
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or if
the occupant tries to lean forward too
quickly, the seat belt retractor will lock
into position.
In certain frontal collisions, the pretensioner will activate and pull the seat
belt into tighter contact against the
occupant’s body.
If the system senses excessive tension
on the driver or passenger’s seat belt
when the pre-tensioner system activates,
the load limiter inside the retractor
pre-tensioner will release some of the
pressure on the affected seat belt.
03
WARNING
• Always wear your seat belt and sit
properly in your seat.
• Do not use the seat belt if it is loose
or twisted. A loose or twisted seat
belt will not protect you properly in
an accident.
• Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely affect
the buckle and cause it to function
improperly.
• Always replace your pre-tensioners
after activation or an accident.
• NEVER inspect, service, repair or
replace the pre-tensioners yourself.
This must be done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
OHI038175L
WARNING
Do not touch the pre-tensioner seat
belt assemblies for several minutes
after they have been activated. When
the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the pretensioner can become hot and can burn
you.
CAUTION
Body work on the front area of the
vehicle may damage the pre-tensioner
seat belt system. Therefore, we
recommend the system to be serviced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSH039034L
The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System
consists mainly of the following
components. Their locations are shown
in the illustration above:
(1) SRS air bag warning light
(2) Retractor pre-tensioner
(3) SRS control module
(4) Rear Retractor pre-tensioner
3-25
Safety system
NOTICE
The sensor that activates the SRS
control module is connected with the
pre–tensioner seat belts. The SRS air
bag warning light on the instrument
cluster will illuminate for approximately
6 seconds after the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position, and then it
should turn off.
If the pre-tensioner is not working
properly, the warning light will
illuminate even if the SRS air bag is not
malfunctioning. If the warning light
does not illuminate, stays illuminated
or illuminates when the vehicle is
being driven, we recommend the pretensioner seat belts and/or SRS control
module be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
Information
• Both the driver’s and front passenger’s
pre-tensioner seat belts may be
activated in certain frontal or side
collisions.
• When the pre-tensioner seat belts are
activated, a loud noise may be heard
and fine dust, which may appear to be
smoke, may be visible in the passenger
compartment. These are normal
operating conditions and are not
hazardous.
• Although it is non-toxic, the fine dust
may cause skin irritation and should
not be inhaled for prolonged periods.
Wash all exposed skin areas thoroughly
after an accident in which the pretensioner seat belts were activated.
3-26
Additional seat belt safety
precautions
Seat belt use during pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat belt.
Pregnant women should always wear
a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed
between your breasts and away from
your neck. Place the lap belt below your
belly so that it fits SNUGLY across your
hips and pelvic bone, under the rounded
part of the belly.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to an unborn child during an
accident, pregnant women should
NEVER place the lap portion of the
seat belt above or over the area of the
abdomen where the unborn child is
located.
Seat belt use and children
Infant and small children
Most countries have Child Restraint
System laws which require children to
travel in approved Child Restraint System
devices, including booster seats. The age
at which seat belts can be used instead
of Child Restraint System differs among
countries, so you should be aware of the
specific requirements in your country,
and where you are travelling. Infant and
Child Restraint System must be properly
placed and installed in a rear seat.
For more information refer to the “Child
Restraint Systems” section in this
chapter.
03
WARNING
ALWAYS properly restrain infants and
small children in a Child Restraint
System appropriate for the child’s
height and weight.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to a child and other passengers,
NEVER hold a child in your lap or arms
when the vehicle is moving. The violent
forces created during an accident will
tear the child from your arms and throw
the child against the interior of the
vehicle.
Small children are best protected from
injury in an accident when properly
restrained in the rear seat by a Child
Restraint System that meets the
requirements of the Safety Standards of
your country. Before buying any Child
Restraint System, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets Safety
Standard of your country.
The Child Restraint System must be
appropriate for your child’s height and
weight. Check the label on the Child
Restraint System for this information.
Refer to “Child Restraint Systems”
section in this chapter.
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are
too large for a booster seat should
always occupy the rear seat and use the
available lap/shoulder belts. A seat belt
should lie across the upper thighs and
be snug across the shoulder and chest
to restrain the child safely. Check belt fit
periodically. A child’s squirming could
put the belt out of position. In the event
of an accident, children are afforded the
best safety restrained by a proper Child
Restraint System in the rear seats.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child must
be securely restrained by the available
lap/shoulder belt and the seat should be
placed in the rearmost position.
If the shoulder belt portion slightly
touches the child’s neck or face, try
placing the child closer to the center
of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still
touches their face or neck, they need to
be returned to an appropriate booster
seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
• Always make sure larger children’s
seat belts are worn and properly
adjusted.
• NEVER allow the shoulder belt to
contact the child’s neck or face.
• Do not allow more than one child to
use a single seat belt.
Seat belt use and injured people
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific
recommendations.
3-27
Safety system
One person per belt
Care of seat belts
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition,
care should be taken to assure that seat
belts and belt hardware are not damaged
by seat hinges, doors or other abuse.
Do not lie down
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts
and/or air bags) is greatly reduced by
reclining your seatback.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
During an accident, you could be thrown
into the seat belt, causing neck or other
injuries.
The more the seat back is reclined, the
greater the chance for the passenger’s
hips to slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck to strike the shoulder
belt.
WARNING
• NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
• Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
• Driver and passengers should always
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks
upright.
3-28
Periodic inspection
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of any
kind. Any damaged parts should be
replaced as soon as possible.
Keep belts clean and dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution
and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong
detergents or abrasives should not be
used because they may damage and
weaken the fabric.
When to replace seat belts
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident.
This should be done even if no damage is
visible. We recommend that you consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (CRS)
Our recommendation: Children
always in the rear
WARNING
Always properly restrain children in the
vehicle. Children of all ages are safer
when riding in the rear seats. Never
place a rearward-facing Child Restraint
System on the front passenger seat,
unless the air bag is deactivated.
Children under age 13 should always
ride in the rear seats and must always be
properly restrained to minimize the risk
of injury in an accident, sudden stop or
sudden maneuver.
According to accident statistics, children
are safer when properly restrained in the
rear seats than in the front seat. Children
too large for a Child Restraint System
must use the seat belts provided.
Most countries have regulations which
require children to travel in approved
Child Restraint Systems.
The laws governing the age or height/
weight restrictions at which seat belts
can be used instead of Child Restraint
System differs among countries, so
you should be aware of the specific
requirements in your country, and where
you are travelling.
Child Restraint Systems must be properly
installed in the vehicle seat. Always use
a commercially available Child Restraint
System that meets the requirements of
your country.
Child Restraint System (CRS)
Infants and younger children must be
restrained in an appropriate rearwardfacing or forward-facing CRS that has
first been properly secured to the seat
of the vehicle. Read and comply with
the instructions for installation and use
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
WARNING
• Always follow the Child Restraint
System manufacturer’s instructions
for installation and use.
• Always properly restrain your child in
the Child Restraint System.
• Do not use an infant carrier or a
child safety seat that “hooks” over
a seatback, it may not provide
adequate protection in an accident.
• After an accident, we recommend
a HYUNDAI dealer to check the
Child Restraint System, seat belts,
ISOFIX anchorages and top-tether
anchorages.
3-29
Safety system
Selecting a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
When selecting a Child Restraint System
for your child, always:
• Make sure the Child Restraint System
has a label certifying that it meets
applicable Safety Standards of your
country.
A Child Restraint System may only
be installed if it was approved in
accordance with the requirements of
ECE-R44 or ECE-R129.
• Select a Child Restraint System based
on your child’s height and weight. The
required label or the instructions for
use typically provide this information.
• Select a Child Restraint System that
fits the vehicle seating position where
it will be used.
• Read and comply with the warnings
and instructions for installation and
use provided with the Child Restraint
System.
Child Restraint System types
There are three main types of Child
Restraint Systems: rearward-facing,
forward-facing and booster Child
Restraint Systems.
They are classified according to the
child’s age, height and weight.
3-30
OOSH039035L
Rearward-facing Child Restraint System
A rearward-facing Child Restraint System
provides restraint with the seating
surface against the back of the child. The
harness system holds the child in place,
and in an accident, acts to keep the child
positioned in the Child Restraint Systems
and reduce the stress to the fragile neck
and spinal cord.
All children under the age of one year
must always ride in a rearward-facing
Child Restraint System. There are
different types of rearward-facing Child
Restraint Systems: infant-only Child
Restraint Systems can only be used
rearward-facing. Convertible and 3-in-1
Child Restraint Systems typically have
higher height and weight limits for the
rearward-facing position, allowing you
to keep your child rearward-facing for a
longer period of time.
Keep using Child Restraint Systems in
the rearward-facing position as long as
children fit within the height and weight
limits allowed by the Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer.
03
OOSH039036L
Forward-facing Child Restraint System
A forward-facing Child Restraint System
provides restraint for the child’s body
with a harness. Keep children in a
forward-facing Child Restraint System
with a harness until they reach the top
height or weight limit allowed by your
Child Restraint System’s manufacturer.
Once your child outgrows the forwardfacing Child Restraint System, your child
is ready for a booster seat.
Booster seats
A booster seat is a Child Restraint
System designed to improve the fit of
the vehicle’s seat belt system. A booster
seat positions the seat belt so that it
fits properly over the stronger parts of
your child’s body. Keep your children in
booster seats until they are big enough
to fit in a seat belt properly.
For a seat belt to fit properly, the lap belt
must lie comfortable across the upper
thighs, not the stomach. The shoulder
belt should lie comfortable across the
shoulder and chest and not across the
neck or face. Children under age 13
must always be properly restrained to
minimize the risk of injury in an accident,
sudden stop or sudden maneuver.
3-31
Safety system
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
Before installing your Child Restraint
System always:
Read and follow the instructions
provided by the manufacturer of the
Child Restraint System.
Failure to follow all warnings and
instructions could increase the risk of
the SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if an
accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle headrest prevents proper
installation of a Child Restraint System,
the headrest of the respective seating
position shall be readjusted or entirely
removed.
After selecting a proper Child Restraint
System for your child and checking that
the Child Restraint System fits properly
on the seating position, there are three
general steps for a proper installation:
• Properly secure the Child Restraint
System to the vehicle. All Child
Restraint Systems must be secured
to the vehicle with the lap belt or lap
part of a lap/shoulder belt or with
the ISOFIX top-tether and/or ISOFIX
anchorage and/or with the support
leg.
3-32
• Make sure the Child Restraint System
is firmly secured. After installing a
Child Restraint System to the vehicle,
push and pull the seat forward and
from side-to-side to verify that it is
securely attached to the seat. A Child
Restraint System secured with a seat
belt should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-to-side
movement can be expected.
When installing a Child Restraint
System, adjust the vehicle seat and
seatback (up and down, forward
and rearward) so that your child fits
in the Child Restraint System in a
confortable manner.
• Secure the child in the Child
Restraint System. Make sure the
child is properly strapped in the Child
Restraint System according to the
Child Restraint System manufacturer’s
instructions.
CAUTION
A Child Restraint System in a closed
vehicle can become very hot. To prevent
burns, check the seating surface and
buckles before placing your child in the
Child Restraint System.
03
Suitability of each seating position for belted & ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems according to UN regulations (for Europe) (Information for vehicle
users and CRS manufacturers)
•
•
•
•
Yes : Suitable for fitment of the designated category of CRS
No : Not suitable for fitment of the designated category of CRS
‘’-’’ : Not applicable
The table is based on LHD vehicle. Except for the front passenger seat, the table is
valid for RHD vehicle. For RHD vehicle front passenger seat, please use information
for the seating position number 3.
CRS categories
Seating positions
1
2
3
4
5
6
Universal belted CRS
-
-
Yes1)
F, R
Yes
F, R
Yes2)
F, R
Yes
F, R
i-size CRS
-
-
No
Yes
F, R
No
Yes
F, R
ISOFIX infant
CRS
(i.e. CRS for a
baby)
ISOFIX
( R1 )
-
-
No
Yes
R
No
Yes
R
Carry cot
(ISOFIX lateral
facing CRS)
ISOFIX
( L1,L2 )
-
-
No
No
No
No
ISOFIX
ISOFIX toddler
( F2,F2X,
CRS - small
R2X )
-
-
No
Yes
F, R
No
Yes
F, R
ISOFIX toddler
CRS – large*
ISOFIX
(* : not booster ( F3, R3 )
seats)
-
-
No
Yes3)
F, R
No
Yes3)
F, R
Booster Seat –
reduced Width
ISO CRF
: B2
-
-
No
Yes
No
Yes
Booster Seat –
full Width
ISO CRF
: B3
-
-
No
No
No
No
Seat number
Seating position
F : Forward facing
R : Rearward facing
Position in the
vehicle
Seat number
OOSEV038035L
Position in the
vehicle
1
Front left
4
2nd row left
2
Front center
5
2nd row center
3
Front right
6
2nd row right
3-33
Safety system
Note1) : You should adjust seatback or seat pumping(if equipped) properly.
Note2) : The seating position(number 5) is not suitable for fitment of child restraint
system with support leg.
Note3) : For fitment of ISOFIX toddler’s rearward facing large CRS
-- Driver’s seat : Seat pumping should be adjusted to appropriate height.
-- Front passenger seat : Seat sliding should be adjusted to appropriate
position.
ÃÃ Never place a rearward facing Child Restraint System on the front passenger seat,
unless the passenger air bag is deactivated.
ÃÃ For semi-universal or vehicle specific CRS (ISOFIX or belted CRS), please see the
vehicle list provided in the manual of CRS.
ÃÃ It is recommended to remove the head restraint, when CRS is unstable due to head
restraint
Recommended Child Restraint Systems (for Europe)
Mass group
Name
Manufacturer
Type of Fixation
ECE-R44/R129
Approval No.
Group 0+
Cabriofix &
Familyfix
Maxi Cosi
ISOFIX
E4 04443907
Group I
Duo Plus
Britax Römer
ISOFIX and toptether
E1 04301133
Group II
KidFix II XP
Britax Römer
ISOFIX and
vehicle belt
E1 04301323
Group III
Junior III
Graco
Vehicle belt
E11 03.44.164
E11 03.44.165
CRS Manufacturer information
Maxi Cosi Cabriofix & Familyfix http://www.maxi-cosi.com
Britax Römer http://www.britax.com
Graco http://www.gracobaby.com
3-34
03
Suitability of each seating position for belted & ISOFIX Child Restraint
Systems according to UN regulations (except Europe) (Information for
vehicle users and CRS manufacturers)
•
•
•
•
Yes : Suitable for fitment of the designated category of CRS
No : Not suitable for fitment of the designated category of CRS
‘’-’’ : Not applicable
The table is based on LHD vehicle. Except for the front passenger seat, the table is
valid for RHD vehicle. For RHD vehicle front passenger seat, please use information
for the seating position number 3.
CRS categories
Seating positions
1
2
3
4
5
6
Universal belted CRS
-
-
Yes1)
F, R
Yes
F, R
Yes2)
F, R
Yes
F, R
i-size CRS
-
-
No
Yes
F, R
No
Yes
F, R
ISOFIX infant
CRS
(i.e. CRS for a
baby)
ISOFIX
( R1 )
-
-
No
Yes
R
No
Yes
R
Carry cot
(ISOFIX lateral
facing CRS)
ISOFIX
( L1,L2 )
-
-
No
No
No
No
ISOFIX
ISOFIX toddler
( F2,F2X,
CRS - small
R2X )
-
-
No
Yes
F, R
No
Yes
F, R
ISOFIX toddler
CRS – large*
ISOFIX
(* : not booster ( F3, R3 )
seats)
-
-
No
Yes3)
F, R
No
Yes3)
F, R
Booster Seat –
reduced Width
ISO CRF
: B2
-
-
No
Yes
No
Yes
Booster Seat –
full Width
ISO CRF
: B3
-
-
No
No
No
No
Seat number
Seating position
F : Forward facing
R : Rearward facing
Position in the
vehicle
Seat number
OOSEV038035L
Position in the
vehicle
1
Front left
4
2nd row left
2
Front center
5
2nd row center
3
Front right
6
2nd row right
3-35
Safety system
Note1) : You should adjust seatback or seat pumping(if equipped) properly.
Note2) : The seating position(number 5) is not suitable for fitment of child restraint
system with support leg.
Note3) : For fitment of ISOFIX toddler’s rearward facing large CRS
-- Driver’s seat : Seat pumping should be adjusted to appropriate height.
-- Front passenger seat : Seat sliding should be adjusted to appropriate
position.
ÃÃ Never place a rearward facing Child Restraint System on the front passenger seat,
unless the passenger air bag is deactivated.
ÃÃ For semi-universal or vehicle specific CRS (ISOFIX or belted CRS), please see the
vehicle list provided in the manual of CRS.
ÃÃ It is recommended to remove the head restraint, when CRS is unstable due to head
restraint
3-36
03
ISOFIX anchorage and top-tether
anchorage (ISOFIX anchorage
system) for children
The ISOFIX system holds a Child
Restraint System during driving and in
an accident. This system is designed
to make installation of the Child
Restraint System easier and reduce
the possibility of improperly installing
your Child Restraint System. The ISOFIX
system uses anchors in the vehicle and
attachments on the Child Restraint
System. The ISOFIX system eliminates
the need to use seat belts to secure the
Child Restraint System to the rear seats.
ISOFIX anchorages are metal bars built
into the vehicle. There are two lower
anchors for each ISOFIX seating position
that will accommodate a Child Restraint
System with lower attachments.
To use the ISOFIX system in your vehicle,
you must have a Child Restraint System
with ISOFIX attachments.
The Child Restraint System manufacturer
will provide you with instructions on how
to use the Child Restraint System with its
attachments for the ISOFIX anchorages.
WARNING
Do not attempt to install a Child
Restraint System using ISOFIX
anchorages in the rear center
seating position. There are no ISOFIX
anchorages provided for this seat.
Using the outboard seat anchorages, for
the CRS installation on the rear center
seating position, can damage the
anchorages.
OOSH039038L
[A] : ISOFIX Anchorage Position Indicator,
[B] : ISOFIX Anchorage
ISOFIX anchorages are located between
the seatback and the seat cushion of the
rear seat left and right outboard seating
positions, indicated by the symbols .
Securing a Child Restraint System
with the “ISOFIX Anchorage System”
OOSH039037L
ISOFIX anchorages have been provided
in the left and right outboard rear seating
positions. Their locations are shown in
the illustration.
To install an i-Size or ISOFIX-compatible
Child Restraint System in either of the
rear outboard seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away from
the ISOFIX anchorages.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchorages that could prevent
a secure connection between the
Child Restraint System and the ISOFIX
anchorages.
3-37
Safety system
3. Place the Child Restraint System on
the vehicle seat, then attach the seat
to the ISOFIX anchorages according to
the instructions provided by the Child
Restraint System manufacturer.
4. Follow the instructions of the Child
Restraint System’s manufacturer for
proper installation and connection
of the ISOFIX attachments on the
Child Restraint System to the ISOFIX
anchorages.
Securing a Child Restraint System
seat with “Top-tether Anchorage”
system
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the ISOFIX system:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
• To prevent the child from reaching
and taking hold of unretracted
seat belts, buckle all unused rear
seat belts and retract the seat belt
webbing behind the child. Children
can be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around their neck
and the seat belt tightens.
• NEVER attach more than one
Child Restraint System to a single
anchorage. This could cause the
anchor or attachment to come loose
or break.
• Always have the ISOFIX system
inspected by your dealer after an
accident. An accident can damage
the ISOFIX system and may not
properly secure the Child Restraint
System.
3-38
OOSH039039L
Top-tether anchorages for Child Restraint
Systems are located on the rear of the
seatbacks.
OOSH039040L
1. Route the Child Restraint System toptether strap over the seatback. Placing
the top tether strap, please follow
the instructions of the Child Restraint
System manufacturer.
2. Connect the top-tether strap to the
top-tether anchorage, then tighten
the top-tether strap according to the
instructions of your Child Restraint
System’s manufacturer to firmly
attach the Child Restraint System to
the seat.
03
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
installing the top-tether:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your Child
Restraint System.
• NEVER attach more than one Child
Restraint System to a single ISOFIX
top-tether anchorage. This could
cause the anchorage or attachment
to come loose or break.
• Do not attach the top-tether to
anything other than the correct toptether anchorage. It may not work
properly if attached to something
else.
• Child Restraint System anchorages
are designed to withstand only those
loads imposed by correctly fitted
Child Restraint System.
Under no circumstances are they
to be used for adult seat belts or
harnesses or for attaching other
items or equipment to the vehicle.
Securing a Child Restraint System
with a lap/shoulder belt
When not using the ISOFIX system, all
Child Restraint Systems must be secured
to a rear seat with the lap part of a lap/
shoulder belt.
OHI038145
Installing a Child Restraint System with a
lap/shoulder belt
To install a Child Restraint System on the
rear seats, do the following:
1. Place the Child Restraint System on a
rear seat and route the lap/ shoulder
belt around or through the Child
Restraint System, following the Child
Restraint System manufacturer’s
instructions.
3-39
Safety system
OOSH039041L
2. Make sure to insert the belt into the
guide (1) and check that the seat belt
is not twisted.
OHI038146
3. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct
“click” sound.
Information
Position the release button so that it is easy
to access in case of an emergency.
3-40
OHI038183L
4. Remove as much slack from the belt
as possible by pushing down on the
Child Restraint System while feeding
the shoulder belt back into the
retractor.
5. Push and pull on the Child Restraint
System to confirm that the seat belt is
holding it firmly in place.
If your Child Restraint System
manufacturer recommends the use of a
top-tether with the lap/shoulder belt, see
page 3-38.
To remove the Child Restraint System,
press the release button on the buckle
and then pull the lap/shoulder belt out of
the Child Restraint System and allow the
seat belt to retract fully.
03
AIR BAG - SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
Left-hand drive
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OOS037034/OOS037070L
1. Driver’s front air bag
2. Passenger’s front air bag
3. Side air bag
4. Curtain air bag
5. Front passenger air bag ON/OFF
switch
3-41
Safety system
Right-hand drive
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OOS037034R/OOS037070E
1. Driver’s front air bag
2. Passenger’s front air bag
3. Side air bag
3-42
4. Curtain air bag
5. Front passenger air bag ON/OFF
switch
03
The vehicles are equipped with a Supplemental Air Bag System for the driver’s seat and
front passenger’s seats.
The front air bags are designed to supplement the three-point seat belts. For these air
bags to provide protection, the seat belts must be worn at all times when driving.
You can be severely injured or killed in an accident if you are not wearing a seat belt.
Air bags are designed to supplement seat belts, but do not replace them. Also, air bags
are not designed to deploy in every collision. In some accidents, the seat belts are the
only restraint protecting you.
WARNING
AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
ALWAYS use seat belts Child Restraint Systems - every trip, everytime, everyone!
Even with air bags, you can be seriously injured or killed in a collision if you are
improperly belted or not wearing your seat belt when the air bag inflates.
NEVER place a child in any Child Restraint System or booster seat in the front
passenger seat, unless the air bag is deactivated.
An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant or child causing serious or fatal
injuries.
ABC - Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the safest place
for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older must be seated in the front
seat, he or she must be properly belted and the seat should be moved as far back as
possible.
All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their feet
on the floor until the vehicle is parked and the vehicle is turned off. If an occupant
is out of position during an accident, the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully
contact the occupant causing serious or fatal injuries.
You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily close to the air bags
or lean against the door or center console.
Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still maintaining
control of the vehicle.
3-43
Safety system
Where are the air bags?
Driver’s and passenger’s front air
bags
Driver’s front air bag
The purpose of the SRS is to provide the
vehicle’s driver and front passengers with
additional protection than that offered
by the seat belt system alone in case of a
frontal impact of sufficient severity.
WARNING
OOSH039042L
Passenger’s front air bag
OOSH039043L
Your vehicle is equipped with a
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
and lap/shoulder belts at both the driver
and passenger seating positions.
The SRS consists of air bags which are
located in the center of the steering
wheel, in the driver’s side lower crash
pad below the steering wheel, and the
passenger’s side front panel pad above
the glove box.
The air bags are labeled with the letters
“AIR BAG” embossed on the pad covers.
3-44
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from inflating front air bags, take
the following precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
• Move your seat as far back as
possible from front air bags, while
still maintaining control of the
vehicle.
• Never lean against the door or center
console.
• Do not allow the front passenger
to place their feet or legs on the
dashboard.
• No objects (such as crash pad
cover, cellular phone holder, cup
holder, perfume or stickers) should
be placed over or near the air bag
modules on the steering wheel,
instrument panel, windshield glass,
and the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box. Such objects
could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
crash severe enough to cause the air
bags to deploy.
• Do not attach any objects on the
front windshield and inside mirror.
03
OOSH039044L
Passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF switch
(if equipped)
The purpose of the switch is to disable
the passenger’s front air bag in order
to transport occupants who are at
increased risk for air bag-related injury
due to age, size, or medical condition.
OOSH039046L
To reactivate the passenger’s front air
bag:
Insert the key or a similar rigid device
into the passenger’s front air bag
ON/OFF switch and turn it to the ON
position. The passenger air bag ON
indicator ( ) will illuminate and stay on
for 60 seconds.
Information
The passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
indicator illuminates for about 4 seconds
after the ignition switch is placed in the
ON position.
OOSH039045L
To deactivate the passenger’s front air
bag:
Insert the key or a similar rigid device
into the passenger’s front air bag ON/
OFF switch and turn it to the OFF
position. The passenger air bag OFF
indicator ( ) will illuminate and stay
on until the passenger’s front air bag is
reactivated.
3-45
Safety system
WARNING
Side air bags
Never allow an adult passenger to
ride in the front passenger seat when
the passenger air bag OFF indicator is
illuminated. During a collision, the air
bag will not inflate if the indicator is
illuminated. Turn on the passenger’s
front air bag or have your passenger
move to the rear seat.
WARNING
If the passenger’s front air bag ON/
OFF switch malfunctions, the following
conditions may occur:
• The air bag warning light ( ) on the
instrument cluster will illuminate.
• The passenger air bag OFF indicator
( ) will not illuminate and the ON
indicator ( ) will come on and go off
after approximately 60 seconds. The
passenger’s front air bag will inflate
in a frontal impact even though the
passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
switch is set to the OFF position.
• We recommend that an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer inspect the
passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
switch and the SRS air bag system as
soon as possible.
3-46
OOSH039047L
OOSH039048L
Your vehicle is equipped with a side air
bag in each front seat. The purpose of
the air bag is to provide the vehicle’s
additional protection than that offered by
the seat belt alone.
The side air bags are designed to deploy
during certain side impact collisions,
depending on the crash severity.
The side air bags on both sides of the
vehicle are designed to deploy when a
rollover is detected by a rollover sensor.
The side air bags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
03
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating side air bag,
take the following precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
• Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
• Hold the steering wheel at the 9
o’clock and 3 o’clock positions, to
minimize the risk of injuries to your
hands and arms.
• Do not use any accessory seat
covers. This could reduce or prevent
the effectiveness of the system.
• Do not hang other objects except
clothes. In an accident it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury
especially when air bag is inflated.
• Do not place any objects over the
air bag or between the air bag and
yourself. Also, do not attach any
objects around the area the air bag
inflates such as the door, side door
glass, front and rear pillar.
• Do not place any objects between
the door and the seat. They may
become dangerous projectiles if the
side air bag inflates.
• Do not install any accessories on the
side or near the side air bags.
• Do not cause impact to the doors
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position as this may cause the side
air bags to inflate.
• If the seat or seat cover is damaged,
we recommend that the system be
serviced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
3-47
Safety system
Curtain air bags
The curtain air bags on both sides of the
vehicle are designed to deploy when a
rollover is detected by a rollover sensor.
The curtain air bags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
WARNING
OOSH039049L
OOSH039050L
Curtain air bags are located along both
sides of the roof rails above the front and
rear doors.
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants and
the rear outboard seat occupants in
certain side impact collisions.
The curtain air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity.
3-48
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating curtain air bag,
take the following precautions:
• All seat occupants must wear
seat belts at all times to help keep
occupants positioned properly.
• Properly secure Child Restraint
System as far away from the door as
possible.
• Do not place any objects over the air
bag. Also, do not attach any objects
around the area the air bag inflates
such as the door, side door glass,
front and rear pillar, roof side rail.
• Do not hang other objects except
clothes, especially hard or breakable
objects.
In an accident, it may cause vehicle
damage or personal injury.
• Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
• Do not open or repair the side curtain
air bags.
03
How does the air bags system
operate?
SRS warning light
The SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
air bag warning light on the instrument
panel displays the air bag symbol
depicted in the illustration. The system
checks the air bag electrical system for
malfunctions. The light indicates that
there is a potential problem with your air
bag system, which could include your
side and/or curtain air bags used for
rollover protection.
OOSH039051L
The SRS consists of the following
components:
(1) Driver’s front air bag module
(2) Passenger’s front air bag module
(3) Side air bag modules
(4) Curtain air bag modules
(5) Rear retractor pre-tensioner
(6) Front retractor pre-tensioner
(7) Air bag warning light
(8) SRS control module (SRSCM)/
Rollover sensor
(9) Front impact sensors
(10) Side impact sensors
(11) Side pressure sensors
(12) Passenger’s front air bag OFF
indicator (front passenger’s seat only)
(13) Passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF
switch
WARNING
If your SRS malfunctions, the air bag
may not inflate properly during an
accident increasing the risk of serious
injury or death.
If any of the following conditions occur,
your SRS is malfunctioning:
• The light does not turn on for
approximately six seconds when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
• The light stays on after illuminating
for approximately six seconds.
• The light comes on while the vehicle
is in motion.
• The light blinks when the vehicle is in
the ready ( ) mode.
We recommend that an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer inspect the SRS
as soon as possible if any of these
conditions occur.
The SRSCM (Supplemental Restraint
System Control Module) continually
monitors all SRS components while the
ignition switch is ON to determine if a
crash impact is severe enough to require
air bag deployment or pre-tensioner seat
belt deployment.
3-49
Safety system
During a moderate to severe frontal
collision, sensors will detect the
vehicle’s rapid deceleration. If the rate of
deceleration is high enough, the control
unit will inflate the front air bags, at the
time and with the force needed.
The front air bags help protect the driver
and front passenger by responding to
frontal impacts in which seat belts alone
cannot provide adequate restraint. When
needed, the side air bags help provide
protection in the event of a side impact
or rollover by supporting the side upper
body area.
• Air bags are activated (able to inflate
if necessary) only when the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
• Air bags inflate in the event of certain
frontal or side collisions to help
protect the occupants from serious
physical injury.
• There is no single speed at which the
air bags will inflate. Generally, air bags
are designed to inflate based upon the
severity of a collision and its direction.
These two factors determine whether
the sensors produce an electronic
deployment/inflation signal.
• The front air bags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant. It is
virtually impossible for you to see the
air bags inflate during an accident. It is
much more likely that you will simply
see the deflated air bags hanging out
of their storage compartments after
the collision.
3-50
• In addition to inflating in serious side
collisions, vehicles equipped with a
rollover sensor, side and/or curtain air
bags will inflate if the sensing system
detects a rollover.
When a rollover is detected, curtain
air bags will remain inflated longer to
help provide protection from ejection,
especially when used in conjunction
with the seat belts. (if equipped with a
rollover sensor)
• To help provide protection, the air
bags must inflate rapidly. The speed
of air bag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which
to inflate the air bag between the
occupant and the vehicle structures
before the occupant impacts those
structures. This speed of inflation
reduces the risk of serious or lifethreatening injuries and is thus a
necessary part of air bag design.
However, the rapid air bag inflation
can also cause injuries which can
include facial abrasions, bruises and
broken bones because the inflation
speed also causes the air bags to
expand with a great deal of force.
• There are even circumstances under
which contact with the air bag can
cause fatal injuries, especially if the
occupant is positioned excessively
close to the air bag.
You can take steps to reduce the risk of
being injured by an inflating air bag. The
greatest risk is sitting too close to the air
bag. An air bag needs space to inflate.
It is recommended that drivers sit as far
as possible between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest while still
maintaining control of the vehicle.
03
Driver’s front air bag (1)
Driver’s front air bag (3)
ODN8039077L
When the SRSCM detects a sufficiently
severe impact to the front of the vehicle,
it will automatically deploy the front air
bags.
ODN8039079L
Passenger’s front air bag
Driver’s front air bag (2)
ODN8039080L
ODN8039078L
Upon deployment, tear seams molded
directly into the pad covers will separate
under pressure from the expansion of the
air bags. Further opening of the covers
allows full inflation of the air bags.
A fully inflated air bag, in combination
with a properly worn seat belt, slows the
driver’s or the front passenger’s forward
motion, reducing the risk of head and
chest injury.
After complete inflation, the air bag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility
and the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
WARNING
To prevent objects from becoming
dangerous projectiles when the
passenger’s air bag inflates:
• Do not install or place any objects
(drink holder, CD holder, stickers,
etc.) on the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box where the
passenger’s air bag is located.
• Do not install a container of liquid
air freshener near the instrument
cluster or on the instrument panel
surface.
3-51
Safety system
What to expect after an air bag
inflates
After a frontal or side air bag inflates, it
will deflate very quickly. Air bag inflation
will not prevent the driver from seeing
out of the windshield or being able
to steer. Curtain air bags may remain
partially inflated for some time after they
deploy.
WARNING
After an air bag inflates, take the
following precautions:
• Open your windows and doors as
soon as possible after impact to
reduce prolonged exposure to the
smoke and powder released by the
inflating air bag.
• Do not touch the air bag storage
area’s internal components
immediately after an air bag has
inflated. The parts that come into
contact with an inflating air bag may
be very hot.
• Always wash exposed skin areas
thoroughly with cold water and mild
soap.
• We recommend that an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer replace the air bag
immediately after deployment. Air
bags are designed to be used only
once.
Noise and smoke from inflating air
bag
When the air bags inflate, they make a
loud noise and may produce smoke and
powder in the air inside of the vehicle.
This is normal and is a result of the
ignition of the air bag inflator. After the
air bag inflates, you may feel substantial
discomfort in breathing because of the
contact of your chest with both the seat
belt and the air bag, as well as from
breathing the smoke and powder. The
powder may aggravate asthma for some
people. If you experience breathing
problems after an air bag deployment,
seek medical attention immediately.
Though the smoke and powder are
nontoxic, they may cause irritation to
the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If this is
the case, wash and rinse with cold water
immediately and seek medical attention
if the symptoms persist.
Do not install a Child Restraint
System on the front passenger seat
OHI038169L
Never install a Child Restraint System in
the front passenger seat, unless the air
bag is deactivated
3-52
03
WARNING
NEVER use a rearward facing Child
Restraint on a seat protected by an
ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH
or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can
occur.
Why didn’t my air bag go off in a
collision?
There are certain types of accidents in
which the air bag would not be expected
to provide additional protection. These
include rear impacts, second or third
collisions in multiple impact accidents,
as well as low speed impacts. Damage to
the vehicle indicates a collision energy
absorption, and is not an indicator of
whether or not an air bag should have
inflated.
Air bag collision sensors
WARNING
To reduce the risk of an air bag
deploying unexpectedly and causing
serious injury or death:
• Do not hit or allow any objects to
impact the locations where air bags
or sensors are installed.
• Do not perform maintenance on or
around the air bag sensors. If the
location or angle of the sensors is
altered, the air bags may deploy
when they should not or may not
deploy when they should.
• Do not install bumper guards or
replace the bumper with a nongenuine part. This may adversely
affect the collision and air bag
deployment performance.
• Place the ignition switch to the
LOCK/OFF or ACC position, when the
vehicle is being towed to prevent
inadvertent air bag deployment.
• We recommend that all air bag
repairs are conducted by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
3-53
Safety system
OOSH039052L/OOS037045/OOSH039053L/OOS037047/OOS037077
1.
2.
3.
4.
SRS control module
Front impact sensor
Side pressure sensor
Side impact sensor
3-54
03
Air bag inflation conditions
OOSH039055L
OOSH039054L
Front air bags
Front air bags are designed to inflate
in a frontal collision depending on the
severity of impact of the front collision.
OOSH039056L
Side and curtain air bags
Side and curtain air bags are designed
to inflate when an impact is detected by
side collision sensors depending on the
severity of impact resulting from a side
impact collision.
Although the driver’s and front
passenger’s air bags are designed to
inflate in frontal collisions, they also may
inflate in other types of collisions if the
front impact sensors detect a sufficient
impact. Side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate in side impact
collisions, but they may inflate in other
collisions if the side impact sensors
detect a sufficient impact.
3-55
Safety system
Also, the side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate when a rollover is
detected by a rollover sensor.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved roads,
the air bags may deploy. Drive carefully
on unimproved roads or on surfaces not
designed for vehicle traffic to prevent
unintended air bag deployment.
Air bag non-inflation conditions
OOSH039059L
Front air bags are not designed to inflate
in rear collisions, because occupants
are moved backward by the force of the
impact. In this case, inflated air bags
would not provide any additional benefit.
OOSH039058L
In certain low-speed collisions the air
bags may not deploy. The air bags are
designed not to deploy in such cases
because they may not provide benefits
beyond the protection of the seat belts.
OOSH039057L
Front air bags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move in the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, front air bag
deployment would not provide additional
occupant protection.
However, side and curtain air bags may
inflate depending on the severity of
impact.
3-56
03
OOSH039060L
In an angled collision, the force of impact
may direct the occupants in a direction
where the air bags would not be able to
provide any additional benefit, and thus
the sensors may not deploy any air bags.
OOSH039062L
Front air bags may not inflate in
rollover accidents because front air bag
deployment would not provide additional
occupant protection.
Information
The side and curtain air bags may inflate
in a rollover situation, when it is detected
by the rollover sensor.
OOSH039061L
Just before impact, drivers often brake
heavily. Such heavy braking lowers the
front portion of the vehicle causing it
to “ride” under a vehicle with a higher
ground clearance. Air bags may not
inflate in this “underride” situation
because deceleration forces that are
detected by sensors may be significantly
reduced by such “underride” collisions.
OOSH039063L
Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility poles
or trees, where the point of impact is
concentrated and the collision energy is
absorbed by the vehicle structure.
3-57
Safety system
SRS care
The SRS is virtually maintenance-free
and there are no parts you can safely
service by yourself. If the SRS air bag
warning light does not illuminate
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position, or continuously remains on,
we recommend that the system be
immediately inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
We recommend any work on the SRS
system, such as removing, installing,
repairing, or any work on the steering
wheel, the front passenger’s panel, front
seats and roof rails be performed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Improper
handling of the SRS system may result in
serious personal injury.
3-58
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death take the following precautions:
• Do not attempt to modify or
disconnect the SRS components or
wiring, including the addition of any
kind of badges to the pad covers or
modifications to the body structure.
• Do not place objects over or near
the air bag modules on the steering
wheel, instrument panel, and the
front passenger’s panel above the
glove box.
• Clean the air bag pad covers with
a soft cloth moistened with plain
water. Solvents or cleaners could
adversely affect the air bag covers
and proper deployment of the
system.
• We recommend that inflated air
bags be replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If components of the air bag system
must be discarded, or if the vehicle
must be scrapped, certain safety
precautions must be observed.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for the necessary information.
Failure to follow these precautions
could increase the risk of personal
injury.
03
Additional safety precautions
Passengers should not move out of
or change seats while the vehicle is
moving. A passenger who is not wearing
a seat belt during a crash or emergency
stop can be thrown against the inside of
the vehicle, against other occupants, or
be ejected from the vehicle.
Do not use any accessories on seat
belts. Devices claiming to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the seat
belt can reduce the protection provided
by the seat belt and increase the chance
of serious injury in a crash.
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components or side air bags.
Do not place items under the front
seats. Placing items under the front seats
could interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components and wiring harnesses.
Do not cause impact to the doors.
Impact to the doors when the ignition
switch is in the ON position may cause
the air bags to inflate.
Air bag warning labels
OOSH039064L
Air bag warning labels are attached to
alert the passengers of potential risks of
the air bag system.
Be sure to read all of the information
about the air bags that are installed on
your vehicle in this Owner’s Manual.
Adding equipment to or modifying
your air bag equipped vehicle
If you modify your vehicle by changing
your vehicle’s frame, bumper system,
front end or side sheet metal or ride
height, this may affect the operation of
your vehicle’s air bag system.
3-59
4. Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster............................................................................................. 4-4
Instrument cluster control............................................................................................4-5
Instrument panel illumination....................................................................................4-5
Gauges and meters.......................................................................................................4-5
Speedometer..............................................................................................................4-5
Power gauge...............................................................................................................4-5
Fuel gauge.................................................................................................................. 4-6
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge........................................................... 4-6
Outside temperature gauge....................................................................................... 4-7
Odometer.................................................................................................................... 4-7
Distance to empty...................................................................................................... 4-7
Dual clutch transmission shift indicator.................................................................. 4-8
Warning and indicator lights....................................................................................... 4-9
Seat belt warning light.............................................................................................. 4-9
Air bag warning light................................................................................................. 4-9
Parking brake & Brake fluid warning light............................................................... 4-10
Regenerative brake warning light............................................................................. 4-11
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) warning light............................................................ 4-11
Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) system warning light........................... 4-11
Electric Power Steering (EPS) warning light........................................................... 4-12
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)........................................................................... 4-12
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) warning light......................................................... 4-13
Charging system warning light................................................................................ 4-13
Engine oil pressure warning light............................................................................ 4-13
Low fuel level warning light..................................................................................... 4-14
Service warning light................................................................................................ 4-14
Exhaust system (GPF) warning light........................................................................ 4-15
Master warning light................................................................................................. 4-15
Low tire pressure warning light............................................................................... 4-16
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) warning light....................................... 4-16
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) indicator light................................................................4-17
LED headlight warning light......................................................................................4-17
Icy road warning light................................................................................................4-17
Ready indicator......................................................................................................... 4-18
EV mode indicator.................................................................................................... 4-18
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) indicator light.................................................... 4-18
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF indicator light............................................ 4-18
Immobilizer indicator light (without smart key)..................................................... 4-18
Immobilizer indicator light (with smart key)........................................................... 4-19
4
4
Turn signal indicator light......................................................................................... 4-19
High beam indicator light........................................................................................ 4-19
Light ON indicator light............................................................................................4-20
Front fog indicator light............................................................................................4-20
Rear fog indicator light.............................................................................................4-20
High Beam Assist (HBA) indicator light...................................................................4-20
AUTO HOLD indicator light......................................................................................4-20
LCD display messages.................................................................................................4-21
Shift to P to start engine (for smart key system).....................................................4-21
Shift to P (for smart key system)...............................................................................4-21
Low key battery (for smart key system)...................................................................4-21
Press START button while turning wheel (for smart key system)...........................4-21
Check steering wheel lock system (for smart key system).....................................4-21
Press brake pedal to start engine (for smart key system).......................................4-21
Key not in vehicle (for smart key system).................................................................4-21
Key not detected (for smart key system).................................................................4-21
Press START button again (for smart key system)...................................................4-21
Press START button with key (for smart key system).............................................4-22
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse (for smart key system)...............................................4-22
12V battery discharging due to additional electrical devices................................4-22
Door, Hood, Tailgate open indicator.......................................................................4-22
Sunroof open indicator.............................................................................................4-23
Low pressure.............................................................................................................4-23
Lights mode..............................................................................................................4-23
Wiper.........................................................................................................................4-23
Low washer fluid.......................................................................................................4-24
Low fuel.....................................................................................................................4-24
Engine has overheated.............................................................................................4-24
Check exhaust system..............................................................................................4-24
Check headlight........................................................................................................4-24
Check turn signal......................................................................................................4-24
Check brake light......................................................................................................4-24
Check fog light..........................................................................................................4-24
Check cornering lamp..............................................................................................4-25
Check headlamp LED...............................................................................................4-25
Check Active Air Flap system...................................................................................4-25
4. Instrument cluster
Ready to start driving...............................................................................................4-25
Check regenerative brakes......................................................................................4-25
Stop vehicle and check brakes................................................................................4-25
Check Hybrid system................................................................................................4-25
Stop safely and check Hybrid system.....................................................................4-26
Check Hybrid system. Do not start engine.............................................................4-26
Stop safely and check power supply.......................................................................4-26
Check virtual engine sound system........................................................................4-26
Refuel to prevent Hybrid battery damage..............................................................4-26
Refill inverter coolant...............................................................................................4-26
Park with engine On to charge battery...................................................................4-26
Start engine to avoid battery discharge..................................................................4-26
LCD display........................................................................................................4-27
LCD display control..................................................................................................... 4-27
LCD display modes.....................................................................................................4-28
Trip computer mode.................................................................................................4-29
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode..........................................................................................4-29
Assist mode...............................................................................................................4-29
Master warning mode............................................................................................. 4-30
User settings mode................................................................................................... 4-31
Trip computer...................................................................................................4-40
Trip modes................................................................................................................ 4-40
Fuel economy........................................................................................................... 4-40
Accumulated Info display......................................................................................... 4-41
Drive Info display......................................................................................................4-42
Digital speedometer.................................................................................................4-42
Driving style..............................................................................................................4-42
Energy flow.............................................................................................................. 4-43
Engine coolant temperature................................................................................... 4-43
4
Instrument cluster
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
Type A
Type B
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more information, refer to “Gauges and meters” section in this chapter.
OOSH049001L/OOSH049002L
1. Power gauge
2. Speedometer
3. Battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge
4-4
4. Fuel gauge
5. Warning and indicator lights
6. LCD display (including Trip computer)
04
Instrument cluster control
Instrument panel illumination
(if equipped)
Gauges and meters
Speedometer
km/h
MPH, km/h
OOSH049005L
OOSH049003L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
When the vehicle’s position lights or
headlamps are on, press the illumination
control button to adjust the brightness of
the instrument panel illumination.
When pressing the illumination control
button, the interior switch illumination
intensity is also adjusted.
OOSH049006L
The speedometer indicates the speed of
the vehicle and is calibrated in kilometers
per hour (km/h) and/or miles per hour
(MPH).
Power gauge
WARNING
Never adjust the instrument cluster
while driving. This could result in loss
of control and lead to an accident that
may cause death, serious injury, or
vehicle damage.
OOSH049004L
OOSH049007L
The power gauge indicates whether the
current driving condition is fuel efficient
or not.
• CHARGE : Shows that the energy
made by the vehicle is being
converted to electrical energy.
(Regenerated energy)
• ECO : Shows that the vehicle is being
driven in an Eco-friendly manner.
• POWER : Shows that the vehicle is
exceeding the Eco-friendly range.
• The brightness of the instrument
panel illumination is displayed.
• If the brightness reaches to the
maximum or minimum level, a chime
will sound.
4-5
Instrument cluster
WARNING
Information
Accordance to the power gauge area the
“EV” indicator comes on or off.
-- “EV” indicator ON : Vehicle is driven
using the electric motor or the gasoline
engine is stopped.
-- “EV” indicator OFF : Vehicle is driven
using the gasoline engine.
NOTICE
Fuel gauge
Type A
Running out of fuel can expose vehicle
occupants to danger.
You must stop and obtain additional
fuel as soon as possible after the
warning light comes on or when the
gauge indicator comes close to the “0
or E (Empty)” level.
Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire damaging
the catalytic converter.
Type B
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge)
gauge
Type A
OOSH049008L
Type B
OOSH049009L
This gauge indicates the approximate
amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank.
Information
• The fuel tank capacity is given in
chapter 2.
• The fuel gauge is supplemented by
a low fuel warning light, which will
illuminate when the fuel tank is nearly
empty.
• On inclines or curves, the fuel gauge
pointer may fluctuate or the low fuel
warning light may come on earlier than
usual due to the movement of fuel in
the tank.
4-6
OOSH049010L
OOSH049011L
This gauge indicates the remaining
hybrid battery power. If the SOC is near
the “0 or L (Low)” level, the vehicle
automatically operates the engine to
charge the battery.
However, if the Service Indicator ( )
and Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
( ) turn on when the SOC gauge is near
the “0 or L (Low)” level, we recommend
the vehicle be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
04
NOTICE
Odometer
Never try to start the vehicle if the fuel
tank is empty. In this condition, the
engine cannot charge the high voltage
battery of the hybrid system. If you
try to start the vehicle when the fuel
is empty, the high voltage battery will
become discharged and be damaged.
Outside temperature gauge
OOSH049013L
The odometer indicates the total
distance that the vehicle has been
driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should be
performed.
Distance to empty
OOSH049012L
This gauge indicates the current outside
air temperatures by 1°C (1°F).
Note that the temperature indicated
on the LCD display may not change
as quickly as the outside temperature
(there may be a slight delay before the
temperature changes.)
You can change the temperature unit
from °C to °F ° or F to °C in the User
Settings mode in the cluster:
-- Go to User settings → Other →
Temperature unit.
For vehicles equipped with Automatic
Climate Control, you can also:
-- Press the AUTO button while pressing
the OFF button on the climate control
unit for 3 seconds
OOSH049014L
• The distance to empty is the
estimated distance the vehicle can be
driven with the remaining fuel.
• If the estimated distance is below 1 km
(1 mi.), the trip computer will display
“---” as distance to empty.
Both the temperature unit on the cluster
LCD display and climate control screen
will change.
4-7
Instrument cluster
Information
• If the vehicle is not on level ground or
the battery power has been interrupted,
the distance to empty function may not
operate correctly.
• The distance to empty may differ
from the actual driving distance as it
is an estimate of the available driving
distance.
• The trip computer may not register
additional fuel if less than 6 liters (1.5
gallon) of fuel are added to the vehicle.
• The distance to empty may vary
significantly based on driving
conditions, driving habits, and
condition of the vehicle.
Dual clutch transmission shift
indicator
OOSH049016L
Dual clutch transmission shift indicator
in Manual Shift mode (for Europe, if
equipped)
In the Manual Shift mode, this indicator
informs which gear is recommended
while driving, to save fuel.
-- Shifting up :▲2, ▲3, ▲4, ▲5, ▲6
-- Shifting down :▼1, ▼2, ▼3, ▼4, ▼5
For example
: Indicates that shifting up to the 3rd
gear is recommended (currently the shift
lever is in the 2nd or 1st gear).
: Indicates that shifting down to the
3rd gear is recommended (currently the
shift lever is in the 4th, 5th, or 6th gear).
When the system is not working properly,
the indicator is not displayed.
OOSH049015L
This indicator displays which shift lever
position is selected.
4-8
04
Warning and indicator lights
Information
Make sure that all warning lights are OFF
after starting the engine. If any light is still
ON, this indicates a situation that needs
attention.
Seat belt warning light
OOSH049017L
Shift indicator pop-up
The pop-up indicates the current gear
position displayed in the cluster for
about 2 seconds when shifting into other
positions (P/R/N/D).
The shift indicator pop-up function can
be activated or deactivated from the
User Settings mode in the cluster LCD
display.
This warning light informs the driver that
the seat belt is not fastened.
For more details, refer to “Seat Belts”
section in chapter 3.
Air bag warning light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The air bag warning light illuminates
for about 6 seconds and then turns
off when all checks have been
performed.
• The air bag warning light will remain
illuminated if there is a malfunction
with the Safety Restraint System (SRS)
air bag operation.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-9
Instrument cluster
Parking brake & Brake fluid
warning light
(red)
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The parking brake light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and will then
turn off once the parking brake is
released.
• Whenever the parking brake is
applied.
• Whenever the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
-- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
• Whenever the regenerative brake
does not operate.
If the brake fluid level in the reservoir is
low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the engine stopped, check the
brake fluid level immediately and add
fluid as required (For more details,
refer to “Brake Fluid” section in
chapter 8). After adding brake fluid,
check all brake components for fluid
leaks. If a brake fluid leak is found, or
if the warning light remains on, or if
the brakes do not operate properly, do
not drive the vehicle. We recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-10
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with dualdiagonal braking system. This means you
still have braking on two wheels even if
one of the dual systems should fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal travel
and greater pedal pressure is required to
stop the vehicle.
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as short
a distance with only a portion of the
brake system working.
If the brakes fail while you are driving,
shift to a lower gear for additional engine
braking and stop the vehicle as soon as it
is safe to do so.
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning
Light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light
ON is dangerous. If the Parking Brake
& Brake Fluid warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid level is
low.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
04
Regenerative brake warning
light
(yellow)
This warning light illuminates:
When the regenerative brake does not
operate and the brake does not perform
well. This causes the Brake Warning
light (red) and Regenerative Brake
Warning Light (yellow) to illuminate
simultaneously.
If this occurs, drive safely and we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
The operation of the brake pedal may
be more difficult than normal and the
braking distance may increase.
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
warning light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The ABS warning light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and then goes
off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the ABS.
Note that the hydraulic braking
system will still be operational even if
there is a malfunction with the ABS.
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD) system
warning light
When the ABS warning and
Parking Brake warning lights are on
simultaneously, it may indicate a
problem with the Electronic Brake Force
Distribution system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Electronic Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) System Warning Light
When both ABS and Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid warning lights are on, the
brake system will not work normally
and you may experience an unexpected
and dangerous situation during sudden
braking.
If this occurs, avoid high speed driving
and abrupt braking.
We recommend that you have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
4-11
Instrument cluster
Information - Electronic Brake
Force Distribution (EBD)
system warning light
When the ABS warning light is on or both
ABS and Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
warning lights are on, the speedometer,
odometer, or tripmeter may not work.
Also, the EPS warning light may
illuminate and the steering effort may
increase or decrease.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
warning light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The electric powering steering
Warning light illuminates for about 3
seconds and then goes off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the EPS.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-12
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL)
This indicator light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The malfunction indicator light
illuminates for about 3 seconds and
then goes off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
either the emission control system or
the engine or the vehicle powertrain.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Driving with the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on may cause damage to
the emission control system which
could affect drivability and/or fuel
economy.
NOTICE
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) illuminates, potential catalytic
converter damage is possible which
could result in loss of engine power.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
04
Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB) warning light
Charging system warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The EPB warning light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and then goes
off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the EPB.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
When the battery is not being charged
while the engine is running. Immediately
turn OFF all electrical accessories. Try
not to use electrically operated controls,
such as the power windows. Keep the
engine running.
We recommend that you have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
Information
The Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
warning light may illuminate when
the Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
indicator light comes on to indicate that
the ESC is not working properly (This
does not indicate malfunction of the EPB).
Engine oil pressure warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
When the engine oil pressure is low.
If the engine oil pressure is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check the
engine oil level (For more details,
refer to “Engine Oil” section in
chapter 2). If the level is low, add oil
as required.
If the warning light remains on after
adding oil or if oil is not available, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
4-13
Instrument cluster
NOTICE
• If the engine does not stop
immediately after the Engine Oil
Pressure warning light is illuminated,
severe damage could result.
• If the warning light stays on while the
engine is running, it indicates that
there may be serious engine damage
or malfunction. In this case:
1. Stop the vehicle as soon as it is
safe to do so.
2. Turn off the engine and check the
oil level. If the oil level is low, fill
the engine oil to the proper level.
3. Start the engine again. If the
warning light stays on after the
engine is started, turn the engine
off immediately. If this occurs,
we recommend that you have
the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Low fuel level warning light
This warning light illuminates:
When the fuel tank is nearly empty.
Add fuel as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Driving with the Low Fuel Level warning
light on or with the fuel level below “0
or E” can cause the engine to misfire
and damage the catalytic converter.
4-14
Service warning light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The service warning light illuminates
for approximately 3 seconds and
then turns off when all checks have
been performed.
• When there is a problem with the
hybrid vehicle control system or
hardware.
When the warning light illuminates
while driving, or does not go OFF after
starting the vehicle, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
04
Exhaust system (GPF)
warning light
Master warning light
• This warning light illuminates, wen
accumulated soot reaches a certain
amount.
• When this warning light illuminates, it
may turn off after driving the vehicle
at more than 80 km/h (50 mph) for
about 30 minutes (above 3rd gear
with 1500 ~ 4000 engine rpm).
If this warning light blinks in spite
of the procedure (at this time LCD
warning message will be displayed),
we recommend that you have the
GPF system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
When there is a malfunction in operation
in any of the following systems:
-- LED headlamp malfunction
(if equipped)
-- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system malfunction (if equipped)
-- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
radar blocked (if equipped)
-- Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
malfunction (if equipped)
-- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
-- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
malfunction (if equipped)
-- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
radar blocked (if equipped)
-- Lamp malfunction
-- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
-- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the LCD display.
NOTICE
If you continue to drive with the GPF
warning light blinking for a long time,
the GPF system can be damaged and
fuel consumption can worsen.
4-15
Instrument cluster
Low tire pressure warning
light
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The low tire pressure warning light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When one or more of your tires are
significantly underinflated. (The
location of the underinflated tires are
displayed on the LCD display.)
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 7.
This warning light remains ON after
blinking for approximately 60 seconds, or
repeatedly blinks ON and OFF in 3 second
intervals:
When there is a malfunction with the
TPMS.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 7.
4-16
WARNING
Safe Stopping
• The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors.
• If you notice any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off the
accelerator pedal, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) warning light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The FCA warning light illuminates
for approximately 3 seconds and
then goes off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the FCA.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
System” section in chapter 6.
04
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
• [Green] When the system operating
conditions are satisfied.
• [White] When the system operating
conditions are not satisfied.
• [Yellow] Whenever there is a
malfunction with the lane keeping
assist system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) System” section in chapter
6.
LED headlight warning light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The LED headlight warning light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the LED headlight.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This warning light blinks:
Whenever there is a malfunction with a
LED headlight related part.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Continuous driving with the LED
Headlight warning light on or blinking
can reduce LED headlight life.
Icy road warning light
(if equipped)
This warning light is to warn the driver
the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside
temperature gauge is approximately
below 4°C (40°F), the Icy Road warning
light and Outside Temperature Gauge
blinks and then illuminates. Also, the
warning chime sounds 1 time.
You can activate or deactivate Icy Road
Warning function from the User Settings
mode in the cluster LCD display.
Information
If the Icy Road warning light appears
while driving, you should drive more
attentively and safely refraining from
over-speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden
braking or sharp turning, etc.
4-17
Instrument cluster
Ready indicator
This indicator illuminates:
When the vehicle is ready to be driven.
-- ON : Normal driving is possible.
-- OFF : Normal driving is not possible,
or a problem has occurred.
-- Blinking : Emergency driving.
When the ready indicator goes OFF
or blinks, there is a problem with the
system. If this occurs, we recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
EV mode indicator
This indicator illuminates:
When the vehicle is driven by the electric
motor.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The Electronic Stability Control
indicator light illuminates for about
3 seconds and then goes off.
• Whenever there is a malfunction with
the ESC system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-18
This indicator light blinks:
While the ESC is operating.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” section in
chapter 6.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) OFF indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When you set the ignition switch or
the Engine Start/Stop button to the
ON position.
-- The ESC OFF indicator light
illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When you deactivate the ESC system
by pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more details, refer to “Electronic
Stability Control (ESC)” section in
chapter 6.
Immobilizer indicator light
(without smart key)
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When the vehicle detects the
immobilizer in the key with the ignition
switch in the ON position.
-- At this time, you can start the engine.
-- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
04
Immobilizer indicator light
(with smart key)
(if equipped)
Turn signal indicator light
This indicator light illuminates for up to
30 seconds:
When the vehicle detects the smart key
in the vehicle with the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ACC or ON position.
-- Once the smart key is detected, you
can start the engine.
-- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
When you operate the turn signal
indicator stalk.
This indicator light blinks for a few
seconds:
When the smart key is not in the vehicle.
-- If the smart key is not detected, you
cannot start the engine.
This indicator light illuminates for 2
seconds and goes off:
If the smart key is in the vehicle and the
Engine Start/Stop button is ON, but the
vehicle cannot detect the smart key.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If any of the following occur, there may
be a malfunction with the turn signal
system.
-- The turn signal indicator light
illuminates but does not blink
-- The turn signal indicator light blinks
rapidly
-- The turn signal indicator light does not
illuminate at all
If any of these conditions occur, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
High beam indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the headlights are on and in the
high beam position
• When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
4-19
Instrument cluster
Light ON indicator light
AUTO HOLD indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
When the tail lights or headlights are on.
This indicator light illuminates:
• [White] When you activate the auto
hold system by pressing the AUTO
HOLD switch.
• [Green] When you stop the vehicle
completely by depressing the brake
pedal with the Auto Hold system
activated.
• [Yellow] Whenever there is a
malfunction with the Auto Hold
system.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to “Auto Hold”
section in chapter 6.
Front fog indicator light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
When the front fog lights are on.
Rear fog indicator light
This indicator light illuminates:
When the rear fog lights are on.
High Beam Assist (HBA)
indicator light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the high-beam is on with the
light switch in the AUTO light position.
• If your vehicle detects oncoming or
preceding vehicles, the High Beam
Assist (HBA) system will switch the
high beam to low beam automatically.
For more details, refer to “High Beam
Assist (HBA) system” section in chapter
5.
4-20
04
LCD display messages
Shift to P to start engine
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you try to
start the vehicle with the shift lever in
any other position except the P (Park)
position.
Shift to P (for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you try to
turn off the vehicle without the shift lever
in the P (Park) position.
If this occurs, the Engine Start/Stop
button turns to the ACC position.
Low key battery
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the battery
of the smart key is discharged while
changing the Engine Start/Stop button to
the OFF position.
Press START button while turning
wheel (for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the steering
wheel does not unlock normally when
the Engine Start/Stop button is pressed.
You should press the Engine Start/Stop
button while turning the steering wheel
right and left.
Check steering wheel lock system
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the steering
wheel does not lock normally while the
Engine Start/Stop button is pressed to
the OFF position.
Press brake pedal to start engine
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the Engine
Start/Stop button changes to the ACC
position twice by pressing the button
repeatedly without depressing the brake
pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing
the brake pedal and then pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button.
Key not in vehicle
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the smart
key is not in the vehicle when you press
the Engine Start/ Stop button.
When attempting to start the vehicle,
always have the smart key with you.
Key not detected
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the smart
key is not detected when you press the
Engine Start/Stop button.
Press START button again
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if you were
unable to start the vehicle when the
Engine Start/Stop button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the engine
by pressing the Engine Start/ Stop button
again.
If the warning message appears each
time you press the Engine Start/Stop
button, we recommend that you have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
4-21
Instrument cluster
Press START button with key
(for smart key system)
Door, Hood, Tailgate open indicator
This message is displayed if you press
the Engine Start/Stop button while the
warning message “Key not detected” is
displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse
(for smart key system)
This message is displayed if the brake
switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a new
one before starting the engine.
If that is not possible, you can start the
engine by pressing the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds in the ACC
position.
12V battery discharging due to
additional electrical devices
This message is displayed if the 12V
battery voltage is weak due to any
non-factory electrical accessories (ex.
dashboard camera) while parking. Be
careful that the battery is not discharged.
If the message appears after removing
the non-factory electrical accessories,
we recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
4-22
OOSH049018L
This warning is displayed if any door or
the hood or the tailgate is left open. The
warning will indicate which door is open
in the display.
CAUTION
Before driving the vehicle, you should
confirm that the door/ hood/tailgate
is fully closed. Also, check there is no
door/ hood/tailgate open warning light
or message displayed on the instrument
cluster.
04
Sunroof open indicator (if equipped)
Lights mode
Type A
OOSH049019L
This warning is displayed if you turn off
the engine when the sunroof is open.
Close the sunroof securely before leaving
your vehicle.
Low pressure
Type B
OOSH049021L
OOSH049022L
This indicator displays which exterior
light is selected using the lighting
control.
You can activate or deactivate Wiper/
Lights Display function from the User
Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.
Wiper
Type A
Type B
OOSH049020L
This warning message is displayed if the
tire pressure is low. The corresponding
tire on the vehicle will be illuminated.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 7.
OOSH049023L
OOSH049024L
This indicator displays which wiper speed
is selected using the wiper control.
You can activate or deactivate Wiper/
Lights Display function from the User
Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.
4-23
Instrument cluster
Low washer fluid (if equipped)
Check headlight (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the washer
fluid level in the reservoir is nearly empty.
Have the washer fluid reservoir refilled.
This message is displayed if the
headlights are not operating properly. A
headlight bulb may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
Low fuel
This message is displayed if the fuel tank
is almost out of fuel.
When this message is displayed, the low
fuel level warning light in the cluster will
come on.
It is recommended to look for the nearest
fueling station and refuel as soon as
possible.
Engine has overheated
This message is displayed when the
engine coolant temperature is above
120°C (248°F). This means that the
engine is overheated and may be
damaged.
If your vehicle is overheated, refer to
“Overheating” section in chapter 7.
Check exhaust system (if equipped)
This message is displayed if there is a
problem with the GPF system. At this
time, the GPF warning light will also
blink. If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the GPF system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
GPF : Gasoline Particulate Filter
4-24
Check turn signal (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the turn
signal lamps are not operating properly.
A lamp may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
Check brake light (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the stop
lamps are not operating properly. A lamp
may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
Check fog light (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the fog
lamps are not operating properly. A lamp
may need to be replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
04
Check cornering lamp (if equipped)
Ready to start driving
This message is displayed if the
cornering lamps are not operating
properly. A lamp may need to be
replaced.
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same wattage
rating.
This message is displayed when the
vehicle is ready to be driven.
Check headlamp LED (if equipped)
This message is displayed if there is a
problem with the LED headlamp. We
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Check Active Air Flap system
This message is displayed in the
following situations:
-- There is a malfunction with the
actuator flap
-- There is a malfunction with the
actuator air flap controller
-- The air flap does not open
When all of the above conditions are
fixed, the warning will disappear.
Check regenerative brakes
This message is displayed when
the brake performance is low or the
regenerative brake does not work
properly due to a failure in the brake
system.
If this occurs, it may take longer for the
brake pedal to operate and the braking
distance may become longer.
Stop vehicle and check brakes
This message is displayed when a failure
occurs in the brake system.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a
safe location and we recommend that
you tow your vehicle to the nearest
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have the
vehicle inspected.
Check Hybrid system
This message is displayed when there
is a problem with the hybrid system.
Refrain from driving when the warning
message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-25
Instrument cluster
Stop safely and check Hybrid system
This message is displayed when there is
a problem with the hybrid system. The
“ ” indicator will blink and a warning
chime will sound until the problem is
solved. Refrain from driving when the
warning message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check Hybrid system. Do not start
engine
This message is displayed when the
hybrid battery power (SOC) level is low.
A warning chime will sound until the
problem is solved. Refrain from driving
when the warning message is displayed.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Stop safely and check power supply
This message is displayed when a failure
occurs in the power supply system.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a safe
location and tow your vehicle to the
nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the vehicle inspected.
Check virtual engine sound system
This message is displayed when there is
a problem with the Virtual Engine Sound
System (VESS).
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-26
Refuel to prevent Hybrid battery
damage
This message is displayed when the fuel
tank is nearly empty.
You should refill the fuel tank to prevent
hybrid battery damage.
Refill inverter coolant
This message is displayed when the
inverter coolant is nearly empty.
You should refill the inverter coolant.
Park with engine On to charge
battery
This message is displayed when the
hybrid battery power (SOC) level is low.
If this occurs, park the vehicle in a safe
location and wait until the hybrid battery
is charged.
Start engine to avoid battery
discharge
This message is displayed to inform the
driver the 12V battery may be discharged
if the ignition switch is in ON position
indicator ON).
(without the
Set the vehicle to the ready ( ) mode
to prevent the 12V battery from being
discharged.
04
LCD DISPLAY
LCD display control
OOSH049025L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
The LCD display modes can be changed by using the control buttons.
1.
: MODE button for changing modes
2.
,
: MOVE switch for changing items
3. OK : SELECT/RESET button for setting or resetting the selected item
4-27
4-28
Up/
Down
Service Interval
Engine Coolant
Temperature
Reset
Language
Other
Convenience
Sound
Energy Flow
Tire Pressure
Lights
Intelligent Speed Limit
Warning
Digital Speedometer
Driving Style
Door
Driver Attention
Warning
Drive Info
Head-Up Display
WDH-5007
User Settings
Driver Assistance
Lane Keeping Assist
WVI-5002
Assist
Menu
Smart Cruise Control
Destination Info
Accumulated Info
WVI-5004
Route Guidance
TBT
Fuel Economy
WHD-5001
Trip Computer
LCD display modes
The Master Warning
mode displays
warning messages
related to the vehicle
when one or more
systems is not
operating normally.
WVI-5006
Master warning
Instrument cluster
04
Trip computer mode
Assist mode
OOSH049026L
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including fuel economy,
tripmeter information and vehicle speed.
For more details, refer to “Trip
Computer” section in this chapter.
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode
OOSH049028L
SCC/LKA/DAW/ISLW
This mode displays the state of the Smart
Cruise Control (SCC), Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA), Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) and Intelligent Speed Limit
Warning (ISLW).
For more details, refer to each system
information section in chapter 6.
OOSH049027L
This mode displays the state of the
navigation.
OOSH049029L
Tire pressure
This mode displays information related to
Tire Pressure.
For more details, refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” section in
chapter 7.
4-29
Instrument cluster
Master warning mode
The Master Warning Light illuminates
if one or more of the above warning
situations occur. At this time, the LCD
Modes Icon will change from ( ) to ( ).
If the warning situation is solved, the
master warning light will be turned off
and the LCD Modes Icon will be changed
back to its previous icon ( ).
OOSH049030L
This warning light informs the driver the
following situations.
-- LED headlamp malfunction
(if equipped)
-- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system malfunction (if equipped)
-- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
radar blocked (if equipped)
-- Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
malfunction (if equipped)
-- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
-- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
malfunction (if equipped)
-- Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go
radar blocked (if equipped)
-- Lamp malfunction
-- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
-- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction
4-30
04
User settings mode
OOSH049032L
OOSH049031L
In this mode, you can change the
settings of the instrument cluster, doors,
lamps, etc.
1. Head-up display
2. Driver assistance
3. Door
4. Lights
5. Sound
6. Convenience
7. Service interval
8. Other features
9. Language
10. Reset
The information provided may differ
depending on which functions are
applicable to your vehicle.
Shift to P to edit settings
This warning message appears if you try
to adjust the User Settings while driving.
For your safety, change the User Settings
after parking the vehicle, applying the
parking brake and shifting to P (Park).
Quick guide help
This mode provides quick guides for the
systems in the User Settings mode.
Select an item, press and hold the OK
button.
For more details, about each system,
refer to this Owner’s Manual.
4-31
Instrument cluster
1. Head-up display
Items
Explanation
Display height
To adjust the height of the image displayed.
Rotation
To adjust the angle of the image displayed.
Brightness
To adjust the brightness of the image displayed.
Content selection
To select the content to be displayed.
-- Turn by turn
-- Traffic info
-- Driving assist info
-- Lane safety info
-- Blind-spot safety info
Speedometer size
To select the speedometer size displayed.
-- Small / Medium / Large
Speedometer color
To select the speedometer color displayed.
-- White / Orange / Green
For more information, refer to “Head-up display” section in chapter 5.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-32
04
2. Driver assistance
Items
SCC response
Explanation
• Fast / Normal / Slow
To adjust the sensitivity of the Smart Cruise Control system.
For more details, refer to ‘’Smart Cruise Control with Stop &
Go’’ section in chapter 6.
• Leading vehicle departure alert
To activate or deactivate the Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
function.
For more details, refer to the “Leading Vehicle Departure
Alert” section in chapter 6.
Driving assist
• LFA (Lane Following Assist)
To activate or deactivate the Lane Following Assist function.
For more details, refer to the “Lane Following Assist (LFA)
System” section in chapter 6.
• SLW (Speed Limit Warning)
To activate or deactivate the Speed Limit Warning function.
For more details, refer to the “Intelligent Speed Limit
Warning (ISLW) System” section in chapter 6.
DAW (Driver Attention
Warning)
• Swaying warning
To activate or deactivate the Driver Attention Warning
function.
For more details, refer to the “Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) System” section in chapter 6.
Warning timing
• Normal / Later
To select when to provide a warning for driver assistance
systems.
4-33
Instrument cluster
Items
Explanation
Forward safety
• Active assist: If selected, the system controls the vehicle and
provides a warning when a collision is detected.
• Warning only: If selected, the system provides a warning
when a collision is detected.
• Off: Deactivates the system.
For more details, refer to the “Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist System” section in chapter 6.
Lane safety
• Active LKA (Lane Keeping Assist): If selected, the system
controls the vehicle and provides a warning when the vehicle
leaves the lane.
• LKA (Lane Keeping Assist): If selected, the system controls
the vehicle and provides a warning when the vehicle leaves
the lane.
• LDW (Lane Departure Warning): If selected, the system
provides a warning when the vehicle leaves the lane.
• Off: Deactivates the LKA system.
For more details, refer to the “Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
System” section in chapter 6.
Blind-spot safety
• Warning only: If selected, the system provides a warning
when a collision is detected.
• Off: Deactivates the system.
For more details, refer to the “Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW) System” section in chapter 6.
Parking safety
• Rear cross-traffic safety
To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning function.
For more details, refer to “Rear Cross-traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) System” section in chapter 6.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-34
04
3. Door
Items
Explanation
Auto lock
• Enable on shift: All doors will be automatically locked if the
vehicle is shifted from the P (Park) position to the R (Reverse),
N (Neutral), or D (Drive) position.
• Enable on speed: All doors will be automatically locked when
the vehicle speed exceeds 15 km/h (9 mph).
• Off: The auto door lock operation will be cancelled.
Auto unlock
• On shift to P: All doors will be automatically unlocked if the
automatic transmission is shifted to the P (Park) position.
• On key out : All doors will be automatically unlocked when
the ignition key is removed from the key ignition switch (if
equipped with remote key).
• Vehicle off : All doors will be automatically unlocked when
the Engine Start/Stop button is set to the OFF position (if
equipped with smart key).
• Off: The auto door unlock operation will be cancelled.
Horn feedback
To activate or deactivate the horn feedback.
If the horn feedback is activated, after locking the door by
pressing the lock button on the remote key, and pressing it
again within 4 seconds, the horn feedback sound will operate
once to indicate that all doors are locked (if equipped with
remote key).
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-35
Instrument cluster
4. Lights
Items
Explanation
One touch turn indicator
• Off: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated.
• 3, 5, 7 Flashes: The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7
times when the turn signal lever is moved slightly.
For more details, refer to “Lighting” section in chapter 5.
Head lamp delay
To activate or deactivate the headlamp delay function.
For more details, refer to “Lighting” section in chapter 5.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
5. Sound
Items
Explanation
Volume for PDW (Parking
Distance Warning)
To adjust the volume of the Parking Distance Warning function.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-36
04
6. Convenience
Items
Welcome mirror
Explanation
To activate or deactivate the welcome mirror function.
When activated, the outside rearview mirrors are unfolded if
approached with the smart key.
For more details, refer to ‘’Outside Rearview Mirror’’ section
in chapter 5.
To activate or deactivate the wireless charging system in the
front seat.
Wireless charging system For more details, refer to “Wireless Cellular Phone Charging
System” section in chapter 5.
Wiper/Lights display
To activate or deactivate the Wiper/Light mode.
When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/
Light mode whenever you change the mode.
Auto rear wiper (reverse)
To activate or deactivate the rear wiper while the vehicle is in
reverse with the front wiper ON.
Gear position pop-up
To activate or deactivate the gear position pop-up.
When activated, the gear position will be displayed in the
cluster LCD display.
Coasting guidance
• Coasting guidance: To activate or deactivate the Coasting
Guide function.
• Sound: To activate or deactivate the Coasting Guide function
sound.
For more details, refer to “Coasting Guide” section in chapter
6.
Coasting timing
• Late / Normal / Early
To adjust the sensitivity of the Coasting Guide function.
For more details, refer to “Coasting Guide” section in chapter
6.
Icy road warning
To activate or deactivate the Icy Road Warning function.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-37
Instrument cluster
7. Service interval
Items
Explanation
Enable service interval
To activate or deactivate the service interval function.
Adjust Interval
If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the
time and distance.
If the service interval is activated and the time and distance is adjusted, messages are
displayed in the following situations each time the vehicle is turned on.
-- Service in: Displayed to inform the driver the remaining mileage and days to service.
-- Service required: Displayed when the mileage and days to service has been reached
or passed.
Information
If any of the following conditions occur, the mileage and number of days to service may be
incorrect.
-- The battery cable is disconnected.
-- The fuse switch is turned off.
-- The battery is discharged.
4-38
04
8. Other
Explanation
Items
Fuel economy auto reset
• Off: The average fuel economy will not reset automatically
whenever refueling.
• After ignition: When the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or
longer the average fuel economy will reset automatically.
• After refueling: The average fuel economy will reset
automatically after adding 6 liters (1.6 gallons) of fuel or more
and after driving speed exceeds 1 km/h (1 mph).
For more details, refer to “Trip Computer” in the following
pages.
Fuel economy unit
• km/L / L/100km
To select the fuel economy unit.
Temperature unit
• °C / °F
To select the temperature unit.
Tire pressure unit
• psi / kPa / bar
To select the tire pressure unit.
9. Language
Explanation
Items
To select language.
Language
10. Reset
Items
Reset
Explanation
You can reset the menus in the User Settings mode. All menus
in the User Settings mode are reset to factory settings, except
language and service interval.
ÃÃ The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-39
Instrument cluster
TRIP COMPUTER
The trip computer is a microcomputercontrolled driver information system that
displays information related to driving.
Information
• Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
• The vehicle must be driven for a
minimum of 300 meters (0.19 miles)
since the last ignition key cycle before
the average fuel economy will be
recalculated.
Trip modes
OOSH049025L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
To change the trip mode, toggle the “
” switch on the steering wheel.
,
Fuel economy
Fuel Economy
•Average Fuel Economy
•Instant Fuel Economy
Accumulated Info
•Tripmeter
•Fuel Economy
•Timer
Drive Info
•Tripmeter
•Fuel Economy
•Timer
Digital Speedometer
Driving Style
Energy Flow
Engine Coolant Temperature
4-40
OOSH049033L
Average Fuel Economy (1)
• The average fuel economy is
calculated by the total driving
distance and fuel consumption since
the last average fuel economy reset.
• The average fuel economy can
be reset both manually and
automatically.
04
Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the OK button on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second
when the average fuel economy is
displayed.
Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average fuel
economy, select between “After Ignition”
or “After Refueling” in the User Settings
mode in the cluster LCD display.
-- After ignition: When the engine has
been OFF for 4 hours or longer the
average fuel economy will reset
automatically.
-- After refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically after
adding 1.6 gallons (6 liters) of fuel or
more and after driving speed exceeds
1 mph (1 km/h).
Instant Fuel Economy (2)
• The instantaneous fuel economy is
displayed according to the bar graph
in the LCD display while driving.
Accumulated Info display
Type A
Type B
OOSH049034L
OOSH049035L
This display shows the accumulated trip
distance (1), the average fuel economy
(2), and the total driving time (3).
The information is accumulated starting
from the last reset.
To reset the details, press and hold
the OK button when viewing the
Accumulated driving info. The trip
distance, the average fuel economy,
and total driving time will reset
simultaneously.
The accumulated driving information will
continue to be counted while the engine
is still running (for example, when the
vehicle is in traffic or stopped at a stop
light).
4-41
Instrument cluster
Drive Info display
Type A
Digital speedometer
Type B
OOSH049036L
OOSH049037L
This display shows the trip distance (1),
the average fuel economy (2), and the
total driving time (3).
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the engine
has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the
Drive Info screen will reset.
To reset the details, press and hold
the OK button when viewing the Drive
Info. The trip distance, the average fuel
economy, and total driving time will reset
simultaneously.
The driving information will continue
to be counted while the engine is still
running (for example, when the vehicle is
in traffic or stopped at a stop light).
OOSH049038L
This digital speedometer display shows
the speed of the vehicle.
Driving style
OOSH049039L
The driving style is displayed when you
are driving in ECO mode.
When you drive in SPORT mode, each
driving category will be displayed with
“--”.
4-42
04
NOTICE
Energy flow
When the gauge indicator gets out of
the normal range, toward the “H(Hot)”
position, it indicates overheating of the
engine. It may damage the engine.
Do not continue driving with the
overheated engine.
For more details, refer to “If the Engine
Overheats” section in the chapter 7.
OOSH049040L
The hybrid system informs the drivers its
energy flow in various operating modes.
While driving, the current energy flow is
specified in 11 modes.
For more details, refer to HEV Energy
Flow in the “Hybrid System Overview”
section in chapter 1.
Engine coolant temperature
OOSH049041L
This engine coolant temperature gauge
display shows the temperature of the
engine coolant when the engine is
running.
4-43
5. Convenient features
Accessing your vehicle...................................................................................... 5-5
Remote key....................................................................................................................5-5
Smart key.......................................................................................................................5-8
Immobilizer system......................................................................................................5-12
Door locks......................................................................................................... 5-13
Operating door locks from outside the vehicle.........................................................5-13
Operating door locks from inside the vehicle........................................................... 5-14
Automatic door lock and unlock features................................................................. 5-16
Child-protector rear door locks...................................................................................5-17
Theft-alarm system...........................................................................................5-18
Steering wheel..................................................................................................5-19
Electric Power Steering (EPS)..................................................................................... 5-19
Tilt steering / Telescopic steering..............................................................................5-20
Horn.............................................................................................................................5-20
Heated steering wheel.................................................................................................5-21
Mirrors............................................................................................................... 5-21
Inside rearview mirror..................................................................................................5-21
Outside rearview mirrors............................................................................................ 5-23
Windows............................................................................................................5-25
Power windows...........................................................................................................5-26
Sunroof............................................................................................................. 5-29
Sunroof opening and closing.....................................................................................5-30
Sliding the sunroof......................................................................................................5-30
Tilting the sunroof.......................................................................................................5-30
Sunshade......................................................................................................................5-31
Resetting the sunroof..................................................................................................5-31
Sunroof open warning................................................................................................ 5-32
Exterior features............................................................................................... 5-33
Hood.............................................................................................................................5-33
Tailgate.........................................................................................................................5-34
Fuel filler door.............................................................................................................5-36
Head-Up Display (HUD).................................................................................. 5-39
5
Lighting............................................................................................................. 5-42
Exterior lights..............................................................................................................5-42
Interior lights.............................................................................................................. 5-50
Wipers and washers......................................................................................... 5-52
Windshield wipers.......................................................................................................5-52
Windshield washers....................................................................................................5-53
Rear window wiper and washer.................................................................................5-54
Driver assist system......................................................................................... 5-55
Rear View Monitor.......................................................................................................5-55
Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) system...................................................5-56
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) system....................................5-59
Automatic climate control system.................................................................. 5-63
Automatic temperature control mode...................................................................... 5-64
Manual temperature control mode............................................................................5-65
System operation.........................................................................................................5-71
System maintenance.................................................................................................. 5-72
5
Windshield defrosting and defogging.............................................................5-74
To defog inside windshield......................................................................................... 5-74
To defrost inside windshield....................................................................................... 5-75
Defogging logic........................................................................................................... 5-75
Auto defogging system............................................................................................... 5-76
Rear window defroster............................................................................................... 5-77
Climate control additional features................................................................ 5-78
Automatic ventilation.................................................................................................. 5-78
Sunroof inside air recirculation.................................................................................. 5-78
Storage compartment......................................................................................5-79
Center console storage............................................................................................... 5-79
Glove box..................................................................................................................... 5-79
Sunglass holder.......................................................................................................... 5-80
Multi box..................................................................................................................... 5-80
5. Convenient features
Interior features................................................................................................5-81
Cup holder................................................................................................................... 5-81
Sunvisor.......................................................................................................................5-82
Power outlet................................................................................................................5-82
USB charger.................................................................................................................5-83
Wireless cellular phone charging system................................................................. 5-84
Clock........................................................................................................................... 5-86
Coat hook.....................................................................................................................5-87
Floor mat anchor(s).....................................................................................................5-87
Luggage net holder.................................................................................................... 5-88
Cargo area cover........................................................................................................ 5-89
Luggage tray............................................................................................................... 5-89
Exterior features...............................................................................................5-90
Roof side rails............................................................................................................. 5-90
Infotainment system.........................................................................................5-91
USB Port....................................................................................................................... 5-91
Antenna........................................................................................................................ 5-91
Steering wheel remote controls.................................................................................5-92
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology................................................................................5-93
How vehicle radio works.............................................................................................5-93
Audio (without touch screen)..........................................................................5-96
System layout – control panel................................................................................... 5-96
System layout – steering wheel remote control...................................................... 5-98
Turning the system on or off.....................................................................................5-100
Turning the display on or off.....................................................................................5-100
Getting to know the basic operations.......................................................................5-101
Radio................................................................................................................5-102
Turning on the radio.................................................................................................. 5-102
Changing the radio mode......................................................................................... 5-103
Scanning for available radio stations....................................................................... 5-103
Searching for radio stations..................................................................................... 5-104
Saving radio stations................................................................................................. 5-104
Listening to saved radio stations............................................................................. 5-104
5
Media player....................................................................................................5-105
Using the media player............................................................................................. 5-105
Using the USB mode................................................................................................. 5-105
Using the iPod mode................................................................................................. 5-108
Bluetooth.......................................................................................................... 5-111
Connecting Bluetooth devices...................................................................................5-111
Using a Bluetooth audio device................................................................................ 5-114
Using a Bluetooth phone........................................................................................... 5-115
Setup................................................................................................................5-120
Display........................................................................................................................ 5-120
Sound......................................................................................................................... 5-120
Date/Time................................................................................................................... 5-121
Bluetooth.................................................................................................................... 5-121
System......................................................................................................................... 5-121
System status icons........................................................................................ 5-122
Infotainment system specifications.............................................................. 5-123
5
USB..............................................................................................................................5-123
Bluetooth................................................................................................................... 5-124
Trademarks...................................................................................................... 5-124
Declaration of conformity.............................................................................. 5-125
CE RED for EU.............................................................................................................5-125
RoHS for Taiwan.........................................................................................................5-125
NCC for Taiwan.......................................................................................................... 5-126
05
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
Remote key (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not leave the keys in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could place the
key in the ignition switch and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking your vehicle
Your HYUNDAI uses a remote key, which
you can use to lock or unlock the driver
and passenger doors or the rear tailgate.
(1) Door Lock
(2) Door Unlock
(3) Tailgate Unlock
To unlock your vehicle:
1. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the remote key.
2. All doors will unlock. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times.
3. After unlocking the doors, the doors
will automatically relock after 30
seconds unless a door is opened.
Locking your vehicle
Opening the tailgate
OOSH059001L
To lock your vehicle:
1. Make sure all doors, the engine hood
and the tailgate are closed.
2. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
3. If the Door Lock button (1) is pressed
once more within four seconds, the
horn will beep once and the hazard
warning lights will blink.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
To unlock the tailgate:
1. Press and hold the Tailgate Unlock
button (3) on the remote key for more
than one second.
2. The hazard warning lights will blink
two times and the tailgate will be
unlocked.
3. After the tailgate is opened and then
closed, the tailgate will automatically
relock after 30 seconds.
5-5
Convenient features
Information
The word “HOLD” is written on the
button to inform you that you must press
and hold the button for more than one
second.
Mechanical key
If the Remote Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the door
by using the mechanical key.
Start-up
For information, refer to the “Key
Ignition Switch” section in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the remote key:
• Keep the remote key away from
water or any liquid and fire. Internal
circuits may malfunction if the inside
of the remote key gets damp (from
liquids or moisture) or if it is heated.
This can exclude the remote key from
being covered under warranty.
• Avoid dropping or throwing the
remote key.
• Protect the remote key from extreme
temperatures.
5-6
OOSH059002L
If the remote key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver’s door by using the mechanical
key.
To unfold the mechanical key, press the
release button on the remote.
To return the key to its stored position,
press the release button and fold the key
back into the remote.
05
Remote key precautions
The remote key will not work if any of the
following occur:
• The key is in the ignition switch.
• You exceed the operating distance
limit (about 30 m [90 feet]).
• The remote key battery is weak.
• Other vehicles or objects may be
blocking the signal.
• The weather is extremely cold.
• The remote key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the remote key.
If the remote key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have
a problem with the remote key, it is
recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the remote key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is specifically
relevant when the phone is active such
as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails.
When possible, avoid placing the remote
key and your mobile phone in the same
location such as a pants or jacket pocket
in order to avoid interference between
the two devices.
NOTICE
Keep the remote key away from
electromagnetic materials that block
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
Battery replacement
OOSH059003L
If the remote key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and
gently pry open the cover.
2. Using a screw driver, remove the
battery cover.
3. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the battery cover and key
cover in the reverse order of removal.
If you suspect your remote key might
have sustained some damage, or you feel
your remote key is not working correctly,
it is recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
5-7
Convenient features
Smart key (if equipped)
Locking your vehicle
OOSH059004L
OOSH059005L
Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key, which
you can use to lock or unlock the driver
and passenger doors or the rear tailgate.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Tailgate Unlock
To lock your vehicle using the door
handle button or the Smart Key:
1. Make sure all doors, the hood and the
tailgate are closed.
2. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
3. Press either the button on the door
handle or the Door Lock button (1) on
the smart key. The hazard warning
lights will blink.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
Information
The door handle button will only operate
when the smart key is within 0.7~1 m
(28~40 in.) from the outside door handle.
Note that you cannot lock your vehicle
using the door handle button if any of
the following occur:
• The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
• The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
• Any of the doors are open except for
the tailgate.
5-8
05
WARNING
Information
Do not leave the Smart Key in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could press the
Engine Start/ Stop button and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking your vehicle
The door handle buttons will only operate
when the smart key is within 0.7~1 m
(28~40 in.) from the outside door handle
Opening the tailgate
To unlock and open the tailgate:
1. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
2. Press either the tailgate handle
release button on the vehicle or press
and hold the Tailgate Unlock button
on the smart key for more than one
second. The hazard warning lights will
blink two times and the tailgate latch
will unlock.
NOTICE
OOSH059005L
To unlock your vehicle using the door
handle button or the Smart Key:
1. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
2. Press either the button on the door
handle or the Door Unlock button (2)
on the smart key. All doors will unlock
and the hazard warning lights will
blink two times.
3. After unlocking the doors, the doors
will automatically relock after 30
seconds unless a door is opened.
The tailgate must be operated manually
to open the tailgate. Once the tailgate
latch is unlocked, pull upward on
the tailgate handle to fully open the
tailgate.
3. After the tailgate is opened and then
closed, the tailgate will automatically
relock after 30 seconds.
5-9
Convenient features
Information
• The tailgate handle switch will only
operate when the smart key is within
0.7 m (28 in.) from the tailgate handle.
• The Tailgate Unlock button (3) will
only unlock the tailgate. It will not
release the latch and open the tailgate
automatically. If the tailgate Unlock
button is used, someone must still press
the tailgate handle switch to open the
tailgate.
Mechanical key
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver’s door by using the mechanical
key.
Start-up
You can start the vehicle without
inserting the key.
For information, refer to the “Engine
Start/Stop Button” section in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the smart key:
• Keep the smart key in a cool,
dry place to avoid damage or
malfunction. Exposure to moisture
or high temperature may cause
the internal circuit of the smart key
to malfunction which may not be
covered under warranty.
• Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
• Protect the smart key from extreme
temperatures.
5-10
OOSH059006L
To remove the mechanical key from the
smart key FOB, slide the release lever in
the direction of the arrow (1) and then
pull the mechanical key (2) outward.
To unlock the vehicle using the
mechanical key. insert the mechanical
key into the key hole in the driver door.
To reinstall the mechanical key into the
FOB, insert the key in the top of the key
FOB and push inward until a click sound
is heard.
Loss of a smart key
A maximum of two Smart Keys can
be registered to a single vehicle. If
you happen to lose your smart key,
it is recommended that you should
immediately take the vehicle and
remaining keys to your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle, if
necessary.
05
Smart key precautions
The smart key may not work if any of the
following occur:
• The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the transmitter.
• The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular phone.
• Another vehicle’s smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
If the smart key does not work correctly,
open and close the door with the
mechanical key. If you have a problem
with the smart key, it is recommended to
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is specifically
relevant when the phone is active such
as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails. When possible, avoid keeping the
smart key and your mobile phone in the
same location such as a pants or jacket
pocket in order to avoid interference
between the two devices.
NOTICE
Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that blocks
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
NOTICE
Always have the smart key with you
when leaving the vehicle. If the smart
key is left near the vehicle, the vehicle
battery may be discharged.
Battery replacement
OOSH059007L
If the Smart Key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Remove the mechanical key.
2. Use a slim tool to pry open the rear
cover of the smart key.
3. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the rear cover of the smart
key.
If you suspect your smart key might have
sustained some damage, or you feel
your smart key is not working correctly,
it is recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
5-11
Convenient features
Immobilizer system (if equipped)
The immobilizer system protects your
vehicle from theft. If an improperly
coded key (or other device) is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
When the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position, the immobilizer system
indicator should come on briefly, then
go off. If the indicator starts to blink, the
system does not recognize the coding of
the key.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF
position, then turn the ignition switch to
the ON position again.
In some circumstances, the vehicle may
not recognize your smart key if another
smart key device is nearby or a metal
object such as a key chain is causing
interference with the smart key.
If this occurs, your vehicle may not
start. Remove any metal objects or
additional keys near the smart key before
attempting to start the vehicle again.
5-12
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer
unique password and should be kept
confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give years
of trouble-free service, however you
should avoid exposure to moisture,
static electricity and rough handling.
Immobilizer system malfunction could
occur.
05
DOOR LOCKS
Operating door locks from
outside the vehicle
Remote key
Mechanical key
Remote key
Smart key
OOSH059009L
[A] : Unlock, [B] : Lock
OOSH059008L
[A] : Lock, [B] : Unlock
If you lock the driver’s door with a
mechanical key, all vehicle doors will
lock. If you unlock the driver’s door with
a mechanical key, all vehicle doors will
unlock.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
To lock the doors, press the Door Lock
button (1) on the remote key.
To unlock the doors, press the Door
Unlock button (2) on the remote key.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
5-13
Convenient features
Smart key
Information
• In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
• If the door is locked/unlocked multiple
times in rapid succession with either
the vehicle key or door lock switch, the
system may stop operating temporarily
in order to protect the circuit and
prevent damage to system components.
OOSH059005L
Operating door locks from inside
the vehicle
With the door lock button
OOSH059010L
Press the button on the driver’s outside
door handle while carrying the Smart Key
with you or press the Door Lock button
(1) on the Smart Key, all the doors will
lock.
Press the button on the driver’s outside
door handle while carrying the Smart
Key with you or press the Unlock button
(2) on the Smart Key, all the doors will
unlock.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
5-14
OOSH059011L
• To unlock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Unlock” position.
The red mark (2) on the door lock
button will be visible.
• To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Lock” position. If the
door is locked properly, the red mark
(2) on the door lock button will not be
visible.
• To open a door, pull the door handle
(3) outward.
05
• For Key Start Vehicles (with Remote
Key)
The front doors cannot be locked if
the remote key is in the ignition switch
and either of the front doors are open.
• For Push Button Start Vehicles (with
Smart Key)
The doors cannot be locked if the
smart key fob is inside the vehicle and
any of the doors are open.
With the door handle
Front door
If the inner door handle is pulled when
the door is locked, the door will unlock
and open.
Rear door
If the inner door handle is pulled once
when the door is locked, the door will
unlock. If the inner door handle is pulled
once more, the door will open.
Information
If a power door lock ever fails to function
while you are in the vehicle try one or
more of the following techniques to exit:
• Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and
manual) while simultaneously pulling
on the door handle.
• Operate the other door locks and
handles, front and rear.
• Lower a front window and use the
mechanical key to unlock the door from
outside.
With the central door lock switch
OOSH059012L
The driver side door armrest is equipped
with a central door lock switch. The lock
button is indicated by a ( ) symbol.
The unlock button is indicated by a ( )
symbol.
When the lock button (1) is pressed, all
the vehicle doors will lock.
When the unlock button (2) is pressed, all
the vehicle doors will unlock.
• For Key Start Vehicles (with remote
key)
If the key is in the ignition switch and
any door is opened, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (1) is
pressed.
• For Push Button Start Vehicles (with
Smart Key)
If the smart key is in the vehicle and
any door is open, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (1) is
pressed.
5-15
Convenient features
WARNING
• The doors should always be fully
closed and locked while the
vehicle is in motion. If the doors
are unlocked, the risk of being
thrown from the vehicle in a crash is
increased.
• Do not pull the inner door handle of
the driver’s or passenger’s door while
the vehicle is moving.
WARNING
Do not leave children or animals
unattended in your vehicle. An enclosed
vehicle can become extremely hot,
causing death or serious injury to
unattended children or animals who
cannot escape the vehicle. Children
might operate features of the vehicle
that could injure them, or they could
encounter other harm, possibly from
someone gaining entry to the vehicle.
WARNING
Always secure your vehicle.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked increases
the potential risk to you or others from
someone hiding in your vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while depressing
the brake, move the shift lever to the
P (Park) position, engage the parking
brake, and place the ignition switch
in the LOCK/OFF position, close all
windows, lock all doors, and always
take the key with you.
5-16
CAUTION
Opening a door when something is
approaching may cause damage or
injury. Be careful when opening doors
and watch for vehicles, motorcycles,
bicycles or pedestrians approaching the
vehicle in the path of the door.
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a long time
while the weather is very hot or cold,
there are risks of injuries or danger to
life. Do not lock the vehicle from the
outside when someone is in the vehicle.
Automatic door lock and unlock
features
Your vehicle is equipped with features
that will automatically lock or unlock
your vehicle based on settings you select
in the cluster LCD display.
Auto LOCK - Enable on speed
When this feature is set in the cluster
LCD display, all the doors will be locked
automatically when the vehicle exceeds
15 km/h (9 mph).
Auto LOCK - Enable on shift
When this feature is set in the cluster
LCD display, all the doors will be locked
automatically when the vehicle is shifted
out of P (Park) while the engine is
running.
05
Auto UNLOCK - On Shift to P
Child-protector rear door locks
When this feature is set in the cluster
LCD display, all the doors will be
unlocked automatically when the vehicle
is shifted back into P (Park).
Auto UNLOCK- On key out (with
Remote key)
When this feature is set in the cluster
LCD display, all the doors will be
unlocked automatically when the key is
removed from the ignition switch.
OOSH059013L
Auto UNLOCK - Vehicle off (with
Smart key)
When this feature is set in the cluster
LCD display, all the doors will be
unlocked automatically when the vehicle
is turned off.
For more details, on these features,
refer to the LCD Display section in
chapter 4.
Additional unlock safety feature - air
bag deployment
As an additional safety feature, all doors
will be automatically unlocked when an
impact causes the air bags to deploy.
The child safety lock is provided to help
prevent children seated in the rear from
accidentally opening the rear doors. The
rear door safety locks should be used
whenever children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on the
edge of each rear door. When the child
safety lock is in the lock position, the
rear door will not open if the inner door
handle is pulled.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a
small flat blade tool (like a screwdriver or
similar) (1) into the slot and turn it to the
lock position as shown.
To allow a rear door to be opened from
inside the vehicle, unlock the child safety
lock.
WARNING
If children accidently open the rear
doors while the vehicle is in motion,
they could fall out of the vehicle. The
rear door safety locks should always
be used whenever children are in the
vehicle.
5-17
Convenient features
THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM
This system helps to protect your vehicle
and valuables. The horn will sound and
the hazard warning lights will blink
continuously if any of the following
occur:
-- A door is opened without using the
remote key or smart key.
-- The tailgate is opened without using
the remote key or smart key.
-- The engine hood is opened.
The alarm continues for 30 seconds, then
the system resets. To turn off the alarm,
unlock the doors with the remote key or
smart key.
The Theft Alarm System automatically
sets 30 seconds after you lock the
doors and the tailgate. For the system
to activate, you must lock the doors and
the tailgate from outside the vehicle
with the remote key or smart key or by
pressing the button on the outside of the
door handle with the smart key in your
possession.
The hazard warning lights will blink and
the chime will sound once to indicate the
system is armed.
Once the security system is set, opening
any door, the tailgate, or the hood
without using the remote key or smart
key will cause the alarm to activate.
The Theft Alarm System will not set if the
hood, the tailgate, or any door is not fully
closed. If the system will not set, check
the hood, the tailgate, or the doors are
fully closed.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it.
5-18
Information
• Do not lock the doors until all
passengers have left the vehicle. If the
remaining passenger leaves the vehicle
when the system is armed, the alarm
will be activated.
• If the vehicle is not disarmed with the
remote key or smart key, open the
doors by using the mechanical key
and place the ignition switch in the
ON position (for remote key) or start
the engine (for smart key) by directly
pressing the ignition switch with the
smart key.
• If the system is disarmed by unlocking
the vehicle, but neither a door or the
tailgate is opened within 30 seconds, the
doors will relock and the system will
rearm automatically.
Information
OHI038181L
Vehicles equipped with a theft alarm
system will have a label attached to the
vehicle with the following words:
1. WARNING
2. SECURITY SYSTEM
05
STEERING WHEEL
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
The system assists you with steering the
vehicle. If the vehicle is turned off or
if the power steering system becomes
inoperative, you may still steer the
vehicle, but it will require increased
steering effort.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, we recommend that
you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
CAUTION
If the Electric Power Steering System
does not operate normally, the warning
light ( ) and the message “Check
motor driven power steering” will
illuminate on the instrument cluster.
You may steer the vehicle, but it will
require increased steering efforts. We
recommend that you take the vehicle
to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked as soon as
possible.
Information
The following symptoms may occur during
normal vehicle operation:
• The steering effort may be high
immediately after placing the ignition
switch in the ON position.
This happens as the system performs
the EPS system diagnostics. When the
diagnostics are completed, the steering
wheel effort will return to its normal
condition.
• A click noise may be heard from the
EPS relay after the ignition switch is in
the ON or LOCK/OFF position.
• Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at a stop or at a low driving
speed.
• When you operate the steering wheel
in low temperatures, abnormal noise
may occur. If the temperature rises, the
noise will disappear.
This is a normal condition.
• When an error is detected from the
EPS, the steering effort assist function
will not be activated in order to
prevent fatal accidents. Instrument
cluster warning lights may be on or the
steering effort may be high. If these
symptoms occur, drive the vehicle
to a safe area as soon as it is safe to
do so. We recommend that you have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
5-19
Convenient features
Tilt steering / Telescopic steering
When adjusting the steering wheel to a
comfortable position, adjust the steering
wheel so that it points toward your chest,
not toward your face. Make sure you can
see the instrument cluster warning lights
and gauges. After adjusting, push the
steering wheel both up and down to be
certain it is locked in position.
Always adjust the position of the steering
wheel before driving.
Information
Sometimes the lock release lever may not
engage completely. This may occur when
the gears of the locking mechanism do not
completely mesh. If this occurs, pull down
on the lock-release lever, readjust the
steering wheel again, and then pull back
up on the release lever to lock the steering
wheel in place.
Horn
WARNING
NEVER adjust the steering wheel while
driving. This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
OOSH059015L
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel (see illustration). The
horn will operate only when this area is
pressed.
OOSH059014L
To adjust the steering wheel angle and
height:
1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1).
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the
desired angle (2) and distance
forward/back (3).
3. Pull up the lock-release lever to lock
the steering wheel in place.
5-20
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist. Do not
press on the horn with a sharp-pointed
object.
05
MIRRORS
Heated steering wheel
(if equipped)
Inside rearview mirror
Before driving your vehicle, check to
see that your inside rearview mirror is
properly positioned. Adjust the rearview
mirror so that the view through the rear
window is properly centered.
WARNING
OOSH059016L
When the ignition switch is in the ON
position or when the engine is running,
press the heated steering wheel button
to warm the steering wheel. The
indicator on the button will illuminate.
To turn the heated steering wheel off,
press the button again. The indicator on
the button will turn off.
The heated steering wheel will
automatically turn off after
approximately 30 minutes.
NOTICE
Do not install any cover or accessory
on the steering wheel. The cover or
accessory could cause damage to the
heated steering wheel system.
Make sure your line of sight is not
obstructed. Do not place objects in the
rear seat, cargo area, or behind the rear
headrests which could interfere with
your vision through the rear window.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during an
accident or deployment of the air bag,
do not modify the rearview mirror and
do not install a wide mirror.
WARNING
NEVER adjust the mirror while driving.
This may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
NOTICE
When cleaning the mirror, use a paper
towel or similar material dampened
with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass
cleaner directly on the mirror as this
may cause the liquid cleaner to enter
the mirror housing.
5-21
Convenient features
Day/night rearview mirror
(if equipped)
Electric Chromic Mirror (ECM)
(if equipped)
OOSH059017L
OOSH059018L
[A] : Day, [B] : Night
[A] : Indicator
Make this adjustment before you start
driving and while the day/night lever is in
the day position.
Pull the day/night lever towards you to
reduce glare from the headlights of the
vehicles behind you during night driving.
Remember that you lose some rearview
clarity in the night position.
Some vehicles come equipped with an
electrochromic mirror that helps control
glare while driving at night or under low
light driving conditions.
When the engine is running, the glare is
automatically controlled by the sensor
mounted in the rearview mirror. The
sensor detects the light level around the
vehicle, and automatically adjusts to
control the headlamp glare from vehicles
behind you.
Whenever the shift lever is placed in R
(Reverse), the mirror will automatically
go to the brightest setting in order to
improve the driver’s view behind the
vehicle.
5-22
05
Outside rearview mirrors
OOSH059019L
Make sure to adjust the outside rearview
mirrors to your desired position before
you begin driving.
Your vehicle is equipped with both lefthand and right-hand outside rearview
mirrors. The mirrors can be adjusted
remotely with the remote switch. The
outside rearview mirrors can be folded
to help prevent damage when going
through an automatic car wash or when
passing through a narrow street.
The right outside rearview mirror is
convex. Objects seen in the mirror are
closer than they appear.
Use the inside rear view mirror or look
back directly to determine the actual
distance of other vehicles prior to
changing lanes.
WARNING
Do not adjust or fold the outside
rearview mirrors while driving. This may
cause loss of vehicle control resulting in
an accident.
NOTICE
• Do not scrape ice off the mirror face;
this may damage the surface of the
glass.
• If the mirror is jammed with ice, do
not adjust the mirror by force. Use an
approved spray de-icer (not radiator
antifreeze) spray, or a sponge or soft
cloth with very warm water, or move
the vehicle to a warm place and
allow the ice to melt.
• Do not clean the mirror with harsh
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum
based cleaning products.
Adjusting the rearview mirrors
OOSH059020L
Adjusting the rearview mirrors:
1. Press either the L (Left side) or R
(Right side) button (1) to select the
rearview mirror you would like to
adjust.
2. Use the mirror adjustment control
switch to position the selected mirror
up, down, left or right.
3. After adjustment, put the button into
neutral (center) position to prevent
inadvertent adjustment.
5-23
Convenient features
NOTICE
• The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting
angles, but the motor continues to
operate while the switch is pressed.
Do not press the switch longer than
necessary, because this can damage
the motor.
• Do not attempt to adjust the
rearview mirrors by hand, because
this can damage the motor.
Folding the rearview mirrors
Center (AUTO): The mirror will fold or
unfold automatically as follows:
• With remote key system
-- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the remote key
• With smart key system
-- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the smart key.
-- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the button on the outside door
handle.
-- The mirror will unfold when the
vehicle is approached with the
smart key and ‘Welcome mirror’
from the User Settings mode in the
cluster LCD display is selected (if
equipped).
NOTICE
OOSH059021L
Manual type (if equipped)
To fold the rearview mirrors, grasp the
housing of the mirror and then fold it
inwards.
The electric type outside rearview
mirror operates even though the
ignition switch is in the OFF position.
However, to prevent unnecessary
battery discharge, do not adjust the
mirrors longer than necessary while the
vehicle is not in the ready ( ) mode.
NOTICE
Do not fold the electric type outside
rearview mirror by hand. It could cause
motor failure.
OOSH059022L
Electric type (if equipped)
The rearview mirrors can be folded
or unfolded by pressing the switch as
below.
Left: The mirror will unfold.
Right: The mirror will fold.
5-24
05
WINDOWS
OOS047017
(1) Driver’s door power window switch
(2) Front passenger’s door power
window switch
(3) Rear door (left) power window switch
(4) Rear door (right) power window
switch
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window
(7) Power window lock switch
5-25
Convenient features
Power windows
Auto down window (if equipped)
The ignition switch must be in the
ON position to be able to raise or
lower the windows. Each door has a
Power Window switch to control that
door’s window. The driver has a Power
Window Lock switch which can block
the operation of passenger windows.
The power windows will operate for
approximately 30 seconds after the
ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
LOCK/OFF position. However, if the front
doors are opened, the Power Windows
will not operate even within the 30
second period.
Pressing the power window switch
down momentarily to the second
detent position (6) completely lowers
the window even when the switch is
released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up or press down and
release the switch.
Window opening and closing
Auto up/down window (if equipped)
Pressing or pulling up the power window
switch momentarily to the second
detent position (6) completely lowers or
lifts the window even when the switch
is released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up or press down and
release the switch.
To reset the power windows
OOSH059023L
To open:
Press the window switch down to the
first detent position (5). Release the
switch when you want the window to
stop.
To close:
Pull the window switch up to the first
detent position (5). Release the window
switch when you want the window to
stop.
5-26
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window
system must be reset as follows:
1. Place the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Close the window and continue
pulling up on the power window
switch for at least one second.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
05
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
Information
The automatic reverse feature is only
active when the “Auto Up” feature is used
by fully pulling up the switch to the second
detent.
WARNING
OOSH059024L
If a window senses any obstacle while it
is closing automatically, it will stop and
lower approximately 30 cm (12 in.) to
allow the object to be cleared.
If the window detects the resistance
while the power window switch is
pulled up continuously, the window
will stop upward movement then lower
approximately 2.5 cm (1 in.).
If the power window switch is pulled
up continuously again within 5 seconds
after the window is lowered by the
automatic window reverse feature,
the automatic window reverse will not
operate.
Make sure body parts or other objects
are safely out of the way before closing
the windows to avoid injuries or vehicle
damage.
Objects less than 4 mm (0.16 inch) in
diameter caught between the window
glass and the upper window channel
may not be detected by the automatic
reverse window and the window will
not stop and reverse direction.
5-27
Convenient features
Power window lock switch
WARNING
Do not allow children to play with the
power windows. Keep the driver’s
door power window lock switch in the
LOCK position. Serious injury or death
can result from unintentional window
operation by a child.
NOTICE
OOSH059025L
The driver can disable the power window
switches on the rear passenger doors by
pressing the power window lock switch.
When the power window lock switch is
pressed:
• The rear passenger control will not
be able to operate the rear passenger
power window
• Note that the front passenger control
is still able to operate the front
passenger window, and that the driver
master control can still operate all the
power windows.
5-28
• To prevent possible damage to the
power window system, do not open
or close two windows or more at the
same time. This will also ensure the
longevity of the fuse.
• Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver’s door and the
individual door window switch in
opposite directions at the same time.
If this is done, the window will stop
and cannot be opened or closed.
05
SUNROOF (IF EQUIPPED)
If your vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, you can slide or tilt your sunroof
with the sunroof control switch located
on the overhead console.
OOSH059026L
The sunroof can only be opened, closed,
or tilted when the ignition switch is in the
ON position.
The sunroof can be operated for
approximately 30 seconds after the
ignition switch is in the ACC or LOCK/
OFF position. However, if the front
door is opened, the sunroof cannot be
operated even within 30 seconds period.
Information
• In cold and wet climates, the sunroof
may not work properly due to freezing
conditions.
• After the vehicle is washed or in a
rainstorm, be sure to wipe off any
water that is on the sunroof before
operating it.
WARNING
• Never adjust the sunroof or sunshade
while driving. This could result in
loss of control and an accident that
may cause death, serious injury, or
property damage.
• Make sure heads, hands, arms or
any other body parts or objects are
out of the way before operating the
sunroof.
• Do not extend your head, arms or
body outside the sunroof while
driving, to avoid serious injury.
• Do not leave the engine running
and the key in your vehicle with
unsupervised children. Unattended
children could operate the sunroof,
which could result in serious injury.
• Do not sit on the top of the vehicle. It
may cause injury or vehicle damage.
NOTICE
• Do not continue to move the sunroof
control lever after the sunroof is fully
opened, closed, or tilted. Damage
to the motor or system components
could occur.
• Make sure the sunroof is closed fully
when leaving your vehicle.
If the sunroof is left open, rain or
snow may wet the interior of the
vehicle. Also, leaving the sunroof
open when the vehicle is unattended
may invite theft.
5-29
Convenient features
Sunroof opening and closing
WARNING
Small objects that can get caught
between the sunroof glass and the front
glass channel may not be detected by
the automatic reverse system. In this
case, the sunroof glass will not detect
the object and reverse direction.
Sliding the sunroof
OOSH059027L
To open the sunroof:
Press the sunroof control lever backward
to the first detent position. Release the
switch when you want the sunroof to
stop.
To close the sunroof:
Press the sunroof control lever forward
to the first detent position. Release the
switch when you want the sunroof to
stop.
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
Pressing the sunroof control lever
backward or forward momentarily to the
second detent position completely opens
or closes the sunroof even when the
switch is released. To stop the sunroof at
the desired position while the sunroof is
in operation, press the sunroof control
lever backward or forward and release
the switch.
Information
To minimize wind noise while driving, it
is recommended that you drive with the
sunroof slightly closed (stop the sunroof
about 2 inch (5 cm) before the maximum
slide open position).
Tilting the sunroof
OOSH049042L
If the sunroof senses any obstacle while
it is closing automatically, it will reverse
direction then stop to allow the object to
be cleared.
The auto reverse function does not work
if a small obstacle is between the sliding
glass and the sunroof sash.
You should always check that all
passengers and objects are away from
the sunroof before closing it.
5-30
OOSH059028L
Tilt the sunroof open:
Push the sunroof control lever upward
until the sunroof moves to the desired
position.
To close the sunroof:
Push the sunroof control lever forward
until the sunroof moves to the desired
position.
05
NOTICE
Resetting the sunroof
• Periodically remove any dirt that may
accumulate on the sunroof guide
rail or between the sunroof and roof
panel which can make a noise.
• Do not try to open the sunroof when
the temperature is below freezing
or when the sunroof is covered with
snow or ice, otherwise the motor
could be damaged. In cold and wet
climates, the sunroof may not work
properly.
Sunshade
OOSH059029L
The sunshade can be opened and closed
manually. However, the sunshade will
open automatically with the sunroof
glass when both the sunroof and
sunshade are closed and the sunroof
control lever is operated.
NOTICE
Do not leave the sunshade closed while
the sunroof is open.
In some circumstances resetting the
sunroof operation may need to be
performed. Some instances where
resetting the sunroof may be required
include:
-- When the 12V battery in the engine
room is either disconnected or
discharged
-- When the 12V battery fuse is replaced
-- If the sunroof one-touch AUTO OPEN/
CLOSE operation is not functioning
properly
Sunroof resetting procedure:
1. It is recommended to perform the
reset procedure with the vehicle
engine running. Start the vehicle in P
(Park).
2. Make sure the sunroof is in the fully
closed position. If the sunroof is open,
push the control lever forward until
the sunroof is fully closed.
3. Release the control lever when the
sunroof is fully closed.
4. Push the control lever forward about
10 seconds.
-- When the sunroof is in the closed
position:
The glass will tilt and slightly move
up and down.
-- When the sunroof is in the tilt
position:
The glass will slightly move up and
down.
5-31
Convenient features
Do not release the lever until the
operation is completed.
If you release the lever during operation,
start the procedure again from step 2.
Sunroof open warning
5. Within 3 seconds, push and hold the
control lever forward until the sunroof
operates as follows:
Tilt down → Slide Open → Slide Close.
Do not release the lever until the
operation is completed.
If you release the lever during operation,
start the procedure again from step 2.
6. Release the sunroof control lever after
all steps have completed. The sunroof
system has been reset.
Information
• If the sunroof is not reset when the
vehicle battery is disconnected or
discharged, or the sunroof fuse is
blown, the sunroof may not operate
normally.
• For more detailed information, we
recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-32
OOSH059030L
• If the driver turns off the engine
when the sunroof is not fully closed,
the warning chime will sound for
approximately 3 seconds and the
sunroof open warning will appear on
the LCD display.
• If the driver turns off the engine and
opens the door when the sunroof is
not fully closed, the open sunroof
warning will appear on the LCD
display until the door is closed or the
sunroof is fully closed.
Close the sunroof securely when leaving
your vehicle.
05
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Hood
Opening the hood
OOSH059033L
OOSH059031L
1. Park the vehicle and set the parking
brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch the
hood. The hood should pop open
slightly.
4. Pull out the support rod and hold the
hood open with the support rod (1).
WARNING
• When handling the support rod,
grasp the rod in the area wrapped
with rubber only. In some cases
where the engine has been running
the support rod may be hot. Caution
should be taken to avoid getting
burned by the support rod.
• The support rod must be inserted
completely into the hole provided
whenever you inspect the engine
compartment. This will prevent the
hood from becoming dislodged and
falling and causing potential injury.
OOSH059032L
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise the
hood slightly, push up the secondary
latch (1) inside of the hood center and
lift the hood (2).
5-33
Convenient features
Closing the hood
1. Before closing the hood, check in and
around the engine compartment to
ensure the following:
-- Any tools or other loose objects
are removed from the engine room
area or hood opening area
-- All glove, rags, or other
combustible material is removed
from the engine compartment
-- All filler caps are tightly and
correctly installed
2. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 30 cm (12 in.) from the
closed position) and push down to
securely lock in place. Then double
check to be sure the hood is secure.
If the hood can be raised slightly, it is
not securely locked. Open it again and
close it with more force.
WARNING
• Before closing the hood, ensure
all obstructions are removed from
around the hood opening.
• Always double check to be sure that
the hood is firmly latched before
driving away. Check there is no
hood open warning light or message
displayed on the instrument cluster.
Driving with the hood opened may
cause a total loss of visibility, which
might result in an accident.
• Do not move the vehicle with the
hood in the raised position, as vision
is obstructed, which might result in
an accident, and the hood could fall
or be damaged.
5-34
Tailgate
Opening the tailgate
OOSH059034L
Before attempting to open the tailgate,
make sure the vehicle is in P (Park).
To open the tailgate, perform one the
following:
1. Unlock all doors with the Door Unlock
button on your smart key. From
outside press the tailgate handle
switch and open the tailgate.
2. Press and hold the Tailgate Unlock
button on the smart key. From outside
press the tailgate handle switch and
open the tailgate.
3. With the Smart Key in your
possession, press the tailgate handle
switch and open the tailgate.
05
Closing the tailgate
WARNING
OOSH059035L
Lower the tailgate lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the tailgate lid is
securely fastened, always check by trying
to pull it up again without pressing the
tailgate handle button.
Information
OOSH059204L
Do not hold on to or try to pull on
the tailgate strut. Be aware that the
deformation of the tailgate strut may
cause vehicle damage and risk of injury.
Emergency tailgate safety release
In cold and wet climates, door lock and
door mechanisms may not work properly
due to freezing conditions.
WARNING
The tailgate swings upward. Make sure
no objects or people are near the rear of
the vehicle when opening the tailgate.
NOTICE
Make certain that you close the tailgate
before driving your vehicle. Possible
damage may occur to the tailgate struts
and mounting hinges if the tailgate is
not closed prior to driving.
OOSH059036L
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emergency tailgate safety release lever
located on the bottom of the tailgate
inside the vehicle.
5-35
Convenient features
To unlock and open the tailgate manually
from inside the luggage compartment,
perform the following steps:
1. Insert the mechanical key from the
key fob or a small screwdriver into
the slot at the bottom of the tailgate
inside the luggage compartment.
2. Slide the key or screwdriver to the
right to engage the safety release
lever.
3. Push the tailgate outward and
upward.
WARNING
• Be aware of the location of the
emergency tailgate safety release
lever in your vehicle and know how
to open the tailgate using the safety
release lever.
• No one should be allowed to occupy
the luggage compartment of the
vehicle at any time. The luggage
compartment is a very dangerous
location in the event of a crash.
• Use the release lever for emergencies
only. Use extreme caution, especially
while the vehicle is in motion.
Fuel filler door
Opening the fuel filler door
OOSH059037L
The fuel filler door is opened from inside
the vehicle using the fuel filler door
release lever.
1. Turn the engine off. Locate the fuel
filler door release lever on the floor on
the left side of the driver seat.
2. Pull up on the release lever.
OOSH059038L
3. Pull the fuel filler door (1) outward to
access the fuel tank cap.
4. To remove the fuel tank cap (2), turn
it counterclockwise. You may hear a
hissing noise as the pressure inside
the tank equalizes.
5. Place the cap on the fuel filler door.
5-36
05
Information
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break the
ice and release the door. Do not pry on the
door. If necessary, spray around the door
with an approved deicer fluid (do not use
radiator antifreeze) or move the vehicle to
a warm place and allow the ice to melt.
Closing the fuel filler door
1. To install the fuel tank cap, turn it
clockwise until it “clicks” one time.
2. Close the fuel filler door until it is
latched securely.
WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and
explosive. Failure to follow these
guidelines may result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
• Read and follow all warnings posted
at the gas station.
• Before refueling, note the location of
the Emergency Gasoline Shut-Off, if
available, at the gas station.
• Before touching the fuel nozzle, you
should eliminate the potential buildup of static electricity by touching
a metal part of the vehicle, a safe
distance away from the fuel filler
neck, nozzle, or other gas source,
with your bare hand.
• Do not use cellular phones while
refueling. Electric current and/or
electronic interference from cellular
phones can potentially ignite fuel
vapors and cause a fire.
• Do not get back into a vehicle
once you have begun refueling.
You can generate a buildup of
static electricity by touching,
rubbing or sliding against any item
or fabric capable of producing
static electricity. Static electricity
discharge can ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire. If you must re-enter
the vehicle, you should once again
eliminate potentially dangerous
static electricity discharge by
touching a metal part of the vehicle,
away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle
or other gasoline source, with your
bare hand.
• When using an approved portable
fuel container, be sure to place the
container on the ground prior to
refueling. Static electricity discharge
from the container can ignite fuel
vapors causing a fire.
Once refueling has begun, contact
between your bare hand and the
vehicle should be maintained until
the filling is complete.
• Use only approved portable plastic
fuel containers designed to carry and
store gasoline.
5-37
Convenient features
• When refueling, always move the
shift lever to the P (Park) position,
set the parking brake, and place
the ignition switch to the LOCK/
OFF position. Sparks produced by
electrical components related to the
engine can ignite fuel vapors causing
a fire.
• Do not use matches or a lighter and
do not smoke or leave a lit cigarette
in your vehicle while at a gas station,
especially during refueling.
• Do not over-fill or top-off your
vehicle tank, which can cause
gasoline spillage.
• If a fire breaks out during refueling,
leave the vicinity of the vehicle, and
immediately contact the manager
of the gas station and then contact
the local fire department. Follow any
safety instructions they provide.
• If pressurized fuel sprays out, it can
cover your clothes or skin and thus
subject you to the risk of fire and
burns. Always remove the fuel cap
carefully and slowly. If the cap is
venting fuel or if you hear a hissing
sound, wait until the condition stops
before completely removing the cap.
• Always check that the fuel cap is
installed securely to prevent fuel
spillage in the event of an accident.
5-38
Information
Make sure to refuel your vehicle according
to the “Fuel Requirements” suggested in
chapter 1.
NOTICE
• Do not spill fuel on the exterior
surfaces of the vehicle. Any type of
fuel spilled on painted surfaces may
damage the paint.
• If the fuel filler cap requires
replacement, use only a genuine
HYUNDAI cap or the equivalent
specified for your vehicle. An
incorrect fuel filler cap can result
in a serious malfunction of the fuel
system or emission control system.
05
HEAD-UP DISPLAY (HUD) (IF EQUIPPED)
When it is difficult to read the head up
display information, adjust the image
height or brightness level from the User
Settings mode in the cluster LCD display
mode.
For more details, refer to “LCD Display
Modes” section in chapter 4.
WARNING
OOSH059039L
The Head-Up Display is an optional
feature that allows the driver to view
information projected onto a transparent
screen while still keeping your eyes
safely on the road ahead while driving.
Precautions while using the head up
display
It may sometimes be difficult to read
information on the head up display in the
following situations.
-- The driver is improperly positioned in
the driver’s seat.
-- The driver wears polarizing-filter
sunglasses.
-- An object is located above the head
up display cover
-- The vehicle is driven on a wet road.
-- Any improper lighting accessory is
installed inside the vehicle, or there
is incoming light from outside of the
vehicle.
-- The driver wears glasses.
-- The driver wears contact lenses.
• Do not attach any stickers or
accessories on the head-up display
or crash pad.
• Do not attempt to adjust or try to
move the combiner screen or the
mechanical door on top of the dash
manually by hand.
• The image may be invisible due
to finger prints. Also, excessive
force applied during operation may
damage the display.
• Do not place any objects near the
head-up display. Interference with
such objects during activation may
influence the operation or damage
the display.
• Do not put any drinks near the headup display. If liquid flows in the
display, the unit could be damaged.
• Do not place any objects on or
around the head-up display. Do not
apply any decals or stickers on the
combiner screen. Doing so may
obstruct the image display.
5-39
Convenient features
• Avoid prolonged exposure of direct
sunlight onto the combiner screen.
• Do not place any objects on, inside,
or near the combiner screen when
the head-up display is either opened
or closed.
Use caution to prevent any objects
from falling inside the mechanical
door.
• Use only a soft cloth to clean the
combiner screen. Do not use any
organic solvents, detergents, or
polishing materials. Doing so could
damage the display.
• For your safety, make sure to stop the
vehicle before adjusting the settings.
NOTICE
• When you open or close the head-up
display, noise may occur from the
motor and gear.
• When you adjust the image height of
the head-up display, noise may occur
from the motor and gear.
5-40
Head-up display ON/OFF
OOSH059040L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
Use the head-up display ON/OFF button
to activate or deactivate the head-up
display when the ignition switch is in the
ON position or when the vehicle is in the
ready ( ) mode.
The head-up display will retract
automatically when the vehicle is turned
OFF and the doors are locked with the
Smart Key or when pressing the button
on the outside door handle.
Note that if the vehicle is turned OFF and
the doors are not locked, the head-up
display will automatically retract after
approximately five minutes.
05
Head-up display information
OOSH059041L
1. Turn By Turn (TBT) navigation
information (if equipped)
2. Road signs (if equipped)
3. Speedometer
4. Cruise setting speed (if equipped)
5. Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
information (if equipped)
6. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system
information (if equipped)
7. Blind-spot Collision Warning (BCW)
system information (if equipped)
Head-up display setting
OOSH059042L
On the LCD display, you can change the
head-up display settings as follows.
• Display height
• Rotation
• Brightness
• Content selection
• Speedometer size
• Speedometer color
For more details, refer to “LCD Display
Modes” section in chapter 4.
Information
If you select the Turn By Turn (TBT)
navigation information as head-up
display contents, the Turn By Turn
(TBT) navigation information will not be
displayed on the LCD Display.
5-41
Convenient features
LIGHTING
Exterior lights
Lighting control
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of the
following positions:
OOSH059044L
OOSH059043L
1.
2.
3.
4.
OFF position
AUTO headlamp position
Position lamp position
Headlamp position
Daytime Running Light (DRL)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can
make it easier for others to see the front
of your vehicle during the day, especially
after dawn and before sunset.
The DRL system will turn the dedicated
lamp OFF when :
• The headlamps or front fog lamps are
ON.
• The position lamps are ON.
• The vehicle is turned off.
5-42
AUTO headlamp position (if equipped)
The position lamp and headlamp will
be turned ON or OFF automatically
depending on the amount of daylight as
measured by the ambient light sensor on
the center dash.
Even with the AUTO headlamp feature
in operation, it is recommended to
manually turn ON the headlamps when
driving at night or in a fog, driving in the
rain, or when you enter dark areas, such
as tunnels and parking facilities.
NOTICE
• Do not cover or spill anything on
the sensor (1) located in front of the
instrument panel.
• Do not clean the sensor using
a window cleaner, the cleanser
may leave a light film which could
interfere with sensor operation.
• If your vehicle has window tint or
other types of metallic coating on
the front windshield, the AUTO
headlamp system may not work
properly.
05
High beam operation
OOSH059045L
Position lamp position ( )
The position lamp, license plate lamp
and instrument panel lamp are turned
ON.
OOSH059047L
To turn on the high beam headlamp,
push the lever away from you. The lever
will return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light when
the headlamp high beams are switched
on.
To turn off the high beam headlamp, pull
the lever towards you. The low beams
will turn on.
OOSH059046L
Headlamp position ( )
The headlamp, position lamp, license
plate lamp and instrument panel lamp
are turned ON.
Information
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to turn on the headlamp.
OOSH059048L
To flash the high beam headlamp, pull
the lever towards you, then release the
lever. The high beams will remain ON as
long as you hold the lever towards you.
5-43
Convenient features
High Beam Assist (HBA) (if equipped)
OOSH059049L
The High Beam Assist (HBA) is a system
that automatically adjusts the headlamp
range (switches between high beam and
low beam) depending on the brightness
of detected vehicles and certain road
conditions.
Operating condition
1. Place the headlamp switch in the
AUTO position.
2. Turn on the high beam by pushing
the lever away from you. The High
Beam Assist (HBA) ( ) indicator will
illuminate.
3. The High Beam Assist (HBA) will turn
on when vehicle speed is above 40
km/h (25 mph).
• If the headlamp switch is pushed
away when the High Beam Assist
(HBA) is operating, the High Beam
Assist (HBA) will turn off and the
high beam will be on continuously.
5-44
• If the headlamp switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam
is off, the high beam will turn on
without the High Beam Assist (HBA)
canceled. When you let go of the
light switch, the lever will move to
the middle and the high beam will
turn off.
• If the headlamp switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam is
on by the High Beam Assist (HBA),
the low beam will be on and the
High Beam Assist (HBA) will turn off.
• If the headlamp switch is placed
to the headlamp ON position, the
High Beam Assist (HBA) will turn
off and the low beam will be on
continuously.
When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is on,
the high beam switches to low beam if
any of the following conditions occur:
-- When the headlamp of an oncoming
vehicle is detected.
-- When the tail lamp of a vehicle in front
is detected.
-- When the headlamp or tail lamp of a
motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.
-- When the surrounding ambient light is
bright enough that high beams are not
required.
-- When streetlights or other lights are
detected.
-- When the headlamp switch is not in
the AUTO position.
-- When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is
off.
-- When vehicle speed is below 30 km/h
(20 mph).
05
OOSH059050L
Warning light and message
When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is
not working properly, the Check High
Beam Assist warning message will come
on for a few second. After the message
disappears, the master warning light
( ) will illuminate. We recommend that
you take your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the system
checked.
WARNING
The High Beam Assist system may
not work properly in the following
situations.
• When the light from an on-coming or
front vehicle is dim. Such examples
may include:
-- Light from a vehicle is not detected
because of lamp damage, or
because it is hidden from sight,
etc.
-- Headlamp of a vehicle is covered
with dust, snow or water.
-- A vehicle’s headlamps are off but
the fog lamps are on and etc.
• When the system is affected by
external conditions. Such examples
may include:
-- There is a lamp that has a similar
shape as a vehicle’s lamp.
-- Headlamps have been damaged or
not repaired properly.
-- Headlamps are not aimed properly.
-- Driving on a narrow curved road,
rough road, uphill or downhill.
-- Vehicle in front is partially visible
on a crossroad or curved road.
-- There is a traffic light, reflecting
sign, flashing sign or mirror ahead.
-- There is a temporary reflector or
flash ahead (construction area).
-- The road conditions are bad such
as being wet, iced or covered with
snow.
-- A vehicle suddenly appears from a
curve.
-- The vehicle is tilted from a flat tire
or being towed.
-- The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system indicator (yellow) light
illuminates.
• When front visibility is poor. Such
examples may include:
-- Light from a vehicle is not detected
because of exhaust fume, smoke,
fog, snow, etc.
-- The front windshield is covered
with foreign substance.
5-45
Convenient features
NOTICE
• Do not attempt to disassemble
the front view camera without the
assistance of an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer technician. If camera is
removed for any reason, the system
may need to be recalibrated. We
recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• If the windshield of your vehicle is
replaced, most likely the front view
camera will need to be recalibrated.
If this occurs, we recommend
that the vehicle be inspected and
have the system recalibrated by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Be careful that water doesn’t get into
the High Beam Assist (HBA) unit and
do not remove or damage related
parts of the High Beam Assist (HBA)
system.
• Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflect light such as
mirrors, white paper, etc. The system
may not be able to function properly
if sunlight is reflected.
• At times, the High Beam Assist (HBA)
may not work properly. The system
is for convenience only. It is the
responsibility of the driver for safe
driving practices and always check
the road conditions for your safety.
• When the system does not operate
normally, change the headlamp
position manually between the high
beam and low beam.
5-46
Turn signals and lane change signals
OOSH059051L
To signal a turn, push down on the lever
for a left turn or up for a right turn in
position (A).
If an indicator stays on and does not flash
or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn
signal bulbs may be burned out and will
require replacement.
One touch turn indicator function
To activate the One Touch Turn Indicator
function, push the turn signal lever up or
down to position (B) and then release it.
The lane change signals will blink 3, 5 or
7 times.
You can activate or deactivate the One
Touch Turn Indicator function or choose
the number of blinks (3, 5, or 7) from the
User Settings mode in the LCD display.
For more details, refer to the “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.
05
Front fog lamp (if equipped)
OOSH059052L
Fog lamps are used to provide improved
visibility when visibility is poor due to
fog, rain or snow, etc. Use the switch
next to the headlamp switch to turn the
fog lamps ON and OFF.
1. Turn on the position lamp.
2. Turn the headlamp switch (1) to the
front fog lamp position.
3. To turn off the front fog lamp, turn the
headlamp switch to the front fog lamp
position again or turn off the position
lamp.
NOTICE
When in operation, the fog lamps
consume large amounts of vehicle
electrical power. Only use the fog lamps
when visibility is poor.
Rear fog lamp
OOSH059053L
Vehicle with front fog lamps
To turn on the rear fog lamp:
Position the headlamp switch in
the position lamp position, turn the
headlamp switch (1) to the front fog
lamps position, and then turn the
headlamp switch (1) to the rear fog lamp
position.
To turn the rear fog lamps off, do one of
the following:
• Turn off the headlamp switch.
• Turn the headlamp switch (1) to the
rear fog lamp position again.
• When the headlamp switch is in the
position lamp position, if you turn off
the front fog lamps, the rear fog lamp
will also turn off.
5-47
Convenient features
Headlamp delay function
OOSH059054L
Vehicle without front fog lamps
To turn on the rear fog lamp:
Position the headlamp switch in the
headlamp position, and then turn the
headlamp switch (1) to the rear fog lamp
position.
To turn the rear fog lamps off, do one of
the following:
• Turn off the headlamp switch.
• Turn the headlamp switch (1) to the
rear fog lamp position again.
Battery saver function
The purpose of this feature is to prevent
the battery from being discharged.
The system automatically turns off the
position lamp when the driver turns the
vehicle off and opens the driver-side
door.
With this feature, the position lamps will
turn off automatically if the driver parks
on the side of road at night.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on when
the vehicle is turned off, perform the
following:
(1) Open the driver-side door.
(2) Turn the position lamps OFF and ON
again using the headlamp switch on
the steering column.
5-48
If the key is removed from the ignition
switch or placed in the ACC position
or the LOCK/OFF position with the
headlamps ON, the headlamps (and/
or position lamps) remain on for about
5 minutes. However, if the driver’s door
is opened and closed, the headlamps
are turned off after 15 seconds. Also,
with the vehicle off if the driver’s door is
opened and closed, the headlamps (and/
or position lamps) are turned off after 15
seconds.
The headlamps (and/or position lamps)
can be turned off by pressing the lock
button on the remote key or smart key
twice or turning the headlamp switch to
the OFF or AUTO position.
You can activate or deactivate the
Headlamp Delay function from the User
Settings mode in the LCD display.
For more details, refer to the “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.
NOTICE
If the driver exits the vehicle through
another door besides the driver
door, the battery saver function
does not operate and the headlamp
delay function does not turn OFF
automatically.
This may cause the battery to
discharge. To avoid battery discharge,
turn OFF the headlamps manually from
the headlamp switch before exiting the
vehicle.
05
Low beam assist-static light
(if equipped)
While driving a corner, for greater
visibility and safety, either the left or
right side Low Beam Assist-Static light
will turn on automatically.
Headlight leveling device
OOSH059055L
Manual type (if equipped)
To adjust the headlight beam level
according to the number of the
passengers and loading weight in the
luggage area, turn the beam leveling
switch.
The higher the number of the switch
position, the lower the headlight beam
level. Always keep the headlight beam
at the proper leveling position, or
headlights may dazzle other road users.
Listed below are examples of appropriate
switch settings for varying loads. For
loading conditions other than those
listed, adjust the switch position to the
most similar situation.
Loading condition
Switch position
Driver only
0
Driver + Front
passenger
0
Full passengers
(including driver)
1
Full passengers
(including driver)+
Maximum permissible
loading
2
Driver + Maximum
permissible loading
3
Automatic type (if equipped)
It automatically adjusts the headlamp
beam level according to the number of
passengers and loading weight in the
luggage area.
It also adjusts to the appropriate
headlamp beam level for various
situations.
WARNING
If the function does not work properly,
we recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer. Do not attempt to inspect or
replace the wiring yourself.
5-49
Convenient features
Interior lights
Front lamps
Type A
WARNING
Do not use the interior lights when
driving in the dark. The interior lights
may obscure your view and cause an
accident.
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the vehicle is
turned off or the battery will discharge.
OOSH059056L
Type B
Interior lamp AUTO cut
The interior lamps will automatically go
off approximately 20 minutes after the
vehicle is turned off and the doors are
closed. If a door is opened, the lamp will
go off 40 minutes after the vehicle is
turned off. If the doors are locked by the
remote key or smart key and the vehicle
enters the armed stage of the theft
alarm system, the lamps will go off five
seconds later.
OOSH059057L
Front map lamp (1):
Press either lenses to turn the map lamp
on or off. This light produces a spot
beam for convenient use as a map lamp
at night or as a personal lamp for the
driver and the front passenger.
):
Front door lamp (2) (
The front or rear room lamps come
on when the front or rear doors are
opened. When doors are unlocked by the
remote key or smart key, the front and
rear lamps come on for approximately
30 seconds as long as any door is not
opened. The front and rear room lamps
go out gradually after approximately
30 seconds when the door is closed.
However, if the ignition switch is in the
ON position or all doors are locked, the
front and rear lamps will turn off. If a
door is opened with the ignition switch in
the ACC position or the OFF position, the
front and rear lamps stay on for about 20
minutes.
5-50
05
Front room lamp
(3):
•
Press the button to turn ON the room
lamp for the front/rear seats.
•
Luggage compartment lamp
(4):
Press the button to turn OFF the
room lamp for the front/rear seats
regardless of front or rear door open
position.
Rear lamp
OOSH059205L
Type A
The luggage compartment lamp comes
on when the tailgate is opened.
Vanity mirror lamp (if equipped)
OOSH059058L
Type B
OOSH059060L
Push the switch to turn the light on or off.
: The lamp will turn on if this
•
button is pressed.
: The lamp will turn off if this
•
button is pressed.
OOSH059059L
Rear room lamp (
):
Press this switch to turn the rear room
lamp on and off.
5-51
Convenient features
WIPERS AND WASHERS
Windshield wipers
Front windshield wiper/washer
OOSH059061L
Rear window wiper/washer
OOSH059062L
A. Wiper speed control
• V – Single wipe
• O – Off
• --- – Intermittent wipe
AUTO* – Auto control wipe
• 1 – Low wiper speed
• 2 – High wiper speed
B. Intermittent control wipe time
adjustment
C. Wash with brief wipes (pull lever
towards you)
D. Rear wiper/washer control
• 2 – High wiper speed
• 1 – Low wiper speed
• O – Off
E. Wash with brief wipes (rear) (push
lever away from you)
* : if equipped
5-52
Operates as follows when the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
V (MIST) : For a single wiping cycle,
push the lever downward
and release. The wipers will
operate continuously if the
lever is held in this position.
O (OFF) : Wiper is not in operation.
--- (INT) : Wiper operates intermittently
at the same wiping intervals.
To vary the speed setting,
move the speed control lever.
The top most setting will run
the wipers most frequently (for
more rain). The bottom setting
will run the wipers the least
frequently (for less rain).
AUTO : The rain sensor located on the
upper end of the windshield glass
senses the amount of rainfall and
controls the wiping cycle for the
proper interval. The more it rains,
the faster the wiper operates.
When the rain stops, the wiper
stops. To vary the speed setting,
turn the speed control knob (B).
1 (LO) : The wiper runs at a lower speed.
2 (HI) : The wiper runs at a higher speed.
Information
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or until
the snow and/or ice is removed before
using the windshield wipers to ensure
proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or ice
before using the wiper and washer, it may
damage the wiper and washer system.
05
NOTICE
AUTO (Automatic) control
(if equipped)
OOSH059063L
The rain sensor (A) located on the upper
end of the windshield glass senses
the amount of rainfall and controls the
wiping cycle for the proper interval.
The wiper operation time will be
automatically controlled depends on
rainfall.
When the rain stops, the wiper stops.
To vary the sensitivity setting, turn the
sensitivity control knob (1).
If the wiper switch is set in AUTO mode
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position, the wiper will operate once to
perform a self-check of the system. Set
the wiper to the O (OFF) position when
the wiper is not in use.
WARNING
To avoid personal injury from the
windshield wipers, when the vehicle
is in the ready ( ) mode and the
windshield wiper switch is placed in the
AUTO mode:
• Do not touch the upper end of the
windshield glass facing the rain
sensor.
• Do not wipe the upper end of the
windshield glass with a damp or wet
cloth.
• Do not put pressure on the
windshield glass.
• When washing the vehicle, set the
wiper switch in the O (OFF) position
to stop the auto wiper operation. The
wiper may operate and be damaged
if the switch is set in the AUTO mode
while washing the vehicle.
• Do not remove the sensor cover
located on the upper end of the
passenger side windshield glass.
Damage to system components
could occur and may not be covered
by your vehicle warranty.
• Because of using a photo sensor,
temporary malfunction could occur
according to sudden ambient light
change made by stone and dust
while driving.
Windshield washers
OOSH059064L
In the O (OFF) position, pull the lever
gently toward you to spray washer fluid
on the windshield and to run the wipers
1-3 cycles. The spray and wiper operation
will continue until you release the lever. If
the washer does not work, you may need
to add washer fluid to the washer fluid
reservoir.
5-53
Convenient features
WARNING
Rear window wiper and washer
When the outside temperature is below
freezing, ALWAYS warm the windshield
using the defroster to help prevent
the washer fluid from freezing on the
windshield and obscuring your vision
which could result in an accident and
serious injury or death.
NOTICE
• To prevent possible damage to the
washer pump, do not operate the
washer when the fluid reservoir is
empty.
• To prevent possible damage to the
wipers or windshield, do not operate
the wipers when the windshield is
dry.
• To prevent damage to the wiper
arms and other components, do
not attempt to move the wipers
manually.
• To prevent possible damage to the
wipers and washer system, use antifreezing washer fluids in the winter
season or cold weather.
OOSH059065L
The rear window wiper and washer
switch is located at the end of the wiper
and washer switch lever. Turn the switch
to the desired position to operate the
rear wiper and washer.
2 (HI) – High wiper speed
1 (LO) – Low wiper speed
O (OFF) – Off
OOSH059066L
Push the lever away from you to spray
rear washer fluid and to run the rear
wipers 1~3 cycles. The spray and wiper
operation will continue until you release
the lever.
Auto rear wiper
The rear wiper will operate while the
vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper
ON by selecting the function from the
User Settings mode in the LCD display.
Go to ‘User settings → Convenience →
Auto rear wiper (reverse)’.
5-54
05
DRIVER ASSIST SYSTEM
Rear View Monitor (if equipped)
The Rear View Monitor system is a
supplemental system that shows the
area behind the vehicle on the audio or
navigation system screen to assist you
when parking or driving.
WARNING
The Rear View Monitor is not a safety
device. It only serves to assist the driver
in identifying objects directly behind
the middle of the vehicle. The camera
does NOT cover the complete area
behind the vehicle.
WARNING
OOSH059067L
• Never rely solely on the Rear View
Monitor when backing up.
• ALWAYS look around your vehicle
to make sure there are no objects or
obstacles before moving the vehicle
in any direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention when the
vehicle is driven close to objects,
particularly pedestrians, and
especially children.
NOTICE
OOSH059068L
The Rear View Monitor will activate when
the vehicle is in the ready ( ) mode
and the shift lever is in the R (Reverse)
position.
To assist in parking, the rear view
is shown (the parking guide line
disappears) on the screen when the shift
lever is moved from R (Reverse) to D
(Drive) with vehicle speed below 10 km/h
(6 mph).
• Do not spray the camera or its
surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Shock applied from
high pressure water may cause the
device to not operate normally.
• Do not use any cleanser containing
acid or alkaline detergents when
cleaning the lens. Use only a mild
soap or neutral detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with water.
• Always keep the camera lens clean.
The camera may not work normally
if the lens is covered with dirt, water
or snow.
5-55
Convenient features
Reverse Parking Distance
Warning (PDW) system
(if equipped)
OOSH059069L
[A] : Sensor
The Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system assists the driver during
reverse movement of the vehicle by
chiming if any object is sensed within
approximately 120 cm (48 inches) behind
the vehicle.
This system is a supplemental system
that senses objects within the range and
location of the sensors, it cannot detect
objects in other areas where sensors are
not installed.
5-56
WARNING
• ALWAYS look around your vehicle to
make sure there are not any objects
or obstacles before moving the
vehicle in any direction to prevent a
collision.
• Always pay close attention when the
vehicle is driven close to objects,
particularly pedestrians, and
especially children.
• Be aware that some objects may
not be visible on the screen or be
detected by the sensors, due to the
objects distance, size or material, all
of which can limit the effectiveness
of the sensor.
Operation of the Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
Operating condition
• This system will activate when
backing up with the ignition switch
in the ON position. However, if the
vehicle speed exceeds 5 km/h (3
mph), the system may not detect
objects.
• If the vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h
(6 mph), the system will not warn you
even though objects are detected.
• When more than two objects are
sensed at the same time, the closest
one will be recognized first.
05
Types of warning sound and indicator
Types of warning sound
Indicator
When an object is 120
to 60 cm (47 to 24 in.)
from the rear bumper,
the warning sound beeps
intermittently.
When an object is 60 to
30 cm (24 to 12 in.) from
the rear bumper, the
warning sound beeps
more frequently.
NOTICE
When you shift the gear to R (Reverse)
and if one or more of the below occurs
you may have a malfunction with the
Parking Distance Warning system.
• The audible warning does not sound.
• The buzzer sounds intermittently.
• A message “Parking sensor error or
blockage” appears on the instrument
cluster LCD display.
When an object is within
30 cm (12 in.) from
the rear bumper, the
warning sound beeps
continuously
Information
The indicator may differ from the
illustration depending on objects or
sensors status. If the indicator blinks,
we recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OOSH059071L
If one of the above occurs, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
5-57
Convenient features
To turn off the Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system
(if equipped)
OOSH059070L
Push the button to turn off the Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system. The
indicator light on the button will turn on.
Non-operational conditions of
Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system
The Reverse Parking Distance Warning
system may not operate normally when:
• Moisture is frozen to the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with dirt or
debris such as snow or ice, or the
sensor cover is blocked.
5-58
There is a possibility of the Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system
malfunction when:
• Driving on uneven road surfaces such
as unpaved roads, gravel, bumps, or
gradient.
• Objects generating excessive
noise such as vehicle horns, loud
motorcycle engines, or truck air
brakes can interfere with the sensor.
• Heavy rain or water spray is present.
• Wireless transmitters or mobile
phones are present near the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with snow.
• Any non-factory equipment or
accessories have been installed, or if
the vehicle bumper height or sensor
installation has been modified.
Detecting range may decrease when:
• Outside air temperature is extremely
hot or cold.
• Undetectable objects smaller than
100 cm (40 in.) and narrower than
14 cm (6 in.) in diameter.
The following objects may not be
recognized by the sensor:
• Sharp or slim objects such as ropes,
chains or small poles.
• Objects, which tend to absorb sensor
frequency such as clothes, spongy
material or snow.
05
Rear Parking Distance Warning
system precautions
• The Rear Parking Distance Warning
system may not operate consistently
in some circumstances depending
on the speed of the vehicle and the
shapes of the objects detected.
• The Rear Parking Distance Warning
system may malfunction if the vehicle
bumper height or sensor installation
has been modified or damaged. Any
non-factory installed equipment or
accessories may also interfere with
the sensor performance.
• The sensor may not recognize objects
less than 30 cm (12 in.) from the
sensor, or it may sense an incorrect
distance. Use caution.
• When the sensor is blocked with
snow, dirt, debris, or ice, the rear
parking assist system may be
inoperative until the snow or ice
melts, or the debris is removed. Use
a soft cloth to wipe debris away from
the sensor.
• Do not push, scratch or strike the
sensor with any hard objects that
could damage the surface of the
sensor. Sensor damage could occur.
• Do not spray the sensors or its
surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Doing so may cause
the sensors to fail to operate normally.
WARNING
Your new vehicle warranty does not
cover any accidents or damage to the
vehicle or injuries to its occupants
related to a Rear Parking Distance
Warning system. Always drive safely
and cautiously.
Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning (PDW) system
(if equipped)
OOSH059072L
OOSH059073L
[A] : Front Sensor, [B] : Rear Sensor
The Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system assists the driver during
movement of the vehicle by chiming if
any object is sensed within the distance
of 100 cm (39 in) in front and 120 cm (47
in) behind the vehicle.
This system is a supplemental system
that senses objects within the range and
location of the sensors, it cannot detect
objects in other areas where sensors are
not installed.
5-59
Convenient features
WARNING
• ALWAYS look around your vehicle
to make sure there are no objects or
obstacles before moving the vehicle
in any direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention when the
vehicle is driven close to objects,
particularly pedestrians, and
especially children.
• Be aware that some objects may
not be visible on the screen or be
detected by the sensors, due to the
objects distance, size or material, all
of which can limit the effectiveness
of the sensor.
• Do not tamper with the location
or size of the license plate
discretionally.
Operation of the Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system
OOSH059206L
Operating condition
• This system will activate when the
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system button is pressed
with the vehicle in the ready ( )
mode.
5-60
• The Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system button turns
on automatically and activates the
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system when the shift lever
is in R (Reverse) position. However,
if vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h (6
mph), the system will not warn you
even though objects are detected,
and if vehicle speed exceeds 20 km/h
(12 mph), the system will turn off
automatically. To turn on the system,
press the Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system button.
• When more than two objects are
sensed at the same time, the closest
one will be recognized first.
05
Types of warning sound and indicator
cm (in)
Explanation
Distance from object
60 ~ 100
(24 ~39)
Front
60 ~ 120
(24 ~47)
Rear
30 ~ 60
(12 ~24)
30
(12)
When driving
forward
-
Front
Rear
-
Front
Rear
When driving
rearward
-
Warning sound
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Information
The indicator may differ from the
illustration depending on objects or
sensors status. If the indicator blinks, we
recommend that the system be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
When you shift the gear to R (Reverse)
and if one or more of the below occurs
you may have a malfunction with the
Parking Distance Warning system.
• The audible warning does not sound.
• The buzzer sounds intermittently.
• A message “Parking sensor error or
blockage” appears on the instrument
cluster LCD display.
OOSH059074L
If one of the above occurs, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
5-61
Convenient features
Non-operational conditions of
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system may not operate normally
when:
• Moisture is frozen to the sensor.
• Sensor is covered with foreign matter,
such as snow or water, or the sensor
cover is blocked.
There is a possibility of Forward/Reverse
Parking Distance Warning system
malfunction when:
• Driving on uneven road surfaces such
as unpaved roads, gravel, bumps, or
gradient.
• Objects generating excessive
noise such as vehicle horns, loud
motorcycle engines, or truck air
brakes can interfere with the sensor.
• Heavy rain or water spray is present.
• Wireless transmitters or mobile
phones are present near the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with snow.
• Any non-factory equipment or
accessories have been installed, or if
the vehicle bumper height or sensor
installation has been modified.
Detecting range may decrease when:
• Outside air temperature is extremely
hot or cold.
• Undetectable objects smaller than 1 m
(40 in.) and narrower than 14 cm (6 in.)
in diameter.
The following objects may not be
recognized by the sensor:
• Sharp or slim objects such as ropes,
chains or small poles.
• Objects, which tend to absorb sensor
frequency such as clothes, spongy
material or snow.
5-62
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance
Warning system precautions
• The Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system may not
sound consistently depending on
the speed and shapes of the objects
detected.
• The Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system may
malfunction if the vehicle bumper
height or sensor installation has
been modified or damaged. Any
non-factory installed equipment or
accessories may also interfere with
the sensor performance.
• The sensor may not recognize objects
less than 30 cm (12 in.) from the
sensor, or it may sense an incorrect
distance. Use caution.
• When the sensor is frozen or stained
with snow, dirt, or water, the sensor
may be inoperative until the stains are
removed using a soft cloth.
• Do not push, scratch or strike the
sensor. Sensor damage could occur.
• Do not spray the sensors or its
surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Shock applied from
high pressure water may cause the
device to not operate normally.
WARNING
Your new vehicle warranty does not
cover any accidents or damage to the
vehicle or injuries to its occupants
related to a Forward/Reverse Parking
Distance Warning system. Always drive
safely and cautiously.
05
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM
OOSH059115L
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Temperature control knob
Fan speed control knob
AUTO (automatic control) button
Air conditioning button
OFF button
Driver only button
7.
8.
9.
10.
Mode selection button
Front windshield defroster button
Rear window defroster button
Air intake control button
(Recirculation mode/Fresh mode)
11. Climate control information screen
5-63
Convenient features
Automatic temperature control
mode
The Automatic Climate Control System
is controlled by setting the desired
temperature.
OOSH059101L
1. Press the AUTO button.
The modes, fan speeds, air intake and
air-conditioning will be controlled
automatically by the temperature setting
you select.
2. Turn the temperature control knob
(1) to the desired temperature. If
the temperature is set to the lowest
setting (Lo), the air conditioning
system will operate continuously.
After the interior has cooled
sufficiently, adjust the knob to
a higher temperature set point
whenever possible.
5-64
To turn the automatic operation off,
select any function of the following:
-- Mode selection button
-- Front windshield defroster button
(Press the button one more time
to deselect the front windshield
defroster function. The ‘AUTO’
sign will illuminate on the climate
information screen once again.)
-- Fan speed control knob
The selected function will be controlled
manually while other functions operate
automatically.
For your convenience and to improve the
efficiency of the climate control, use the
AUTO button and set the temperature to
22°C (72°F).
To change the temperature unit from °C
to °F or °F to °C:
Press the AUTO button for 3 seconds
while pressing the OFF button.
05
Manual temperature control
mode
Information
OOSH059075L
Never place anything near the ambient
light/solar sensor to ensure better control
of the heating and cooling system.
The heating and cooling system can be
controlled manually by pushing buttons
other than the AUTO button. In this case,
the system works sequentially according
to the order of buttons selected.
When pressing any button except the
AUTO button while using automatic
operation, the functions not selected will
be controlled automatically.
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select the mode
according to the following:
-- Heating:
-- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to Fresh
mode.
5. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the
air conditioning system on.
7. Press the AUTO button to convert to
full automatic control of the system.
The climate control system settings
will be maintained, even when the
vehicle is turned OFF. However, the
climate control system settings will be
initialized when the battery has been
discharged, or when the cables have
been disconnected.
In this case, adjust the climate control
system settings again.
5-65
Convenient features
Mode selection
OOSH059114L/OOSH059102L
The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation
system.
5-66
05
The air flow outlet direction is cycled as
follows:
Face-Level (B, D)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
OOSH059104L
Defrost-Level (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
Instrument panel vents
Floor & Defrost (A, C, D, E)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Floor-Level (A, C, D, E)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and side
window defrosters.
OOSH059103L
The instrument panel vent air flow can be
directed up/down or left/right using the
vent adjustment lever.
The air flow can also be CLOSED
using the vent adjustment lever. The
instrument panel air vents are the “clickto-close” type.
To CLOSE the instrument panel vents
perform the following:
-- For the driver side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the left until
it clicks.
-- For the passenger side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the right until
it clicks.
5-67
Convenient features
Recirculation mode
When Recirculation mode
is selected, air from the
passenger compartment will
be recirculated through the
system and heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Temperature control
Fresh mode
OOSH059113L
Turn the knob to the right to increase the
temperature. Turn the knob to the left to
decrease temperature.
The temperature will increase or
decrease by 0.5°C (1°F) for each
incremental location. When set to the
lowest temperature setting, the air
conditioning will operate continuously.
Air intake control
OOSH059105L
The air intake control button is used to
select either Fresh mode (outside air) or
Recirculation mode (cabin air).
5-68
When Fresh mode is selected,
air enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
Information
Operating the system primarily in Fresh
mode is recommended. Use Recirculation
mode temporarily only when needed.
Prolonged operation of the heater in
Recirculation mode and without the air
conditioning ON can cause fogging of the
windshield. In addition, prolonged use of
the air conditioning ON in Recirculation
mode may result in excessively dry,
dehumidified air in the cabin and may
promote formation of musty vent odor due
to stagnant air.
05
WARNING
• Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode for a prolonged period of
time may cause drowsiness to the
occupants in the cabin. This may lead
to loss of vehicle control which may
lead to an accident.
• Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode with the air conditioning OFF
may allow humidity to increase
inside the cabin. This may cause
condensation to accumulate on the
windshield and obscure visibility.
• Do not sleep in your vehicle or
remain parked in your vehicle with
the windows up and either the
heater or the air conditioning ON for
prolonged periods of time. Doing so
may increase the levels of carbon
dioxide in the cabin which may lead
to serious injury or death.
Fan speed control
OOSH059107L
The fan speed can be set to the desired
speed by turning the fan speed control
knob.
More air is delivered with higher fan
speeds.
Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.
Information
For better sound quality, fan speed may
automatically slow down for a couple
of minutes when you activate voice
recognition or hands free.
NOTICE
Operating the fan when the ignition
switch is in the ON position could cause
the battery to discharge. Operate the
fan when the vehicle is in the ready
( ) mode.
5-69
Convenient features
Driver only
Air conditioning
OOSH059108L
OOSH059106L
If you press the DRIVER ONLY button,
the indicator light will illuminate. In this
mode the climate control system blows
air primarily through the two left-most
vents (nearest the driver). The purpose of
the DRIVER ONLY option helps to reduce
energy consumption from the climate
control system when only the driver is in
the vehicle.
Note that the DRIVER ONLY function will
be disabled when:
1. The DRIVER ONLY button is
deselected (indicator light OFF)
2. Whenever the FRONT Defroster
button is selected.
The DRIVER ONLY indicator light will
remain illuminated, but air will flow
through all upper vents towards the
windshield glass for as long as the
FRONT defrost button is activated.
Push the A/C button to manually turn the
system on (indicator light will illuminate)
and off.
5-70
OFF mode
OOSH059109L
Push the OFF button to turn the climate
control system off. You can still operate
the mode and air intake buttons as
long as the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
05
System operation
Cooling / Ventilation
1. Select the Face Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Select the Floor Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning ON
with the temperature control knob set
to heat in order to dehumidify the air
before it enters into the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the Floor
mode or press the Front
& Defrost
Defrost
mode.
Operation Tips
• To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculation
mode. Return the control to the to
Fresh mode when the unpleasant air
outside has diminished. This will help
keep the driver alert and comfortable.
• To help prevent the inside of the
windshield from fogging, set the air
intake control to fresh mode and the
fan speed to the desired position, turn
on the air conditioning system, and
adjust the temperature control to the
desired temperature.
Air conditioning
Your HYUNDAI vehicle air conditioning
system is filled with R-134a or R-1234yf
refrigerant.
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Press the air conditioning button.
3. Set the mode to the Face Level
mode.
4. Set the air intake control to
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly. When
the desired temperature in the cabin
is reached, change the air intake
control back to Fresh mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
When maximum cooling is desired, set
the temperature control to the lowest
position, then set the fan speed control
to the highest setting.
NOTICE
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the engine temperature gauge
closely while driving up hills or in heavy
traffic when outside temperatures are
high. Air conditioning system operation
when climbing a steep grade or in
high outside ambient temperatures
can cause engine overheating.
Continue to use the fan, but turn the air
conditioning system off if the engine
temperature gauge indicates engine
overheating.
5-71
Convenient features
Air conditioning system operation tips
• If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
• After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from
recirculation mode to fresh mode.
• To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
• Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system
performance.
• If you operate air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield
to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In
this case, set the mode selection knob
position and fan
or button to the
speed control to the lower speed.
5-72
System maintenance
Cabin air filter
OHI048581L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle through
the heating and air conditioning system.
We recommend that the cabin air filter
be replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer according to the maintenance
schedule. If the vehicle is being driven in
severe conditions such as dusty or rough
roads, more frequent cabin air filter
inspections and changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
we recommend that the system be
inspected at an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
05
Checking the amount of air
conditioner refrigerant and
compressor lubricant
We recommend the air conditioning
system be serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the
performance of the air conditioning
system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, we recommend that the system
be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Air Conditioning refrigerant label
(if equipped)
Type A
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Because the refrigerant is at
very high pressure, the air
conditioning system
OOSH059076L
Type B
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians. It is important
that the correct type and amount of oil
and refrigerant is used. Otherwise, it
may cause damage to the vehicle and
personal injury.
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf
Because the refrigerant is at
very high pressure, the air
conditioning system should
only be serviced by trained
and certified technicians. It
is important that the correct
type and amount oil and
refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, it may cause damage to the
vehicle and personal injury.
OOSH059077L
The actual Air Conditioning refrigerant
label in the vehicle may differ from the
illustration.
Each symbols and specification on air
conditioning refrigerant label means as
below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of Compressor lubricant
Refer to chapter 2 for more detail
location of the air conditioning
refrigerant label.
5-73
Convenient features
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
WARNING
Windshield heating
or
position
Do not use the
during cooling operation in extremely
humid weather. The difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause the
outer surface of the windshield to fog
up, causing loss of visibility could cause
an accident resulting in serious injury
or death. In this case, set the mode
position
selection button to the
and fan speed control knob to a lower
speed.
• For maximum defrost performance,
set the temperature control knob
to the highest temperature setting
(rotated all the way to the right) and
the fan speed control to the highest
setting.
• If warm air to the floor is desired while
defrosting or defogging, set the mode
to the floor-defrost position.
• Before driving, clear all snow and ice
from the windshield, rear window,
side view mirrors, and all side
windows.
• Clear all snow and ice from the
hood and air inlet in the cowl grill
to improve heater and defroster
efficiency and to reduce the
probability of fogging up the inside of
the windshield.
5-74
NOTICE
If the engine temperature is still cold
after starting, then a brief engine warm
up period may be required for the
vented air flow to become warm or hot.
To defog inside windshield
OOSH059110L
1.
2.
3.
4.
Select the desired fan speed.
Select the desired temperature.
Press the defroster button ( ).
Fresh mode will be selected
automatically.
Check to make sure the air intake control
is in Fresh mode. If the air intake control
indicator light is illuminated, press the
button once to enable Fresh mode
(indicator light OFF).
position is selected, the fan
If the
speed is automatically increased.
05
To defrost inside windshield
OOSH059111L
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
(extreme right) position.
2. Set the temperature to the extreme
hot (HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The outside (fresh) air position will be
selected automatically.
Check to make sure the air intake control
is in Fresh mode. If the air intake control
indicator light is illuminated, press the
button once to enable Fresh mode
(indicator light OFF).
position is selected, lower fan
If the
speed is adjusted to a higher fan speed.
Defogging logic
To reduce the probability of fogging
up the inside of the windshield, the air
intake or air conditioning are controlled
automatically according to certain
or
positions.
conditions such as
To cancel or reset the defogging logic, do
the following.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Press the defroster button ( ).
3. While pressing the air conditioning
button (A/C), press the air intake
control button at least 5 times within
3 seconds.
The air intake control button indicator
will blink 3 times to indicate that the
defogging logic has been disabled.
Repeat the steps again to re-enable the
defogging logic.
If the battery has been discharged or
disconnected, it resets to the defog logic
status.
5-75
Convenient features
To cancel or reset the Auto Defogging
System
Press the front windshield defroster
button for 3 seconds when the ignition
switch is in the ON position. When the
Auto Defogging System is canceled, the
ADS OFF symbol will blink 3 times and
ADS OFF will be displayed on the climate
control information screen.
When the Auto Defogging System is
reset, the ADS OFF symbol will blink 6
times without a signal.
Auto defogging system
OOSH059078L
Auto defogging helps reduce the
possibility of fogging up the inside of the
windshield by automatically sensing the
moisture on inside the windshield.
The auto defogging system operates
when the heater or air conditioning is on.
Information
The auto defogging system may not
operate normally, when the outside
temperature is below -10 °C (14 °F).
When the Auto Defogging
System operates, the indicator
will illuminate.
If a high amount of humidity is detected
in the vehicle, the Auto Defogging
System will be enabled. The following
steps will be performed automatically:
Step 1) The A/C button will turn ON.
Step 2) The air intake control will change
to Fresh mode.
Step 3) The mode will be changed to
defrost to direct airflow to the
windshield.
Step 4) The fan speed will be set to MAX.
If the air conditioning is off or
recirculation mode is manually selected
while Auto Defogging System is ON, the
Auto Defogging System Indicator will
blink 3 times to signal that the manual
operation has been canceled.
5-76
Information
• When the air conditioning is turned
on by Auto defogging system, if you
try to turn off the air conditioning, the
indicator will blink 3 times and the air
conditioning will not be turned off.
• To maintain the effectiveness and
efficiency of the Auto Defogging
System, do not select Recirculation
mode while the system is operating.
• When the Auto Defogging System is
operating, the fan speed adjustment
knob, the temperature adjustment
knob, and the air intake control button
are all disabled.
NOTICE
Do not remove the sensor cover located
on the upper end of the windshield
glass.
Damage to system parts could occur
and may not be covered by your vehicle
warranty.
05
Rear window defroster
Information
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the rear window
defroster conducting elements bonded
to the inside surface of the rear window,
never use sharp instruments or window
cleaners containing abrasives to clean
the window.
• If there is heavy accumulation of snow
on the rear window, brush it off before
operating the rear defroster.
• The rear window defroster
automatically turns off after
approximately 20 minutes or when the
ignition switch is in the LOCK/OFF
position.
Outside rearview mirror defroster
If your vehicle is equipped with the
rearview mirror defrosters, they will
operate at the same time you turn on the
rear window defroster.
OOSH059112L
The defroster heats the window to
remove frost, fog and thin ice from the
interior and exterior of the rear window,
while the vehicle is in the ready ( )
mode.
• To activate the rear window defroster,
press the rear window defroster
button located in the center control
panel. The indicator on the rear
window defroster button illuminates
when the defroster is ON.
• To turn off the defroster, press the rear
window defroster button again.
5-77
Convenient features
CLIMATE CONTROL ADDITIONAL FEATURES
Automatic ventilation
(if equipped)
Sunroof inside air recirculation
(if equipped)
To increase cabin air quality and reduce
windshield misting, recirculation mode
switches off automatically after about 5
to 30 minutes, depending on the outside
temperature, and the air intake will
change to fresh mode.
To cancel or set the automatic ventilation
mode
feature, select Face level
and press the air intake control button
for 3 seconds. When the automatic
ventilation is set, the air intake control
button indicator will blink 6 times. When
canceled, the indicator will blink 3 times.
When the is sunroof opened, fresh
mode will be automatically selected.
At this time, if you press the air intake
control button, recirculation mode will
be selected but will change back to fresh
mode after 3 minutes. When the sunroof
is closed, the air intake position will
return to the original position that was
selected.
5-78
05
STORAGE COMPARTMENT
WARNING
Center console storage
Never store cigarette lighters, propane
cylinders, or other flammable/explosive
materials in the vehicle. These items
may catch fire and/or explode if the
vehicle is exposed to hot temperatures
for extended periods.
WARNING
ALWAYS keep the storage compartment
covers closed securely while driving.
Items inside your vehicle are moving as
fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the
items may fly out of the compartment
and may cause an injury if they strike
the driver or a passenger.
OOSH059079L
To open:
Grab and hold the latch (1) on the armrest
then lift the lid.
Glove box
NOTICE
To avoid possible theft, do not leave
valuables in the storage compartments.
OOSH059080L
To open:
Pull the lever (1).
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box door after
use.
An open glove box door can cause
serious injury to the passenger in an
accident, even if the passenger is
wearing a seat belt.
5-79
Convenient features
Sunglass holder (if equipped)
Multi box
OOSH059081L
To open:
Push and release the cover and the
holder will slowly open. Place your
sunglasses in the compartment door
with the lenses facing out.
To close:
Push back into position.
Make sure the sunglass holder is closed
while driving.
WARNING
• Do not keep objects except
sunglasses inside the sunglass
holder. Such objects can be thrown
from the holder in the event of a
sudden stop or an accident, possibly
injuring the passengers in the
vehicle.
• Do not open the sunglass holder
while the vehicle is moving. The rear
view mirror of the vehicle can be
blocked by an open sunglass holder.
• Do not put the glasses forcibly into
a sunglass holder. It may cause
personal injury if you try to open
it forcibly when the glasses are
jammed in holder.
5-80
OOSH059082L
Small things may be placed in the multi
box.
WARNING
Do not keep objects that can be thrown
from the multi box and severely injure
passengers in the vehicle in the event of
a sudden stop or an accident.
05
INTERIOR FEATURES
Cup holder
WARNING
Front
OOSH059083L
Cups or small beverages cups may be
placed in the cup holders.
Rear
• Avoid abrupt starting and braking
when the cup holder is in use to
prevent spilling your drink. If hot
liquid spills, you could be burned.
Such a burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
• Do not place uncovered or unsecured
cups, bottles, cans, etc., in the cup
holder containing hot liquid while
the vehicle is in motion. Injuries may
result in the event of a sudden stop
or collision.
• Only use soft cups in the cup holders.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
WARNING
Keep cans or bottles out of direct sun
light and do not put them in a hot
vehicle. It may explode.
NOTICE
OOSH059084L
Pull the armrest down to use the cup
holders.
• Keep your drinks sealed while
driving to prevent spilling your drink.
If liquid spills, it may get into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and damage electrical/electronic
parts.
• When cleaning spilled liquids do not
use hot air to blow out or dry the cup
holder. This may damage the interior.
5-81
Convenient features
Sunvisor
Power outlet
OOSH059085L
OOSH059086L
To use the sunvisor, pull it downward.
To use the sunvisor to block the sun
from the side window, pull it downward,
release it from the bracket (1) and swing
it to the side (2) towards the window.
To use the vanity mirror, pull down the
sunvisor and slide the mirror cover (3).
Adjust the sunvisor forward or backward
(4) as needed (if equipped). Use the
ticket holder (5) to hold tickets.
Close the vanity mirror cover securely
and return the sunvisor to its original
position after use.
The power outlet is designed to provide
power for mobile telephones or other
devices designed to operate with vehicle
electrical systems. The devices should
draw less than 180 W with vehicle is in
the ready ( ) mode.
WARNING
For your safety, do not block your view
when using the sunvisor.
NOTICE
The tab (5) adjacent to the vanity mirror
on the sunvisor can be used for toll
road tickets or self parking tickets. Use
caution when inserting tickets into the
ticket holder to avoid damage. Refrain
from putting several tickets in the ticket
holder as this could also damage the
retaining tab.
5-82
WARNING
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not place
your fingers or foreign objects (pin, etc.)
into a power outlet or touch the power
outlet with a wet hand.
05
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the Power
Outlets:
• Use the power outlet only when the
vehicle is in the ready ( ) mode
and remove the accessory plug after
use. Using the accessory plug for
prolonged periods of time with the
engine off could cause the battery to
discharge.
• Only use 12V electric accessories
which are less than 180 W in electric
capacity.
• Adjust the air-conditioner or heater
to the lowest operating level when
using the power outlet.
• Close the cover when not in use.
• Some electronic devices can
cause electronic interference
when plugged into a vehicle’s
power outlet. These devices may
cause excessive audio static and
malfunctions in other electronic
systems or devices used in your
vehicle.
• Push the plug in as far as it will go. If
good contact is not made, the plug
may overheat and the fuse may open.
• Plug in battery equipped electrical/
electronic devices with reverse
current protection. The current
from the battery may flow into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and cause system malfunction.
USB charger (if equipped)
OOSH059087L
The USB charger is designed to recharge
batteries of small size electrical devices
using a USB cable.
The electrical devices can be recharged
when the ignition switch is in the ACC or
ON (or START) position.
The battery charging state may be
monitored on the electrical device.
Disconnect the USB cable from the USB
port after use.
• A smart phone or a tablet PC may
get warmer during the re-charging
process. It does not indicate any
malfunction with the charging system.
• A smart phone or a tablet PC, which
adopts a different re-charging
method, may not be properly recharged. In this case, use an exclusive
charger of your device.
• The charging terminal is only to
recharge a device. Do not use the
charging terminal either to turn ON an
audio or to play media on the AVN.
5-83
Convenient features
Wireless cellular phone charging
system (if equipped)
OOSH059088L
[A] : Indicator light, [B] : Charging pad
On certain models, the vehicle comes
equipped with a wireless cellular phone
charger.
The system is available when all doors
are closed, and when the ignition switch
is in the ACC or ON (or START) position.
To charge a cellular phone
The wireless cellular phone charging
system charges only the Qi-enabled
cellular phones ( ). Read the label on
the cellular phone accessory cover or
visit your cellular phone manufacturer’s
website to check whether your cellular
phone supports the Qi technology.
The wireless charging process starts
when you put a Qi-enabled cellular
phone on the wireless charging unit.
1. Remove other items, including the
smart key, from the wireless charging
unit. If not, the wireless charging
process may be interrupted. Place the
cellular phone on the center of the
charging pad.
2. The indicator light is orange when
the cellular phone is charging. The
indicator light turns green when
phone charging is complete.
3. You can turn ON or OFF the wireless
charging function from the User
Settings mode in the cluster LCD
display. For more details, refer to “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.
If your cellular phone is not charging:
-- Slightly change the position of the
cellular phone on the charging pad.
-- Make sure the indicator light is
orange.
5-84
05
The indicator light will blink orange for 10
seconds if there is a malfunction in the
wireless charging system.
In this case, temporarily stop the
charging process, and re-attempt to
charge your cellular phone again.
The system warns you with a message
on the LCD display if the cellular phone
is still on the wireless charging unit after
the vehicle is turned OFF and the front
door is opened.
For some manufacturer’s cellular
phones, the system may not warn you
even though the cellular phone is left on
the wireless charging unit. This is due
to the particular characteristic of the
cellular phone and not a malfunction of
the wireless charging.
NOTICE
• The wireless cellular phone charging
system may not support certain
cellular phones, which are not
verified for the Qi specification ( ).
• When placing your cellular phone on
the charging pad, position the phone
in the middle of the mat for optimal
charging performance. If your cell
phone is off to the side, the charging
rate may be less and in some cases
the cell phone may experience
higher heat conduction.
• In some cases, the wireless charging
may stop temporarily when the
Smart Key is used, either when
starting the vehicle or locking/
unlocking the doors, etc.
• When charging certain cellular
phones, the charging indicator may
not change to green when the cell
phone is fully charged.
• The wireless charging process may
temporarily stop, when temperature
abnormally increases inside the
wireless cellular phone charging
system. The wireless charging
process restarts, when temperature
falls to a certain level.
• The wireless charging process may
temporarily stop when there is
any metallic item, such as a coin,
between the wireless cellular phone
charging system and cellular the
phone.
5-85
Convenient features
• When charging some cellular phones
with a self-protection feature,
the wireless charging speed may
decrease and the wireless charging
may stop.
• If the cellular phone has a thick
cover, the wireless charging may not
be possible.
• If the cellular phone is not
completely contacting the charging
pad, wireless charging may not
operate properly.
• Some magnetic items like credit
cards, phone cards or rail tickets may
be damaged if left with the cellular
phone during the charging process.
• When any cellular phone without
a wireless charging function or a
metallic object is placed on the
charging pad, a small noise may
sound. This small sound is due to the
vehicle discerning compatibility of
the object placed on the charging
pad. It does not affect your vehicle or
the cellular phone in any way.
Information
If the ignition switch is OFF, the charging
also stops.
5-86
Clock
WARNING
Do not attempt to adjust the clock
while driving. Doing so may result in
distracted driving which may lead to
an accident involving personal injury or
death.
Vehicles with Audio system
Select the [SETUP] button on the audio
system → Select [Date/Time].
• Set time: Set the time displayed on
the audio screen.
• Time format: Choose between 12-hour
and 24-hour time formats.
Vehicles with Navigation system
Select the Settings menu on the
Navigation system → Select [Date/Time].
• GPS time: Displays time according to
the received GNSS time.
• 24-hour: Switches to 12 hour or 24
hour.
05
Coat hook
Floor mat anchor(s)
OOSH059089L
These hooks are not designed to hold
large or heavy items.
WARNING
OOSH059091L
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors to
attach the front floor mats to the vehicle.
The anchors on the front floor carpet
keep the floor mats from sliding forward.
WARNING
Do not overlay additional mats or liners
over the floor mats. If using All Weather
mats, remove the carpeted floor mats
before installing them. Only use floor
mats designed to connect to the
anchors.
OOSH059090L
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects except
clothes. Also, do not put heavy, sharp
or breakable objects in the clothes
pockets. In an accident or when the
curtain air bag is inflated, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
5-87
Convenient features
WARNING
The following must be observed when
installing ANY floor mat to the vehicle.
• Ensure to remove a protective
film attached on the carpet
before attaching a floor mat on
the front floor carpet. Otherwise,
the floor mat may move freely on
the protective film and it could
result in unintentional braking or
accelerating.
• Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchor(s) before driving
the vehicle.
• Do not use ANY floor mat that cannot
be firmly attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchors.
• Do not stack floor mats on top of one
another (e.g. all-weather rubber mat
on top of a carpeted floor mat). Only
a single floor mat should be installed
in each position.
IMPORTANT Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver’s side floor
mat anchors that are designed to
securely hold the floor mat in place.
To avoid any interference with pedal
operation, HYUNDAI recommends that
the HYUNDAI floor mat designed for use
in your vehicle be installed.
5-88
Luggage net holder (if equipped)
OOSH059092L
To keep items from shifting in the
luggage compartment, you can use the 4
holders located in the luggage board to
attach the luggage net.
Make sure the luggage net is securely
attached to the holders in the luggage
board.
If necessary, we recommend that you
contact your authorized HYUNDAI dealer
to obtain a luggage net.
WARNING
Avoid eye injury. DO NOT overstretch
the luggage net. ALWAYS keep your
face and body out of the luggage net’s
recoil path. DO NOT use the luggage net
when the strap has visible signs of wear
or damage.
Use the luggage net to keep only light
items from shifting in the luggage
compartment.
05
Cargo area cover
Luggage tray (if equipped)
OOSH059093L
Use the cover to hide items stored in the
cargo area.
The cargo area cover will lift when the
liftgate is opened.
Disconnect the strap (1) from the holder
if you want to return the cover to the
original position. To remove the cargo
area cover completely, lift the cover to a
50-degree angle and pull it out (2).
OOSH059094L
You can place a first aid kit, a reflector
triangle (front tray), tools, etc. in the box
for easy access.
• Grasp the handle on the top of the
cover and lift it.
NOTICE
Since the cargo area cover may be
damaged or deformed, do not put
luggage on it when it is being used.
WARNING
• Do not place objects on the cargo
area cover while driving. Such
objects may be thrown about inside
the vehicle and possibly injure
vehicle occupants during an accident
or when braking.
• Never allow anyone to ride in the
luggage compartment. It is designed
for luggage only.
• Maintain balance of the vehicle and
locate the weight as far forward as
possible.
5-89
Convenient features
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Roof side rails (if equipped)
WARNING
• The following specification is the
maximum weight that can be loaded
onto the roof side rails. Distribute the
load as evenly as possible onto the
roof side rails and secure the load
firmly.
Loading cargo or luggage in excess
of the specified weight limit on the
roof side rails may damage your
vehicle.
OOSH059095L
If your vehicle comes with roof side rails,
then roof side rails crossbars can be
installed on top of your vehicle.
The roof side rails crossbars are an
accessory and are available at your local
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, be sure not to position cargo
onto the roof side rails in such a way
that it could interfere with sunroof
operation.
NOTICE
• When carrying cargo on the roof side
rails, take the necessary precautions
to make sure the cargo does not
damage the roof of the vehicle.
• When carrying large objects on the
roof side rails, make sure they do
not exceed the overall roof length or
width.
5-90
ROOF SIDE
RAILS
80 kg (176 lbs.)
EVENLY DISTRIBUTED
• The vehicle center of gravity will be
higher when items are loaded onto
the roof side rails. Avoid sudden
starts, braking, sharp turns, abrupt
maneuvers or high speeds that may
result in loss of vehicle control or
rollover resulting in an accident.
• Always drive slowly and turn corners
carefully when carrying items on the
roof side rails. Severe wind updrafts,
caused by passing vehicles or natural
causes, can cause sudden upward
pressure on items loaded on the
roof side rails. This is especially true
when carrying large, flat items such
as wood panels or mattresses. This
could cause the items to fall off the
roof side rails and cause damage to
your vehicle or others around you.
• To prevent damage or loss of cargo
while driving, check frequently
before or while driving to make sure
the items on the roof side rails are
securely fastened.
05
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM
NOTICE
Antenna
• If you install an aftermarket HID
head lamp, your vehicle’s audio and
electronic devices may not function
properly.
• Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand
cleaner, and air freshener from
contacting the interior parts
because they may cause damage or
discoloration.
Pole antenna (if equipped)
USB Port
OOSH059097L
Your vehicle uses a roof antenna to
receive AM or/and FM broadcast signals.
This antenna pole is removable. To
remove the roof antenna pole, turn it
counterclockwise.
To install the roof antenna pole, turn it
clockwise.
NOTICE
OOSH059096L
You can use an USB cable to connect
audio devices to the vehicle USB port.
Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise may
occur during playback. If this happens,
use the portable audio device’s power
source.
Before entering a place with a low
height clearance or a car wash,
remove the antenna pole by rotating it
counterclockwise. If not, the antenna
may be damaged.
When reinstalling your roof antenna,
it is important that it is fully tightened
and adjusted to the upright position to
ensure proper reception.
When cargo is loaded on the roof rack,
do not place the cargo near the antenna
pole to ensure proper reception.
5-91
Convenient features
Shark fin antenna (if equipped)
VOLUME (VOL + / - ) (1)
• Rotate the VOLUME scroll up to
increase volume.
• Rotate the VOLUME scroll down to
decrease volume.
SEEK/PRESET (
OOSH059098L
The shark fin antenna will receive AM,
FM broadcast signals and transmit data.
Steering wheel remote controls
Type A
/
) (2)
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down and held for 0.8 second or more,
it will function in the following modes:
• RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK
select button. It will SEEK until you
release the button.
• MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/RW button.
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down, it will function in the following
modes:
• RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION
UP/DOWN button.
• MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/
DOWN button.
OOSH059200L
Type B
MODE (
) (3)
Press the MODE button to toggle
through Radio or AUX modes.
MUTE (
) (4)
• Press the MUTE button to mute the
sound.
• Press the MUTE button again to
activate the sound.
OOSH059201L
NOTICE
Do not operate multiple audio remote
control buttons simultaneously.
5-92
Detailed information are described in
the following pages or in a separately
supplied manual.
05
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
How vehicle radio works
FM reception
OOSH059202L
OJF045308L
OOSH059203L
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
(3) Microphone (Right-hand drive vehicle
: Right side)
Detailed information are described in
the following pages or in a separately
supplied manual.
AM and FM radio signals are broadcast
from transmitter towers located around
your city. They are intercepted by the
radio antenna on your vehicle. This signal
is then received by the radio and sent to
your vehicle speakers.
When a strong radio signal has reached
your vehicle, the precise engineering
of your audio system ensures the best
possible quality reproduction. However,
in some cases the signal coming to your
vehicle may not be strong and clear.
This can be due to factors, such as
the distance from the radio station,
closeness of other strong radio stations
or the presence of buildings, bridges or
other large obstructions in the area.
CAUTION
To avoid driver distractions, do not
excessively operate the device while
driving the vehicle which may lead to
an accident.
5-93
Convenient features
AM (MW, LW) reception
The following conditions are normal and
do not indicate radio trouble:
♬♩♪
OJF045309L
AM broadcasts can be received at
greater distances than FM broadcasts.
This is because AM radio waves are
transmitted at low frequencies. These
long, low frequency radio waves can
follow the curvature of the earth rather
than travelling straight out into the
atmosphere.
In addition, they curve around
obstructions so that they can provide
better signal coverage.
FM radio station
JBM004
• Fading - As your vehicle moves away
from the radio station, the signal will
weaken and sound will begin to fade.
When this occurs, we suggest that you
select another stronger station.
• Flutter/Static - Weak FM signals
or large obstructions between the
transmitter and your radio can disturb
the signal causing static or fluttering
noises to occur. Reducing the treble
level may lessen this effect until the
disturbance clears.
OJF045310L
FM broadcasts are transmitted at high
frequencies and do not bend to follow
the earth’s surface. Because of this, FM
broadcasts generally begin to fade at
short distances from the station. Also, FM
signals are easily affected by buildings,
mountains, or other obstructions. These
can result in certain listening conditions
which might lead you to believe a
problem exists with your radio.
5-94
OJF045311L
• Station Swapping - As a FM signal
weakens, another more powerful
signal near the same frequency may
begin to play. This is because your
radio is designed to lock onto the
clearest signal. If this occurs, select
another station with a stronger signal.
05
• Multi-Path Cancellation - Radio
signals being received from several
directions can cause distortion or
fluttering. This can be caused by a
direct and reflected signal from the
same station, or by signals from two
stations with close frequencies. If this
occurs, select another station until the
condition has passed.
Using a cellular phone or a twoway
radio
When a cellular phone is used inside
the vehicle, noise may be produced
from the audio system. This does not
mean that something is wrong with the
audio equipment. In such a case, use
the cellular phone at a place as far as
possible from the audio equipment.
iPod®
iPod® is a registered trademark of Apple
Inc.
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos
are registered trademarks owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such
marks by HYUNDAI is under license.
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
A Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
enabled cell phone is required to use
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology.
NOTICE
When using a communication system
such as a cellular phone or a radio set
inside the vehicle, a separate external
antenna must be fitted. When a cellular
phone or a radio set is used with an
internal antenna alone, it may interfere
with the vehicle’s electrical system and
adversely affect safe operation of the
vehicle.
WARNING
Do not use a cellular phone while
driving. Stop at a safe location to use a
cellular phone.
5-95
Convenient features
AUDIO (WITHOUT TOUCH SCREEN)
System layout – control panel
(With Bluetooth® Wireless Technology)
CMG4K0000EE
(1) SEEK/TRACK button
• Change the station/track/file.
• While listening to the radio, press
and hold to search for a station.
• While playing media, press and hold
to rewind or fast forward (except for
the Bluetooth audio mode).
(2) RADIO button
• Press to turn on the radio. While
listening to the radio, press to
change the radio mode.
(3) MEDIA button
• Press to play content from a media
storage device. Press repeatedly to
switch modes between USB (iPod)
and Bluetooth audio.
• If you have multiple media storage
devices, select one from the media
selection window.
5-96
(4) PHONE button
• Press to start connecting a mobile
phone via Bluetooth.
• After a Bluetooth phone connection
is made, press to access the
Bluetooth phone menu.
(5) POWER button/VOL knob
• Press to turn the system on or off.
• Turn to the left or right to adjust the
system sound volume.
(6) Reset button
ÃÃ The system’s actual appearance and
layout may differ depending on the
vehicle model and specification.
05
(With Bluetooth® Wireless Technology)
CMG4K0001EE
(7) PRESET button
• While listening to the radio, press
to move to previous or next page of
the preset list.
(8) SETUP button/CLOCK button
• Press to access the setup screen.
• Press and hold to access the time
setup screen.
(9) MENU button
• Press to access the menu screen for
the current mode.
(10) BACK button
• Press to return to the previous
screen.
(11) TUNE knob/FILE knob/ENTER
button
• While listening to the radio, turn to
adjust the frequency.
• While playing media, turn to search
for a track/file (except for the
Bluetooth audio mode).
• During a search, press to select the
current track/file.
(12) Number buttons (1–6)
• While listening to the radio, press to
listen to a saved radio station.
• While listening to the radio, press
and hold to save the current radio
station to the preset.
• Press the corresponding number
button to select an item.
ÃÃ The system’s actual appearance and
layout may differ depending on the
vehicle model and specification.
5-97
Convenient features
System layout – steering wheel
remote control
CMG4K0002EE
(Bluetooth® equipped model)
ÃÃ The system’s actual appearance and
layout may differ depending on the
vehicle model and specification.
(1) MUTE button
• Press to mute or unmute the
system.
• During a call, press to mute or
unmute the microphone.
• While playing media, press to pause
or resume playback (except for the
iPod mode).
(2) MODE button
• Press to switch between radio and
media modes.
(3) Volume lever
• Push up or down to adjust the
volume.
5-98
(4) Up/Down lever
• Change the station/track/file.
• While listening to the radio, push
to listen to the previous/next saved
radio station.
• While listening to the radio, push
and hold to search for a station.
• While playing media, push and hold
to rewind or fast forward (except for
the Bluetooth audio mode).
(5) Call/Answer button
• Press to start connecting a mobile
phone via Bluetooth.
• After a Bluetooth phone connection
is made, access the Bluetooth
phone screen. Press and hold to
dial the most recent phone number.
When a call comes in, press to
answer the call.
• During a call, press to switch
between the active call and the held
call. Press and hold to switch the
call between the system and the
mobile phone.
(6) Call end button
WARNING - About driving
• Do not operate the system while
driving. Driving while distracted may
result in a loss of vehicle control,
potentially leading to an accident,
severe personal injury, or death.
The driver’s primary responsibility
is the safe and legal operation of a
vehicle, and any handheld devices,
equipment, or vehicle systems which
divert the driver’s attention from this
responsibility should never be used
during operation of the vehicle.
05
• Avoid watching the screen while
driving. Driving while distracted
may lead to a traffic accident. Stop
your vehicle in a safe location before
using functions that require multiple
operations.
• Stop your vehicle first before using
your mobile phone. Using a mobile
phone while driving may lead to a
traffic accident. If necessary, use the
Bluetooth Handsfree feature to make
calls and keep the call as short as
possible.
• Keep the volume low enough to hear
external sounds. Driving without the
ability to hear external sounds may
lead to a traffic accident. Listening
to a loud volume for a long time may
cause hearing damage.
WARNING - About handling
the system
• Do not disassemble or modify the
system. Doing so may result in an
accident, fire, or electric shock.
• Do not allow liquids or foreign
substances to enter the system.
Liquids or foreign substances may
cause noxious fumes, a fire, or a
system malfunction.
• Stop using the system if it
malfunctions, such as no audio
output or display. If you continue
using the system when it is
malfunctioning, it may lead to a fire,
electric shock, or system failure.
• Do not touch the antenna during
thunder or lightning because such an
act may cause electric shock.
Information - About operating
the system
• Use the system with the engine running.
Using the system for a long time when
the engine is stopped may discharge the
battery.
• Do not install unapproved products.
Using unapproved products may cause
an error while using the system. System
errors caused by installing unapproved
products are not covered under the
warranty.
Information - About handling
the system
• Do not apply excessive force to the
system. Excessive pressure on the
screen may damage the LCD panel or
the touch panel.
• When cleaning the screen or button
panel, make sure to stop the engine
and use a soft, dry cloth. Wiping the
screen or buttons with a rough cloth or
using solvents (alcohol, benzene, paint
thinner, etc.) may scratch or chemically
damage the surface.
• If you attach a liquid-type air freshener
to the fan louvre, the surface of the
louvre may become deformed due to
the flowing air.
• If you want to change the position of
the installed device, please inquire
with your place of purchase or service
maintenance centre. Technical expertise
is required to install or disassemble the
device.
5-99
Convenient features
NOTICE
• If you experience any problems with
the system, contact your place of
purchase or dealer.
• Placing the infotainment system
within an electromagnetic
environment may result in noise
interference.
NOTICE
Manufacturer: HYUNDAI MOBIS Co.,
Ltd.
203, Teheran-ro, Gangnam-gu, Seoul,
06141, Korea Tel: +82-31-260-2707
Turning the system on or off
To turn on the system, start the engine.
• If you do not want to use the system
while driving, you can turn off the
system by pressing the [POWER]
button on the control panel. To use
the system again, press the [POWER]
button again.
After you have turned off the engine, the
system will automatically turn off after a
while or as soon as you open the driver’s
door.
• Depending on the vehicle model or
specifications, the system may turn
off as soon as you turn off the engine.
• When you turn back on the system,
the previous mode and settings will
remain intact.
5-100
WARNING
• Some functions may be disabled for
safety reasons while the vehicle is
moving. They work only when the
vehicle stops. Park your vehicle in
a safe location before using any of
them.
• Stop using the system if it
malfunctions, such as no audio
output or display. If you continue
using the system when it is
malfunctioning, it may lead to a fire,
electric shock, or system failure.
Information
You can turn on the system when the key
ignition switch is placed in the “ACC”
or “ON” position. Using the system for
an extended period without the engine
running drains the battery. If you plan on
using the system for a long time, start the
engine.
Turning the display on or off
To prevent glare, you can turn off the
screen. The screen can be turned off only
while the system is on.
1. On the control panel, press the
[SETUP/CLOCK] button.
2. On the control panel, press the [6]
button to select Display Off.
• To turn the screen back on, press
any of the control panel buttons.
05
Getting to know the basic
operations
You can select an item or adjust the
settings by using the number buttons
and the [TUNE] knob on the control
panel.
Adjusting the settings
Turn the [TUNE] knob to adjust the value,
and then press the knob to save changes.
Turn the [TUNE] knob to the right to
increase the value and turn the [TUNE]
knob to the left to decrease the value.
Selecting an item
Numbered items
Press the corresponding number button.
CMG4K005EE/CMG4K006EE
CMG4K001EE/CMG4K002EE
Numberless items
Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired item, and then press the knob.
CMG4K003EE/CMG4K004EE
5-101
Convenient features
RADIO
FM/AM Mode (With RDS)
Turning on the radio
On the control panel, press the [RADIO]
button.
FM/AM Mode
CMG4K008EE
CMG4K007EE
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• List: Display all available radio
stations.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals and
plays each radio station for about five
seconds.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
5-102
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• List: Display all available radio
stations.
• Traffic Announcement (TA)
(if equipped): Activate or
deactivate traffic announcements.
Announcements and programmes will
be received automatically if available.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals and
plays each radio station for about five
seconds.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
05
DAB/FM Mode (With DAB)
Changing the radio mode
Alternatively, press the [RADIO] button
on the control panel or the [MODE]
button on the steering wheel. Each time
you press the button, the radio mode
switches.
Scanning for available radio
stations
CMG4K009EE
(1) Current radio mode
(2) Radio station information
(3) Preset list
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• List: Display all available radio
stations.
• Traffic Announcement (TA): Activate
or deactivate traffic announcements.
Announcements and programmes will
be received automatically if available.
• Region: Enable or disable automatic
switching between regional stations.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
• Scan: The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals and
plays each radio station for about five
seconds.
• Manual tune FM: Tune the radio
frequency manually.
You can listen to each radio station for
a few seconds to test the reception and
select the one you want.
1. From the radio screen, press the
[MENU] button on the control panel.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select Scan,
and then press the knob.
• The system searches for radio
stations with strong radio signals
and plays each radio station for
about five seconds.
3. When you find the radio station you
want to listen to, press the [TUNE]
knob.
• You can continue listening to the
selected station.
5-103
Convenient features
Searching for radio stations
Listening to saved radio stations
To search for the previous or next
available radio station, press the
[˅ SEEK/TRACK ˄] button on the control
panel.
• You can also press and hold the
[˅ SEEK/TRACK ˄] button to search
for frequencies quickly. When you
release the button, a radio station
with a strong signal is selected
automatically. (if equipped)
1. Confirm the preset number for the
radio station you want to listen to.
2. On the control panel, press the
desired number button.
• Alternatively, push the Up/Down
lever on the steering wheel to
change the station.
If you know the exact frequency of the
radio station you want to listen to, turn
the [TUNE] knob on the control panel to
change the frequency.
Saving radio stations
You can save your favourite radio stations
and listen to them by selecting them
from the preset list.
While listening to the radio, press the
number button for an empty preset slot
on the radio screen.
• The radio station you are listening to
will be added to the selected number.
NOTICE
• You can save up to 36 radio stations.
• If the preset list is full, you can
replace one of your favourite stations
with the station you are listening to.
On the control panel, press and hold
the desired number button.
5-104
05
MEDIA PLAYER
Using the media player
You can play music stored in various
media storage devices, such as USB
storage devices, smartphones, and
iPods.
1. Connect a device to the USB port in
your vehicle.
• Playback may start immediately
depending on the device that you
connect to the system.
2. On the control panel, press the
[MEDIA] button.
• If you have multiple media storage
devices, press the [MEDIA] button
again and press the corresponding
number button to select the desired
mode.
NOTICE
• When you connect an Apple
device, playback does not start
automatically. To start the media
player in the iPod mode, press the
[MEDIA] button on the control panel.
• You can also change the mode by
press the [MODE] button repeatedly
on the steering wheel.
• Make sure to connect or disconnect
external USB devices with the system
power turned off.
• Depending on vehicle models and
specifications, available buttons or
the appearance and layout of the
USB ports in your vehicle may vary.
• Do not connect a smartphone or
an MP3 device to the system via
multiple methods such as USB and
Bluetooth, simultaneously. Doing
so may cause a distorted noise or a
system malfunction.
• When the equaliser function of the
connected device and Equaliser
settings of the system are both
activated, the effects may interfere
with each other and may lead to
sound degradation or distortion.
Deactivate the device’s equaliser
function if possible.
• Noise may occur when an Apple
device is connected. When such
devices are not being used,
disconnect the device for storage.
• When the Apple device power is
connected to the power jack, playing
the external device may result in
noise. In such cases, disconnect the
power connection before use.
Using the USB mode
You can play media files stored in
portable devices, such as USB storage
devices and MP3 players. Check
compatible USB storage devices and
file specifications before using the USB
mode.
Connect your USB device to the USB port
in the vehicle.
• Playback starts immediately.
• If a USB device is already connected
to the system, press the [MEDIA]
button and press the [1] button to
select USB from the media selection
window.
5-105
Convenient features
Playing the previous or next song
CMG4K010EE
(1) Repeat play mode
(2) Current file number and total number
of files
(3) Information about the song currently
playing
(4) Playback time and playback position
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• Information: Display information
about the song currently playing.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
Rewinding/Fast forwarding
On the control panel, press and hold the
[˅ SEEK/TRACK ˄] button.
• You can also push and hold the Up/
Down lever on the steering wheel.
Restarting the current playback
On the control panel after the song has
played for 2 seconds, press the [˅ SEEK/
TRACK] button.
• You can also push the Up/Down lever
on the steering wheel.
5-106
To play the previous song on the control
panel within the first 2 seconds of the
current song, press the [˅ SEEK/TRACK]
button. To play the next song, press the
[SEEK/TRACK ˄] button on the control
panel.
• If more than 2 seconds of playback
have elapsed, press the [˅ SEEK/
TRACK] button on the control panel
twice to play the previous song.
• You can also push the Up/Down lever
on the steering wheel.
NOTICE
• On the control panel, turn the [FILE]
knob to find the desired song and
press the knob within five seconds to
play the file.
• If no control is detected within five
seconds, the search is cancelled
and the screen displays information
about the song currently playing.
Playing repeatedly
On the control panel, press the [1] button.
The repeat play mode changes each time
you press it. The corresponding mode
icon will be displayed on the screen.
Playing in random order
On the control panel, press the [2]
button. The shuffle play mode is
activated or deactivated each time you
press it. When you activate the shuffle
mode, the corresponding mode icon will
be displayed on the screen.
05
Searching for music files on a file list
1. On the control panel, press the [3]
button to select List.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired category and file, and then
press the knob to play the music file.
Information
• Start the engine of your vehicle before
connecting a USB device to your
system. Starting the engine with a USB
device connected to the system may
damage the USB device.
• Be careful of static electricity when
connecting or disconnecting a USB
device. A static discharge may cause a
system malfunction.
• Be careful not to let your body or
external objects contact the USB port.
Doing so may cause an accident or a
system malfunction.
• Do not connect and disconnect a USB
connector repeatedly in a short time.
Doing so may cause an error in the
device or a system malfunction.
• Do not use a USB device for purposes
other than playing files. Using USB
accessories for charging or heating may
cause poor performance or a system
malfunction.
NOTICE
• When connecting a USB storage
device, do not use an extension
cable. Connect it directly to the
USB port. If you use a USB hub or an
extension cable, the device may not
be recognized.
• Fully insert a USB connector into the
USB port. Failure to do so may cause
a communication error.
• When you disconnect a USB storage
device, a distorted noise may occur.
• The system can play only files
encoded in a standard format.
• The following types of USB devices
may not be recognised or work
correctly:
-- Encrypted MP3 players
-- USB devices not recognised as
removable disks
• A USB device may not be recognised
depending on its condition.
• Some USB devices may be
incompatible with your system.
• Depending on the USB device’s type,
capacity, or the format of files, USB
recognition time may be longer.
• Image and video playback are not
supported.
5-107
Convenient features
Using the iPod mode
Rewinding/Fast forwarding
You can listen to music stored on your
Apple devices, such as an iPod or an
iPhone.
1. Connect your Apple device to the USB
port in your vehicle using the cable
supplied with the Apple device.
• When connected, the device will
begin charging. Music playback will
not start automatically.
2. On the control panel, press the
[MEDIA] button.
• If multiple devices are connected
to the system, press the [MEDIA]
button and press the [1] button
to select iPod from the media
selection window.
On the control panel, press and hold the
[˅ SEEK/TRACK ˄] button.
• You can also push and hold the Up/
Down lever on the steering wheel.
CMG4K011EE
(1) Repeat play mode
(2) Current file number and total number
of files
(3) Information about the song currently
playing
(4) Playback time and playback position
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• Information: Display information
about the song currently playing.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
5-108
Restarting the current playback
On the control panel after the song has
played for 2 seconds, press the [˅ SEEK/
TRACK] button.
• You can also push the Up/Down lever
on the steering wheel.
Playing the previous or next song
To play the previous song on the control
panel within the first 2 seconds of the
current song, press the [˅ SEEK/TRACK]
button. To play the next song, press the
[SEEK/TRACK ˄] button on the control
panel.
• If more than 2 seconds of playback
have elapsed, press the [˅ SEEK/
TRACK] button on the control panel
twice to play the previous song.
• You can also push the Up/Down lever
on the steering wheel.
NOTICE
• On the control panel, turn the [FILE]
knob to find the desired song and
press the knob within five seconds to
play the file.
• If no control is detected within five
seconds, the search is cancelled
and the screen displays information
about the song currently playing.
05
Playing repeatedly
On the control panel, press the [1] button.
The repeat play mode changes each time
you press it. The corresponding mode
icon will be displayed on the screen.
Playing in random order
On the control panel, press the [2]
button. The shuffle play mode is
activated or deactivated each time you
press it. When you activate the shuffle
mode, the corresponding mode icon will
be displayed on the screen.
Searching for music files on a file list
1. On the control panel, press the [3]
button to select List.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired category and file, and then
press the knob to play the music file.
Information
• Be sure to start the engine before you
connect devices to the system. The
device may be damaged if the engine is
started while the device connected.
• Do not connect and disconnect a USB
connector repeatedly in a short time.
Doing so may cause an error in the
device or a system malfunction.
Notes on connecting Apple devices
• Ensure that the iOS and firmware
of your device is up-to-date before
connecting it to your system.
Outdated devices may cause a system
error.
• If your device’s battery is low, the
device may not be recognised. Check
the battery level and, if necessary,
charge the battery before connecting
the device to your system.
• Use an Apple-approved cable. Using
an unapproved cable may cause a
distorted noise or an error during
playback.
• Use a cable shorter than 1 metre in
length, such as the one originally
supplied with a new Apple device.
Longer cables may lead to the
infotainment system not recognising
the Apple device.
• Fully insert a USB connector into the
USB port. Failure to do so may cause a
communication error.
• If you connect your device to the
system while playback is in progress
on the device, you may hear a high
pitch sound just after the connection.
Connect the device after stopping or
pausing playback.
• Connecting your device during a
download or synchronizing with
iTunes may cause an error. Connect
the device after the download or
synchronization is complete.
• If you connect an iPod nano (except
for the 6th generation) or an iPod
classic, the brand logo will be
displayed on the device screen. For
an iPhone and an iPod touch, the logo
will not be displayed.
5-109
Convenient features
Notes on playing Apple devices
• Depending on the model, your
device may not be recognised due
to unsupported communication
protocols.
• The order of the songs displayed or
played on the system may differ from
the order of the songs stored in your
device.
• Depending on the music player
application you are using, information
displayed on the system may differ.
• In an iPhone, the audio streaming
function and iPod mode control may
conflict. If an error occurs, disconnect
and reconnect the USB cable.
• When using an iPhone or an iPod
touch, do not control the device while
it is connected to your system. An
error may occur.
• If you make or receive a call during
playback via an iPhone, the music
may remain paused after you end the
call. If you do not hear the music after
ending a call, check the device to see
if the music is paused.
• Do not duplicate a song in multiple
folders. One song saved in multiple
folders may cause an error with search
and playback functions.
5-110
• If you perform a media control
function, such as stop or repeat,
just before a song ends, the song
information displayed on the screen
may not match the song currently
playing. This is not a system error.
Restart the iPod mode on the system
or pause and resume playback on
your device.
• Skipping or improper operations
may occur depending on the
characteristics of your Apple device.
• If the Apple device malfunctions due
to an Apple device defect, reset the
Apple device and try again. (To learn
more, refer to your Apple device
manual.)
05
BLUETOOTH
Connecting Bluetooth devices
Bluetooth is a short-range wireless
networking technology. Via Bluetooth,
you can connect nearby mobile
devices wirelessly to send and receive
data between connected devices.
This enables you to use your devices
effectively.
To use Bluetooth, you must first connect
a Bluetooth-enabled device to your
system, such as a mobile phone or an
MP3 player. Ensure that the device you
want to connect supports Bluetooth.
WARNING
Park your vehicle in a safe location
before connecting Bluetooth devices.
Distracted driving can cause a traffic
accident and lead to personal injury or
death.
NOTICE
• On your system, you can use only
Bluetooth Handsfree and Audio
features. Connect a mobile device
that supports both features.
• Some Bluetooth devices may cause
malfunctions to the infotainment
system or make interference noises.
In this case, storing the device in a
different location may resolve the
problem.
• Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device or mobile
phone, some functions may not be
supported.
• If the system is not stable due
to a vehicle-Bluetooth device
communication error, delete the
paired devices and connect the
Bluetooth devices again.
• If Bluetooth connection is not stable,
follow these steps to try again.
1. Deactivate Bluetooth and
reactivate it on the device. Then,
reconnect the device.
2. Turn the device off and on. Then,
reconnect it.
3. Remove the battery from the
device and reinstall it. Then, turn
the device on and reconnect it.
4. Unregister the Bluetooth pairing
on both the system and the device
and then re-register and connect
them.
Pairing devices with your system
For Bluetooth connections, first pair your
device with your system to add it to the
system’s list of Bluetooth devices. You
can register up to five devices.
1. From the control panel, press the
[SETUP/CLOCK] button, and then
select Bluetooth ► Connections.
• If you are pairing a device with your
system for the first time, you can
also press the [PHONE] button on
the control panel or the Call/Answer
button on the steering wheel.
2. On the Bluetooth device you want to
connect, activate Bluetooth, search
for your vehicle’s system, and then
select it.
• Check the system’s Bluetooth
name, which is displayed in the new
registration pop-up window on the
system screen.
5-111
Convenient features
NOTICE
CMG4K012EE
3. Enter or confirm the passkey to
confirm the connection.
• If the passkey input screen is
displayed on the Bluetooth device
screen, enter the passkey ‘0000’
which is displayed on the system
screen.
• If the 6-digit passkey is displayed
on the Bluetooth device screen,
ensure that the Bluetooth passkey
displayed on the Bluetooth device
is the same as the passkey on the
system screen and confirm the
connection from the device.
4. Choose whether or not to connect the
Bluetooth device to your system prior
to other devices.
• If you grant priority to the Bluetooth
device, it will be connected
automatically to the system when
you turn on the system.
5-112
• The screen image in this manual is an
example. Check your system screen
for the exact vehicle name and
Bluetooth device name.
• The default passkey is ‘0000’.
• It may take a while for the system
to connect with the device after
you permit the system to access the
device. When a connection is made,
the Bluetooth status icon appears at
the top of the screen.
• You can change the permission
settings via the mobile phone’s
Bluetooth settings menu. For more
information, refer to your mobile
phone’s user guide.
• To register a new device, repeat
steps 1 to 4.
• When a device is connected to the
system via Bluetooth, you cannot
pair another device.
• If you use the automatic Bluetooth
connection function, a call may be
switched to the vehicle’s Handsfree
when you are taking on the phone
near the vehicle while the vehicle’s
engine is on. If you do not want the
system to connect with the device
automatically, deactivate Bluetooth
on your device.
• When a device is connected to the
system via Bluetooth, the device’s
05
Connecting a paired device
Disconnecting a device
To use a Bluetooth device on your
system, connect the paired device to the
system. Your system can connect with
only one device at a time.
1. From the control panel, press the
[SETUP/CLOCK] button, and then
select Bluetooth ► Connections.
• If there is no connected device,
press the [PHONE] button on the
control panel or the Call/Answer
button on the steering wheel.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
device to connect, and then press the
knob.
• If another device is already
connected to your system,
disconnect it. Select the connected
device to disconnect.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select
Connect, and then press the knob.
If you want to stop using a Bluetooth
device or connect another device,
disconnect your currently connected
device.
1. From the control panel, press the
[SETUP/CLOCK] button, and then
select Bluetooth ► Connections.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
device to disconnect, and then press
the knob.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select
Disconnect, and then press the knob.
NOTICE
• If a connection ends because a
device is out of the connection
range or a device error occurs,
the connection will be restored
automatically when the device
enters the connection range or when
the error is cleared.
• The Bluetooth connection is
unavailable when the device’s
Bluetooth function is turned off.
Be sure to turn on the device’s
Bluetooth function.
• Depending on auto connection
priority, connection to a device may
take time.
Deleting paired devices
If you no longer want a Bluetooth device
paired or if you want to connect a new
device when the Bluetooth device list is
full, delete paired devices.
1. From the control panel, press the
[SETUP/CLOCK] button, and then
select Bluetooth ► Connections.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
device to delete, and then press the
knob.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select Delete,
and then press the knob.
NOTICE
• When you delete a paired device, the
Call history and Contacts stored in
the system are also deleted.
• To re-use a deleted device, you must
pair the device again.
5-113
Convenient features
Using a Bluetooth audio device
Playing repeatedly
You can listen to music stored in the
connected Bluetooth audio device via
your vehicle’s speakers.
On the control panel, press the [1] button.
The repeat play mode changes each time
you press it. The corresponding mode
icon will be displayed on the screen.
On the control panel, press the [MEDIA]
button.
• If you have multiple media storage
devices, press the [MEDIA] button and
press the [2] button to select BT Audio
from the media selection window.
Playing in random order
On the control panel, press the [2]
button. The shuffle play mode is
activated or deactivated each time you
press it. When you activate the shuffle
mode, the corresponding mode icon will
be displayed on the screen.
NOTICE
CMG4K013EE
(1) Repeat play mode
(2) Information about the song currently
playing
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• Connections: Set up the Bluetooth
connection.
• Sound Settings: Customise the
system sound settings.
Pausing/Resuming playback
To pause playback, press the [3]
button on the control panel. To resume
playback, press the [3] button again.
5-114
• Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device, mobile phone,
or the music player you are using,
playback controls may differ.
• Depending on the music player you
are using, streaming may not be
supported.
• Depending on the connected
Bluetooth device or mobile
phone, some functions may not be
supported.
• If you connect a Bluetooth device or
mobile phone to your system via USB
and Bluetooth simultaneously the
Bluetooth mode is deactivated and
music plays in the USB or iPod mode.
To listen to music streamed via
Bluetooth, remove the USB device.
• If a Bluetooth enabled phone is being
used to play music and it receives or
makes a phone call, the music will
stop.
05
• Receiving an incoming call or making
an outgoing call while playing
Bluetooth audio may result in audio
interference.
• If you use the Bluetooth phone
mode while using Bluetooth audio,
playback may not automatically
resume after you end the call
depending on the connected mobile
phone.
• Moving the track up/down while
playing Bluetooth audio mode may
result in pop noises with some
mobile phones.
• The Rewinding/Fast forwarding
function is not supported in the
Bluetooth audio mode.
• The playlist feature is not supported
in the Bluetooth audio mode.
• If the Bluetooth device is
disconnected, Bluetooth audio mode
will end.
Using a Bluetooth phone
You can use Bluetooth to talk on the
phone hands free. View call information
on the system screen, and make or
receive calls safely and conveniently via
the vehicle’s built-in microphone and
speakers.
WARNING
• Park your vehicle in a safe location
before connecting Bluetooth
devices. Distracted driving can
cause a traffic accident and lead to
personal injury or death.
• Never dial a phone number or pick
up your mobile phone while driving.
Use of a mobile phone may distract
your attention, making it difficult to
recognize external conditions and
reducing the ability to cope with
unexpected situations, which may
lead to an accident. If necessary, use
the Bluetooth Handsfree feature to
make calls and keep the call as short
as possible.
NOTICE
• You cannot access the Phone screen
if there is no connected mobile
phone. To use the Bluetooth phone
function, connect a mobile phone to
the system.
• The Bluetooth Handsfree function
may not work when you are
passing out of the cellular service
coverage area, such as when you
are in a tunnel, underground, or in a
mountainous area.
• Call quality may be degraded in the
following environments:
-- The reception of the mobile phone
is poor
-- The inside of the vehicle is noisy
-- The mobile phone is placed
near metallic objects, such as a
beverage can
• Depending on the connected mobile
phone, the volume and sound quality
of the Bluetooth Handsfree may vary.
5-115
Convenient features
Making a call
If your mobile phone is connected to the
system, you can make a call by selecting
a name from your call history or contacts
list.
1. On the control panel, press the
[PHONE] button.
• Alternatively, press the Call/Answer
button on the steering wheel.
2. If you have multiple paired mobile
devices, select a mobile phone from
your list of paired devices.
Using the favourites list
1. From the Phone screen, press the [1]
button to select Favourites.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired contact, and then press the
knob to make a phone call.
CMG4K015EE
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following a menu
option:
• Delete: Delete favourites items.
CMG4K014EE
3. Select a phone number.
• To select a phone number from your
favourites list, select Favourites.
• To select a phone number from your
call history, select Call history.
• To select a phone number from your
contacts list that downloaded from
the connected mobile phone, select
Contacts.
4. To end the call, press the [2] button on
the control panel to select End.
• Alternatively, press the Call end
button on the steering wheel.
5-116
NOTICE
• You can register up to 20 favourites
for each device.
• You must first download the contacts
to the system to register favourites.
• The favourites list saved on the
mobile phone is not downloaded to
the system.
• Even if the contact information on
the mobile phone is edited, the
favourites on the system are not
automatically edited. Delete and add
the item to favourites again.
• When you connect a new mobile
phone, your favourites set for the
previous mobile phone will not be
displayed, but they will remain in
your system until you delete the
previous phone from the device list.
05
Using your call history
1. From the Phone screen, press the [2]
button to select Call history.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired entry, and then press the knob
to make a phone call.
CMG4K016EE
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following menu
options:
• All calls: View all call records.
• Missed calls: View only missed calls.
• Dialled calls: View only dialled calls.
• Received calls: View only received
calls.
• Download: Download your call
history.
NOTICE
• Some mobile phones may not
support the download function.
• The call history is accessed only
when the mobile phone is connected
to the system.
• Calls from restricted IDs are not
saved on the call history list.
• Up to 50 call records will be
downloaded per individual list.
• Call duration and time information
will not be displayed on the system
screen.
• Permission is required to download
your call history from the mobile
phone. When you attempt to
download data, you may need to
permit the download on the mobile
phone. If the download fails, check
the mobile phone screen for any
notification or the mobile phone’s
permission setting.
• When you download your call
history, any old data will be deleted.
5-117
Convenient features
Using the contacts list
1. From the Phone screen, press the [3]
button to select Contacts.
2. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired group of alphanumeric
characters, and then press the knob.
3. Turn the [TUNE] knob to select the
desired contact, and then press the
knob to make a phone call.
CMG4K017EE
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following a menu
option:
• Download: Download your mobile
phone contacts.
NOTICE
• Contacts can be downloaded only
from the currently connected
Bluetooth device.
• Contacts can be viewed only when
the Bluetooth device is connected.
• Only contacts in the supported
format can be downloaded and
displayed from the Bluetooth device.
Contacts from some applications will
not be included.
• Up to 2,000 contacts can be
downloaded from your device.
5-118
• Some mobile phones may not
support the download function.
• Depending on the system’s
specifications, some of the
downloaded contacts may be lost.
• Contacts stored both in the phone
and in the SIM card are downloaded.
With some mobile phones,
contacts in the SIM card may not be
downloaded.
• Special characters and figures used
in the contact name may not be
displayed properly.
• Permission is required to download
contacts from the mobile phone.
When you attempt to download
data, you may need to permit the
download on the mobile phone. If
the download fails, check the mobile
phone screen for any notification
or the mobile phone’s permission
setting.
• Depending on the mobile phone type
or status, downloading may take
longer.
• When you download your contacts,
any old data will be deleted.
• You cannot edit or delete your
contacts on the system.
• When you connect a new mobile
phone, your contacts downloaded
from the previous mobile phone
will not be displayed, but they will
remain in your system until you
delete the previous phone from the
device list.
05
Answering calls
Using options during a call
When a call comes in, a notification popup window of the incoming call appears
on the system screen.
During a call, you will see the call screen
shown below. Press a button to perform
the function you want.
CMG4K018EE
To answer the call, press the [1] button on
the control panel to select Accept.
• Alternatively, press the Call/Answer
button on the steering wheel.
To reject the call, press the [2] button on
the control panel to select Reject.
• Alternatively, press the Call end
button on the steering wheel.
NOTICE
• Depending on the mobile phone
type, call rejection may not be
supported.
• Once your mobile phone is
connected to the system, the call
sound may be output through the
vehicle’s speakers even after you
exit the vehicle if the phone is within
the connection range. To end the
connection, disconnect the device
from the system or deactivate
Bluetooth on the device.
CMG4K019EE
To switch the call to your mobile phone,
press the [1] button on the control panel
to select Private.
• Alternatively, press and hold the Call/
Answer button on the steering wheel.
To end the call, press the [2] button on
the control panel to select End.
• Alternatively, press the Call end
button on the steering wheel.
Press the [MENU] button on the control
panel to access the following a menu
option:
• Microphone Volume: Adjust the
microphone volume or turn off the
microphone so the other party cannot
hear you.
5-119
Convenient features
SETUP
NOTICE
• If the caller information is saved in
your contacts list, the caller’s name
and phone number will be displayed.
If the caller information is not saved
in your contacts list, only the caller’s
phone number will be displayed.
• You cannot switch to any other
screen, such as the audio screen
or the settings screen, during a
Bluetooth call.
• Depending on the mobile phone
type, call quality may vary. On some
phones, your voice may be less
audible to the other party.
• Depending on the mobile phone
type, the phone number may not be
displayed.
• Depending on the mobile phone
type, the call switching function may
not be supported.
Display
You can change the settings related to
the system display.
On the control panel, press the [SETUP/
CLOCK] ► [1] buttons to select Display.
• Dimming mode: Set the screen
brightness to be adjusted
automatically according to the
headlight use or set the screen to stay
bright or dark continuously.
• Brightness: Adjust the brightness for
the day or night mode according to
your setting in the Dimming mode
option.
• Screensaver: Select a screen saver
option to be displayed when the
system is turned off.
• Text Scroll: Set to scroll text when
information text is too long to display
all on the screen.
NOTICE
The text scroll function is only available
in the following situation:
• When displaying main screen in
the USB/iPod/Bluetooth audio and
radio/DAB modes When displaying
list screen in the USB/iPod/Bluetooth
audio, radio/DAB and phone modes
Sound
You can change the settings related to
sounds, such as location where sound
will be concentrated and the output level
for each range.
On the control panel, press the [SETUP/
CLOCK] ► [2] buttons to select Sound.
• Position: Select a location where
sound will be concentrated in the
vehicle. Select Fade or Balance, turn
the [TUNE] knob to select the desired
position, and then press the knob. To
set sound to be centred in the vehicle,
select Centre.
5-120
05
• Equaliser: Adjust the output level for
each sound tone mode.
• Speed dependent volume control:
Set the volume to be adjusted
automatically according to your
driving speed.
• Rear parking sensors prioritised:
Set to decrease the audio volume to
hear a reverse warning prior to other
sounds while reversing your vehicle.
NOTICE
• Depending on vehicle models or
specifications, available options may
vary.
• Depending on the system or
amplifier specifications applied to
your vehicle, available options may
vary.
Date/Time
You can change the date and time that
are shown on the system display.
On the control panel, press the [SETUP/
CLOCK] ► [3] buttons to select Date/
Time.
• Set date: Set date to display on the
system display.
• Set time: Set time to display on the
system display.
• Time format: Select to display time
in the 12 hour format or the 24 hour
format.
Bluetooth
You can change the settings for
Bluetooth connections.
On the control panel, press the [SETUP/
CLOCK] ► [4] buttons to select
Bluetooth.
• Connections: Pair new Bluetooth
devices with your system, or connect
or disconnect a paired device. You can
also delete paired devices.
• Auto connection priority: Select
a paired device to connect to your
system automatically when it turns on.
• Update contacts: Download the
contacts list from the connected
mobile phone.
• Bluetooth voice guidance: Turn on or
off the voice guidance for Bluetooth
pairing, connection, and errors.
NOTICE
• If no Bluetooth device is connected,
the Update contatcts menu is
disabled.
• If the system language is selected to
Slovakian or Hungarian, Bluetooth
voice guidance menu is disabled.
System
You can change the display language or
initialise system settings.
On the control panel, press the [SETUP/
CLOCK] ► [5] buttons to select System.
• Language: Change the display
language.
• Default: Reset your system settings to
the default values. All user data stored
in the system will also be deleted.
5-121
Convenient features
SYSTEM STATUS ICONS
Status icons appear at the top of the
screen to display the current system
status.
Familiarise yourself with the status icons
that appear when you perform certain
actions or functions and their meanings.
Signal strength
Icon
Description
Signal strength of the mobile
phone connected via Bluetooth
NOTICE
CMG4K019EE
Mute
Icon
Description
Audio muted
Bluetooth
Icon
Description
Battery level of connected
Bluetooth device
Mobile phone connected via
Bluetooth
Audio device connected via
Bluetooth
Mobile phone and audio device
connected via Bluetooth
Bluetooth call in progress
Microphone turned off during
Bluetooth call
Downloading call history from
a mobile phone connected via
Bluetooth to the system
Downloading contacts from a
mobile phone connected via
Bluetooth to the system
5-122
• The battery level displayed on the
screen may differ from the battery
level displayed on the connected
device.
• The signal strength displayed on the
screen may differ from the signal
strength displayed on the connected
mobile phone.
• Depending on vehicle models and
specifications, some status icons
may not be displayed.
05
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM SPECIFICATIONS
USB
Supported audio formats
• Audio file specification
-- WAVeform audio format
-- MPEG1/2/2.5 Audio Layer3
-- Windows Media Audio Ver 7.X/8.X
• Bit rates
-- MPEG1 (Layer3):
32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/
160/192/224/256/320 kbps
-- MPEG2 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/
112/128/144/160 kbps
-- MPEG2.5 (Layer3):
8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/
112/128/144/160 kbps
-- WMA (High Range):
48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
• Bits Per Sample
-- WAV (PCM(Stereo)): 24 bit
-- WAV (IMA ADPCM): 4 bit
-- WAV (MS ADPCM): 4 bit
• Sampling frequency
-- MPEG1: 44100/48000/32000 Hz
-- MPEG2: 22050/24000/16000 Hz
-- MPEG2.5: 11025/12000/8000 Hz
-- WMA: 32000/44100/48000 Hz
-- WAV: 44100/48000 Hz
• Maximum number of directory layers:
No limitation
• Maximum length of folder names
(Based on Unicode): 31 English or
Korean characters
• Maximum length of file names (Based
on Unicode): 63 English or Korean
characters
• The scroll feature can be used to
display file and folder names that are
too long to display on the screen.
• Supported characters for folder/
file names (Unicode support): 2,604
Korean characters, 94 alphanumeric
characters, 4,888 Chinese characters
in common use, 986 special
characters
• Maximum number of folders: 2,000
• Maximum number of files: 6,000
NOTICE
• Files that are not in a supported
format may not be recognised or
played, or information about them,
such as the file name, may not be
displayed properly.
• Only files with .mp3/.wma/.wav
extensions can be recognised by the
system. If the file is not in supported
format, change the file format by
using the latest encoding software.
• The device will not support files
locked by DRM (Digital Rights
Management).
• For MP3/WMA compression files and
WAV file, differences in sound quality
will occur depending on the bitrate.
(Music files with a higher bitrate
have a better sound quality.)
• Japanese or Simplified Chinese
characters in folder or file names
may not be displayed properly.
5-123
Convenient features
TRADEMARKS
Supported USB storage devices
• Byte/Sector: 64 kbyte or less
• Format system: FAT12/16/32
(recommended)
• Maximum device size: 32 GB
NOTICE
• Operation is guaranteed only for a
metal cover type USB storage device
with a plug type connector.
-- USB storage devices with a plastic
plug may not be recognised.
-- USB storage devices in memory
card types, such as CF card or SD
cards, may not be recognised.
• USB hard disk drives may not be
recognised.
• When you use a large capacity USB
storage device with multiple logical
drives, only files stored on the first
drive will be recognised.
• If an application program is loaded
on a USB storage device, the
corresponding media files may not
play.
• Use USB 2.0 devices for better
compatibility.
Bluetooth
•
•
•
•
Bluetooth Power Class 2: -6 to 4 dBm
Aerial power: Max 3 mW
Frequency range: 2400 to 2483.5 MHz
Bluetooth patch RAM software
version: 1
5-124
Other trademarks and trade names are
those of their respective owners.
• The Bluetooth®
word mark and
logos are registered
trademarks owned
by Bluetooth SIG,
Inc. and any use
of such marks by
HYUNDAI is under
licence.
• Apple®, iPad®, iPad mini™, iPhone®,
iPod®, iPod classic®, iPod nano®, iPod
touch®, and iTunes® are a registered
trademark of Apple Inc.
CE RED for EU
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
RoHS for Taiwan
05
5-125
Convenient features
NCC for Taiwan
According to NCC low-power radio frequency devices technical regulations:
Article 12
Without permission, any company, firm or user shall not alter the frequency, increase
the power, or change the characteristics and functions of the original design of the
certified lower power frequency electric machinery.
Article 14
The application of low power frequency electric machineries shall not affect the
navigation safety nor interfere a legal communication, if an interference is found, the
service will be suspended until improvement is made and the interference no longer
exists.
5-126
6. Driving your vehicle
Before driving..................................................................................................... 6-5
Before entering the vehicle..........................................................................................6-5
Before starting...............................................................................................................6-5
Ignition switch....................................................................................................6-6
Key ignition switch....................................................................................................... 6-6
Engine Start/Stop button............................................................................................. 6-9
Dual clutch transmission..................................................................................6-13
Dual clutch transmission operation........................................................................... 6-13
Paddle shifter.............................................................................................................. 6-20
Parking........................................................................................................................ 6-20
Good driving practices................................................................................................ 6-21
Coasting guide................................................................................................. 6-22
Braking system................................................................................................. 6-23
Power brakes...............................................................................................................6-23
Disc brakes wear indicator.........................................................................................6-24
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)...................................................................................6-24
Auto Hold.....................................................................................................................6-29
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS).....................................................................................6-32
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)..............................................................................6-34
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)....................................................................... 6-36
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)................................................................................... 6-38
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS).................................................................................... 6-38
Good braking practices...............................................................................................6-39
Forward Collision – Avoidance Assist (FCA) system......................................6-40
System setting and activation................................................................................... 6-40
FCA warning message and brake control................................................................. 6-42
FCA sensor.................................................................................................................. 6-45
System malfunction....................................................................................................6-47
Limitations of the system.......................................................................................... 6-49
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) system................................................. 6-55
System description.....................................................................................................6-55
System setting and operation................................................................................... 6-56
Warning message and system control.......................................................................6-57
6
Rear Cross – Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) system................................6-65
System description.................................................................................................... 6-65
System setting and operation................................................................................... 6-66
Warning message and system control.......................................................................6-67
Detecting sensor........................................................................................................ 6-69
Declaration of conformity............................................................................... 6-74
Lane Following Assist (LFA) system................................................................ 6-78
LFA operation............................................................................................................. 6-80
Warning message........................................................................................................ 6-81
Limitations of the system.......................................................................................... 6-82
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system..................................................................6-84
LKA operation............................................................................................................. 6-86
Warning light and message....................................................................................... 6-89
Limitations of the system.......................................................................................... 6-90
LKA system function change...................................................................................... 6-91
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system........................................................ 6-92
System setting and operation................................................................................... 6-92
Resetting the system................................................................................................. 6-94
System standby.......................................................................................................... 6-95
System malfunction................................................................................................... 6-95
6
Intelligent Speed Limit Warning (ISLW)......................................................... 6-97
System setting and operation................................................................................... 6-98
Display......................................................................................................................... 6-98
Limitations of the system..........................................................................................6-101
Speed limit control.........................................................................................6-103
Speed limit control operation................................................................................... 6-103
Cruise control..................................................................................................6-105
Cruise control operation........................................................................................... 6-105
Smart cruise control with stop & go.............................................................. 6-110
Smart cruise control switch........................................................................................6-111
To adjust the sensitivity of Smart Cruise Control..................................................... 6-112
To convert to Cruise Control mode........................................................................... 6-112
Smart Cruise Control speed...................................................................................... 6-113
Smart Cruise Control Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance.................................................. 6-117
Sensor to detect distance to the vehicle ahead...................................................... 6-120
Limitations of the system......................................................................................... 6-122
6. Driving your vehicle
Leading vehicle departure alert..................................................................... 6-127
System setting and activation...................................................................................6-127
Special driving conditions..............................................................................6-128
Hazardous driving conditions.................................................................................. 6-128
Rocking the vehicle................................................................................................... 6-128
Smooth cornering..................................................................................................... 6-129
Driving at night.......................................................................................................... 6-129
Driving in the rain...................................................................................................... 6-129
Driving in flooded areas............................................................................................ 6-130
Highway driving........................................................................................................ 6-130
Winter driving.................................................................................................. 6-131
Snow or icy conditions............................................................................................... 6-131
Winter Precautions.................................................................................................... 6-133
Trailer towing (for europe)..............................................................................6-135
If you decide to pull a trailer?................................................................................... 6-135
Trailer towing equipment......................................................................................... 6-138
Driving with a trailer.................................................................................................. 6-139
Maintenance when towing a trailer......................................................................... 6-142
Vehicle weight.................................................................................................6-143
Overloading............................................................................................................... 6-143
6
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Carbon monoxide (CO) gas is toxic. Breathing CO can cause unconsciousness and
death.
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide which cannot be seen or smelled.
Do not inhale engine exhaust.
If at any time you smell engine exhaust inside the vehicle, open the windows
immediately. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and death by asphyxiation.
Be sure the exhaust system does not leak.
The exhaust system should be checked whenever the vehicle is raised to change the
oil or for any other purpose. If you hear a change in the sound of the exhaust or if you
drive over something that strikes the underneath side of the vehicle, we recommend
that the exhaust system be checked as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Do not run the engine in an enclosed area.
Letting the engine idle in your garage, even with the garage door open, is a hazardous
practice. Run the engine only long enough to start the engine and to move the vehicle
out of the garage.
Avoid idling the engine for prolonged periods with people inside the vehicle.
If it is necessary to idle the engine for a prolonged period with people inside the
vehicle, be sure to do so only in an open area with the air intake set at “Fresh” and fan
control set to high so fresh air is drawn into the interior.
Keep the air intakes clear.
To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes
located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you must drive with the tailgate open:
Close all windows.
Open instrument panel air vents.
Set the air intake control at “Fresh”, the air flow control at “Floor” or “Face”, and the fan
control set to high.
6-4
06
BEFORE DRIVING
Before entering the vehicle
• Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s),
and outside lights are clean and
unobstructed.
• Remove frost, snow, or ice.
• Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
• Check under the vehicle for any sign
of leaks.
• Be sure there are no obstacles behind
you if you intend to back up.
Before starting
• Make sure the hood, the tailgate, and
the doors are securely closed and
locked.
• Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
• Adjust the inside and outside rearview
mirrors.
• Verify all the lights work.
• Fasten your seat belt. Check that all
passengers have fastened their seat
belts.
• Check the gauges and indicators
in the instrument panel and the
messages on the instrument display
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
• Check that any items you are carrying
are stored properly or fastened down
securely.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt. All
passengers must be properly belted
whenever the vehicle is moving.
For more information, refer to “Seat
Belts” section in chapter 3.
• Always drive defensively. Assume
other drivers or pedestrians may be
careless and make mistakes.
• Stay focused on the task of driving.
Driver distraction can cause
accidents.
• Leave plenty of space between you
and the vehicle in front of you.
WARNING
NEVER drink or take drugs and drive.
Drinking or taking drugs and driving
is dangerous and may result in an
accident and SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number one
contributor to the highway death
toll each year. Even a small amount
of alcohol will affect your reflexes,
perceptions and judgment. Just
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions and
emergencies and your reaction time
gets worse with each additional drink.
Driving while under the influence
of drugs is as dangerous or more
dangerous than driving under the
influence of alcohol.
You are much more likely to have a
serious accident if you drink or take
drugs and drive. If you are drinking or
taking drugs, don’t drive. Do not ride
with a driver who has been drinking
or taking drugs. Choose a designated
driver or call a taxi.
6-5
Driving your vehicle
IGNITION SWITCH
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
• NEVER allow children or any person
who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the ignition switch or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur.
• NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the ignition switch, or any
other control, while the vehicle is in
motion. The presence of your hand
or arm in this area may cause a loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Key ignition switch (if equipped)
OOSH069001L
Whenever the front door is opened, the
ignition switch will illuminate, provided
the ignition switch is not in the ON
position. The light will go off immediately
when the ignition switch is turned on or
go off after about 30 seconds when the
door is closed (if equipped).
6-6
OOSH069002L
[A] : LOCK, [B] : ACC, [C] : ON, [D] : START
WARNING
• NEVER turn the ignition switch to
the LOCK or ACC position while the
vehicle is in motion except in an
emergency. This will result in engine
turning off and loss of power assist
for the steering and brake systems.
This may lead to loss of directional
control and braking function, which
could cause an accident.
• Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift lever is
in the P (Park) position, apply the
parking brake, and turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK position.
Unexpected vehicle movement may
occur if these precautions are not
followed.
NOTICE
Never use aftermarket keyhole covers.
This may generate start-up failure due
to communication failure.
06
Key ignition switch positions
Switch
Position
Action
Notes
LOCK
To turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK position, push the key in at
the ACC position and turn the key
towards the LOCK position.
The ignition key can be removed in
the LOCK position.
The steering wheel locks to protect
the vehicle from theft (if equipped).
ACC
Some of the electrical accessories are If difficulty is experienced turning the
usable.
ignition switch to the ACC position,
The steering wheel unlocks.
turn the key while turning the steering
wheel right and left to release.
ON
This is the normal key position when
the vehicle has started. All features
and accessories are usable.
The warning lights can be checked
when you turn the ignition switch
from ACC to ON.
Do not leave the ignition switch in the
ON position when the vehicle is not in
) mode to prevent the
the ready (
battery from discharging.
START
To start the vehicle, turn the ignition
switch to the START position. The
switch returns to the ON position
when you let go of the key.
The engine will crank until you release
the key.
6-7
Driving your vehicle
Starting the vehicle
WARNING
• Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flip-flops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake and
accelerator pedals.
• Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed. The
vehicle can move which can lead to
an accident.
• Wait until the engine rpm is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
rpm is high.
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
3. Depress the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of 10
seconds) until the “ ” comes on and
release it.
6-8
Information
• Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine
speeds. (Steep accelerating and
decelerating should be avoided.)
• Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming
it up.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
• Do not hold the ignition key in the
START position for more than 10
seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before
trying again.
• Do not turn the ignition switch to
the START position with the engine
running. It may damage the starter.
• If the “ ” indicator turns off while
you are in motion, do not attempt to
move the shift lever to the P (Park)
position.
If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift lever in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and turn the ignition
switch to the START position in an
attempt to restart the vehicle.
• Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the vehicle.
06
Engine Start/Stop button
(if equipped)
OOSH069003L
Whenever the front door is opened, the
Engine Start/Stop button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the door
is closed (if equipped).
WARNING
• NEVER press the Engine Start/Stop
button while the vehicle is in motion
except in an emergency. This will
result in the vehicle turning off and
loss of power assist for the steering
and brake systems. This may lead
to loss of directional control and
braking function, which could cause
an accident.
• Before leaving the driver’s seat,
always make sure the shift lever is in
the P (Park) position, set the parking
brake, press the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position, and take
the Smart Key with you. Unexpected
vehicle movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
WARNING
To turn the vehicle off in an emergency:
Press and hold the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than two seconds OR
Rapidly press and release the Engine
Start/ Stop button three times (within
three seconds).
If the vehicle is still moving, you can
restart the vehicle without depressing
the brake pedal by pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button with the shift lever in
the N (Neutral) position.
6-9
Driving your vehicle
Engine Stop/Start button positions
Button Position
Action
OFF
To turn off the vehicle, press the
Engine Start/Stop button with
shift lever in P (Park).
When you press the Engine Start/
Stop button without the shift lever
in P (Park), the Engine Start/Stop
button does not turn to the OFF
position, but turns to the ACC
position.
The steering wheel locks to
protect the vehicle from theft (if
equipped).
ACC
Press the Engine Start/Stop button • If you leave the Engine Start/Stop
when the button is in the OFF
button in the ACC position for
position without depressing the
more than one hour, the battery
brake pedal.
power will turn off automatically
Some of the electrical accessories
to prevent the battery from
are usable.
discharging.
The steering wheel unlocks.
• If the steering wheel doesn’t
unlock properly, the Engine Start/
Stop button will not work. Press
the Engine Start/Stop button
while turning the steering wheel
right and left to release.
ON
Press the Engine Start/Stop button
while it is in the ACC position
without depressing the brake
pedal.
The warning lights can be checked
before the engine is started.
Do not leave the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ON position when the
)
vehicle is not in the ready (
mode to prevent the battery from
discharging.
To start the vehicle, depress the
brake pedal and press the Engine
Start/ Stop button with the shift
lever in neutral.
If you press the Engine Start/Stop
button without depressing the
brake pedal, the vehicle does not
start and the Engine Start/Stop
button changes as follows:
OFF → ACC → ON → OFF or ACC
START
6-10
Notes
If the steering wheel is not locked
properly when you open the
driver’s door, the warning chime
will sound.
06
Starting the vehicle
WARNING
• Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle. Unsuitable
shoes, such as high heels, ski boots,
sandals, flipflops, etc., may interfere
with your ability to use the brake and
accelerator pedals.
• Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle can move which can lead
to an accident.
Information
• The vehicle will start by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button, only when
the smart key is in the vehicle.
• Even if the smart key is in the vehicle,
and when it is far away from the driver,
the hybrid system may not start.
• When the Engine Start/Stop button is
in the ACC or ON position, any door
is open, the system checks for the
smart key. When the smart key is not
” indicator
in the vehicle, the “
will blink and the warning “Key not in
vehicle” will come on. When all doors
are closed, the chime will also sound for
about 5 seconds. Keep the smart key in
the vehicle when in the ACC position or
if the hybrid system is ON.
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button. If
the vehicle starts, the “ ” indicator
will come on.
Information
• Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine
speeds. Steep accelerating and
decelerating should be avoided.
• Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not race the engine while warming
it up.
• If ambient temperature is low, the
“ ” indicator may remain
illuminated longer than the normal
amount of time.
6-11
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
• If the “ ” indicator turns off while
you are in motion, do not attempt to
move the shift lever to the P (Park)
position.
• Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the vehicle.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
Do not press the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp fuse is blown.
When the stop lamp fuse is blown,
you cannot normally start the hybrid
system. Replace the fuse with a new
one. If you are not able to replace
the fuse, you can start the vehicle by
pressing and holding the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds with the
Engine Start/Stop button in the ACC
position.
For your safety always depress the
brake pedal before starting the vehicle.
6-12
OOSH069004L
Information
If the smart key battery is weak or the
smart key does not work correctly, you
can start the vehicle by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button with the smart
key in the direction of the picture above.
06
DUAL CLUTCH TRANSMISSION
Left-hand drive
Right-hand drive
OOSH069005L
OOSH069005R
[A] : Shift lever, [B] : Manual shift mode
Depress the brake pedal and press the shift button while moving the shift lever.
Press the shift button while moving the shift lever.
The shift lever can freely operate.
ÃÃ To move the shift lever from/to P (Parking) or between R (Reverse) and D (Drive), you
must depress the brake pedal for the vehicle to stand still.
Dual clutch transmission operation
The dual clutch transmission has six forward speeds and one reverse speed. The
individual speeds are selected automatically in the D (Drive) position.
• The dual clutch transmission can be thought of as an automatically shifting manual
transmission. It gives the driving feel of a manual transmission, yet provides the
ease of a fully automatic transmission.
• When D (Drive) is selected, the transmission will automatically shift through
the gears similar to a conventional automatic transmission. Unlike a traditional
automatic transmission, the gear shifting can sometimes be felt and heard as the
actuators engage the clutches and the gears are selected.
6-13
Driving your vehicle
• The dual clutch transmission
incorporates a dry-type dual clutch
mechanism, which allows for better
acceleration performance and
increased fuel efficiency while driving.
But it differs from a conventional
automatic transmission because
it does not incorporate a torque
converter. Instead, the transition from
one gear to the next is managed by
clutch slip, especially at lower speeds.
As a result, shifts are sometimes more
noticeable, and a light vibration can
be felt as the transmission shaft speed
is matched with the engine shaft
speed. This is a normal condition of
the dual clutch transmission.
• The dry-type clutch transfers torque
more directly and provides a directdrive feeling which may feel different
from a conventional automatic
transmission. This may be more
noticeable when launching the vehicle
from a stop or when traveling at low,
stop-and-go vehicle speeds.
• When rapidly accelerating from a
lower vehicle speed, the engine
rpm may increase dramatically as a
result of clutch slip as the dual clutch
transmission selects the correct gear.
This is a normal condition.
6-14
• When accelerating from a stop on
an incline, press the accelerator
smoothly and gradually to avoid any
shudder feeling or jerkiness.
• When traveling at a lower vehicle
speed, if you release the accelerator
pedal quickly, you may feel engine
braking before the transmission
changes gears. This engine braking
feeling is similar to operating a
manual transmission at low speed.
• When driving downhill, you may
wish to move the gear shift lever to
Manual Shift mode and downshift to
a lower gear in order to control your
speed without using the brake pedal
excessively.
• When you turn the vehicle on and off,
you may hear clicking sounds as the
system goes through a self-test. This
is a normal sound for the dual clutch
transmission.
• During the first 1,500 km (1000 miles),
you may feel that the vehicle may not
be smooth when accelerating at low
speed. During this break-in period, the
shift quality and performance of your
new vehicle is continuously optimized.
06
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death:
• ALWAYS check the surrounding
areas near your vehicle for people,
especially children, before shifting a
vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
• Before leaving the driver's seat,
always make sure the shift lever
is in the P (Park) position, then set
the parking brake, and place the
ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur if these
precautions are not followed.
• Do not use the engine brake (shifting
from a high gear to lower gear)
rapidly on slippery roads. The vehicle
may slip causing an accident.
NOTICE
• Always come to a complete stop
before shifting into D (Drive) or R
(Reverse).
• Do not put the shift lever in N
(Neutral) while driving.
WARNING
If the transmission cannot shift into
Drive or Reverse, the position indicator
D or R) on the cluster will blink. We
recommend that you contact an
authorized Hyundai dealer to have the
system checked.
DCT warning messages
This warning message is displayed when
vehicle is driven slowly on a grade and
the vehicle detects that the brake pedal
is not applied.
OOSH069010L
Steep grade
Driving up hills or on steep grades:
• To hold the vehicle on an incline use
the foot brake or the parking brake.
• When in stop-and-go traffic on an
incline, allow a gap to form ahead
of you before moving the vehicle
forward. Then hold the vehicle on the
incline with the foot brake.
• If the vehicle is held on a hill by
applying the accelerator pedal
or by creeping with the brake
pedal disengaged, the clutch and
transmission may overheat which
can result in damage. At this time, a
warning message will appear on the
LCD display.
• If the LCD warning is active, the foot
brake must be applied.
• Ignoring the warnings can lead to
damage to the transmission.
6-15
Driving your vehicle
OOSH069012L
Transmission high temperature
• Under certain conditions, such as
repeated stop-and-go launches
on steep grades, sudden take off
or acceleration, or other harsh
driving conditions, the transmission
clutch temperatures will increase
excessively.
• When the clutch is overheated, the
safe protection mode engages and
the gear position indicator on the
cluster blinks with a chime. At this
time, "Transmission temperature is
high! Stop safely" warning message
will appear on the LCD display and
driving may not be smooth.
• If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes
and shift the vehicle to P (Park) with
engine on, and allow the transmission
to cool.
• If you ignore this warning, the driving
condition may become worse.
You may experience abrupt shifts,
frequent shifts, or jerkiness. To return
to the normal driving condition, stop
the vehicle and apply the foot brake
or shift into P (Park). Then allow the
transmission to cool for a few minutes
with engine on, before driving off.
• When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
6-16
OOSH069007L
OOSH069013L
OOSH069014L
Transmission overheated
• If the vehicle continues to be driven
and the clutch temperatures reach
the maximum temperature limit, the
"Transmission hot! Park with engine
on" warning will be displayed. When
this occurs the clutch is disabled
until the clutch cools to normal
temperatures.
06
• The warning will display a time to wait
for the transmission to cool.
• If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes
and shift the vehicle to P (Park) with
engine on, and allow the transmission
to cool.
• When the message "Transmission
cooled down. Resume driving."
appears you can continue to drive
your vehicle.
• When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
If any of the warning messages in the
LCD display continue to blink, for your
safety, we recommend you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked.
Transmission ranges
The indicator in the instrument cluster
displays the shift lever position when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into P (Park).
To shift from P (Park), you must depress
firmly on the brake pedal and make sure
your foot is off the accelerator pedal.
If you have done all of the above and
still cannot shift the lever out of P
(Park), see "Shift-Lock Release" section
in this chapter.
The shift lever must be in P (Park) before
turning the vehicle off.
WARNING
• Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
• After the vehicle has stopped, always
make sure the shift lever is in P
(Park), apply the parking brake, and
turn the vehicle off.
• Do not use the P (Park) position in
place of the parking brake.
• When parking on an incline, place
the shift lever in P (Park) and apply
the parking brake to prevent the
vehicle from rolling down.
• For safety, always engage the
parking brake with the shift lever in
the P (Park) position except for the
case of emergency parking.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
NOTICE
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into or out of R (Reverse); you
may damage the transmission if you
shift into R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
in motion.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and transmission are not
engaged.
Always depress the brake pedal when
you are shifting from N (Neutral) to
another gear.
WARNING
Do not shift into gear unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into
gear when the engine is running at high
speed can cause the vehicle to move
very rapidly. You could lose control of
the vehicle and hit people or objects.
6-17
Driving your vehicle
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position. The
transmission will automatically shift
through a 6-gear sequence, providing
the best fuel economy and power.
For extra power when passing another
vehicle or driving uphill, depress the
accelerator fully. The transmission will
automatically downshift to the next
lower gear (or gears, as appropriate).
If you drive the vehicle with the shift
lever in D (Drive), the vehicle will
automatically change to ECO mode.
indicator will illuminate on the
The
instrument cluster.
When driving in ECO mode, the vehicle
improves fuel efficiency for eco-friendly
driving.
OOSH069016L
[A] : + (Up), [B}: - (Down)
Manual shift mode
Whether the vehicle is stationary or in
motion, manual shift mode is selected by
pushing the shift lever from the D (Drive)
position into the manual gate. To return
to D (Drive) range operation, push the
shift lever back into the main gate
In manual shift mode, moving the shift
lever backwards and forwards will allow
you to make gearshifts rapidly.
Up (+): Push the lever forward once to
shift up one gear.
Down (-): Pull the lever backwards once
to shift down one gear.
OOSH069015L
SPORT mode
SPORT mode is selected by pushing
the shifter lever from the D (Drive)
position into the manual gate. The
indicator will illuminate on the
instrument cluster.
When driving in SPORT mode, the
vehicle provides sporty but firm riding.
Information
In SPORT mode, the fuel efficiency may
decrease.
6-18
06
Information
• Only the six forward gears can be
selected in Manual Shift Mode. To
reverse or park the vehicle, move the
shift lever to the R (Reverse) or P
(Park) position as required.
• Downshifts are made automatically
when the vehicle slows down. When the
vehicle stops, 1st gear is automatically
selected.
• When the engine rpm approaches the
red zone the transmission will upshift
automatically.
• If the driver presses the lever to + (Up)
or - (Down) position, the transmission
may not make the requested gear
change if the next gear is outside of the
allowable engine rpm range. The driver
must execute upshifts in accordance
with road conditions, taking care to
keep the engine rpms below the red
zone.
• When driving in manual shift mode,
slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. Otherwise, the lower gear may
not be engaged if the engine rpms are
outside of the allowable range.
Shift-lock system
For your safety, the dual clutch
transmission has a shift-lock system
which prevents shifting the transmission
from P (Park) into R (Reverse) unless the
brake pedal is depressed.
To shift the transmission from P (Park)
into R (Reverse):
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the vehicle or place the ignition
switch in the ON position.
3. Move the shift lever.
Shift-lock release
If the shift lever cannot be moved from
the P (Park) position into R (Reverse)
position with the brake pedal depressed,
continue depressing the brake, and then
do the following:
OOSH069017L
1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Carefully remove the cap (1) covering
the shift-lock access hole.
4. Insert a tool (e.g. flathead screwdriver)
into the access hole and press down
on the tool.
5. Move the shift lever while holding
down the screwdriver.
6. Remove the tool from the shift-lock
release access hole then install the
cap.
If you need to use the shift-lock release,
we recommend that the system be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer immediately.
Ignition key interlock system
(if equipped)
The ignition key cannot be removed
unless the shift lever is in the P (Park)
position.
6-19
Driving your vehicle
Paddle shifter (if equipped)
Parking
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Move the shift lever into the P (Park)
position, apply the parking brake, and
place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position. Take the Key with you
when exiting the vehicle.
WARNING
OOSH069018L
The paddle shifter is functional when the
shift lever is in the D (Drive) or S (Sport)
position, or the manual shift mode.
The paddle shifter will operate when the
vehicle speed is more than 5 km/h (3
mph).
Pull the [+] or [-] paddle shifter once
to shift up or down one gear and the
system changes from automatic mode to
manual mode.
• The system changes from manual
mode to automatic mode when
-- the vehicle speed is lower than 5
km/h (3 mph),
-- you depress the accelerator pedal
for more than 5 seconds,
-- you pull the [+] paddle shifter for
more than 1 second, or
-- you move the shift lever from D
(Drive) to S (Sport) or manual shift
mode (+, -) and then back to D
(Drive).
Information
If the [+] and [-] paddle shifters are pulled
at the same time, gear shift may not occur.
6-20
When you stay in the vehicle with
the engine running, be careful not to
depress the accelerator pedal for a long
period of time. The engine or exhaust
system may overheat and start a fire.
The exhaust gas and the exhaust system
are very hot. Keep away from the
exhaust system components.
Do not stop or park over flammable
materials, such as dry grass, paper or
leaves. They may ignite and cause a fire.
06
Good driving practices
• Never move the shift lever from P
(Park) or N (Neutral) to any other
position with the accelerator pedal
depressed.
• Never move the shift lever into P
(Park) when the vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
• Do not move the shift lever to N
(Neutral) when driving. If the shift
lever is moved to N (Neutral) while
driving, the vehicle loses the ability to
provide engine braking. Doing so may
increase the risk of an accident.
Also, moving the shift lever back
to D (Drive) while the vehicle is
moving may severely damage the
transmission.
• Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can result
in the brakes overheating, brake wear
and possibly even brake failure.
• Always apply the parking brake when
leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on
placing the transmission in P (Park) to
keep the vehicle from moving.
• Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident
• Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
• Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
• Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
• The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
• Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
• In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
• HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
6-21
Driving your vehicle
COASTING GUIDE (IF EQUIPPED)
Operation conditions
OOSH069019L
The coasting guide function informs the
driver when to take the foot off from the
accelerator by anticipating a decelerating
event* based on the analysis of driving
routes and road conditions of the
navigation. It encourages the driver to
remove foot from the pedal and allow
coasting down the road with EV motor
only. This helps prevent unnecessary
fuel consumption and increases fuel
efficiency.
Information
Example of a deceleration event is making
a right/left turn, driving through a rotary,
entering or exiting a highway (freeway),
etc.
Setting Coasting Guide function
Coasting Guide can be selected from
the User Settings mode in the cluster
LCD display by following the procedure
below.
1. Set the ignition switch in the ON
position.
2. Select ‘User settings → Convenience →
Coasting guidance’ in the cluster LCD
display.
6-22
After selecting the function from the
User Settings mode, the system enters
the ready status by following the
procedure below.
1. Enter your destination information in
the navigation system and select the
driving route.
2. Check that the vehicle is in ECO mode
by driving the vehicle in D (Drive).
3. Drive the vehicle between 40 km/h
(25 mph) ~ 160 km/h (100 mph).
Information
The operating speed may vary due to
difference between instrument cluster and
navigation effected by tire inflation level.
Information
Coasting guide is only a supplemental
function to assist with fuel-efficient
driving. Thus, the operating conditions
may be different in accordance with
traffic/road conditions (i.e. driving in a
traffic jam, driving on a slope, driving
on a curve). Take the actual driving
conditions into consideration, such as
distances from the vehicles ahead/behind,
while referring to the coasting guide
function as guidance.
06
BRAKING SYSTEM
Power brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes
that adjust automatically through normal
usage.
If the vehicle is not in the ready ( )
mode or the vehicle is turned off while
driving, the power assist for the brakes
will not work. You can still stop your
vehicle by applying greater force to the
brake pedal than typical. The stopping
distance, however, will be longer than
with power brakes.
When the vehicle is not in the ready
( ) mode, the reserve brake power is
partially depleted each time the brake
pedal is applied. Do not pump the brake
pedal when the power assist has been
interrupted.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. This will create
abnormal high brake temperatures,
excessive brake lining and pad wear,
and increased stopping distances.
• When descending down a long or
steep hill, move the shift lever to
Manual Shift mode and manually
downshift to a lower gear in order
to control your speed without using
the brake pedal excessively. Applying
the brakes continuously will cause
the brakes to overheat and could
result in a temporary loss of braking
performance.
• Wet brakes may impair the vehicle's
ability to safely slow down; the
vehicle may also pull to one side
when the brakes are applied.
Applying the brakes lightly will
indicate whether they have been
affected in this way. Always test your
brakes in this fashion after driving
through deep water. To dry the
brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to
heat up the brakes while maintaining
a safe forward speed until brake
performance returns to normal.
Avoid driving at high speeds until the
brakes function correctly.
NOTICE
• Do not continue depressing the
brake pedal if the " " indicator is
OFF. The battery may be discharged.
• Noise and vibration generated
during braking is normal.
• Under normal operation, electric
brake pump noise and motor
vibration may occur temporarily in
below cases.
-- When the pedal is depressed
suddenly.
-- When the pedal is repeatedly
depressed in short intervals.
-- When the ABS function is activated
while braking.
6-23
Driving your vehicle
Disc brakes wear indicator
When your brake pads are worn and new
pads are required, you will hear a high
pitched warning sound from your front
or rear brakes. You may hear this sound
come and go or it may occur whenever
you depress the brake pedal.
Note that some driving conditions or
climates may cause a brake squeal
when you first apply (or lightly apply)
the brakes. This is normal and does not
indicate a problem with your brakes.
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do not
continue to drive with worn brake pads.
Information
Always replace brake pads as complete
front or rear axle sets.
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
Applying the parking brake
OOSH069020L
To apply EPB (Electronic Parking Brake):
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Pull up the EPB switch.
Make sure the Parking Brake Warning
Light comes on.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH, do not operate the EPB
while the vehicle is moving except
in an emergency situation. It could
damage the brake system and lead to
an accident.
6-24
06
Releasing the parking brake
OOSH069022L
To release EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake):
• Place the ignition switch in the ON
position.
• Depress the brake pedal.
• Press the EPB switch.
Make sure the Parking Brake Warning
Light goes off.
To release EPB (Electronic Parking Brake)
automatically:
• Shift lever in P (Park)
With the vehicle in the ready ( )
mode, depress the brake pedal and
shift out of P (Park) to R (Reverse) or
D (Drive).
• Shift lever in N (Neutral)
With the vehicle in the ready ( )
mode, depress the brake pedal and
shift out of N (Neutral) to R (Reverse)
or D (Drive).
• Satisfy the following conditions
1. Ensure seat belts are fastened and the
doors, hood and tailgate are closed.
2. With the vehicle in the ready ( )
mode, depress the brake pedal and
shift out of P (Park) to R (Reverse), D
(Drive) or Manual shift mode.
3. Depress the accelerator pedal.
Make sure the Parking Brake Warning
Light goes off.
Information
• For your safety, you can engage EPB
even though the ignition switch is in the
OFF position (only if battery power is
available), but you cannot release it.
• For your safety, depress the brake
pedal and release the parking brake
manually with the EPB switch when
you drive downhill or when backing up
the vehicle.
NOTICE
• If the parking brake warning light
is still on even though the EPB has
been released, we recommend that
you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not drive your vehicle with EPB
applied. It may cause excessive brake
pad and brake rotor wear.
EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) may be
automatically applied when:
• Requested by other systems
• The driver turns the vehicle off while
Auto Hold is operating.
6-25
Driving your vehicle
Warning messages
• NEVER allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch
the EPB switch. If EPB is released
unintentionally, serious injury may
occur.
• Only release EPB when you are
seated inside the vehicle with your
foot firmly on the brake pedal.
NOTICE
OOSH069023L
To release EPB, close the doors, hood and
tailgate and fasten seatbelt
• If you try to drive with EPB applied, a
warning will sound and a message will
appear.
• If the driver's seat belt is unfastened
and the engine hood or tailgate is
opened, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
• If there is a problem with the vehicle,
a warning may sound and a message
may appear.
If the situation occurs, depress the brake
pedal and release EPB by pressing the
EPB switch.
WARNING
• Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the
brake pedal.
Move the shift lever into the P (Park)
position, press the EPB switch, and
set the ignition switch to the OFF
position. Take the Key with you when
exiting the vehicle.
Vehicles not fully engaged in P (Park)
with the parking brake set are at risk
for moving inadvertently and causing
injury to yourself or others.
6-26
• Do not apply the accelerator pedal
while the parking brake is engaged.
If you depress the accelerator pedal
with EPB engaged, a warning will
sound and a message will appear.
Damage to the parking brake may
occur.
• Driving with the parking brake on
can overheat the braking system and
cause premature wear or damage
to brake parts. Make sure EPB is
released and the Parking Brake
Warning Light is off before driving.
Information
• A clicking sound may be heard while
operating or releasing the EPB. These
conditions are normal and indicate that
EPB is functioning properly.
• When leaving your keys with a parking
attendant or assistant, make sure to
inform him/her how to operate EPB.
06
EPB malfunction indicator
Type A
OOSH069024L
Deactivating AUTO HOLD...
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold to
EPB is not working properly a warning
will sound and a message will appear.
Type A
Type B
OOSH069025L
OOSH069026L
Type B
OOSH069027L
OOSH069028L
This warning light illuminates if the
ignition switch is set to the ON position
and goes off in approximately 3 seconds
if the system is operating normally.
If the EPB malfunction indicator remains
on, comes on while driving, or does not
come on when the ignition switch is set
to the ON position, this indicates that the
EPB may have malfunctioned.
If this occurs, we recommend that
you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The EPB malfunction indicator may
illuminate when the ESC indicator comes
on to indicate that ESC is not working
properly, but it does not indicate a
malfunction of EPB.
Parking brake automatically applied
If EPB is applied while Auto Hold is
activated, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
6-27
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
• If the EPB warning light is still on,
we recommend that you have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the parking brake warning light
does not illuminate or blinks even
though the EPB switch was pulled
up, EPB may not be applied.
• If the parking brake warning light
blinks when the EPB warning light is
on, press the switch, and then pull
it up. Repeat this one more time.
If the EPB warning does not go off,
we recommend that you have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Parking brake warning light
Check the Parking Brake
Warning Light by setting the
ignition switch to the ON
indicator off).
position (
This light will be illuminated when the
parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the START or ON position.
Before driving, be sure the parking brake
is released and the Brake Warning Light
is OFF.
If the Parking Brake Warning Light
remains on after the parking brake is
released while the vehicle is in the ready
( ) mode, there may be a malfunction
in the brake system. Immediate attention
is necessary.
If at all possible, cease driving the vehicle
immediately. If that is not possible,
use extreme caution while operating
the vehicle and only continue to drive
the vehicle until you can reach a safe
location.
6-28
Emergency braking
If there is a problem with the brake
pedal while driving, emergency braking
is possible by pulling up and holding
the EPB switch. Braking is possible only
while you are holding the EPB switch.
However, braking distance will be longer
than normal.
WARNING
Do not operate the parking brake while
the vehicle is moving except in an
emergency situation. It could damage
the brake system and lead to a severe
accident.
Information
During emergency braking, the parking
brake warning light will illuminate to
indicate that the system is operating.
NOTICE
If you continuously notice a noise or
burning smell when the EPB is used for
emergency braking, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When the EPB (Electronic Parking Brake)
does not release
If the EPB does not release normally,
we recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer by loading
the vehicle on a flatbed tow truck and
have the system checked.
06
Auto Hold
The Auto Hold maintains the vehicle in a
standstill even though the brake pedal is
not depressed after the driver brings the
vehicle to a complete stop by depressing
the brake pedal.
To apply:
OOSH069030L
OOSH069029L
1. With the driver's door and engine
hood closed, depress the brake
pedal and then press the [AUTO
HOLD] switch. The white AUTO HOLD
indicator will come on and the system
will be in the standby position.
2. When you stop the vehicle
completely by depressing the brake
pedal, the Auto Hold maintains the
brake pressure to hold the vehicle
stationary. The indicator changes from
white to green.
3. The vehicle will remain stationary
even if you release the brake pedal.
4. If EPB is applied, Auto Hold will be
released.
To release:
• If you depress the accelerator pedal
with the shift lever in D (Drive) or
Manual shift mode, the Auto Hold will
be released automatically and the
vehicle will start to move. The AUTO
HOLD indicator changes from green
to white.
• If the vehicle is restarted using the
cruise control toggle switch (RES+
or SET-) while Auto Hold and cruise
control is operating, the Auto Hold will
be released regardless of accelerator
pedal operation. The AUTO HOLD
indicator changes from green to
white.
6-29
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Information
When the AUTO HOLD is automatically
released by depressing the accelerator
pedal, always take a look around your
vehicle.
Slowly depress the accelerator pedal
for a smooth start.
To cancel:
OOSH069031L
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch.
The AUTO HOLD indicator will turn off.
WARNING
To prevent, unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement, ALWAYS press your
foot on the brake pedal to cancel the
Auto Hold before you:
-- Drive downhill.
-- Drive the vehicle in R (Reverse).
-- Park the vehicle.
6-30
• The Auto Hold does not operate when:
-- The driver's door is opened
-- The engine hood is opened
-- The shift lever is in P (Park) or R
(Reverse)
-- EPB is applied
• For your safety, the Auto Hold
automatically switches to EPB when:
-- The driver's door is opened
-- The engine hood is opened
-- The vehicle is in a standstill for more
than 10 minutes
-- The vehicle is standing on a steep
slope
-- The vehicle moved several times
In these cases, the parking brake
warning light comes on, the AUTO
HOLD indicator changes from green
to white, and a warning sound and a
message will appear to inform you that
EPB has been automatically engaged.
Before driving off again, depress the
brake pedal, check the surrounding
area near your vehicle and release the
parking brake manually with the EPB
switch.
• While operating Auto Hold, you may
hear mechanical noise. However, it is
normal operating noise.
NOTICE
If the AUTO HOLD indicator changes
to yellow, the Auto Hold is not working
properly. We recommend that you
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
06
WARNING
• Depress the accelerator pedal slowly
when you start the vehicle.
• For your safety, cancel the Auto Hold
when you drive downhill, back up the
vehicle or park the vehicle.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
driver's door or engine hood open
detection system, the Auto Hold may
not work properly.
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Warning messages
Type A
Type B
OOSH069025L
OOSH069024L
Deactivating AUTO HOLD...
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold to
EPB is not working properly a warning
will sound and a message will appear.
When this message is displayed, the Auto
Hold and EPB may not operate. For your
safety, depress the brake pedal.
OOSH069026L
Parking brake automatically applied
When the EPB is applied from Auto Hold,
a warning will sound and a message will
appear.
OOSH069032L
Press brake pedal to deactivate AUTO
HOLD
If you did not apply the brake pedal when
you release the Auto Hold by pressing
the [AUTO HOLD] switch, a warning will
sound and a message will appear.
6-31
Driving your vehicle
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
OOSH069033L
AUTO HOLD conditions not met.
Close door and hood.
When you press the [AUTO HOLD]
switch, if the driver's door and engine
hood are not closed, a warning will
sound and a message will appear on the
cluster LCD display.
Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch after
closing the driver's door and hood.
An Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) or
an Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system will not prevent accidents
due to improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle
control is improved during emergency
braking, always maintain a safe
distance between you and objects
ahead of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during extreme
road conditions. The braking distance
for vehicles equipped with ABS or ESC
may be longer than for those without
these systems in the following road
conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced speeds
during the following conditions:
• Rough, gravel or snow-covered
roads.
• On roads where the road surface is
pitted or has different surface height.
• Tire chains are installed on your
vehicle.
The safety features of an ABS or ESC
equipped vehicle should not be tested
by high speed driving or cornering. This
could endanger the safety of yourself or
others.
ABS is an electronic braking system that
helps prevent a braking skid. ABS allows
the driver to steer and brake at the same
time.
6-32
06
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your brake
pressure and do not try to pump your
brakes. Depress your brake pedal as hard
as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your ABS is active.
ABS does not reduce the time or distance
it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that results
from sudden changes in direction, such
as trying to take a corner too fast or
making a sudden lane change. Always
drive at a safe speed for the road and
weather conditions.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability.
Always steer moderately when braking
hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel
movement can still cause your vehicle to
veer into oncoming traffic or off the road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system
may result in a longer stopping distance
than for vehicles equipped with a
conventional brake system.
) will stay on
The ABS warning light (
for several seconds after the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
During that time, the ABS will go through
self-diagnosis and the light will go off
if everything is normal. If the light stays
on, you may have a problem with your
ABS. We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
WARNING
If the ABS warning light (
) is on and
stays on, you may have a problem with
the ABS. Your power brakes will work
normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, contact your HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
When you drive on a road having poor
traction, such as an icy road, and apply
your brakes continuously, the ABS will
be active continuously and the ABS
) may illuminate. Pull
warning light (
your vehicle over to a safe place and
turn the vehicle off.
Restart the vehicle. If the ABS warning
light is off, then your ABS system is
normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem
with your ABS system. We recommend
that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
6-33
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Information
When you jump start your vehicle because
of a drained battery, the ABS warning
) may turn on at the same
light (
time. This happens because of the low
battery voltage. It does not mean your
ABS is malfunctioning. Have the battery
recharged before driving the vehicle.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions when cornering. The ESC
system will not prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns, abrupt
maneuvers, and hydroplaning on wet
surfaces can result in severe accidents.
ESC operation
ESC ON condition
When the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds. After both
lights go off, the ESC is enabled.
When operating
When the ESC is in operation,
the ESC indicator light blinks:
OOSH069034L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system helps to stabilize the vehicle
during cornering maneuvers.
ESC checks where you are steering and
where the vehicle is actually going. ESC
applies braking pressure to any one of
the vehicle's brakes and intervenes in the
engine management system to assist the
driver with keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. It is not a substitute for
safe driving practices. Always adjust your
speed and driving to the road conditions.
6-34
• When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in
the brake pedal. This is normal and it
means your ESC is active.
• When the ESC activates, the engine
may not respond to the accelerator as
it does under routine conditions.
• If the Cruise Control was in use when
the ESC activates, the Cruise Control
automatically disengages. The Cruise
Control can be reengaged when the
road conditions allow. See “Cruise
Control System” later in this chapter
(if equipped).
06
• When moving out of the mud or
driving on a slippery road, the engine
rpm (revolutions per minute) may
not increase even if you press the
accelerator pedal deeply. This is to
maintain the stability and traction of
the vehicle and does not indicate a
problem.
Indicator lights
■ ESC indicator light (blinks)
■ ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation:
• State 1
Press the ESC OFF button briefly.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message “Traction Control disabled”
will illuminate. In this state, the traction
control function of ESC (engine
management) is disabled, but the
brake control function of ESC (braking
management) still operates.
• State 2
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds.
The ESC OFF indicator light and/or
message “Traction & Stability Control
disabled” illuminates and a warning
chime sounds. In this state, both the
traction control function of ESC (engine
management) and the brake control
function of ESC (braking management)
are disabled.
If the ignition switch is placed in the
LOCK/OFF position when ESC is off, ESC
remains off. Upon restarting the vehicle,
ESC will automatically turn on again.
When the ignition switch is set to the
ON position, the ESC indicator light
illuminates, then goes off if the ESC
system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever
the ESC is operating.
If the ESC indicator light stays on, your
vehicle may have a malfunction with
the ESC system. When this warning light
illuminates we recommend that the
vehicle be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes on
when ESC is turned off.
WARNING
When ESC is blinking, this indicates the
ESC is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt to
accelerate. NEVER turn the ESC off
while the ESC indicator light is blinking
or you may lose control of the vehicle
resulting in an accident.
6-35
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before replacing
tires, make sure all four tires and wheels
are the same size. Never drive the
vehicle with different sized wheels and
tires installed.
ESC OFF usage
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be used
briefly to help free the vehicle if stuck in
snow or mud, by temporarily stopping
operation of ESC, to maintain wheel
torque.
To turn ESC off while driving, press the
ESC OFF button while driving on a flat
road surface.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the transmission:
• Do not allow wheel(s) of one axle to
spin excessively while the ESC, ABS,
and parking brake warning lights
are displayed. The repairs would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce engine power and do not
spin the wheel(s) excessively while
these lights are displayed.
• When operating the vehicle on
a dynamometer, make sure the
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
Information
Turning the ESC off does not affect ABS
or standard brake system operation.
6-36
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM)
The Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)
is a function of the Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system. It helps the vehicle
stay stable when accelerating or braking
suddenly on wet, slippery and rough
roads where traction over the four tires
can suddenly become uneven.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM):
• ALWAYS check the speed and the
distance to the vehicle ahead. The
VSM is not a substitute for safe
driving practices.
• Never drive too fast for the road
conditions. The VSM system will not
prevent accidents. Excessive speed
in bad weather, on slippery and
uneven roads can result in severe
accidents.
06
VSM operation
VSM ON condition
The VSM operates when:
• The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
is on.
• Vehicle speed is approximately above
15 km/h (9 mph) on curve roads.
• Vehicle speed is approximately above
20 km/h (12 mph) when the vehicle is
braking on rough roads.
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate the ESC,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your VSM is active.
Information
The VSM does not operate when:
• Driving on a banked road such as
gradient or incline.
• Driving in reverse.
• The ESC OFF indicator light is on.
• The EPS (Electric power steering)
warning light ( ) is on or blinks.
VSM OFF condition
To cancel VSM operation, press the ESC
OFF button. ESC OFF indicator light ( )
will illuminate.
To turn on VSM, press the ESC OFF
button again. The ESC OFF indicator light
will go out.
WARNING
If the ESC indicator light ( ) or EPS
warning light ( ) stays illuminated
or blinks, your vehicle may have a
malfunction with the VSM system.
When the warning light illuminates
we recommend that the vehicle be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the VSM
system to malfunction. Before replacing
tires, make sure all four tires and wheels
are the same size. Never drive the
vehicle with different sized tires and
wheels installed.
6-37
Driving your vehicle
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
The Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
helps prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards when starting a vehicle from
a stop on a hill. The system operates the
brakes automatically for approximately
5 seconds and releases the brake after 5
seconds or when the accelerator pedal is
depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting off
an incline. The HAC activates only for
approximately 5 seconds.
Information
• HAC does not operate when the shift
lever is in P (Park) or N (Neutral).
• HAC activates even when the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) is off.
However, it does not activate, when
ESC does not operate normally.
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS)
(if equipped)
The Emergency Stop Signal system
alerts the driver behind by blinking the
stop lights, while sharply and severely
braking.
The system is activated when:
• The vehicle suddenly stops. (The
deceleration power exceeds 7 m/
s2, and the driving speed exceeds 55
km/h (34 mph).)
• The ABS is activated.
The hazard warning flasher automatically
turns ON after blinking the stop lights:
• When the driving speed is under 40
km/h (25 mph),
• When the ABS is deactivated, and
• When the sudden braking situation is
over.
The hazard warning flasher turns OFF:
• When the vehicle drives at a low
speed for a certain period of time.
The driver can manually turn OFF the
hazard warning flasher by pressing the
button.
Information
The Emergency Stop Signal (ESS) system
will not activate, when the hazard warning
flashers are already on.
6-38
06
Good braking practices
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the brake
pedal. Move the shift lever into the P
(Park) position, then apply the parking
brake, and set the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF position.
Vehicles parked with the parking brake
not applied or not fully engaged may
roll inadvertently and may cause injury
to the driver and others. ALWAYS apply
the parking brake before exiting the
vehicle.
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it
is washed. Your vehicle will not stop as
quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet brakes
may cause the vehicle to pull to one side.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns to
normal. If the braking action does not
return to normal, stop as soon as it is safe
to do so and we recommend that you
call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting on
the brake pedal. Even light, but constant
pedal pressure can result in the brakes
overheating, brake wear, and possibly
even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving,
apply the brakes gently and keep the
vehicle pointed straight ahead while you
slow down. When you are moving slowly
enough for it to be safe to do so, pull off
the road and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal
when the vehicle is stopped to prevent
the vehicle from rolling forward.
6-39
Driving your vehicle
FORWARD COLLISION – AVOIDANCE ASSIST (FCA) SYSTEM SENSOR FUSION TYPE (FRONT RADAR + FRONT CAMERA)
(IF EQUIPPED)
The Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA) system is designed to help detect
and monitor the vehicle ahead or detect
a pedestrian or cyclists (if equipped)
in the roadway through radar signals
and camera recognition to warn the
driver that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
System setting and activation
System setting
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system:
• This system is only a supplemental
system and it is not intended to,
nor does it replace the need for
extreme care and attention of
the driver. The sensing range and
objects detectable by the sensors
are limited. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
• Drive at posted speed limits and
accordance to road conditions.
• Always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. FCA does not stop
the vehicle completely and is not a
collision avoidance system.
6-40
OOSH069035L
• Setting Forward Safety function
The driver can activate the FCA by
placing the ignition switch to the ON
position and by selecting:
‘User settings → Driver assistance →
Forward safety’
-- If you select ‘Active assist’, the FCA
system activates. FCA produces
warning messages and warning
alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. Braking assist
will be applied in accordance with
the collision risk.
-- If you select ‘Warning only’, the FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. Braking
assist will not be applied in this
setting.
-- If you select ‘Off’, the FCA system
deactivates.
06
The warning light illuminates
on the instrument cluster,
when you cancel the FCA
system.
The driver can monitor the FCA ON/
OFF status on the LCD display. Also,
the warning light illuminates when ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) is turned
off. If the warning light remains ON
when FCA is activated, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
•
OOSH069036L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting ‘User settings →
Driver assistance → Warning timing →
Normal/Later’.
The options for the initial Forward
Collision Warning includes the following:
-- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Forward Collision Warning is
activated sensitively. If you feel the
warning activates too early, set the
Forward Collision Warning to ‘Later’.
Even though, ‘Normal’ is selected if
the front vehicle suddenly stops the
initial warning activation time may not
seem fast.
-- Later:
When this option is selected, the initial
Forward Collision Warning is activated
later than normal. This setting reduces
the amount of distance between
the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist (if
equipped) ahead before the initial
warning occurs.
Select ‘Later’ when traffic is light and
when driving speed is slow.
When you accelerate suddenly to the
vehicle ahead, the warning may seem
to activate earlier even if ‘Later’ is
selected.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning timing of other systems may
change.
6-41
Driving your vehicle
Prerequisite for activation
FCA gets ready to be activated, when
‘Active assist’ or ‘Warning only’ under
Forward Safety is selected in the cluster
LCD display, and when the following
prerequisites are satisfied.
-- ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is on.
-- Vehicle speed is over 10km/h (6mph).
(The FCA is only activated within a
certain speed range.)
-- The system detects a pedestrian,
cyclist (if equipped) or a vehicle in
front, which may collide with your
vehicle. However, FCA may not be
activated or may only sound a warning
alarm depending on the driving or
vehicle conditions.
FCA may not operate properly according
to the frontal situation, the direction of
pedestrian or cyclist (if equipped) and
speed.
WARNING
• To avoid driver distractions, do not
attempt to set or cancel the FCA
while driving the vehicle. Always
completely stop the vehicle at a safe
place before setting or canceling the
system.
• The FCA automatically activates
upon placing the ignition switch
to the ON position. The driver can
deactivate the FCA by canceling the
system setting on the cluster LCD
display.
• The FCA automatically deactivates
upon canceling ESC (Electronic
Stability Control). When ESC is
canceled, FCA cannot be activated
in the LCD display. In this situation,
the FCA warning light will illuminate
which is normal.
6-42
FCA warning message and brake
control
FCA produces warning messages,
warning alarms, and emergency braking
based on the level of risk of a frontal
collision, such as when a vehicle ahead
suddenly brakes, or the system detects
that a collision with a pedestrian or
cyclist (if equipped) is imminent.
Collision warning (First warning)
OOSH069037L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the engine
management system to help decelerate
the vehicle.
06
• Your vehicle speed may decelerate
moderately.
• If FCA detects a vehicle in front, the
system operates when your vehicle
speed is between 10 km/h (6 mph)
and 180 km/h (110 mph). Maximum
vehicle speed may decrease
depending on the condition of the
vehicle ahead and surroundings.
• If FCA detects a pedestrian or cyclist
in front, the system operates when
your vehicle speed is between 10
km/h (6 mph) and 65 km/h (40
mph). Maximum vehicle speed may
decrease depending on the condition
of the pedestrian or cyclist ahead and
surroundings.
• If you select ‘Warning only’ for the
system setting, the FCA system
activates and produces only warning
alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. You should control
the brake directly because the FCA
system will not control the brake.
Emergency braking (Second
warning)
OOSH069038L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the engine
management system to help decelerate
the vehicle.
• The FCA system limitedly controls
the brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision. The brake control
is maximized just before a collision.
• If FCA detects a vehicle in front, the
system operates when your vehicle
speed is above 10 km/h (6 mph) and
80 km/h (50 mph) or under. Maximum
vehicle speed may decrease
depending on the condition of the
vehicle ahead and surroundings.
6-43
Driving your vehicle
• If FCA detects a pedestrian or cyclist
in front, the system operates when
your vehicle speed is between 10
km/h (6 mph) or above and under 65
km/h (40 mph). Maximum vehicle
speed may decrease depending on
the condition of the pedestrian or
cyclist ahead and surroundings.
• If you select ‘Warning only’ for the
system setting, the FCA system
activates and produces only warning
alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. You should control
the brake directly because the FCA
system will not control the brake.
Brake operation
• In an urgent situation, the braking
system enters into the ready status for
prompt reaction against the driver’s
depressing the brake pedal.
• The FCA provides additional
braking power for optimum braking
performance, when the driver
depresses the brake pedal.
• The braking control is automatically
deactivated, when the driver sharply
depresses the accelerator pedal, or
when the driver abruptly operates the
steering wheel.
• The FCA brake control is automatically
canceled, when risk factors disappear.
6-44
CAUTION
• The driver should always use
extreme caution while operating
the vehicle, whether or not there is a
warning message or alarm from the
FCA system.
• After the brake control is activated,
the driver must immediately depress
the brake pedal and check the
surroundings. The brake activation
by the system lasts for about 2
seconds.
• If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, the Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system
warning may not sound.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system warning
sounds.
06
WARNING
The braking control cannot completely
stop the vehicle nor avoid all
collisions. The driver should hold the
responsibility to safely drive and control
the vehicle.
FCA sensor
Front radar
WARNING
The FCA system logic operates within
certain parameters, such as the
distance from the vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist (if equipped) ahead, the speed
of the vehicle ahead, and the driver’s
vehicle speed. Certain conditions
such as inclement weather and road
conditions may affect the operation of
the FCA system.
OOSH069039L
Front camera
WARNING
Never deliberately drive dangerously to
activate the system.
OOSH069040L
In order for the FCA system to operate
properly, always make sure the sensor
cover or sensor is clean and free of dirt,
snow, and debris.
Dirt, snow, or foreign substances on the
sensor cover or sensor may adversely
affect the sensing performance of the
sensor.
6-45
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
• Do not apply license plate frame or
foreign objects such as a bumper
sticker or a bumper guard near the
radar sensor. Doing so may adversely
affect the sensing performance of
the radar.
• Always keep the radar sensor and
cover clean and free of dirt and
debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized
water directly on the sensor or
sensor cover.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the FCA
system may not operate correctly.
In this case, a warning message may
not be displayed. We recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around the
radar sensor, the FCA system may not
operate properly. We recommend
that you have the vehicle inspected
by authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine parts to repair or
replace a damaged sensor or sensor
cover. Do not apply paint to the
sensor cover.
6-46
NOTICE
• NEVER install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, or
tint the front windshield.
• NEVER place any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection may
prevent the system from functioning
properly.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera dry.
• NEVER disassemble the camera
assembly, or apply any impact on the
camera assembly.
Information
We recommend that you have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer when:
• The windshield glass is replaced.
• The radar sensor or cover gets
damaged or replaced.
06
Warning message and warning light
OOSH069041L
FCA disabled (Forward Collision
Avoidance Assist). Radar blocked
When the sensor cover is blocked with
dirt, snow, or debris, the FCA system may
not detect other vehicles. If this occurs, a
warning message will appear on the LCD
display.
The system will operate normally when
such dirt, snow or debris is removed.
FCA may not properly operate in an area
(e.g. open terrain), where any substances
are not detected after turning ON the
vehicle.
Also, even though a warning message
does not appear on the LCD display, FCA
may not properly operate.
WARNING
System malfunction
OOSH069042L
Check FCA (Forward Collision Avoidance
Asst.)
• When FCA is not working properly,
FCA warning light ( ) will illuminate
and the warning message will appear
for a few seconds. After the message
disappears, the master warning light
( ) will illuminate. In this case, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• The FCA warning message may
appear along with the illumination of
the ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
warning light. Both FCA warning light
and warning message will disappear
once the ESC warning light issue is
resolved.
The FCA system may not activate
according to the road conditions,
inclement weather, driving conditions
or traffic conditions.
6-47
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• FCA is only a supplemental system
for the driver's convenience. The
driver should hold the responsibility
to control the vehicle operation. Do
not solely depend on the FCA system.
Rather, maintain a safe braking
distance, and, if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce the driving
speed or to stop the vehicle.
• In certain instances and under
certain driving conditions, the FCA
system may activate unintentionally.
This initial warning message appears
on the LCD display with a warning
chime.
Also due to sensing limitations, in
certain situations, the front radar
sensor or camera recognition
system may not detect the vehicle,
pedestrian or cyclist (if equipped)
ahead. The FCA system may not
activate and the warning message
may not be displayed.
• Even if there is any problem with the
brake control function of the FCA
system, the vehicle’s basic braking
performance will operate normally.
However, brake control function for
avoiding collision will not activate.
6-48
• If the vehicle in front stops suddenly,
you may have less control of the
brake system. Therefore, always keep
a safe distance between your vehicle
and the vehicle in front of you.
• The FCA system may activate during
braking and the vehicle may stop
suddenly shifting loose objects
toward the passengers. Always keep
loose objects secured.
• The FCA system may not activate if
the driver applies the brake pedal to
avoid collision.
• The brake control may be
insufficient, possibly causing a
collision, if a vehicle in front abruptly
stops. Always pay extreme caution.
• Occupants may get injured, if
the vehicle abruptly stops by the
activated FCA system. Pay extreme
caution.
• The FCA system operates only
when the system detect vehicles,
pedestrian or cyclist (if equipped) in
front of the vehicle.
06
WARNING
• The FCA system does not operate
when the vehicle is in reverse.
• The FCA system is not designed to
detect other objects on the road
such as animals.
• The FCA system does not detect
vehicles in the opposite lane.
• The FCA system does not detect
cross traffic vehicles that are
approaching.
• The FCA system cannot detect
vehicles that are stopped vertically
to your vehicle at a intersection or
dead end street.
• The FCA system cannot detect
the cross traffic cyclist that are
approaching.
In these cases, you must maintain a
safe braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce the
driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance or to stop the vehicle.
Limitations of the system
The Forward Collision avoidance assist
(FCA) system is designed to monitor the
vehicle ahead or a pedestrian or cyclist (if
equipped) in the roadway through radar
signals and camera recognition to warn
the driver that a collision is imminent,
and if necessary, apply emergency
braking.
In certain situations, the radar sensor or
the camera may not be able to detect
the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist (if
equipped) ahead. In these cases, the
FCA system may not operate normally.
The driver must pay careful attention in
the following situations where the FCA
operation may be limited.
Detecting vehicles
The sensor may be limited when:
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the vehicle is started or
the camera is initialized
• The radar sensor or camera is covered
with a foreign object or debris
• The camera lens is contaminated due
to tinted, filmed or coated windshield,
damaged glass, or stuck of foreign
matter (sticker, bug, etc.) on the glass
• Inclement weather such as heavy rain
or snow obscures the field of view of
the radar sensor or camera
• There is interference by
electromagnetic waves
• There is severe irregular reflection
from the radar sensor
• The radar/camera sensor recognition
is limited
• The vehicle in front is too small to be
detected (for example a motorcycle
etc.)
• The vehicle in front is an oversize
vehicle or trailer that is too big to be
detected by the camera recognition
system (for example a tractor trailer,
etc.)
• The camera’s field of view is not well
illuminated (either too dark or too
much reflection or too much backlight
that obscures the field of view)
• The vehicle in front does not have
their rear lights or their rear lights
does not turned ON or their rear lights
are located unusually
• The outside brightness changes
suddenly, for example when entering
or exiting a tunnel
• Light coming from a street light or an
oncoming vehicle is reflected on a wet
road surface such as a puddle in the
road
6-49
Driving your vehicle
• The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare or head light of oncoming
vehicle
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
• The vehicle in front is driving
erratically
• The vehicle is on unpaved or uneven
rough surfaces, or road with sudden
gradient changes
• The vehicle is driven near areas
containing metal substances as a
construction zone, railroad, etc.
• The vehicle drives inside a building,
such as a basement parking lot
• The camera does not recognize the
entire vehicle in front
• The camera is damaged
• The brightness outside is too low such
as when the headlamps are not on at
night or the vehicle is going through
a tunnel
• The shadow is on the road by a
median strip, trees, etc.
6-50
• The vehicle drives through a tollgate
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
• The rear part of the vehicle in front is
not normally visible (the vehicle turns
in other direction or the vehicle is
overturned.)
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a speed
bump
• The vehicle in front is moving
vertically to the driving direction
• The vehicle in front is stopped
vertically
• The vehicle in front is driving towards
your vehicle or reversing
• You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front circles
06
OOSH069043L
• Driving on a curve
The performance of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may be
limited when driving on a curved road.
The front camera or radar sensor
recognition system may not detect the
vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist traveling
in front on a curved road. This may
result in no alarm and braking when
necessary.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
OOSH069044L
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system may recognize a vehicle or
pedestrian or cyclist in the next lane
or outside the lane when driving on a
curved road.
If this occurs, the system may
unnecessarily alarm the driver and
apply the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system may recognize a vehicle or
pedestrian or cyclist in the next lane
or outside the lane when driving on a
curved road.
If this occurs, the system may
unnecessarily alarm the driver and
apply the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
6-51
Driving your vehicle
OOSH069045L
• Driving on a slope
The performance of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may be
decreased while driving upward or
downward on a slope.
The front camera or front radar sensor
recognition may not detect the
vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist in front.
This may result in unnecessary alarm
and braking or no alarm and braking
when necessary.
When the system suddenly recognizes
the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist in
front while passing over a slope, you
may experience sharp deceleration.
Always keep your eyes forward while
driving upward or downward on a
slope, and, if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain distance.
OOSH069046L
• Changing lanes
When a vehicle changes lanes in
front of you, the FCA system may
not immediately detect the vehicle,
especially if the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
OOSH069047L
When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a vehicle in front of you merges
out of the lane, the FCA system may
not immediately detect the new
vehicle that is now in front of you. In
this case, you must maintain a safe
braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
6-52
06
Detecting pedestrians or cyclists
(if equipped)
OOSH069048L
• Detecting the vehicle in front of you
If the vehicle in front of you has cargo
that extends rearward from the cab,
or when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance, additional
special attention is required. The FCA
system may not be able to detect the
cargo extending from the vehicle. In
these instances, you must maintain
a safe braking distance from the
rearmost object, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
The sensor may be limited when:
• The pedestrian or cyclist is not fully
detected by the camera recognition
system, for example, if the pedestrian
is leaning over or is not fully walking
upright
• The pedestrian or cyclist is moving
very quickly or appears abruptly in the
camera detection area
• The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing
clothing that easily blends into the
background, making it difficult to be
detected by the camera recognition
system
• The outside lighting is too bright (e.g.
when driving in bright sunlight or
in sun glare) or too dark (e.g. when
driving on a dark rural road at night)
• It is difficult to detect and distinguish
the pedestrian or cyclist from other
objects in the surroundings, for
example, when there is a group of
pedestrians, cyclists or a large crowd
• There is an item similar to a person’s
body structure
• The pedestrian or cyclist is small
• The pedestrian has impaired mobility
• The sensor recognition is limited
6-53
Driving your vehicle
• The radar sensor or camera is blocked
with a foreign object or debris
• Inclement weather such as heavy rain
or snow obscures the field of view of
the radar sensor or camera
• When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road
• The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a speed
bump
• You are on a roundabout
• The pedestrian or cyclist suddenly
interrupts in front of the vehicle
• The cyclist in front is riding intersected
with the driving direction
• There is any other electromagnetic
interference
• The construction area, rail or other
metal object is near the cyclist
• The bicycle material is not reflected
well on the radar
WARNING
• Do not use the Forward Collision
avoidance Assist (FCA) system when
towing a vehicle. Application of
the FCA system while towing may
adversely affect the safety of your
vehicle or the towing vehicle.
• Use extreme caution when the
vehicle in front of you has cargo that
extends rearward from the cab, or
when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance.
• The FCA system is designed to help
detect and monitor the vehicle
ahead or detect a pedestrian or
cyclist (if equipped) in the roadway
through radar signals and camera
recognition. It is not designed to
detect bicycles, motorcycles, or
smaller wheeled objects such as
luggage bags, shopping carts, or
strollers.
• Never try to test the operation of
the FCA system. Doing so may cause
severe injury or death.
• If the front bumper, front glass, radar
or camera have been replaced or
repaired, we recommend that you
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
In some instances, the FCA system
may be cancelled when subjected to
electromagnetic interference.
6-54
06
BLIND-SPOT COLLISION WARNING (BCW) SYSTEM
(IF EQUIPPED)
System description
2. Closing at high speed
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)
The Blind-Spot Collision Warning System
(BCW) uses radar sensors in the rear
bumper to monitor and warn the driver
when it detects an approaching vehicle
in the driver’s blind spot area.
1. Blind-Spot Area
OOSH069050L
OOSH069049L
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to vehicle speed.
Note that if your vehicle is traveling
much faster than the vehicles around
you, the warning will not occur.
The Lane Change Assist feature will
alert you when it detects a vehicle is
approaching in an adjacent lane at a high
rate of speed. If the driver activates the
turn signal when the system detects an
oncoming vehicle, the system sounds an
audible alert.
WARNING
• Always be aware of road conditions
while driving and be alert for
unexpected situations even though
the Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System is operating.
• The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System (BCW) is supplemental
systems to assist you. Do not entirely
rely on the systems. Always pay
attention, while driving, for your
safety.
• The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System (BCW) is not substitutes
for proper and safe driving. Always
drive safely and use caution when
changing lanes or backing up the
vehicle.
The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
System (BCW) may not detect every
object alongside the vehicle.
6-55
Driving your vehicle
System setting and operation
System setting
OOSH069052L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
OOSH069051L
• Setting Blind-Spot Safety function
The driver can activate the system
by placing the ignition switch to the
ON position and by selecting ‘User
settings → Driver assistance → Blindspot safety’ in the cluster LCD display.
-- BCW turns on and gets ready to
be operated when ‘Warning only’
is selected. Then, if a vehicle
approaches the driver’s blind spot
area, a warning sounds.
-- The system is deactivated and the
indicator on the BCW button turns
off when ‘Off’ is selected.
6-56
• If you press the BCW button while
‘Warning only’ is selected, the
indicator on the button turns off and
the system deactivates.
• If you press the BCW button while the
system is cancelled, the indicator on
the button illuminates and the system
activates.
When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again while the system
is in activation, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outside rearview mirror.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the last
setting.
06
Operating Conditions
The system enters the ready status, when
‘Warning only’ is selected in the cluster
LCD display and vehicle speed is above
approximately 30 km/h (20 mph).
Warning message and system
control
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)
system
OOSH069036L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting ‘User settings →
Driver assistance → Warning timing →
Normal/Later’.
The options for the initial BlindSpot Collision Warning includes the
following:
-- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Blind-Spot Collision Warning
is activated normally. If this setting
feels too sensitive change the
option to ‘later’.
The warning activation time may
feel late if the side/rear vehicle
abruptly accelerates.
-- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving at low speeds.
Left side
Right side
OOSH069054L
First stage alert
If a vehicle is detected within the
boundary of the system, a warning light
will illuminate on the outside rearview
mirror and the head up display (if
equipped).
If the detected vehicle is no longer within
the blind spot area, the warning will turn
off according to the driving conditions of
the vehicle.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change.
6-57
Driving your vehicle
Left side
OOSH069055L
Right side
When this alert is activated, the warning
light on the outside rearview mirror and
the head up display (if equipped) will
also blink. And a warning chime will
sound.
If you turn off the turn signal indicator,
the second stage alert will be
deactivated.
If the detected vehicle is no longer within
the blind spot area, the warning will turn
off according to the driving conditions of
the vehicle.
WARNING
OOSH069056L
[A] : Warning sound
Second stage alert
A warning chime to alert the driver will
activate when:
1. A vehicle has been detected in the
blind spot area by the radar system
AND.
2. The turn signal is applied (same
side as where the vehicle is being
detected).
6-58
• The warning light on the outside
rearview mirror will illuminate
whenever a vehicle is detected at the
rear side by the system.
To avoid accidents, do not focus only
on the warning light and neglect to
see the surroundings of the vehicle.
• Drive safely even though the vehicle
is equipped with a Blind-Spot
Collision Warning System (BCW).
Do not solely rely on the system but
check your surroundings before
changing lanes or backing the
vehicle up.
• The system may not alert the driver
in some situations due to system
limitations so always check your
surroundings while driving.
06
NOTICE
CAUTION
• Always pay attention to road and
traffic conditions while driving,
whether or not the warning light
on the outside rearview mirror
illuminates or there is a warning
alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may offset the BlindSpot Collision Warning System
warning sounds.
• The warning of the Blind-Spot
Collision Warning System may not
sound while other system’s warning
sounds.
Detecting sensor
OOSH069057L
The rear radars are located inside the
rear bumper for detecting the side and
rear areas. Always keep the rear bumper
clean for proper operation of the system.
• The system may not work properly
when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper has
been replaced or repaired.
• The sensing range differs somewhat
according to the width of the road.
When the road is narrow, the system
may detect other vehicles in the next
lane.
• The system may turn off if interfered
by strong electromagnetic waves.
• Always keep the sensors clean.
• NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact on
the sensor component.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. We recommend that
the vehicle be inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not apply foreign objects such as
a bumper sticker or a bumper guard
near the radar sensor or apply paint
to the sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of
the sensor.
6-59
Driving your vehicle
Warning message
OOSH069058L
BCW (Blind-Spot Collision Warning)
system disabled. Radar blocked
• This warning message may appear
when:
-- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
-- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
-- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
-- A trailer or carrier is installed.
If any of these conditions occur, the light
on the BCW button and the system will
turn off automatically.
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear bumper
is free from any dirt or snow in the areas
where the sensor is located. Remove any
dirt, snow, or foreign material that could
interfere with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed, the
system should operate normally after
about 10 minutes of driving the vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally, we recommend that the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
Turn off the BCW and RCCW system
(if equipped) when a trailer or carrier is
installed.
-- Press the BCW button (the indicator on
the button will turn off)
-- Deactivate the RCCW system by
deselecting ‘User settings → Driver
assistance → Parking safety → Rear
cross-traffic safety’
OOSH069059L
Check BCW (Blind-spot Collision
Warning) system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will appear
and the light on the button will turn off.
The system will turn off automatically.
We recommend that you have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
6-60
06
Limitations of the system
The driver must be cautious in the below
situations because the system may not
detect other vehicles or objects in certain
circumstances:
• When a trailer or carrier is installed.
• The vehicle drives in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or snow.
• The sensor is covered with rain, snow,
mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or the
sensor is out of the original default
position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a trunk,
abnormal tire pressure, etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
• The vehicle is driven on a curved road.
• The vehicle is driven through a
tollgate.
• The road pavement (or the peripheral
ground) abnormally contains metallic
components (i.e. possibly due to
subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
• Driving on a narrow road where trees
or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle or
structure for an extended period of
time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the guardrail
or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus or
truck.
• When the other vehicle approaches
very close.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the same
time as the vehicle next to you and
has accelerated.
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you OR
when the vehicle two lanes away
moves to the next lane from you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
6-61
Driving your vehicle
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such as
a sports car.
• The brake pedal is depressed.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
activated.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
malfunctions.
• The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged.
• The brake is reworked.
• The vehicle abruptly changes driving
direction.
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle sharply stops.
• Temperature is extremely low around
the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road, uneven/
bumpy road, or concrete patch.
• The vehicle is driven on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
OOSH069060L
• Driving on a curve
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving on a curved
road. In certain instances the system
may not detect the vehicle in the next
lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OOSH069061L
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving on a curved
road. In certain instances the system
may recognize a vehicle in the same
lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
6-62
06
OOSH069063L
• Driving where the road is merging/
dividing
The BCW system may not operate
properly when driving where the
road is merging/dividing. In certain
instances the system may not detect
the vehicle in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OOSH069064L
• Driving on a slope
The system may not operate properly
when driving on a slope. In certain
instances the system may not detect
the vehicle in the next lane.
Also, in certain instances the system
may wrongly recognize the ground or
structures.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
6-63
Driving your vehicle
OOSH069062L
• Driving where the heights of the lanes
are different
The system may not operate properly
when driving where the heights of the
lanes are different.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle on a road with
different lane heights (underpass
joining section, grade separated
intersections, etc.).
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
6-64
OOSH069065L
[A] : Noise, [B] : Guardrail
• Driving where there is a structure
beside the road
The system may not operate properly
when driving where there is structure
beside the road.
In certain instances, the system may
wrongly recognize the structures
(noise barriers, guardrail, double
guardrail, median strip, bollard, street
light, road sign, tunnel wall, etc.)
beside the road.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
06
REAR CROSS – TRAFFIC COLLISION WARNING (RCCW)
SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
System description
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
(RCCW) system
OOSH069066L
The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
(RCCW) System uses radar sensors to
monitor the approaching cross traffic
from the left and right side of the vehicle
when your vehicle is in reverse.
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to the approaching vehicle
speed.
WARNING
• Always be aware of road and traffic
conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations
even though the Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning System is
operating.
• The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning System is supplemental
systems to assist you. Do not entirely
rely on the systems. Always pay
attention, while driving, for your
safety.
• The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning System is not substitutes for
proper and safe driving. Always drive
safely and use caution when backing
up the vehicle.
6-65
Driving your vehicle
System setting and operation
System setting
OOSH069036L
OOSH069067L
• Setting Parking Safety function
The driver can activate the systems
by placing the ignition switch to the
ON position and by selecting ‘User
settings → Driver assistance → Parking
safety’. The system turns on and is
ready to be operated when ‘Rear
cross-traffic safety’ is selected.
• When the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system will be ready to be
operated.
• When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outside rearview mirror.
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting ‘User settings →
Driver assistance → Warning timing →
Normal/Later’.
The options for the initial Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning includes the
following:
-- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning is activated normally. If this
setting feels too sensitive change
the option to ‘late’.
The warning activation time may
feel late if the side/rear vehicle
abruptly accelerates.
-- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving at low speeds.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change.
6-66
06
Operating conditions
To operate:
1. Go to the ‘User settings → Driver
assistance → Parking safety → Rear
cross-traffic safety’ in the LCD display.
The system will turn on and standby to
operate.
2. The system will operate when vehicle
speed is below 10 km/h (7 mph) and
with the shift lever in R (Reverse).
ÃÃ The system will not operate when
the vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h
(7 mph). The system will activate
again when the speed is below 8
km/h (5 mph).
The system’s detecting range is
approximately 0.5 m ~ 20 m (1 ft ~
65 ft). An approaching vehicle will
be detected if their vehicle speed is
within 8 km/h ~ 36 km/h (5 ~ 22.5
mph).
Note that the detecting range and
operating speed may vary under
certain conditions. As always, use
caution and pay close attention to
your surroundings when backing up
your vehicle.
Warning message and system
control
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
(RCCW) system
Left
Right
OOSH069068L
OOSH069069L
If the vehicle detected by the sensors
approaches from the rear left/right side
of your vehicle, the warning chime will
sound, the warning light on the outside
rearview mirror will blink and a message
will appear on the LCD display. If the rear
view monitor system is in activation, a
message will also appear on the audio or
AVN screen.
The warning will stop when:
-- the detected vehicle moves out of the
sensing area or
-- when the vehicle is right behind your
vehicle or
-- when the vehicle is not approaching
your vehicle or
-- when the other vehicle slows down.
6-67
Driving your vehicle
CAUTION
• When the operation condition of
the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning System is satisfied the
warning will occur every time a
vehicle approaches the side/rear of
your stopped (0 km/h vehicle speed)
vehicle.
• The system’s warning may not
operate properly if the left/right of
your vehicle’s rear bumper is blocked
by a vehicle or obstacle.
• Always pay attention to road and
traffic conditions while driving,
whether or not the warning light
on the outside rearview mirror
illuminates or there is a warning
alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system’s warning
sounds.
• The warning of the Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning System may not
sound while other system’s warning
sounds.
6-68
WARNING
• Drive safely even though the vehicle
is equipped with a Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning System. Do not
solely rely on the system but check
your surrounding when backing the
vehicle up.
• The driver is responsible for accurate
brake control.
• Always pay extreme caution while
driving. The Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning System may not
operate properly or unnecessarily
operate depending on traffic and
driving conditions.
• The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning System is not a substitute
for safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver to
always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
06
Detecting sensor
• Do not apply foreign objects such as
a bumper sticker or a bumper guard
near the radar sensor or apply paint
to the sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of
the sensor.
OOSH069057L
The rear radars are located inside the
rear bumper for detecting the side and
rear. Always keep the rear bumper clean
for proper operation of the system.
OOSH069058L
NOTICE
• The system may not work properly
when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper has
been replaced or repaired.
• The system may turn off if interfered
by strong electromagnetic waves.
• Always keep the sensors clean.
• NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact on
the sensor component.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. We recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
BCW (Blind-Spot Collision Warning)
system disabled. Radar blocked
• This warning message may appear
when:
-- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
-- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
-- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
-- A trailer or carrier is installed.
If any of these conditions occur, the light
on the BCW button and the system will
turn off automatically.
6-69
Driving your vehicle
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear bumper
is free from any dirt or snow in the areas
where the sensor is located. Remove any
dirt, snow, or foreign material that could
interfere with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed, the
RCCW system should operate normally
after about 10 minutes of driving the
vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally, we recommend that the
vehicle be inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSH069059L
Check BCW (Blind-Spot Collision
Warning) system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will appear
and the light on the button will turn off.
The system will turn off automatically.
RCCW will not operate also if the BCW
system turns off due to malfunction. We
recommend that you have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
6-70
Limitations of the system
The driver must be cautious in the below
situations because the system may not
detect other vehicles or objects in certain
circumstances:
• When a trailer or carrier is installed.
• The vehicle drives in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or snow.
• The sensor is polluted with rain, snow,
mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or the
sensor is out of the original default
position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a trunk,
abnormal tire pressure, etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
• The vehicle is driven on a curved road.
• The road pavement (or the peripheral
ground) abnormally contains metallic
components (i.e. possibly due to
subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
06
• Driving on a narrow road where trees
or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle for an
extended period of time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the guardrail
or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus or
truck.
• When the other vehicle approaches
very close.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the same
time as the vehicle next to you and
has accelerated.
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you OR
when the vehicle two lanes away
moves to the next lane from you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such as
a sports car.
• The brake pedal is depressed.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
activated.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
malfunctions.
• The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged.
• The brake is reworked.
• The vehicle sharply stops.
• Temperature is extremely low around
the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road, uneven/
bumpy road, or concrete patch.
• The vehicle is driven on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
OOSH069070L
[A] : Structure
• Driving where there is a vehicle or
structure near
The system may not operate properly
when driving where there is a vehicle
or structure near.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from behind and the warning may not
operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
6-71
Driving your vehicle
OOSH069071L
• When the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment.
In certain instances, the system may
not be able to exactly determine the
risk of collision for the vehicles which
are parking or pulling out near your
vehicle (e.g. a vehicle escaping beside
your vehicle, a vehicle parking or
pulling out in the rear area, a vehicle
approaching your vehicle making a
turn, etc.).
In this case, the warning may not
operate properly.
OOSH069072L
[A] : Vehicle
• When the vehicle is parked diagonally
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is parked diagonally.
In certain instances, when the
diagonally parked vehicle is pulled out
of the parking space, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right of your vehicle.
In this case, the warning may not
operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
OOSH069073L
• When the vehicle is on/near a slope
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is on/near a slope.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right and the
warning may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
6-72
06
OOSH069074L
[A] : Structure, [B] : Wall
• Pulling into the parking space where
there is a structure
The system may not operate properly
when pulling in the vehicle to the
parking space where there is a
structure at the back or side of your
vehicle.
In certain instances, when backing
into the parking space, the system
may falsely detect the vehicle moving
in front of your vehicle. In this case,
the warning may operate.
Always pay attention to the parking
space while driving.
OOSH069075L
• When the vehicle is parked rearward
If the vehicle is parked rearward and
the sensor detects another vehicle
in the rear area of the parking space,
the warning may operate. Always pay
attention to the parking space while
driving.
6-73
Driving your vehicle
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (IF EQUIPPED)
The radio frequency components (Rear Corner Radar) complies:
-- For Singapore : N3346-15
-- For Moldova
ODN8069105L
-- For Mexico
Certificate of Homologation :
“IFETEL : RLVVAMB15-2026”
ODN8069107L
-- For Russia
-- Brazil
ODN8069108L
-- For UAE
ODN8069109L
-- For Oman
ODN8069110L
ODN8069106L
6-74
06
-- For Vietnam
-- For Argentina
CNC ID : C-202016
ODN8069111L
-- For Jordan
TRC No. TRC/LPD/2015/365
-- For Ukraine
ODN8069113L
-- For Algeria
Agréé par l’ARPT: <1248/1-LG409/
DTDG/ARPT/18>
-- For Paraguay
ODN8069112L
Valeo Schalter und Sensoren GmbH
declares that the type of radio
equipment MBHL2 meet the technical
regulations of radio equipment; the full
text of the declaration of conformity is
available on the website at :
ODN8069114L
-- For Philippine
ODN8069115L
6-75
Driving your vehicle
-- For Zambia
-- For Uzbekistan
ODN8069116L
ZMB/ZICTA/TA/2018/4/24
ODN8069119L
-- For Mozambique
Approval No : N 2/R/SRS/2018 Valeo
MBHL 2 Radar
-- For Malaysia
-- For Jamaica This product has been
Type
Approved by Jamaica : SMA –
“MBHL2”
ODN8069117L
-- For Mongolia
ODN8069118L
6-76
06
-- For Taiwan
Article 12
Without permission, any company, firm
or user shall not alter the frequency,
increase the power, or change the
characteristics and functions of the
original design of the certified lower
power frequency electric machinery.
ODN8069120L
Article 14
The application of low power frequency
electric machineries shall not affect the
navigation safety nor interface a legal
communication, if an interference is
found, the service will be suspended
until improvement is made and the
interference no longer exist.
6-77
Driving your vehicle
LANE FOLLOWING ASSIST (LFA) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
OOSH069040L
The Lane Following Assist (LFA) system
helps detect lane markers on the road
with a front view camera at the front
windshield, and assists the driver’s
steering to help keep the vehicle
between lanes.
WARNING
The Lane Following Assist (LFA) system
is not a substitute for safe driving
practices, but a convenience function.
It is the responsibility of the driver to
always be aware of the surroundings
and steer the vehicle.
6-78
Take the following precautions when
using the Lane Following Assist (LFA)
system:
• Do not turn the steering wheel
suddenly when the steering wheel is
being assisted by the system.
• The LFA system helps the driver to
keep the vehicle in the center of
the lane by assisting the driver’s
steering. However, the driver should
not solely rely on the system but
always pay attention on the steering
wheel to stay in the lane.
• The operation of the LFA system can
be canceled or not work properly
according to road condition and
surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
• Do not disassemble the LFA
system camera temporarily to tint
the window or attach any types
of coatings and accessories. If
you disassemble the camera and
assemble it again, we recommend
that you take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have
the system checked for calibration.
06
• When you replace the windshield
glass, LFA system camera or related
parts of the steering wheel, we
recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
for calibration.
• The system helps detect lane
markers and controls the steering
wheel by a camera, therefore, if the
lane markers are hard to detect, the
system may not work properly.
Please refer to “Limitations of the
System”.
• Do not remove or damage the related
parts of the LFA system.
• You may not hear a warning sound of
the LFA system if the audio volume
is high.
• Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light such
as mirrors, white paper, etc. This
may prevent the LFA system from
functioning properly.
• Always have your hands on the
steering wheel while the LFA system
is activated. If you continue to drive
with your hands off the steering
wheel after the “Keep hands on
steering wheel” warning message
appears, the system will turn off
automatically.
However, if the driver has their
hands on the steering wheel again,
the system will start controlling the
steering wheel.
• The steering wheel is not
continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher rate
when leaving a lane the vehicle may
not be controlled by the system. The
driver must always follow the speed
limit when using the system.
• If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, the system may not assist
steering or the hands off alarm may
not work properly.
• When you tow a trailer, make sure
that you turn off the LFA system.
6-79
Driving your vehicle
LFA operation
LFA system operation
System setting
• With the ignition switch is in the ON
position, Lane Following Assist can be
activated by selecting ‘User settings
→ Driver assistance → Driving assist
→ LFA (Lane Following Assist)’ in the
cluster LCD display. Deselect the
setting to turn off the system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the last
setting.
Operating conditions
Select ‘LFA (Lane Following Assist)’ from
the User settings mode in the cluster
LCD display and meet the following
conditions for the system to operate.
-- The Smart Cruise Control is operating
-- Vehicle speed is lower than 180 km/h
(110 mph)
When the system is activated, the
indicator ( ) on the cluster will
illuminate. The color of the indicator will
change depending on the condition of
the LFA system.
-- Green: Steering assist mode is ON
-- White: Steering assist mode is OFF
6-80
OOSH069076L
• If the vehicle is inside the lane
with both lanes detected by the
system(lane color changes from
gray to white), and there is no abrupt
steering made by the driver, the LFA
system changes to steering assist
mode.
indicator light will come on
The
green, and the system helps the
vehicle stay in line by controlling the
steering wheel.
When the steering wheel is not
controlled temporarily, the
indicator light will flash green and
change to white.
06
Warning message
OOSH069079L
OOSH069077L
Keep hands on steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds while
the LFA system is activated, the system
will warn the driver.
Information
Hold the steering wheel tight. Otherwise,
the LFA system could misjudge that the
driver’s hands are off the steering wheel,
and the above warning may occur.
WARNING
The warning message may appear
late according to road conditions.
Therefore, always have your hands on
the steering wheel while driving.
Driver’s hands not detected.
LFA system is disabled temporarily
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message “Keep hands on steering
wheel”, the system will not control the
steering wheel and warn the driver
only when the driver crosses the lane
markers.
However, if the driver has their hands on
the steering wheel again, the system will
start controlling the steering wheel.
WARNING
• The LFA system is a supplemental
system only. It is the responsibility of
the driver to safely steer the vehicle
and to maintain it in its lane.
• Turn off the LFA system and drive
without using the system in the
following situations:
-- In bad weather
-- In bad road conditions
-- When the steering wheel needs
to be controlled by the driver
frequently
6-81
Driving your vehicle
Information
• Even though the steering is assisted by
the system, the driver may control the
steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted by
the system than when it is not.
OOSH069078L
Check LFA (Lane Following Assist) system
If there is a problem with the system a
message will appear for a few seconds.
If the problem continues the LFA system
failure indicator will illuminate.
The LFA system will not be in the
ENABLED state and/or the steering wheel
will not be assisted when:
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on, the
steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle
of the lane when the system is turned
on or right after changing a lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp curve.
• Vehicle speed is over 180 km/h (110
mph).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• Only one lane marker is detected.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• There are more than two lane markers
on the road (e.g. construction area).
• Radius of a curve is too small.
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the engine is started or
the camera is initialized.
Limitations of the system
The LFA system may operate prematurely
even if the vehicle does not depart from
the intended lane, OR, the LFA system
may not assist your steering or warn you
if the vehicle leaves the intended lane
under the following circumstances:
6-82
06
When the lane and road conditions are
poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking from the road surface or the
lane marking is faded or not clearly
marked.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color of
the lane marker from the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker is indistinct or
damaged.
• The lane marker is merged or divided
(e.g. tollgate).
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane markers
on the road in front of you.
• The lane marker is very thick or thin.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• The lane marker ahead is not visible
due to rain, snow, water on the road,
damaged or stained road surface, or
other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker by
a median strip, trees, guardrail, noise
barriers, etc.
• The lane markers are complicated or a
structure substitutes for the lines such
as a construction area.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane marker in a tunnel is stained
with oil, etc.
• The lane suddenly disappears such as
at the intersection.
When external condition is intervened
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low such
as when the headlamps are not on at
night or the vehicle is going through
a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in the
roadway such as a concrete barrier,
guardrail and reflector post that is
inadvertently being detected by the
camera.
• When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road.
• The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance between
you and the vehicle in front to be
able to detect the lane marker or the
vehicle ahead is driving on the lane
marker.
• Driving on a steep grade, over a hill, or
when driving on a curved road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high due to
direct sunlight, etc.
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a speed
bump or driving on a steep up/down
or right/left grade
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the camera lens is
blocked with dirt or debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard, etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
because of fog, heavy rain or snow.
6-83
Driving your vehicle
LANE KEEPING ASSIST (LKA) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
OOSH069040L
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system
helps detect lane markers (or road
edges) on the road with a camera at
the front windshield, and assists the
driver’s steering to help keep the vehicle
between lanes.
When the system detects the vehicle
straying from its lane (or road), it alerts
the driver with a visual and audible
warning, while applying a countersteering torque, trying to help prevent
the vehicle from moving out of its lane
(or road).
WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system
is not a substitute for safe driving
practices, but a convenience function
only. It is the responsibility of the driver
to always be aware of the surroundings
and steer the vehicle.
6-84
Take the following precautions when
using the Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system:
• Do not turn the steering wheel
suddenly when the steering wheel is
being assisted by the system.
• The LKA system helps to prevent the
driver from moving out of the lane
(or road) unintentionally by assisting
the driver’s steering. However, the
driver should not solely rely on the
system but always pay attention on
the steering wheel to stay in the lane
(or road).
• The operation of the LKA system can
be cancelled or not work properly
according to road condition and
surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
• Do not disassemble the LKA
system camera temporarily to tint
the window or attach any types
of coatings and accessories. If
you disassemble the camera and
assemble it again, we recommend
that you take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have
the system checked for calibration.
06
• When you replace the windshield
glass, LKA system camera or related
parts of the steering wheel, we
recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
for calibration.
• The system detects lane markers (or
road edges) and controls the steering
wheel by a camera, therefore, if the
lane markers (or road edges) are hard
to detect, the system may not work
properly. Please refer to “Limitations
of the System”.
• Do not remove or damage the related
parts of the LKA system.
• You may not hear a warning sound of
the LKA system if the audio volume
is high.
• Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light such
as mirrors, white paper, etc. This
may prevent the LKA system from
functioning properly.
• Always have your hands on the
steering wheel while the LKA system
is activated. If you continue to drive
with your hands off the steering
wheel after the “Keep hands on
steering wheel” warning message
appears, the system will stop
controlling the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel is not
continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher rate
when leaving a lane (or road) the
vehicle may not be controlled by
the system. The driver must always
follow the speed limit when using
the system.
• If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, the system may not assist
steering or the hands off alarm may
not work properly.
• When you tow a trailer, make sure
that you turn off the LKA system.
6-85
Driving your vehicle
LKA operation
Information
If the indicator (white) is activated from
the previous ignition cycle, the system will
turn ON without any additional control.
If you press the LKA button again, the
indicator on the cluster goes off.
LKA system operation
OOSH069080L
To activate/deactivate the LKA system:
With the ignition switch in the ON
position, press the LKA system button
located on the instrument panel on the
left hand side of the steering wheel
(Right hand side of the steering wheel for
RHD vehicles.).
indicator in the cluster
The
display will initially illuminate white. This
indicates the LKA system is in the READY
but NOT ENABLED state.
Note that the vehicle speed
must be at least approximately
60 km/h (40 mph) to ENABLE
the LKA system. The indicator
in the cluster display will
illuminate green.
-- White: Sensor does not detect lane
markers (or road edges) or vehicle
speed is under 60 km/h (37 mph).
-- Green: Sensor detects lane markers
(or road edges) and the system is able
to control vehicle steering.
6-86
OOSH069081L
• To see the LKA screen on the LCD
display in the cluster, select ASSIST
mode ( ). For more information,
refer to “LCD Display Modes” section
in chapter 4.
06
Lane marker
undetected
OOSH069081L
Lane marker
detected
OOSH069082L
• If vehicle speed is over 60 km/h (37
mph) and the system detects lane
markers (or road edges), the color
changes from gray to white.
• If your vehicle speed exceeds 60 km/h
(37 mph) and the LKA system button
is ON, the system is enabled. If your
vehicle departs from the projected
lane (or road edge) in front of you, the
LKA system operates as follows:
Left lane marker
OOSH069083L
2. The LKA system will help control
the vehicle’s steering to prevent the
vehicle from crossing the lane maker
(or road edge) in below conditions.
-- Vehicle speed is over 60 km/h (37
mph)
-- The system detects both lane
markers (or road edges)
-- When driving, the vehicle is located
between both lanes normally.
-- The steering wheel is not turned
suddenly.
When lanes (or road edges) are
detected and all the conditions to
activate the LKA system are satisfied,
)
a LKA system indicator light (
will change from white to green. This
indicates that the LKA system is in
the ENABLED state and the steering
wheel will be controlled.
Right lane marker
OOSH069084L
1. A visual warning appears on the
cluster LCD display. Either the left lane
marker (or road edge) or the right lane
marker (or road edge) in the cluster
LCD display will blink depending on
which direction the vehicle is veering.
6-87
Driving your vehicle
OOSH069077L
OOSH069085L
Keep hands on steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds while
the LKA system is activated, the system
will warn the driver.
Driver’s hands not detected.
LKA system is disabled temporarily
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message “Keep hands on steering
wheel”, the system will not control the
steering wheel and warn the driver only
when the driver crosses the lane markers
(or road edges).
However, if the driver has their hands on
the steering wheel again, the system will
start controlling the steering wheel.
Information
If the steering wheel is held very lightly
the message may still appear because the
LKA system may not recognize that the
driver has their hands on the wheel.
WARNING
The warning message may appear
late according to road conditions.
Therefore, always have your hands on
the steering wheel while driving.
WARNING
• The LKA system is a supplemental
system only. It is the responsibility of
the driver to safely steer the vehicle
and to maintain it in its lane.
• Turn off the LKA system and drive
without using the system in the
following situations:
-- In bad weather
-- In bad road conditions
-- When the steering wheel needs
to be controlled by the driver
frequently
Information
• Even though the steering is assisted by
the system, the driver can still steer to
control the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted by
the system than when it is not.
6-88
06
Warning light and message
OOSH069086L
Check LKA (Lane Keep Assist) system
If there is a problem with the system a
message will appear for a few seconds.
If the problem continues the LKA system
failure indicator will illuminate.
LKA system indicator
The LKA system indicator
(yellow) will illuminate if the
LKA system is not working
properly.
We recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
When there is a problem with the system
do one of the following:
• Turn the system on after turning the
vehicle off and on again.
• Check if the ignition switch is in the
ON position.
• Check if the system is affected by the
weather. (ex: fog, heavy rain, etc.)
• Check if there is foreign matter on the
camera lens.
The LKA system will not be in the
ENABLED state and the steering wheel
will not be assisted when:
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on, the
steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle
of the lane when the system is turned
on or right after changing a lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp curve.
• Vehicle speed is below 60 km/h (37
mph) and over 180 km/h (112 mph).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• Only one lane marker is detected.
• The lane (or road width) is very wide
or narrow.
• There are more than two lane markers
on the road. (e.g. construction area)
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
• The system may not operate for 15
seconds after the engine is started or
the camera is initialized.
If the problem is not solved, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-89
Driving your vehicle
Limitations of the system
The LKA system may operate
prematurely even if the vehicle does
not depart from the intended lane, OR,
the LKA system may not assist your
steering or warn you if the vehicle leaves
the intended lane under the following
circumstances:
When the lane and road conditions are
poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking (or road edge) from the road
surface or the lane marking (or road
edge) is faded or not clearly marked.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color of
the lane marker (or road edge) from
the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker (or road edge) is
indistinct or damaged.
• The lane marker is merged or divided
(e.g. tollgate).
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane markers
on the road in front of you.
6-90
• The lane marker is very thick or thin.
• The lane (or road width) is very wide
or narrow.
• The lane (or road edge) ahead is not
visible due to rain, snow, water on
the road, damaged or stained road
surface, or other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker (or
road edge) by a median strip, trees,
guardrail, noise barriers, etc.
• The lane markers (or road edges) are
complicated or a structure substitutes
for the lines such as a construction
area.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane marker (or road edge) in a
tunnel is stained with oil, etc.
• The lane suddenly disappears such as
at the intersection.
When external condition is intervened
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low such
as when the headlamps are not on at
night or the vehicle is going through
a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in the
roadway such as a concrete barrier,
guardrail and reflector post that is
inadvertently being detected by the
camera.
06
• When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road.
• The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance between
you and the vehicle in front to be able
to detect the lane marker (or road
edge) or the vehicle ahead is driving
on the lane marker (or road edge).
• Driving on a steep grade, over a hill, or
when driving on a curved road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high due to
direct sunlight, etc.
• Road surface is not even.
LKA system function change
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the camera lens is
blocked with dirt or debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard, etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
marker (or road edge) because of fog,
heavy rain or snow.
LKA (Lane Keeping Assist)
The driver can change LKA to the Lane
Departure Warning (LDW) or change the
LKA mode between LKA and Active LKA
from the LCD display. Go to the ‘User
settings → Driver assistance → Lane safety
→ Active LKA (Lane Keeping Assist)/
LKA (Lane Keeping Assist)/LDW (Lane
Departure Warning)’.
The system is automatically set to
Standard LKA if a function is not
selected.
Active LKA (Lane Keeping Assist)
The Active LKA mode provides more
frequent steering wheel control in
comparison with the Standard LKA
mode. Active LKA can reduce the
driver’s fatigue to assist the steering for
maintaining the vehicle in the middle of
the lane.
The LKA mode guides the driver to help
keep the vehicle within the lanes. It
rarely controls the steering wheel, when
the vehicle drives well inside the lanes.
However, it starts to control the steering
wheel, when the vehicle is about to
deviate out of the lanes.
LDW (Lane Departure Warning)
LDW alerts the driver with a visual
warning and a warning alarm when the
system detects the vehicle departing
the lane. The steering wheel will not be
controlled.
6-91
Driving your vehicle
DRIVER ATTENTION WARNING (DAW) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system displays the condition of the
driver’s fatigue level and inattentive
driving practices.
System setting and operation
System setting
• Selecting Driver Attention Warning
function
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
can be activated from the Users
Settings mode in the cluster LCD
display by following the procedure
below.
1. Set the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Select ‘User settings → Driver
assistance → DAW (Driver Attention
Warning)’ in the cluster LCD
display. Deselect the setting to turn
off the system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the last
setting.
OOSH069036L
• Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time from the
User Settings in the cluster LCD
display by selecting ‘User settings →
Driver assistance → Warning timing →
Normal/Later’.
The options for the initial Driver
Attention Warning includes the
following:
-- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Driver Attention Warning is
activated normally. If this setting
feels sensitive, change the option to
‘Later’.
The warning activation time may
feel late if a vehicle at the side or
rear abruptly accelerates.
-- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving at low speeds.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change.
6-92
06
Display of the driver’s attention
level
System off
•
•
OOSH069087L
•
Attentive driving
•
The DAW screen will appear when you
select the Assist mode tab ( ) on the
LCD display if the system is activated.
(For more details, refer to “LCD
Display Modes” section in chapter 4.)
The driver’s attention level is displayed
on the scale of 1 to 5. The lower the
level is, the more inattentive the driver
is.
The level decreases when the driver
does not take a break for a certain
period of time.
The level increases when the driver
attentively drives for a certain period
of time.
When the driver turns on the system
while driving, it displays ‘Last Break
time’ and level.
OOSH069088L
Inattentive driving
OOSH069089L
• The driver can monitor his/her driving
conditions on the cluster LCD display.
6-93
Driving your vehicle
Resetting the system
Take a break
OOSH069090L
• The “Consider taking a break”
message appears on the cluster LCD
display and a warning sounds to
suggest that the driver take a break,
when the driver’s attention level is
below 1.
• The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system will not suggest a break, when
the total driving time is shorter than
10 minutes.
CAUTION
If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, the Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system warning may
not sound.
6-94
• The last break time is set to 00:00 and
the driver’s attention level is set to 5
(very attentive) when the driver resets
the Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system.
• The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system resets the last break time to
00:00 and the driver’s attention level
to 5 in the following situations.
-- The engine is turned OFF.
-- The driver unfastens the seat belt
and then opens the driver’s door.
-- The vehicle is stopped for more
than 10 minutes.
• The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system operates again, when the
driver restarts driving.
06
System standby
System malfunction
OOSH069091L
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system enters the ready status and
displays the ‘Standby’ screen in the
following situations.
-- The camera does not detect the lane.
-- Driving speed remains under 60 km/h
(37 mph) or over 180 km/h (112 mph).
OOSH069092L
Check DAW (Driver Attention Warning)
system
When the “Check Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system” warning
message appears, the system is not
working properly. In this case, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system is not a substitute
for safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver to
always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
• The driver who feels fatigued should
take a break, even though there is
no break suggestion by the Driver
Attention Warning (DAW) system.
6-95
Driving your vehicle
Information
The system may suggest a break according
to the driver’s driving pattern or habits
even if the driver doesn’t feel fatigue.
NOTICE
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system utilizes the camera sensor on
the front windshield for its operation.
To keep the camera sensor in the best
condition, you should observe the
followings:
• Never install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, or
tint the front windshield.
• NEVER place any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the Driver
Attention Warning (DAW) system.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera sensor dry.
• Never disassemble the camera
assembly, or apply any impact on the
camera assembly.
If the sensor is forcibly moved out
of proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. We
recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
for calibration.
CAUTION
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system may not provide alerts in the
following situations:
• The lane detection performance
is limited. (For more information,
refer to “Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system” section in this chapter.)
• The vehicle is erratically driven
or is abruptly turned for obstacle
avoidance (e.g. construction area,
other vehicles, fallen objects, bumpy
road).
• Forward drivability of the vehicle is
severely undermined (possibly due
to wide variation in tire pressures,
uneven tire wear-out, toe-in/toe-out
alignment).
• The vehicle is driven on a curvy road.
• The vehicle is driven through a windy
area.
• The vehicle is driven on a bumpy
road.
• The vehicle is controlled by the
following driving assist systems:
-- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA) system
-- Smart Cruise Control (SCC) system
-- Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system
-- Lane Following Assist (LFA) system
CAUTION
Playing the vehicle audio system at high
volume may prevent occupants from
hearing the Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system warning sounds.
6-96
06
INTELLIGENT SPEED LIMIT WARNING (ISLW) (IF EQUIPPED)
•
•
OOSH069040L
The Intelligent Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW) system displays the speed limit
information and overtaking restriction of
the current road through the instrument
cluster and the navigation. The ISLW
reads the traffic signs through the
camera, which is attached on the upper
part of the inner front windshield.
The ISLW also utilizes the navigation and
vehicle information to display the speed
limit information.
WARNING
• Intelligent Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW) system is only a supplemental
system and is not always able to
correctly display speed limits and
overtaking restrictions.
• The driver still holds the
responsibility not to exceed the
maximum speed limit.
• The ISLW detects the traffic signs
through the camera to display the
speed limit information.
•
•
•
Therefore, the ISLW may not properly
operate, when it is hard to detect
the traffic signs. For further details,
please refer to the "Limitations of the
system".
Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera sensor out of water.
Do not disassemble the camera
assembly, or apply any impact on the
camera assembly.
Do not disassemble the camera
temporarily to tint the window or
attach any types of coatings and
accessories. If you disassemble
the camera and assemble it again,
we recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
for calibration.
Do not place any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction system.
The system is not available in all
countries.
Information
We recommend that you have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer when:
• The windshield glass is replaced.
• The camera or related parts are
repaired or removed.
6-97
Driving your vehicle
System setting and operation
System setting
• The driver can activate the ISLW
by selecting 'User settings → Driver
assistance → SLW (Speed Limit
Warning)'.
• When the ISLW is activated, the
symbols appear on the instrument
cluster to display the speed limit
information and overtaking restriction.
• When the ISLW is activated in
the navigation setting, the above
information and the restriction are
also displayed on the navigation.
System activation
• The ISLW displays the speed limit
information and displays the
overtaking restriction, when your
vehicle passes by the relevant traffic
signs.
• The ISLW displays the previous speed
limit information, right after the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position.
• You may find different speed limit
information for the same road. The
information is displayed depending on
the driving situations. Because, traffic
signs with additional sign (e.g. rainy,
arrow, etc.) are also detected and
compared with vehicle internal data
(e.g. wiper operation, turn signal, etc.).
Information
The speed limit information on the
instrument cluster may differ from the one
on the navigation. In this case, check the
speed unit setting on the navigation.
6-98
Display
Display in the bottom of the cluster
OOSH069093L
The cluster displays the speed limit
information, overtaking restriction and
conditional road sign.
OOSH069094L
Conditional road sign
If the ISLW detects a conditional road
sign, the symbol of a road sign is
overlapped at the bottom or left of the
speed limit on the cluster.
There may be signs with different speed
limits on the same road. For example,
normally, the speed limit is 120 km/h,
however the speed limit is 90 km/h when
it is raining or snowing.
The conditional road sign means that you
observe the speed limit and overtaking
prohibition on certain conditions, such as
when rain or snow.
06
No reliable speed limit information
End of a speed limit
--WTL-220
Additional road signs
• The symbol is displayed on the
instrument cluster and the navigation,
when the ISLW does not have any
reliable speed limit information.
No passing
information
WUM-207
WUM-208
• After the vehicle passes a 'end of
speed limit' sign, the ISLW system
informs the driver of the next
applicable speed limit based on
the information received from the
navigation.
Unlimited speed (only in Germany)
WTL-222
WTL-221
• The symbol is displayed on the
instrument cluster and the navigation,
when the ISLW detects a noovertaking sign.
WUM-205
• The symbol, 'end of limitation', is
displayed on the instrument cluster
for the roads in Germany, which
have no speed limit applicable. It is
displayed, until the vehicle passes by
another speed limit sign.
6-99
Driving your vehicle
Display in the Assist mode of the
cluster
OOSH059207L
OOSH069095L
The driver can monitor the information
provided from the ISLW system on the
LCD display.
The ISLW screen will appear when you
select the Assist mode tab ( ) on the
LCD display if the system is activated.
For more details, refer to "LCD Display
Modes" section in chapter 4.
1. Speed limit and overtaking restriction
of current road
2. Conditional speed limit or overtaking
restriction
3. Conditional road sign: Trailer, rain,
snow or empty space
ÃÃ Empty space: other conditional road
sign (time ect.)
Information
The conditional speed limit and overtaking
restriction may be different from the speed
limit and overtaking restriction of current
road.
And, the conditional speed limit and
overtaking restriction displayed on the
cluster will disappear after driving for a
certain distance.
If ISLW don't recognize the road sign,
nothing is displayed.
6-100
06
To turn ISLW off
OOSH069098L
OOSH069096L
SLW (Speed Limit Warning) system off
If the system is turned off from the User
Settings mode, this message is displayed
on the cluster LCD display when the
ISLW screen is selected from the Assist
mode ( ).
Warning message
Check SLW (Speed Limit Warning)
system
The warning message appears for a
few seconds, when the ISLW does not
properly operate. Then, the master
warning light ( ) will illuminate.
We recommend that you have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of the system
The Intelligent Speed Limit Warning
(ISLW) system may not operate or may
not provide correct information in the
following situations.
OOSH069097L
SLW (Speed Limit Warning) system
disabled. Camera obscured
The warning message appears, when
the camera lens is blocked by some
objects. The ISLW does not operate
until the objects are removed. Check
the windshield glass around the camera
area. If the problem persists after
removing the objects, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When the traffic sign condition is poor
• The traffic sign is located on a sharp
curve.
• The traffic sign is improperly
positioned (i.e. turned over, blocked
by an object, and damaged).
• Another vehicle blocks the traffic sign.
• The LED light of the traffic sign is
broken.
• There is sunlight glare around the
traffic sign due to low solar altitude.
• It is dark at night.
• There is bright light around the traffic
sign.
6-101
Driving your vehicle
When external condition is intervened
• Your vehicle drives right after another
vehicle.
• The bus or truck, on which the speed
sticker is attached, passes by your
vehicle.
• Your vehicle drives in an area, which is
uncovered by the navigation system.
• There is a malfunction with the
navigation
• Your navigation has not been updated.
• Your navigation is being updated.
• As a result of incorrect detection by
the camera.
• The top speed limitations stored in the
navigation system are incorrect.
• The road signs do not correspond to
the standard.
• The camera is calibrated right after
the vehicle is delivered.
• There is something wrong with GPS.
• The vehicle information such as
outside temperature is not accurate.
6-102
When front visibility is poor
• The weather is bad, such as raining,
snowing, and fogging.
• There is dirt, ice or frost on the front
windshield, where the camera is
installed.
• The camera lens is blocked by an
object, such as sticker, paper, or fallen
leaf.
WARNING
• The ISLW is only to assist the driver.
The driver should pay great caution
to the vehicle operation.
• The driver always holds the
responsibility of safe driving by
following the applicable road traffic
rule(s) and regulation(s).
06
SPEED LIMIT CONTROL
Speed limit control operation
To set speed limit
You can set the speed limit when you do
not want to drive over a specific speed.
If you drive over the preset speed limit,
the warning system operates (set speed
limit will blink and chime will sound)
until the vehicle speed returns within the
speed limit.
Information
While speed limit control is in operation,
the cruise control system cannot be
activated.
Speed limit control switch
OOSH069100L
1. Press the
button to turn the
system on. The speed limit (
)
indicator in the instrument cluster will
illuminate.
Information
First, switch the mode to Cruise Control
button.
by pressing the
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Cruise Control /
Smart Cruise Control
OOSH069099L
Speed Limit Control
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
: Changes mode between
cruise control/smart cruise control
system and speed limit control system.
System off
Cruise Control /
Smart Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
RES+: Resumes or increases speed limit
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases speed limit
control speed.
O (CANCEL): Cancels set speed limit.
OOSH069105L
2. Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-).
6-103
Driving your vehicle
Information
OOSH069102L
3. Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+)
or down (SET-), and release it at the
desired speed.
Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+)
or down (SET-) and hold it. The speed
will increase or decrease by 5 km/h (3
mph).
If you would like to drive over the
preset speed limit when you depress the
accelerator pedal less than approximately
50%, the vehicle speed will maintain
within speed limit.
However, if you depress the accelerator
pedal more than approximately 70%, you
can drive over the speed limit. Then the set
speed limit will blink and chime will sound
until you return the vehicle speed within
the speed limit.
To turn off the speed limit control,
do one of the following:
OOSH069100L
OOSH069103L
The set speed limit (1) will display on the
instrument cluster.
6-104
• Press the
button. The speed
limit (
) indicator will go off.
• If you press O (CANCEL) button once,
the set speed limit will cancel, but it
will not turn the system off. If you wish
to resume the speed limit, push the
+RES or SET- toggle switch on your
steering wheel to your desired speed.
06
CRUISE CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)
Cruise control operation
OOSH069104L
1. Cruise indicator
2. Set speed
The Cruise Control system allows you
to drive at speeds above 30 km/h (20
mph) without depressing the accelerator
pedal.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• Always set the vehicle speed under
the speed limit in your country.
• If the Cruise Control is left on,
(cruise indicator light in the
instrument cluster is illuminated)
the Cruise Control can be activated
unintentionally. Keep the Cruise
Control system off (cruise indicator
light OFF) when the Cruise Control
is not in use, to avoid inadvertently
setting a speed.
• Use the Cruise Control system only
when traveling on open highways in
good weather.
• Do not use the Cruise Control when it
may be unsafe to keep the vehicle at
a constant speed:
-- When driving in heavy traffic or
when traffic conditions make it
difficult to drive at a constant
speed
-- When driving on rainy, icy, or
snow-covered roads
-- When driving on hilly or windy
roads
-- When driving in windy areas
-- When driving with limited view
(possibly due to bad weather such
as fog, snow, rain and sandstorm)
• Do not use cruise control when
towing a trailer.
Information
During normal cruise control operation,
when the SET switch is activated or
reactivated after applying the brakes,
the cruise control will energize after
approximately 3 seconds. This delay is
normal.
6-105
Driving your vehicle
Cruise control switch
To set Cruise Control speed
OOSH069099L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
: Changes mode between
cruise control/smart cruise control
system and speed limit control system.
System off
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
RES+: Resumes or increases speed limit
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases speed limit
control speed.
O (CANCEL): Cancels set speed limit.
OOSH069100L
1. Press the
button on the
steering wheel to turn the system on.
The cruise indicator will illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed,
which must be more than 30 km/h
(20 mph).
Information
First, switch the mode to Cruise Control
button if
by pressing the
equipped with the Speed Limit Control
System.
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
6-106
06
To increase Cruise Control speed
OOSH069105L
3. Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-), and release it. The set speed
on the LCD display will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
Information
On a steep slope, the vehicle may slightly
slow down or speed up, while driving
uphill or downhill.
OOSH069106L
• Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+)
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will increase 1.0 km/h
(1.0 mph) each time the toggle switch
is operated in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+)
and hold it, while monitoring the set
speed on the instrument cluster.
Release the toggle switch when
the desired speed is shown and the
vehicle will accelerate to that speed.
• Depress the accelerator pedal. When
the vehicle attains the desired speed,
push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-).
6-107
Driving your vehicle
To decrease Cruise Control speed
Cruise Control will be canceled
when:
OOSH069105L
• Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-) and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will decrease 1.0 km/h
(1.0 mph) each time the toggle switch
is operated in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) down (SET-)
and hold it. Your vehicle will gradually
slow down. Release the toggle switch
at the speed you want to maintain.
• Lightly tap the brake pedal. When
the vehicle attains the desired speed,
push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-).
To temporarily accelerate with the
Cruise Control ON
Depress the accelerator pedal. When you
take your foot off the accelerator, the
vehicle will return to the previously set
speed.
If you push the toggle switch down
(SET-) at the increased speed, the Cruise
Control will maintain the increased
speed.
6-108
OOSH069107L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
• Depressing the brake pedal.
• Pressing the O (CANCEL) button
located on the steering wheel.
• Moving the shift lever into N (Neutral).
• Decreasing the vehicle speed to
less than the memory speed by
approximately 20 km/h (12 mph).
• Decreasing the vehicle speed to less
than approximately 30 km/h (20 mph).
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
operating.
• Downshifting to 2nd gear when in
Manual Shift mode.
06
To turn Cruise Control off
Information
Each of the above actions will cancel
Cruise Control operation (the set speed
on the instrument cluster will go off), but
button will
only pressing the
turn the system off. If you wish to resume
Cruise Control operation, push the toggle
switch up (RES+) located on your steering
wheel. You will return to your previously
preset speed, unless the system was turned
button.
off using the
To resume preset Cruising speed
OOSH069106L
Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+). If
the vehicle speed is over 30 km/h
(20 mph), the vehicle will resume the
preset speed.
OOSH069100L
• Press the
button (The
indicator light will go off.).
-- With the Cruise Control on, pressing
the button once will turn Off the
Cruise Control and turn on the
Speed Limit Control.
-- With the Cruise Control off and
Speed Limit Control on, pressing
the button will turn off both system.
Information
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
6-109
Driving your vehicle
SMART CRUISE CONTROL WITH STOP & GO (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
For your safety, please read the owner's
manual before using the Smart Cruise
Control system.
WARNING
OOSH069108L
(1) Cruise indicator
(2) Set speed
(3) Vehicle-to-vehicle distance
To see the SCC screen on the LCD display
in the cluster, select Assist mode ( ).
For more details, refer to "LCD Display
Modes" section in chapter 4.
The Smart Cruise Control system
allows you to program the vehicle to
help maintain the desired speed and
minimum distance between the vehicle
ahead.
The Smart Cruise Control system will
automatically adjust your vehicle speed
to maintain your programmed speed
and following distance without requiring
you to depress the accelerator or brake
pedals.
6-110
The Smart Cruise Control system is not
a substitute for safe driving practices,
but a convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver to always
check the speed and distance to the
vehicle ahead.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• Always set the vehicle speed under
the speed limit in your country.
• If the Smart Cruise Control is left on,
) indicator light in
(cruise (
the instrument cluster is illuminated)
the Smart Cruise Control can be
activated unintentionally. Keep the
Smart Cruise Control system off
) indicator light
(cruise (
OFF) when the Smart Cruise Control
is not in use, to avoid inadvertently
setting a speed.
• Use the Smart Cruise Control
system only when traveling on open
highways in good weather.
06
• Do not use the Smart Cruise Control
when it may not be safe to keep the
vehicle at a constant speed:
-- When driving in heavy traffic or
when traffic conditions make it
difficult to drive at a constant
speed
-- When driving on rainy, icy, or
snow-covered roads
-- When driving on a steep downhill
or uphill
-- When driving in windy areas
-- When driving in parking lots
-- When driving near crash barriers
-- When driving on a sharp curve
-- When driving with limited view
(possibly due to bad weather, such
as fog, snow, rain or sandstorm)
-- When the vehicle sensing
ability decreases due to vehicle
modification resulting level
difference of the vehicle's front
and rear
• Unexpected situations may lead to
possible accidents. Pay attention
continuously to road conditions and
driving even when the smart cruise
control system is being operated.
Smart cruise control switch
OOSH069109L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
: Changes mode between
smart cruise control system and speed
limit control system.
System off
Smart Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
RES+: Resumes or increases speed limit
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases speed limit
control speed.
O (CANCEL): Cancels set speed limit.
: Sets vehicle-to-vehicle distance.
6-111
Driving your vehicle
To adjust the sensitivity of Smart
Cruise Control
Information
The last selected speed sensitivity of the
smart cruise control is remained in the
system.
To convert to Cruise Control
mode
OOSH069121L
The sensitivity of vehicle speed when
following the front vehicle to maintain
the set distance can be adjusted. Select
'User settings → Driver assistance → SCC
response → Fast/Normal/Slow' in the
cluster LCD display.
You may select one of the three stages
you prefer.
-- Fast: Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance is
faster than normal speed.
-- Normal: Vehicle speed following
the front vehicle to maintain the set
distance is normal.
-- Slow: Vehicle speed following the
front vehicle to maintain the set
distance is slower than normal speed.
6-112
The driver may choose to switch to
use the conventional Cruise Control
mode (speed only control function) by
following these steps:
1. Press the
button on the
steering wheel to turn the system on.
) indicator will
The cruise (
illuminate.
2. Press and hold the Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance button for more than 2
seconds.
3. Choose between "Smart Cruise
Control" and "Cruise Control".
When the system is cancelled using the
button or the
button
is used after the vehicle is in the ready
( ) mode, the Smart Cruise Control
mode will turn on.
WARNING
When using the conventional Cruise
Control mode, you must manually
adjust the distance to other vehicles by
depressing the brake pedal. The system
does not automatically adjust the
distance to vehicles in front of you.
06
Smart Cruise Control speed
To set Smart Cruise Control speed
OOSH069105L
OOSH069100L
1. Push the
button on the
steering wheel to turn the system on.
) indicator will
The cruise (
illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.
The Smart Cruise Control speed can
be set when vehicle speed is between
as follows.
• 10 ~ 160 km/h (6 ~ 100 mph): when
there is no vehicle in front
• 0 ~ 160 km/h (0 ~ 100 mph): when
there is a vehicle in front
Information
First, switch the mode to Smart Cruise
button
Control by pressing the
if equipped with the Speed Limit Control
System.
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
3. Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-). The Set Speed and Vehicle-toVehicle Distance on the LCD display
will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal. The
desired speed will automatically be
maintained.
If there is a vehicle in front of you, the
speed may decrease to maintain the
distance to the vehicle ahead.
On a steep grade, the vehicle may slow
down or speed up slightly while going
uphill or downhill.
Information
• Vehicle speed may decrease on an
upward slope and increase on a
downward slope.
• When you are setting the cruise control
speed, with a vehicle in front and your
vehicle speed is between 0~ 30 km/h (0
~ 20 mph), the speed will set to 30 km/h
(20 mph).
Smart Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
6-113
Driving your vehicle
To increase Smart Cruise Control set
speed
OOSH069106L
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+),
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will increase by 1 km/h
(1 mph) each time you move the
toggle switch up in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) up (RES+),
and hold it. Your vehicle set speed will
increase by 10 km/h (5 mph). Release
the toggle switch at the speed you
want.
• You can set the speed to 160 km/h
(100 mph).
CAUTION
Check the driving condition before
using the toggle switch. Driving speed
sharply increases, when you push up
and hold the toggle switch.
6-114
To decrease the Smart Cruise
Control set speed
OOSH069105L
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-), and release it immediately.
The cruising speed will decrease by 1
km/h (1 mph) each time you move the
toggle switch down in this manner.
• Push the toggle switch (1) down
(SET-), and hold it. Your vehicle set
speed will decrease by 10 km/h (5
mph). Release the toggle switch at the
speed you want.
• You can set the speed to 30 km/h (20
mph).
To temporarily accelerate with the
Smart Cruise Control on
If you want to speed up temporarily
when the Smart Cruise Control is on,
depress the accelerator pedal. Increased
speed will not interfere with Smart Cruise
Control operation or change the set
speed.
To return to the set speed, take your foot
off the accelerator pedal.
If you push the toggle switch down (SET) at increased speed, the cruising speed
will be set again.
06
Information
Be careful when accelerating temporarily,
because the speed is not controlled
automatically at this time even if there is a
vehicle in front of you.
Smart Cruise Control will be
temporarily cancelled when:
OOSH069107L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
Cancelled manually
• Depressing the brake pedal.
• Pressing the O (CANCEL) button
located on the steering wheel.
The Smart Cruise Control turns off
temporarily when the Set Speed and
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance indicator on
the cluster LCD display turns off.
) indicator is
The cruise (
illuminated continuously.
Cancelled automatically
• The driver's door is opened.
• The shift lever is shifted to N (Neutral),
R (Reverse) or P (Park).
• EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) is
applied.
• The vehicle speed is over 170 km/h
(100 mph).
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control), TCS
(Traction Control System) or ABS is
operating.
• ESC is turned off.
• The sensor or the cover is dirty or
blocked with foreign matter.
• The vehicle is stopped for more than
5 minutes.
• The vehicle stops and goes repeatedly
for a long period of time.
• The accelerator pedal is continuously
depressed for a long period of time.
• The engine performance is abnormal.
• Engine rpm is in the red zone.
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator
pedal, after the vehicle is stopped by
the Smart Cruise Control system with
no other vehicle ahead.
6-115
Driving your vehicle
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator
pedal, after stopping the vehicle with
a vehicle stopped far away in front.
• The braking control is operated for
FCA (Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist).
Each of these actions will cancel the
Smart Cruise Control operation. The Set
Speed and Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance
on the LCD display will go off.
In a condition the Smart Cruise Control
is cancelled automatically, the Smart
Cruise Control will not resume even
though the RES+ or SET- toggle switch is
pushed.
Also, if the Smart Cruise Control is
cancelled automatically while the vehicle
is at a standstill, EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) will be applied.
Information
If the Smart Cruise Control is cancelled
by other than the reasons mentioned, we
recommend that the system be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OOSH069110L
SCC (Smart Cruise Control) cancelled
If the system is cancelled, the warning
chime will sound and a message will
appear for a few seconds.
You must adjust the vehicle speed by
depressing the accelerator or brake
pedal according to the road condition
ahead and driving condition.
Always check the road conditions. Do not
rely on the warning chime.
To resume Smart Cruise Control set
speed
If any method other than the cruise
toggle switch was used to cancel
cruising speed and the system is still
activated, the cruising speed will
automatically resume when you push the
toggle switch up (RES+) or down (SET-).
If you push the toggle switch up (RES+),
the speed will resume to the recently set
speed. However, if vehicle speed drops
below 10 km/h (5 mph), it will resume
when there is a vehicle in front of your
vehicle.
Information
Always check the road conditions when
you push the toggle switch up (RES+) to
resume speed.
6-116
06
Smart Cruise Control Vehicle-toVehicle Distance
To turn Cruise Control off
To set Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance
OOSH069100L
• Press the
button (The
) indicator light will go
(
off.). (if equipped with Speed Limit
Control)
-- With the Smart Cruise Control on,
pressing the button once will turn
Off the Smart Cruise Control and
turn on the Speed Limit Control.
-- With the Smart Cruise Control
off and Speed Limit Control on,
pressing the button will turn off
both system.
Information
The mode changes, as below, whenever the
button is pressed.
System off
OOSH069111L
[A] : Type A, [B] : Type B
When the Smart Cruise Control system
is ON, you can set and maintain the
distance from the vehicle ahead of you
without pressing the accelerator or brake
pedal.
Each time the button is pressed, the
vehicle to vehicle distance changes as
follows:
Distance 4
Distance 3
Distance 2
Distance 1
Smart Cruise Control
Speed Limit Control
6-117
Driving your vehicle
For example, if you drive at 90 km/h
(56 mph), the distance is maintained as
follows:
When there is a vehicle ahead of you
in your lane:
Distance 4 - approximately 52.5 m
Distance 3 - approximately 40 m
Distance 2 - approximately 32.5 m
Distance 1 - approximately 25 m
Information
The distance is set to the last set distance
when the system is used for the first time
after the vehicle is in the ready ( ) mode.
Distance 4
OOSH069113L
Distance 3
OOSH069114L
When the lane ahead is clear:
Distance 2
OOSH069115L
OOSH069112L
The vehicle speed will maintain the set
speed.
6-118
Distance 1
OOSH069116L
• Your vehicle speed will slow down or
speed up to maintain the selected
distance.
• If the vehicle ahead speeds up, your
vehicle will travel at a steady cruising
speed after accelerating to the set
speed.
• If distance from the front vehicle has
been changed due to accelerating
or decelerating of the front vehicle,
the distance on the LCD display may
change.
06
WARNING
CAUTION
OOSH069037L
When using the Smart Cruise Control
system:
• The warning message appears and
warning chime sounds if the vehicle
is unable to maintain the selected
distance from the vehicle ahead.
• If the warning message appears and
warning chime sounds, depress the
brake pedal to actively adjust the
vehicle speed, and the distance to
the vehicle ahead.
• Even if the warning message does
not appear and warning chime does
not sound, always pay attention to
the driving conditions to prevent
dangerous situations from occurring.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system warning
sounds.
OOSH069117L
If the vehicle ahead (vehicle speed:
less than 30 km/h (20 mph)) disappears
to the next lane, the warning chime
will sound and a message "Watch for
surrounding vehicles" will appear.
Adjust your vehicle speed for vehicles
or objects that can suddenly appear in
front of you by depressing the brake
pedal.
Always pay attention to the road
condition ahead.
6-119
Driving your vehicle
Sensor to detect distance to the
vehicle ahead
In traffic situation
OOSH069118L
Use switch or pedal to accelerate
• In traffic, your vehicle will stop if the
vehicle ahead of you stops. Also,
if the vehicle ahead of you starts
moving, your vehicle will start as well.
However, if the vehicle stops for more
than 3 seconds, you must depress
the accelerator pedal or push up the
toggle switch (RES+) to start driving.
• If you push the smart cruise control
toggle switch (RES+ or SET-) while
Auto Hold and smart cruise control
is operating the Auto Hold will be
released regardless of accelerator
pedal operation and the vehicle
will start to move. The AUTO HOLD
indicator changes from green to
white.
6-120
OOSH069039L
The Smart Cruise Control uses a sensor
to detect distance to the vehicle ahead.
If the sensor is covered with dirt or
other foreign matter, the vehicle to
vehicle distance control may not operate
correctly.
Always keep the sensor clean.
06
NOTICE
Warning message
OOSH069119L
SCC (Smart Cruise Control) disabled.
Radar blocked
When the sensor lens cover is blocked
with dirt, snow, or debris, the Smart
Cruise Control system operation may
stop temporarily. If this occurs, a warning
message will appear on the cluster
LCD display. Remove any dirt, snow, or
debris and clean the radar sensor lens
cover before operating the Smart Cruise
Control system. The Smart Cruise Control
system may not properly activate, if
the radar is totally covered, or if any
substance is not detected after the
vehicle is in the ready ( ) mode (e.g. in
an open terrain).
Information
For the SCC operation is temporarily
stopped if the radar is blocked, but you
wish to use cruise control mode (speed
control function), you must convert to the
cruise control mode (refer to "To convert
to Cruise Control mode" in the following
page.
• Do not apply license plate frame or
foreign objects such as a bumper
sticker or a bumper guard near the
radar sensor. Doing so may adversely
affect the sensing performance of
the radar.
• Always keep the radar sensor and
lens cover clean and free of dirt and
debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized
water directly on the sensor or
sensor cover.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly
moved out of proper alignment,
the Smart Cruise Control system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around the
radar sensor, the Smart Cruise
Control system may not operate
properly. We recommend you to
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine HYUNDAI parts to
repair or replace a damaged sensor
or sensor cover. Do not apply paint to
the sensor cover.
6-121
Driving your vehicle
Limitations of the system
The Smart Cruise Control system
may have limits to its ability to detect
distance to the vehicle ahead due to road
and traffic conditions.
On curves
OOSH069120L
Check SCC (Smart Cruise Control)
system
The message will appear when the
vehicle to vehicle distance control
system is not functioning normally.
We recommend that you take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked.
6-122
OOSH069043L
• The Smart Cruise Control system may
not detect a moving vehicle in your
lane, and then your vehicle could
accelerate to the set speed. Also, the
vehicle speed will decrease when the
vehicle ahead is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on curves and apply the brakes or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
06
Lane changing
OOSH069044L
Your vehicle speed can be reduced due
to a vehicle in the adjacent lane.
Apply the accelerator pedal and select
the appropriate set speed. Check to be
sure that the road conditions permit safe
operation of the Smart Cruise Control.
On inclines
OOSH069046L
• A vehicle which moves into your lane
from an adjacent lane cannot be
recognized by the sensor until it is in
the sensor's detection range.
• The radar may not detect immediately
when a vehicle cuts in suddenly.
Always pay attention to the traffic,
road and driving conditions.
• If a slower vehicle moves into your
lane, your speed may decrease to
maintain the distance to the vehicle
ahead.
• If a faster vehicle which moves into
your lane, your vehicle will accelerate
to the set speed.
OOSH069045L
• During uphill or downhill driving, the
Smart Cruise Control system may not
detect a moving vehicle in your lane,
and cause your vehicle to accelerate
to the set speed. Also, the vehicle
speed will rapidly decrease when the
vehicle ahead is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on inclines and apply the brake or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
6-123
Driving your vehicle
Vehicle recognition
OOSH069124L
OOSH069123L
• Some vehicles in your lane cannot be
recognized by the sensor:
-- Narrow vehicles such as
motorcycles or bicycles
-- Vehicles offset to one side
-- Slow-moving vehicles or suddendecelerating vehicles
-- Stopped vehicles
-- Vehicles with small rear profile such
as trailers with no loads
• A vehicle ahead cannot be recognized
correctly by the sensor if any of
following occurs:
-- When the vehicle is pointing
upwards due to overloading in the
luggage compartment
-- While the steering wheel is
operating
-- When driving to one side of the lane
-- When driving on narrow lanes or on
curves
Apply the brake or accelerator pedal if
necessary.
6-124
• Your vehicle may accelerate when a
vehicle ahead of you disappears.
• When you are warned that the vehicle
ahead of you is not detected, drive
with caution.
OOSH069125L
• When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a vehicle in front of you merges
out of the lane, the system may not
immediately detect the new vehicle
that is now in front of you. In this case,
you must maintain a safe braking
distance, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain a safe
distance.
06
WARNING
OOSH069126L
• Always look out for pedestrians when
your vehicle is maintaining a distance
with the vehicle ahead.
OOSH069048L
• Always be cautious for vehicles with
higher height or vehicles carrying
loads that sticks out from the back of
the vehicle.
When using the Smart Cruise Control
take the following precautions:
• If an emergency stop is necessary,
you must apply the brakes. The
vehicle cannot be stopped at every
emergency situation by using the
Smart Cruise Control system.
• Keep a safe distance according to
road conditions and vehicle speed. If
the vehicle to vehicle distance is too
close during a high-speed driving, a
serious collision may result.
• Always maintain sufficient braking
distance and decelerate your vehicle
by applying the brakes if necessary.
• The Smart Cruise Control system
cannot recognize a stopped vehicle,
pedestrians or an oncoming vehicle.
Always look ahead cautiously to
prevent unexpected and sudden
situations from occurring.
• Vehicles moving in front of you with
a frequent lane change may cause
a delay in the system's reaction or
may cause the system to react to a
vehicle actually in an adjacent lane.
Always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring.
6-125
Driving your vehicle
• Always be aware of the selected
speed and vehicle to vehicle
distance. The driver should not solely
rely on the system but always pay
attention to driving conditions and
control your vehicle speed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system
may not recognize complex driving
situations so always pay attention to
driving conditions and control your
vehicle speed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system
may recognize a pedestrian, bicycle,
motorcycle, etc. as a vehicle. Always,
look ahead cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring.
• Turn off the Smart Cruise Control
system when the vehicle is being
towed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system
may operate limitedly when towing
a trailer or vehicle so always drive
cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring.
6-126
NOTICE
The Smart Cruise Control system may
not operate temporarily due to:
• Electrical interference
• Modifying the suspension
• Differences of tire abrasion or tire
pressure
• Installing different type of tires
06
LEADING VEHICLE DEPARTURE ALERT (IF EQUIPPED)
The Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
system alerts the driver of the departure
of the vehicle in front when the vehicle
is stopped and the Smart Cruise Control
(SCC) system is operating.
System activation
System setting and activation
System setting
• Selecting Driver Attention Warning
function
The Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
can be activated from Users Settings
mode in the cluster LCD display by
following the procedure below.
1. Set the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Select 'User settings → Driver
assistance → Driving assist →
Leading vehicle departure alert' in
cluster LCD display. Deselect the
setting to turn off the system.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the last
setting.
System standby
OOSH069127L
Leading vehicle is driving away
If the driver does not take action for a
certain period of time after the vehicle in
front departs, the message is displayed
on the cluster.
The vehicle departs automatically if the
accelerator pedal is depressed or RES+
or SET- toggle switch is pushed up or
down when there is a vehicle in front.
The Smart Cruise Control (SCC) system
is deactivated if the accelerator pedal is
depressed or RES+ or SET- toggle switch
is pushed up or down when there is no
vehicle in front.
WARNING
Always check the front of the vehicle
and road conditions before departure.
OOSH069118L
Use switch or pedal to accelerate
While the Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
system is operating, your vehicle stops
behind the vehicle in front when it stops.
The message is displayed on the cluster
within 3 seconds after the stop and the
system will be in the standby position.
6-127
Driving your vehicle
SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS
Hazardous driving conditions
When hazardous driving elements
are encountered such as water, snow,
ice, mud and sand, take the following
precautions:
• Drive cautiously and maintain a longer
braking distance.
• Avoid abrupt braking or steering.
• When your vehicle is stuck in
snow, mud, or sand, use second
gear. Accelerate slowly to avoid
unnecessary wheel spin.
• Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or other
non-slip materials under the wheels to
provide additional traction while the
vehicle becomes stuck in ice, snow,
or mud.
WARNING
Downshifting with an dual clutch
transmission while driving on slippery
surfaces can cause an accident. The
sudden change in tire speed could
cause the tires to skid. Be careful when
downshifting on slippery surfaces.
Rocking the vehicle
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle to
free it from snow, sand, or mud, first turn
the steering wheel right and left to clear
the area around your front wheels. Then,
shift back and forth between R (Reverse)
and a forward gear.
Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and do
not race the engine.
To prevent transmission wear, wait until
the wheels stop spinning before shifting
gears. Release the accelerator pedal
while shifting, and press lightly on the
accelerator pedal while the transmission
is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in
forward and reverse directions causes a
rocking motion that may free the vehicle.
6-128
WARNING
If the vehicle is stuck and excessive
wheel spin occurs, the temperature
in the tires can increase very quickly.
If the tires become damaged, a tire
blow out or tire explosion can occur.
This condition is dangerous - you and
others may be injured. Do not attempt
this procedure if people or objects are
anywhere near the vehicle.
If you attempt to free the vehicle, the
vehicle can overheat quickly, possibly
causing an engine compartment fire
or other damage. Try to avoid spinning
the wheels as much as possible to
prevent overheating of either the tires
or the engine. DO NOT allow the vehicle
to spin the wheels above 56 km/h (35
mph).
Information
The ESC system (if equipped) must be
turned OFF before rocking the vehicle.
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking the
vehicle a few times, have the vehicle
pulled out by a tow vehicle to avoid
engine overheating, possible damage to
the transmission, and tire damage. See
“Towing” section in chapter 7.
06
Smooth cornering
Driving in the rain
Avoid braking or gear changing in
corners, especially when roads are wet.
Ideally, corners should always be taken
under gentle acceleration.
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or on
slick pavement:
• Slow down and allow extra following
distance. A heavy rainfall makes
it harder to see and increases the
distance needed to stop your vehicle.
• Turn OFF your Cruise Control. (if
equipped)
• Replace your windshield wiper blades
when they show signs of streaking or
missing areas on the windshield.
• Be sure your tires have enough tread.
If your tires do not have enough tread,
making a quick stop on wet pavement
can cause a skid and possibly lead to
an accident. See “Tire Tread” section
in chapter 8.
• Turn on your headlamps to make it
easier for others to see you.
• Driving too fast through large puddles
can affect your brakes. If you must go
through puddles, try to drive through
them slowly.
• If you believe your brakes may be wet,
apply them lightly while driving until
normal braking operation returns.
Driving at night
Night driving presents more hazards than
driving in the daylight. Here are some
important tips to remember:
• Slow down and keep more distance
between you and other vehicles, as it
may be more difficult to see at night,
especially in areas where there may
not be any street lights.
• Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glare
from other drivers’ headlamps.
• Keep your headlamps clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlamps will make it much
more difficult to see at night.
• Avoid staring directly at the
headlamps of oncoming vehicles. You
could be temporarily blinded, and it
will take several seconds for your eyes
to readjust to the darkness.
6-129
Driving your vehicle
Hydroplaning
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the water.
The best advice is SLOW DOWN when
the road is wet.
The risk of hydroplaning increases as
the depth of tire tread decreases, refer
to “Tire Tread” section in chapter 8.
Driving in flooded areas
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel hub.
Drive through any water slowly. Allow
adequate stopping distance because
brake performance may be reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several
times while the vehicle is moving slowly.
Highway driving
Tires
Adjust the tire inflation, as specified.
Under-inflation may overheat or damage
the tires.
Do not install worn-out or damaged tires,
which may reduce traction or fail the
braking operation.
Information
Never over-inflate your tires above the
maximum inflation pressure, as specified
on your tires.
Fuel, engine coolant and engine oil
Driving at higher speeds on the highway
consumes more fuel and is less efficient
than driving at a slower, more moderate
speed. Maintain a moderate speed in
order to conserve fuel when driving on
the highway.
Be sure to check both the engine coolant
level and the engine oil before driving.
Drive belt
A loose or damaged drive belt may
overheat the engine.
6-130
06
WINTER DRIVING
The severe weather conditions of winter
quickly wear out tires and cause other
problems. To minimize winter driving
problems, you should take the following
suggestions:
Information
Information for Snow Tires and
Tire Chains in the national language
(Bulgarian, Hungarian, Icelandic, Polish)
is provided in the Appendix.
Snow or icy conditions
You need to keep sufficient distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front of you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding, rapid
acceleration, sudden brake applications,
and sharp turns are potentially
very hazardous practices. During
deceleration, use engine braking to the
fullest extent. Sudden brake applications
on snowy or icy roads may cause the
vehicle to skid.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it
may be necessary to use snow tires or to
install tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment.
Some of the items you may want to carry
include tire chains, tow straps or chains,
a flashlight, emergency flares, sand, a
shovel, jumper cables, a window scraper,
gloves, ground cloth, coveralls, a blanket,
etc.
Snow tires
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent in size
and type to the vehicle’s standard tires.
Otherwise, the safety and handling of
your vehicle may be adversely affected.
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle,
make sure to use radial tires of the same
size and load range as the original tires.
Mount snow tires on all four wheels
to balance your vehicle’s handling in
all weather conditions. The traction
provided by snow tires on dry roads
may not be as high as your vehicle’s
original equipment tires. Check with
the tire dealer for maximum speed
recommendations.
Information
Do not install studded tires without first
checking local and municipal regulations
for possible restrictions against their use.
6-131
Driving your vehicle
Tire chains
WARNING
OOSH069128L
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them. Therefore,
the use of snow tires is recommended
instead of tire chains. If tire chains must
be used, use genuine HYUNDAI parts
and install the tire chain after reviewing
the instructions provided with the tire
chains. Damage to your vehicle caused
by improper tire chain use is not covered
by your vehicle manufacturer’s warranty.
6-132
The use of tire chains may adversely
affect vehicle handling:
• Drive less than 30 km/h (20 mph)
or the chain manufacturer’s
recommended speed limit,
whichever is lower.
• Drive carefully and avoid bumps,
holes, sharp turns, and other road
hazards, which may cause the
vehicle to bounce.
• Avoid sharp turns or locked wheel
braking.
Information
• Install tire chains only in pairs and on
the front tires. It should be noted that
installing tire chains on the tires will
provide a greater driving force, but will
not prevent side skids.
• Do not install studded tires without
first checking local and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions
against their use.
06
Chain Installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer’s instructions and mount
them as tightly possible. Drive slowly
(less than 30 km/h (20 mph)) with
chains installed. If you hear the chains
contacting the body or chassis, stop and
tighten them. If they still make contact,
slow down until the noise stops. Remove
the tire chains as soon as you begin
driving on cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park the
vehicle on level ground away from traffic.
Turn on the vehicle Hazard Warning
Flasher and place a triangular emergency
warning device behind the vehicle (if
available). Always place the vehicle in P
(Park), apply the parking brake and turn
off the engine before installing snow
chains.
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
• Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage your
vehicle’s brake lines, suspension,
body and wheels.
• Use SAE “S” class or wire chains.
• If you hear noise caused by chains
contacting the body, retighten the
chain to prevent contact with the
vehicle body.
• To prevent body damage, retighten
the chains after driving 0.5~1.0 km
(0.3~0.6 miles).
• Do not use tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels. If
unavoidable, use a wire type chain.
• Use wire chains less than 12 mm (0.47
in) thick to prevent damage to the
chain’s connection.
Winter Precautions
Use high quality ethylene glycol coolant
Your vehicle is delivered with high
quality ethylene glycol coolant in the
cooling system. It is the only type of
coolant that should be used because it
helps prevent corrosion in the cooling
system, lubricates the water pump and
prevents freezing. Be sure to replace or
replenish your coolant in accordance
with the maintenance schedule in
chapter 8. Before winter, have your
coolant tested to assure that its freezing
point is sufficient for the temperatures
anticipated during the winter.
Check battery and cables
Winter temperatures affect battery
performance. Inspect the battery and
cables, as specified in chapter 8. The
battery charging level can be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or in a
service station.
Change to “winter weight” oil if
necessary
In some regions during winter, it is
recommended to use the “winter
weight” oil with lower viscosity. For
further information, refer to chapter 2.
When you are not sure about a type of
winter weight oil, consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
6-133
Driving your vehicle
Check spark plugs and ignition system
Inspect the spark plugs, as specified in
chapter 8. If necessary, replace them.
Also check all ignition wirings and
components for any cracks, wear-out,
and damage.
To prevent locks from freezing
To prevent the locks from being frozen,
spray approved de-icing fluid or glycerin
into key holes. When a lock opening is
already covered with ice, spray approved
de-icing fluid over the ice to remove it.
When an internal part of a lock freezes,
try to thaw it with a heated key. Carefully
use the heated key to avoid an injury.
Use approved window washer antifreeze solution in system
To prevent the window washer from
being frozen, add authorized window
washer anti-freeze solution, as specified
on the window washer container.
Window washer anti-freeze solution is
available from an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer, and most vehicle accessory
outlets. Do not use engine coolant or
other types of anti-freeze solution, to
prevent any damage to the vehicle paint.
Do not let your parking brake freeze
Under some conditions your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged position.
This is most likely to happen when there
is an accumulation of snow or ice around
or near the rear brakes or if the brakes
are wet. When there is the risk that your
parking brake may freeze, temporarily
apply it with the shift lever in P (Park).
Also, block the rear wheels in advance,
so the vehicle may not roll. Then, release
the parking brake.
Do not let ice and snow accumulate
underneath
Under some conditions, snow and ice
can build up under the fenders and
interfere with the steering. When driving
in such conditions during the severe
winter, you should check underneath
the vehicle on a regular basis, to ensure
that the front wheels and the steering
components is unblocked.
Carry emergency equipment
In accordance with weather conditions,
you should carry appropriate emergency
equipment, while driving. Some of the
items you may want to carry include tire
chains, tow straps or chains, flashlight,
emergency flares, sand, shovel, jumper
cables, window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, blanket, etc.
Do not place objects or materials in the
engine compartment
Putting objects or materials in the engine
compartment may cause an engine
failure or combustion, because they may
block the engine cooling. Such damage
will not be covered by the manufacturer’s
warranty.
6-134
06
TRAILER TOWING (FOR EUROPE)
If you are considering to tow with your
vehicle, you should first your country’s
legal requirements. As laws vary the
requirements for towing trailers, cars, or
other types of vehicles or apparatus may
differ. Ask an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for further details before towing.
Remember that trailering is different
than just driving your vehicle by
itself. Trailering means changes in
handling, durability, and fuel economy.
Successful, safe trailering requires
correct equipment, and it has to be used
properly. Damage to your vehicle caused
by improper trailer towing is not covered
by your vehicle manufacturer’s warranty.
This section contains many time-tested,
important trailering tips and safety
rules. Many of these are important for
your safety and that of your passengers.
Please read this section carefully before
you pull a trailer.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• If you don’t use the correct
equipment and/or drive improperly,
you can lose control of the vehicle
when you are pulling a trailer. For
example, if the trailer is too heavy,
the braking performance may be
reduced. You and your passengers
could be seriously or fatally injured.
Pull a trailer only if you have followed
all the steps in this section.
• Before towing, make sure the
total trailer weight, GCW (Gross
Combination Weight), GVW (Gross
Vehicle Weight), GAW (Gross Axle
Weight) and trailer tongue load are
all within the limits.
Information - For Europe
• The technically permissible maximum
load on the rear axle(s) may be
exceeded by not more than 15 % and
the technically permissible maximum
laden mass of the vehicle may be
exceeded by not more than 10% or 100
kg (220.4 lbs), whichever value is lower.
In this case, do not exceed 100 km/h
(62.1 mph) for vehicle of category M1
or 80 km/h (49.7 mph) for vehicle of
category N1.
• When a vehicle of category M1 is
towing a trailer, the additional load
imposed at the trailer coupling device
may cause the tire maximum load
ratings to be exceeded, but not by more
than 15%. In this case, do not exceed
100 km/h (62.1 mph) and increase the
tire inflation pressure by at least 0.2
bar.
If you decide to pull a trailer?
Here are some important points if you
decide to pull a trailer:
• Consider using a sway control. You can
ask a trailer hitch dealer about sway
control.
• Do not do any towing with your
vehicle during its first 2,000 km (1,200
miles) in order to allow the engine to
properly break in. Failure to heed this
caution may result in serious engine or
transmission damage.
• When towing a trailer, be sure to
consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for further information on additional
requirements such as a towing kit, etc.
• Always drive your vehicle at a
moderate speed (less than 100 km/h
(60 mph)) or posted towing speed
limit.
• On a long uphill grade, do not exceed
70 km/h (45 mph) or the posted
towing speed limit, whichever is lower.
• Carefully observe the weight and load
limits provided in the following pages.
6-135
Driving your vehicle
Trailer weight
After you’ve loaded your trailer,
weigh the trailer and then the tongue,
separately, to see if the weights are
proper. If they aren’t, you may be able
to correct them simply by moving some
items around in the trailer.
WARNING
Tongue Load
Total Trailer Weight
OOSH069129L
What is the maximum safe weight of a
trailer? It should never weigh more than
the maximum trailer weight with trailer
brakes. But even that can be too heavy.
It depends on how you plan to use your
trailer. For example, speed, altitude,
road grades, outside temperature and
how often your vehicle is used to pull a
trailer are all important. The ideal trailer
weight can also depend on any special
equipment that you have on your vehicle.
Information
Tongue load
Gross Axle Weight
With increasing altitude the engine
performance decreases. From 1,000 m
above sea level and for every 1,000 m
thereafter 10% of vehicle/trailer weight
(trailer weighter + gross vehicle weight)
must be deducted.
Gross Vehicle Weight
OOSH069130L
The tongue load is an important weight
to measure because it affects the
total Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) of
your vehicle. The trailer tongue should
weigh a maximum of 10% of the total
loaded trailer weight, within the limits
of the maximum trailer tongue load
permissible.
6-136
Take the following precautions:
• Never load a trailer with more weight
in the rear than in the front. The front
should be loaded with approximately
60% of the total trailer load; the rear
should be loaded with approximately
40% of the total trailer load.
• Never exceed the maximum weight
limits of the trailer or trailer towing
equipment. Improper loading can
result in damage to your vehicle and/
or personal injury. Check weights
and loading at a commercial scale or
highway patrol office equipped with
scales.
06
Reference weight and distance when towing a trailer (for Europe)
Without trailer
package
With trailer
package
-
1300 (2866)
-
600 (1323)
Maximum permissible static vertical load on the
coupling device
kg (Ibs.)
-
80 (176)
Recommended distance from rear wheel center to
coupling point
mm (inch)
-
820 (32.3)
ltem
With brake system
Maximum trailer weight
kg (Ibs.) Without brake
system
6-137
Driving your vehicle
Trailer towing equipment
Hitches
Safety chains
You should always attach chains between
your vehicle and your trailer.
Instructions about safety chains may
be provided by the hitch manufacturer
or trailer manufacturer. Follow the
manufacturer’s recommendation for
attaching safety chains. Always leave just
enough slack so you can turn with your
trailer. And, never allow safety chains to
drag on the ground.
Trailer brakes
OOSH069131L
Information
The mounting hole for hitches are located
on both sides of the underbody behind the
rear tires.
It’s important to have the correct hitch
equipment. Crosswinds, large trucks
going by, and rough roads are a few
reasons why you’ll need the right hitch.
Here are some rules to follow:
• Do you have to make any holes in
the body of your vehicle when you
install a trailer hitch? If you do, then
be sure to seal the holes later when
you remove the hitch. If you don’t seal
them, carbon monoxide (CO) from
your exhaust can get into your vehicle,
as well as dirt and water.
• The bumpers on your vehicle are not
intended for hitches. Do not attach
rental hitches or other bumper-type
hitches to them. Use only a framemounted hitch that does not attach to
the bumper.
• A HYUNDAI trailer hitch accessory is
available at an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
6-138
If your trailer is equipped with a braking
system, make sure it conforms to
your country’s regulations and that
it is properly installed and operating
correctly.
If your trailer weighs more than the
maximum trailer weight without trailer
brakes loaded, then it needs its own
brakes and they must be adequate. Be
sure to read and follow the instructions
for the trailer brakes so you’ll be able
to install, adjust and maintain them
properly. Be sure not to modify your
vehicle’s brake system.
WARNING
Do not use a trailer with its own brakes
unless you are absolutely certain that
you have properly set up the brake
system. This is not a task for amateurs.
Use an experienced, competent trailer
shop for this work.
06
Driving with a trailer
Backing up
Towing a trailer requires a certain
amount of experience. Before setting
out for the open road, you must get to
know your trailer. Acquaint yourself with
the feel of handling and braking with the
added weight of the trailer. And always
keep in mind that the vehicle you are
driving is now longer and not nearly as
responsive as your vehicle is by itself.
Before you start, check the trailer hitch
and platform, safety chains, electrical
connector(s), lights, tires and brakes.
During your trip, occasionally check
to be sure that the load is secure, and
that the lights and trailer brakes are still
working.
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel
with one hand. Then, to move the trailer
to the left, move your hand to the left. To
move the trailer to the right, move your
hand to the right. Always back up slowly
and, if possible, have someone guide
you.
Distance
When you tow a trailer, your vehicle has
to have a different turn signal flasher and
extra wiring. The green arrows on your
instrument panel will flash whenever you
signal a turn or lane change. Properly
connected, the trailer lights will also flash
to alert other drivers you’re about to turn,
change lanes, or stop.
When towing a trailer, the green arrows
on your instrument panel will flash for
turns even if the bulbs on the trailer
are burned out. Thus, you may think
drivers behind you are seeing your
signals when, in fact, they are not. It’s
important to check occasionally to be
sure the trailer bulbs are still working.
You must also check the lights every time
you disconnect and then reconnect the
wires.
Stay at least twice as far behind the
vehicle ahead as you would when driving
your vehicle without a trailer. This can
help you avoid situations that require
heavy braking and sudden turns.
Passing
You will need more passing distance up
ahead when you’re towing a trailer. And,
because of the increased vehicle length,
you’ll need to go much farther beyond
the passed vehicle before you can return
to your lane.
Making turns
When you’re turning with a trailer, make
wider turns than normal. Do this so your
trailer won’t strike soft shoulders, curbs,
road signs, trees, or other objects. Avoid
jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in
advance.
Turn signals
6-139
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
Do not connect a trailer lighting system
directly to your vehicle’s lighting
system. Use an approved trailer wiring
harness. Failure to do so could result
in damage to the vehicle electrical
system and/or personal injury. Consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
Driving on hills
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear
before you start down a long or steep
downgrade. If you don’t shift down, you
might have to use your brakes so much
that they would get overheated and may
not operate efficiently.
On a long uphill grade, shift down and
reduce your speed to around 70 km/h (45
mph) to reduce the possibility of engine
and transmission overheating.
If your trailer weighs more than the
maximum trailer weight without trailer
brakes and you have a dual clutch
transmission, you should drive in D
(Drive) when towing a trailer.
Operating your vehicle in D (Drive)
when towing a trailer will minimize heat
build-up and extend the life of your
transmission.
6-140
NOTICE
To prevent engine and/or transmission
overheating:
• When towing a trailer on steep
grades (in excess of 6%) pay close
attention to the engine coolant
temperature gauge to ensure the
engine does not overheat. If the
needle of the coolant temperature
gauge moves towards “H” (HOT),
pull over and stop as soon as it is
safe to do so, and allow the engine
to idle until it cools down. You may
proceed once the engine has cooled
sufficiently.
• If you tow a trailer with the maximum
gross vehicle weight and maximum
trailer weight, it can cause the
engine or transmission to overheat.
When driving in such conditions,
allow the engine to idle until it cools
down. You may proceed once the
engine or transmission has cooled
sufficiently.
• When towing a trailer, your vehicle
speed may be much slower than the
general flow of traffic, especially
when climbing an uphill grade. Use
the right hand lane when towing a
trailer on an uphill grade. Choose
your vehicle speed according to the
maximum posted speed limit for
vehicles with trailers, the steepness
of the grade, and your trailer weight.
06
• Vehicles equipped with a dual clutch
transmission when towing a trailer
on steep grades, need to be aware
that the clutch in the transmission
could overheat.
When the clutch is overheated, the
safe protection mode engages. If the
safe protection mode engages, the
gear position indicator on the cluster
blinks with a chime sound.
At this time, a warning message
will appear on the LCD display and
driving may not be smooth.
If you ignore this warning, the driving
condition may become worse.
To return to normal driving
conditions, stop the vehicle on a flat
road and apply the foot brake for a
few minutes before driving off.
Parking on hills
Generally, if you have a trailer attached
to your vehicle, you should not park your
vehicle on a hill.
However, if you ever have to park your
trailer on a hill, here’s how to do it:
1. Pull the vehicle into the parking space.
Turn the steering wheel in the
direction of the curb (right if headed
down hill, left if headed up hill).
2. Shift the vehicle to P (Park).
3. Set the parking brake and shut off the
vehicle.
4. Place wheel chocks under the trailer
wheels on the down hill side of the
wheels.
5. Start the vehicle, hold the brakes, shift
to neutral, release the parking brake
and slowly release the brakes until the
trailer chocks absorb the load.
6. Reapply the brakes and parking
brakes.
7. Move the shift lever to P (Park) when
the vehicle is parked on a uphill grade
and in R (Reverse) on a downhill.
8. Shut off the vehicle and release the
vehicle brakes but leave the parking
brake set.
6-141
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
To prevent serious or fatal injury:
• Do not get out of the vehicle without
the parking brake firmly set. If you
have left the engine running, the
vehicle can move suddenly. You and
others could be seriously or fatally
injured.
• Do not apply the accelerator pedal to
hold the vehicle on an uphill.
Ready to leave after parking on a hill
1. With the shift lever in P (Park), apply
your brakes and hold the brake pedal
down while you:
• Start your engine;
• Shift into gear; and
• Release the parking brake.
2. Slowly remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of
the chocks.
4. Stop and have someone pick up and
store the chocks.
6-142
Maintenance when towing a
trailer
Your vehicle will need service more
often when you regularly pull a trailer.
Important items to pay particular
attention to include engine oil,
transmission fluid, axle lubricant and
cooling system fluid. Brake condition
is another important item to frequently
check. If you’re trailering, it’s a good
idea to review these items before
you start your trip. Don’t forget to
also maintain your trailer and hitch.
Follow the maintenance schedule that
accompanied your trailer and check it
periodically. Preferably, conduct the
check at the start of each day’s driving.
Most importantly, all hitch nuts and bolts
should be tight.
NOTICE
To prevent vehicle damage:
• Due to higher load during trailer
usage, overheating might occur on
hot days or during uphill driving.
If the coolant gauge indicates
over-heating, switch off the air
conditioner and stop the vehicle in a
safe area to cool down the engine.
• Do not switch off the engine while
the coolant gauge indicates overheating.
(Keep the engine idle to cool down
the engine)
• When towing check transmission
fluid more frequently.
• If your vehicle is not equipped with
an air conditioner, you should install
a condenser fan to improve engine
performance when towing a trailer.
06
VEHICLE WEIGHT
Two labels on your driver’s door sill show
how much weight your vehicle was
designed to carry: the Tire and Loading
Information Label and the Certification
Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize
yourself with the following terms for
determining your vehicle’s weight
ratings, from the vehicle’s specifications
and the Certification Label:
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional
equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer
plus any aftermarket equipment.
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added to
the Base Curb Weight, including cargo
and optional equipment.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on each
axle (front and rear) - including vehicle
curb weight and all payload.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
that can be carried by a single axle (front
or rear). These numbers are shown on
the Certification Label. The total load on
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus actual
Cargo Weight plus passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all options, equipment, passengers
and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the
Certification Label located on the driver’s
door sill.
Overloading
WARNING
The Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
and the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) for your vehicle are on the
Certification Label attached to the
driver’s (or front passenger’s) door.
Exceeding these ratings can cause an
accident or vehicle damage. You can
calculate the weight of your load by
weighing the items (and people) before
putting them in the vehicle. Be careful
not to overload your vehicle.
6-143
7. Emergency situations
Hazard warning flasher......................................................................................7-2
In case of an emergency while driving..............................................................7-2
If the engine stalls while driving.................................................................................. 7-2
If the engine stalls at a crossroad or crossing............................................................. 7-2
If you have a flat tire while driving............................................................................... 7-3
If the engine will not start..................................................................................7-3
If the 12 volt battery is discharged.................................................................... 7-4
Before jump starting..................................................................................................... 7-4
Jump starting................................................................................................................ 7-5
If the engine overheats....................................................................................... 7-7
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)......................................................... 7-9
Check tire pressure.......................................................................................................7-9
Tire pressure monitoring system.................................................................................7-10
Low tire pressure warning light....................................................................................7-11
Low tire pressure position and tire pressure telltale...................................................7-11
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring System) malfunction indicator.............................. 7-12
Changing a tire with TPMS.......................................................................................... 7-12
If you have a flat tire (with spare tire).............................................................. 7-14
Jack and tools..............................................................................................................7-14
Changing tires..............................................................................................................7-15
Jack label......................................................................................................................7-19
EC Declaration of conformity for Jack...................................................................... 7-20
If you have a flat tire (with tire mobility kit).....................................................7-21
Introduction.................................................................................................................. 7-21
Notes on the safe use of the Tire Mobility Kit........................................................... 7-22
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit.......................................................................... 7-23
Using the Tire Mobility Kit.......................................................................................... 7-24
Checking the tire inflation pressure........................................................................... 7-26
Towing............................................................................................................... 7-27
Towing service..............................................................................................................7-27
Removable towing hook............................................................................................. 7-28
Emergency towing...................................................................................................... 7-29
Emergency commodity.................................................................................... 7-31
Fire extinguisher...........................................................................................................7-31
First aid kit....................................................................................................................7-31
Triangle reflector..........................................................................................................7-31
Tire pressure gauge......................................................................................................7-31
7
Emergency situations
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If the engine stalls while driving
OOSH079001L
The hazard warning flasher serves as
a warning to other drivers to exercise
extreme caution when approaching,
overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency
repairs are being made or when the
vehicle is stopped near the edge of a
roadway.
To turn the hazard warning flasher on
or off, press the hazard warning flasher
button with the ignition switch in any
position. The button is located in the
center fascia panel. All turn signal lights
will flash simultaneously.
• The hazard warning flasher operates
regardless of whether your vehicle is
in the READY state or not.
• The turn signals do not work when the
hazard flasher is on.
7-2
• Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
• Turn on your hazard warning flasher.
• Try to start the engine again. If your
vehicle will not start, we recommend
that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If the engine stalls at a crossroad
or crossing
If the engine stalls at a crossroads or
crossing, if safe to do so, move the shift
lever to the N (Neutral) position and then
push the vehicle to a safe location.
07
If you have a flat tire while
driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
• Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow down
while driving straight ahead. Do not
apply the brakes immediately or
attempt to pull off the road as this
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. When the
vehicle has slowed to such a speed
that it is safe to do so, brake carefully
and pull off the road. Drive off the
road as far as possible and park on
firm, level ground. If you are on a
divided highway, do not park in the
median area between the two traffic
lanes.
• When the vehicle is stopped, press the
hazard warning flasher button, move
the shift lever into P (Park), apply the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/ OFF position.
• Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on the
side of the vehicle that is away from
traffic.
• When changing a flat tire, follow the
instructions provided later in this
chapter.
IF THE ENGINE WILL NOT
START
• Be sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
The vehicle starts only when the shift
lever is in P (Park).
• This vehicle does not have a regular
12V battery that needs periodic
replacement. It is lithium ion polymer
type integrated into the HEV high
voltage battery. The vehicle has a
12V battery protection system that
cuts 12V battery from vehicle draw
to prevent full discharge. If vehicle
will not start, first try pressing the
12V Battery Reset switch (left side of
the steering wheel near the fuel door
open switch) to reconnect the 12V
battery, but you must start vehicle
within 15 seconds of pressing the 12V
Battery Reset switch. After starting
indicator ON ),
the vehicle (
operate the vehicle safely outdoors in
ready mode stopped and/or drive it
for 30 minutes total to charge the 12V
battery fully.
• Check the fuel level and add fuel if
necessary.
If the vehicle still does not start, we
recommend that you call an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.
NOTICE
Push or pull starting the vehicle may
cause the catalytic converter to
overload which can lead to damage to
the emission control system.
7-3
Emergency situations
IF THE 12 VOLT BATTERY IS DISCHARGED
Before jump starting
This vehicle does not have a regular 12V
battery that needs periodic replacement.
It is lithium ion polymer type integrated
into the HEV high voltage battery. The
vehicle has a 12V battery protection
system that cuts 12V battery from vehicle
draw to prevent full discharge.
Using the 12V battery reset switch
If you do not start the vehicle
immediately after pressing the 12V
Battery Reset switch, the power of 12V
battery is automatically disconnected
after few seconds to save the 12V battery
from additional discharge. If the 12V
battery is disconnected prior to starting
the vehicle, press the 12V Battery Reset
switch again and then immediately start
the vehicle as explained.
Repeated use of the 12V Battery Reset
switch without a sufficient engine
ON cycle (30 Min+) may cause over
discharge of the 12V battery, which will
prevent the vehicle from starting. If the
12V battery is over discharged to a point
that the reset does not work, try to jumpstart the vehicle.
Information
OOSH079002L
1. Press the 12V Battery Reset switch to
reconnect the 12V battery.
2. Start the vehicle within 15 seconds of
pressing the 12V Battery Reset switch.
3. After starting the vehicle (
indicator
on), operate the vehicle safely
outdoors in ready mode stopped
and/or drive it for 30 minutes total to
charge the 12V battery fully.
7-4
After starting the vehicle (
indicator
on), the 12V battery is being charged
whether the engine is running or not.
Although there is no engine sound, it is
unnecessary to depress the accelerator
pedal.
The following items may need to be reset
after the battery has been discharged or
the battery has been disconnected.
See chapter 4 and 5 for:
• Power Windows
• Trip Computer
• Climate Control System
• Clock
• Audio System
• Sunroof
07
NOTICE
External power source using 12V battery
The use of external power accessories
may reduce performance and function
of the vehicle. Especially, the use of
dash cameras may shut off the power of
the vehicle prior to the dash camera’s
automatic shut-down.
If the power of the vehicle is shut off,
start the vehicle as explained. (refer to
“Using the 12V Battery Reset Switch”)
Jump starting
In the event vehicle still does not have a
functional 12V battery (check if interior
lights will not turn on) then you can try
a jump start to the engine compartment
jumper terminals using a 12V booster
pack or jumper cables from another
vehicle’s 12V battery according to the
following instructions.
CAUTION
Jump starting can be dangerous if
done incorrectly. Follow the jump
starting procedure in this section to
avoid serious injury or damage to
your vehicle. If in doubt about how to
properly jump start your vehicle, we
strongly recommend that you have a
service technician or towing service do
it for you.
OOSH079004L
4. Connect the jumper cables in
the exact sequence shown in the
illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) jumper
terminal of your vehicle (1).
5. Connect the other end of the jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
6. Connect the second jumper cable to
the black, negative (-) battery/ chassis
ground of the assisting vehicle (3).
7. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the black, negative (-)
chassis ground of your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct
battery or jumper terminals or the
correct ground. Do not lean over the
battery when making connections.
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach, but
do not allow the vehicles to touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in the
engine compartment at all times, even
when the vehicles are turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such as
radios, lights, air conditioning, etc.
Put the vehicles in P (Park) and set the
parking brake. Turn both vehicles OFF.
7-5
Emergency situations
Information
The voltage range of the charger should be
13.3~14V and its current range should be
less than 60A. (13.8V is recommended).
CAUTION
OOSH079002L
8. Press the 12V Battery Reset switch.
9. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run for a few minutes.
10. Start your vehicle as soon as possible.
indicator
After starting the vehicle (
on), operate the vehicle safely
outdoors in ready mode stopped
and/or drive it for 30 minutes total to
charge the 12V battery fully.
If your vehicle will not start after a
few attempts, it probably requires
servicing. In this event please seek
qualified assistance. If the cause of your
battery discharging is not apparent, we
recommend that you have your vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from the
black, negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative
(-) battery/chassis ground of the
assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper cable
from the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).
7-6
• The use of an improper charger
with a voltage and current range
higher than specified may cause
overheating and damage to the 12V
battery.
• The use of an incorrect charger will
lead to a power shut-off to save the
12V battery. Stop using the incorrect
charger once the power of the
vehicle is shut off.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
• Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to jump
start your vehicle.
• Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle by push-starting.
07
IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS
If your temperature gauge indicates
overheating, you experience a loss of
power, or hear loud pinging or knocking,
the engine may be overheating. If this
happens, you should:
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon as it
is safe to do so.
2. Place the shift lever in P (Park) and set
the parking brake
3. Make sure that there is no hot
steam gushing out of the engine
compartment. When it is safe to do
so, open the engine compartment,
and check the water-pump connector.
When the water-pump connector is
disconnected, stop the engine, reconnect the water-pump connector,
and then re-start the engine.
4. Set the temperature and the air flow
to the maximum, and turn ON the air
conditioner.
WARNING
While the engine is running,
keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the moving parts
such as the cooling fan and
drive belt to prevent serious
injury.
5. When the Service warning light ( )
illuminates on the instrument cluster,
immediately stop the engine, and
contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer. When the engine warning
light ( ) illuminates, or when the
coolant or hot steams gush out of
the engine compartment, leave the
engine compartment opened, while
running the engine. This is to ventilate
the engine compartment and to cool
down the engine.
6. Check the coolant temperature
gauge on the instrument cluster to
make sure the coolant temperature is
sufficiently cooled down. Check the
coolant level. When it is insufficient,
check its connection with the radiator,
the heater hose, and the water pump
for any leakage. When there is no
leakage, add the coolant. However,
if the problems persists, such as
the illumination of the warning
lights, leakages, or the cooling-fan
malfunction, which may overheat the
engine, immediately stop the engine,
and have your vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-7
Emergency situations
WARNING
Never remove the engine
coolant cap and/or inverter
coolant cap or the drain plug
while the engine and radiator
are hot.
Hot coolant and steam may blow out
under pressure, causing serious injury.
Turn the hybrid system off and wait until
the engine cools down. Use extreme
care when removing the engine coolant
cap and/or inverter coolant cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure is
released from the cooling system. When
you are sure all the pressure has been
released, press down on the cap, using
a thick towel, and continue turning
counterclockwise to remove it.
7. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the engine
temperature has returned to normal.
Then, if coolant has been lost,
carefully add coolant to the reservoir
to bring the fluid level in the reservoir
up to the halfway mark.
8. Proceed with caution, keeping alert
for further signs of overheating.
If overheating happens again,
we recommend that you call an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
7-8
CAUTION
• Serious loss of coolant indicates a
leak in the cooling system and we
recommend the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• When the engine overheats from
low engine coolant, suddenly adding
engine coolant may cause cracks
in the engine. To prevent damage,
add engine coolant slowly in small
quantities.
07
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
Check tire pressure (if equipped)
OOSH079005L
OOSH079007L
OOSH079006L
(1) Low Tire Pressure Telltale/TPMS
Malfunction Indicator
(2) Low Tire Pressure Position Telltale
and Tire Pressure Telltale (Shown on
the LCD display)
• You can check the tire pressure in the
Assist mode on the cluster.
Refer to the “LCD Display Modes”
section in chapter 4.
• Tire pressure is displayed after a few
minutes of driving after initial vehicle
start up.
• If tire pressure is not displayed when
the vehicle is stopped, “Drive to
display” message will appear. After
driving, check the tire pressure.
• The displayed tire pressure values may
differ from those measured with a tire
pressure gauge.
• You can change the tire pressure unit
in the User Settings mode in the LCD
display.
-- psi, kpa, bar (Refer to the “User
Settings Mode” section in chapter
4).
7-9
Emergency situations
Tire pressure monitoring system
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire failure
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label. (If your
vehicle has tires of a different size than
the size indicated on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. Accordingly,
when the low tire pressure telltale
illuminates, you should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure. Driving on
a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if
under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
tire pressure telltale.
7-10
Your vehicle has also been equipped with
a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating
properly. The TPMS malfunction
indicator is combined with the low
tire pressure telltale. When the system
detects a malfunction, the telltale will
flash for approximately one minute and
then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able
to detect or signal low tire pressure as
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur
for a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate
tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires
or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that
the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
NOTICE
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure Telltale/ TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position or the vehicle is in the ready
( ) mode.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for
approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure Position
Telltale remains illuminated.
07
Low tire pressure
warning light
Low tire pressure position and
tire pressure telltale
If you cannot reach a service station or
if the tire cannot hold the newly added
air, replace the low pressure tire with the
spare tire.
The Low Tire Pressure Telltale will remain
on and the TPMS Malfunction Indicator
may blink for one minute and then
remain illuminated (when the vehicle
is driven approximately 10 minutes at
speed above 25 km/h (15.5 mph)) until
you have the low pressure tire repaired
and replaced on the vehicle.
CAUTION
OOSH049020L
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are
illuminated and a warning message
displayed on the cluster LCD display,
one or more of your tires is significantly
under-inflated. The Low Tire Pressure
Position Telltale will indicate which
tire is significantly underinflated by
illuminating the corresponding position
light.
If either telltale illuminates, immediately
reduce your speed, avoid hard cornering
and anticipate increased stopping
distances. You should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible. Inflate the
tires to the proper pressure as indicated
on the vehicle’s placard or tire inflation
pressure label located on the driver’s
side center pillar outer panel.
In winter or cold weather, the Low Tire
Pressure Telltale may be illuminated if
the tire pressure was adjusted to the
recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not mean
your TPMS is malfunctioning because
the decreased temperature leads to a
proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle from a
warm area to a cold area or from a cold
area to a warm area, or the outside
temperature is greatly higher or lower,
you should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to the
recommended tire inflation pressure.
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure makes
the vehicle unstable and can contribute
to loss of vehicle control and increased
braking distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires
can cause the tires to overheat and fail.
7-11
Emergency situations
TPMS (Tire Pressure
Monitoring System)
malfunction indicator
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
will illuminate after it blinks for
approximately one minute when there
is a problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
We recommend that the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the TPMS,
the Low Tire Pressure Position Telltale
will not be displayed even though the
vehicle has an under-inflated tire.
NOTICE
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
illuminate after blinking for one minute
if the vehicle is near electric power
supply cables or radio transmitters
such as police stations, government
and public offices, broadcasting
stations, military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow chains
are used or electronic devices such as
computers, chargers, remote starters,
navigation, etc. This may interfere with
normal operation of the TPMS.
7-12
Changing a tire with TPMS
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and Position telltales will come
on. We recommend that the flat tire be
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible or replace the
flat tire with the spare tire.
NOTICE
It is recommended that you do not use a
puncture-repairing agent not approved
by a HYUNDAI dealer to repair and/or
inflate a low pressure tire. Tire sealant
not approved by a HYUNDAI dealer may
damage the tire pressure sensor.
The spare tire (if equipped) does not
come with a tire pressure monitoring
sensor. When the low pressure tire or
the flat tire is replaced with the spare
tire, the Low Tire Pressure Telltale will
remain on. Also, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator will illuminate after blinking
for one minute if the vehicle is driven
at speed above 25 km/h (15.5 mph) for
approximately 10 minutes.
Once the original tire equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure
and reinstalled on the vehicle, the
Low Tire Pressure Telltale and TPMS
Malfunction Indicator will go off within a
few minutes of driving.
If the indicators do not extinguish after a
few minutes, please visit an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the tire
behind the valve stem (except for the
spare tire). You must use TPMS specific
wheels. It is recommended that you
always have your tires serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
07
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking at it.
Always use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to measure. Please note that a tire
that is hot (from being driven) will have a
higher pressure measurement than a tire
that is cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has been
sitting for 3 hours and driven for less
than 1.6 km (1 mile) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
WARNING
• The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors such as nails or road
debris.
• If you feel any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off
the accelerator, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
WARNING
For Europe
• Do not modify the vehicle; it may
interfere with the TPMS function.
• The wheels on the market do not
have a TPMS sensor.
For your safety, we recommend that
you use parts for replacement from
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If you use the wheels on the market,
use a TPMS sensor approved by a
HYUNDAI dealer. If your vehicle is
not equipped with a TPMS sensor
or TPMS does not work properly,
you may fail the periodic vehicle
inspection conducted in your
country.
ÃÃ All vehicles sold in the EUROPE
market during below period must be
equipped with TPMS.
-- New model vehicle : Nov. 1, 2012 ~
-- Current model vehicle : Nov.
1, 2014~ (Based on vehicle
registrations)
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or disabling
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may interfere
with the system’s ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions
and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering
with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may void the warranty for
that portion of the vehicle.
7-13
Emergency situations
IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE (WITH SPARE TIRE, IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
Changing a tire can be dangerous.
Follow the instructions in this section
when changing a tire to reduce the risk
of serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Be careful as you use the jack handle to
stay clear of the flat end. The flat end
has sharp edges that could cause cuts.
Jack and tools
OOSH079009L
Turn the winged hold down bolt
counterclockwise to remove the spare
tire.
Store the spare tire in the same
compartment by turning the winged hold
down bolt clockwise.
To prevent the spare tire and tools from
“rattling”, store them in their proper
location.
OOSH079008L
1. Jack handle
2. Jack
3. Wheel lug nut wrench
The jack, jack handle, and wheel lug
nut wrench are stored in the luggage
compartment under the luggage box
cover.
The jack is provided for emergency tire
changing only.
7-14
OOSH079010L
If it is hard to loosen the tire hold-down
wing bolt by hand, you can loosen it
easily using the wheel nut wrench.
Turn the tire hold-down wing bolt
counterclockwise with the wheel nut
wrench.
07
Changing tires
WARNING
A vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack
causing serious injury or death to you or
those nearby. Take the following safety
precautions:
• Do not get under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
• NEVER attempt to change a tire in
the lane of traffic. ALWAYS move the
vehicle completely off the road on
level, firm ground away from traffic
before trying to change a tire. If you
cannot find a level, firm place off
the road, call a towing service for
assistance.
• Be sure to use the jack provided with
the vehicle.
• ALWAYS place the jack on the
designated jacking positions on the
vehicle and NEVER on the bumpers
or any other part of the vehicle for
jacking support.
• Do not start or run the engine while
the vehicle is on the jack.
• Do not allow anyone to remain in the
vehicle while it is on the jack.
• Keep children away from the road
and the vehicle.
Follow these steps to change your
vehicle’s tire:
1. Park on a level, firm surface.
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park),
apply the parking brake, and place
the ignition switch in the LOCK/ OFF
position.
3. Press the hazard warning flasher
button.
4. Remove the wheel lug nut wrench,
jack, jack handle, and spare tire from
the vehicle.
Block
OOSH079011L
5. Block both the front and rear of the
tire diagonally opposite of the tire you
are changing.
7-15
Emergency situations
OOSH079012L
6. Loosen the wheel lug nuts
counterclockwise one turn each in
the order shown above, but do not
remove any lug nuts until the tire has
been raised off of the ground.
OOSH079013L
[A] : Front, [B] : Rear
7. Place the jack at the designated
jacking position under the frame
closest to the tire you are changing.
The jacking positions are plates
welded to the frame with two
notches. Never jack at any other
position or part of the vehicle. Doing
so may damage the side seal molding
or other parts of the vehicle.
7-16
OOSH079014L
8. Insert the jack handle into the jack
and turn it clockwise, raising the
vehicle until the tire clears the ground.
Make sure the vehicle is stable on the
jack.
9. Loosen the lug nuts with the wheel
lug nut wrench and remove them with
your fingers. Remove the wheel from
the studs and lay it flat on the ground
out of the way. Remove any dirt or
debris from the studs, mounting
surfaces, and wheel.
10. Install the spare tire onto the studs of
the hub.
11. Tighten the lug nuts with your fingers
onto the studs with the smaller end of
the lug nuts closest to the wheel.
12. Lower the vehicle to the ground
by turning the jack handle
counterclockwise.
07
CAUTION
OOSH079015L
13. Use the wheel lug nut wrench to
tighten the lug nuts in the order
shown. Double-check each lug nut
until they are tight. After changing
tires, we recommend that an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer tighten
the lug nuts to their proper torque as
soon as possible. The wheel lug nut
should be tightened to 11~13 kgf.m
(79~94 lbf.ft).
If you have a tire gauge, check the
tire pressure (see “Tires and Wheels”
section in chapter 1 for tire pressure
instructions.). If the pressure is lower or
higher than recommended, drive slowly
to the nearest service station and adjust
it to the recommended pressure. Always
reinstall the valve cap after checking
or adjusting tire pressure. If the cap
is not replaced, air may leak from the
tire. If you lose a valve cap, buy another
and install it as soon as possible. After
changing tires, secure the flat tire and
return the jack and tools to their proper
storage locations.
Your vehicle has metric threads on
the studs and lug nuts. Make certain
during tire changing that the same
nuts that were removed are reinstalled.
If you have to replace your lug nuts
make sure they have metric threads to
avoid damaging the studs and ensure
the wheel is properly secured to the
hub. We recommend that you consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
If any of the equipment such as the jack,
lug nuts, studs, or other equipment is
damaged or in poor condition, do not
attempt to change the tire and call for
assistance.
Use of compact spare tires
(if equipped)
Compact spare tires are designed for
emergency use only. Drive carefully on
the compact spare tire and always follow
the safety precautions.
NOTICE
Check the tire pressure as soon as
possible after installing a spare tire.
Adjust it to the recommended pressure.
7-17
Emergency situations
WARNING
To prevent compact spare tire failure
and loss of control possibly resulting in
an accident:
• Use the compact spare tire only in an
emergency.
• NEVER operate your vehicle over 80
km/h (50 mph).
• Do not exceed the vehicle’s
maximum load rating or the load
carrying capacity shown on the
sidewall of the compact spare tire.
• Do not use the compact spare tire
continuously. Repair or replace the
original tire as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the compact spare
tire.
When driving with the compact spare tire
mounted to your vehicle:
• Check the tire pressure after installing
the compact spare tire. The compact
spare tire should be inflated to 420
kPa (60 psi).
• Do not take this vehicle through
an automatic car wash while the
compact spare tire is installed.
• Do not use the compact spare tire on
any other vehicle because this tire
has been designed especially for your
vehicle.
• The compact spare tire’s tread life is
shorter than a regular tire. Inspect
your compact spare tire regularly and
replace worn compact spare tires with
the same size and design, mounted on
the same wheel.
• Do not use more than one compact
spare tire at a time.
• Do not tow a trailer while the compact
spare tire is installed.
7-18
Information
When the original tire and wheel are
repaired and reinstalled on the vehicle, the
lug nut torque must be set correctly. The
correct lug nut tightening torque is 11~13
kgf.m (79~94 lbf.ft).
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the compact
spare tire and your vehicle:
• Drive slowly enough for the road
conditions to avoid all hazards, such
as a potholes or debris.
• Avoid driving over obstacles. The
compact spare tire diameter is
smaller than the diameter of a
conventional tire and reduces the
ground clearance approximately 25
mm (1 inch).
• Do not use tire chains on the
compact spare tire. Because of the
smaller size, a tire chain will not fit
properly.
• Do not use the compact spare tire
on any other wheels, nor should
standard tires, snow tires, wheel
covers or trim rings be used with the
compact spare wheel.
07
Jack label
OHYK065011
The actual Jack label in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more detailed specifications, refer to the label attached to the jack.
1. Model Name
2. Maximum allowable load
3. When using the jack, set your parking brake.
4. When using the jack, stop the engine.
5. Do not get under a vehicle that is supported by a jack.
6. The designated locations under the frame
7. When supporting the vehicle, the base plate of jack must be vertical under the
lifting point.
8. Shift into Reverse gear on vehicles with manual transmission or move the shift lever
to the P position on vehicles with dual clutch transmission.
9. The jack should be used on firm level ground.
10. Jack manufacture
11. Production date
12. Representative company and address
7-19
Emergency situations
EC Declaration of conformity for Jack
JACKDOC14S
7-20
07
IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE (WITH TIRE MOBILITY KIT,
IF EQUIPPED)
Introduction
OOSH079016L
For safe operation, carefully read and
follow the instructions in this manual
before use.
(1) Compressor
(2) Sealant bottle
The Tire Mobility Kit is a temporary fix to
the tire and the tire should be inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
CAUTION
When two or more tires are flat, do not
use the tire mobility kit because the
supported one sealant of Tire Mobility
Kit is only used for one flat tire.
WARNING
Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit to repair
punctures in the tire walls. This can
result in an accident due to tire failure.
With the Tire Mobility Kit you stay mobile
even after experiencing a tire puncture.
The compressor and sealing compound
system effectively and comfortably seals
most punctures in a passenger car tire
caused by nails or similar objects and
reinflates the tire.
After you ensure that the tire is properly
sealed you can drive cautiously on the
tire (distance up to 200 km (120 miles))
at a max. speed of (80 km/h (50mph))
in order to reach a service station or tire
dealer for the tire replacement.
It is possible that some tires, especially
with larger punctures or damage to the
sidewall, cannot be sealed completely.
Air pressure loss in the tire may adversely
affect tire performance.
For this reason, you should avoid abrupt
steering or other driving maneuvers,
especially if the vehicle is heavily loaded
or if a trailer is in use.
The Tire Mobility Kit is not designed
or intended as a permanent tire repair
method and is to be used for one tire
only.
This instruction shows you step by step
how to temporarily seal the puncture
simply and reliably.
Read the section “Notes on the safe use
of the Tire Mobility Kit”.
WARNING
Have your tire repaired as soon as
possible. The tire may lose air pressure
at any time after inflating with the Tire
Mobility Kit.
7-21
Emergency situations
WARNING
Do not use the TMK if a tire is severely
damaged by driving run flat or with
insufficient air pressure.
Only punctured areas located within the
tread region of the tire can be sealed
using the TMK.
Notes on the safe use of the Tire
Mobility Kit
• Park your car at the side of the road
so that you can work with the Tire
Mobility Kit away from moving traffic.
• To be sure your vehicle will not move,
even when you’re on fairly level
ground, always set your parking brake.
• Only use the Tire Mobility Kit for
sealing/inflation passenger car tires.
Only punctured areas located within
the tread region of the tire can be
sealed using the tire mobility kit.
• Do not use on motorcycles, bicycles
or any other type of tires.
• When the tire and wheel are
damaged, do not use Tire Mobility Kit
for your safety.
• Use of the Tire Mobility Kit may not be
effective for tire damage larger than
approximately 6 mm (0.24 inch).
Please contact the nearest HYUNDAI
dealership if the tire cannot be made
roadworthy with the Tire Mobility Kit.
7-22
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if a tire
is severely damaged by driving run flat
or with insufficient air pressure.
• Do not remove any foreign objects
such as nails or screws that have
penetrated the tire.
• Provided the car is outdoors, leave
the vehicle in the ready ( ) mode.
Otherwise operating the compressor
may eventually drain the car battery.
• Never leave the Tire Mobility Kit
unattended while it is being used.
• Do not leave the compressor running
for more than 10 minutes at a time or
it may overheat.
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if the
ambient temperature is below -30°C
(-22°F).
• In case of skin contact with the
sealant, wash the area thoroughly
with plenty of water. If the irritation
persists, seek medical attention.
• In case of eye contact with the
sealant, flush your eyes for at least 15
minutes. If the irritation persists, seek
medical attention.
• In case of swallowing the sealant,
rinse the mouth and drink plenty of
water. However, never give anything
to an unconscious person and seek
medical attention immediately.
• Long time exposure to the sealant
may cause damage to bodily tissue
such as kidney, etc.
07
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit
ODE067044
1. Speed restriction label
2. Sealant bottle and label with speed restriction
3. Filling hose from sealant bottle to wheel
4. Connectors and cable for power outlet direct connection
5. Holder for the sealant bottle
6. Compressor
7. ON/OFF switch
8. Pressure gauge for displaying the tire inflation pressure
9. Button for reducing tire inflation pressure
Connectors, cable and connection hose are stored in the compressor housing.
Strictly follow the specified sequence, otherwise the sealant may escape under high
pressure.
7-23
Emergency situations
1. Shake the sealant bottle (2).
WARNING
Do not use the tire sealant after
the sealant has expired (i.e. past
the expiration date on the sealant
container). This can increase the risk of
tire failure.
WARNING
• Keep out of reach of children.
• Avoid contact with eyes.
• Do not swallow.
Using the Tire Mobility Kit
WARNING
OOSH079018L
2. Connect the filling hose (3) to the
sealant bottle (2) in the direction of (A)
and connect the sealant bottle to the
compressor (6) in the direction of (B).
3. Ensure that the compressor is
switched OFF.
OOSH079017L
Detach the speed restriction label (1)
from the sealant bottle (2), and place
it in a highly visible place inside the
vehicle such as on the steering wheel to
remind the driver not to drive too fast.
7-24
OOSH079019L
4. Unscrew the valve cap from the valve
of the defective and screw the filling
hose (3) of the sealant bottle onto the
valve.
07
NOTICE
CAUTION
Do not attempt to drive your vehicle if
the tire pressure is below 200 kpa (29
psi). This could result in an accident due
to sudden tire failure.
OOSH079020L
Securely install the sealant filling hose
to the valve. If not, sealant may flow
backward, possibly clogging the filling
hose.
7. Switch off the compressor.
8. Detach the hoses from the sealant
bottle connector and from the tire
valve.
Return the Tire Mobility Kit to its storage
location in the vehicle.
WARNING
Do not leave your vehicle running in
a poorly ventilated area for extended
periods of time. Carbon monoxide
poisoning and suffocation can occur.
OOSH079021L
5. Plug the compressor power cord (4)
into the vehicle power outlet.
6. With the vehicle ON (
indicator
ON), switch on the compressor
and let it run for approximately 5~7
minutes to fill the sealant up to proper
pressure. (Refer to “Tire and Wheels”
section in chapter2). The inflation
pressure of the tire after filling is
unimportant and will be checked/
corrected later.
Be careful not to overinflate the tire
and stay away from the tire when
filling it.
OOSH079022L
Distributing the sealant
9. Immediately drive approximately 7~10
km (4~6 miles or about 10 minutes)
to evenly distribute the sealant in the
tire.
Do not exceed a speed of 80 km/h (50
mph). If possible, do not fall below a
speed of 20 km/h (12 mph).
While driving, if you experience any
unusual vibration, ride disturbance or
noise, reduce your speed and drive with
caution until you can safely pull off of the
side of the road.
Call for road side service or towing.
7-25
Emergency situations
Checking the tire inflation
pressure
1. After driving approximately 7~10 km
(4~6 miles or about 10 minutes), stop
at a safe location.
5. Adjust the tire inflation pressure to the
recommended tire inflation.
With the vehicle in the ready ( )
mode, proceed as follows.
-- To increase the inflation pressure:
Switch on the compressor.
To check the current inflation
pressure setting, briefly switch off
the compressor.
-- To reduce the inflation pressure:
Press the button (9) on the
compressor.
NOTICE
OOSH079023L
2. Connect the filling hose (3) directly
into the compressor.
Do not let the compressor run for more
than 10 minutes, otherwise the device
will overheat and may be damaged.
Information
The pressure gauge may show higher than
actual reading when the compressor is
running. To get an accurate tire pressure,
the compressor needs to be turned off.
CAUTION
OOSH079019L
3. Connect the other end of the filling
hose (3) directly into the tire valve.
4. Plug the compressor power cord (4)
into the vehicle power outlet.
7-26
If the inflation pressure is not
maintained, drive the vehicle a second
time, refer to Distributing the sealant.
Then repeat steps 1 to 4.
Use of the TMK may be ineffectual for
tire damage larger than approximately
4 mm (0.16 in).
We recommend that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer if the tire
cannot be made roadworthy with the
Tire Mobility Kit.
07
TOWING
WARNING
Towing service
The tire inflation pressure must be at
least 220 kPa (32 psi). If it is not, do not
continue driving.
Call for road side service or towing.
CAUTION
Tire pressure sensor
The sealant on the tire pressure sensor
and wheel should be removed when
you replace the tire with a new one and
inspect the tire pressure sensors at an
authorized dealer.
Information
When reinstalling the repaired or replaced
tire and wheel on the vehicle, tighten
the wheel lug nut to 11~13 kgf·m (79~94
lbf·ft).
OOS067007L
[A] : Dollies
If emergency towing is necessary,
we recommend having it done by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service.
Proper lifting and towing procedures
are necessary to prevent damage to
the vehicle. The use of wheel dollies or
flatbed is recommended.
It is acceptable to tow the vehicle with
the rear wheels on the ground (without
dollies) and the front wheels off the
ground.
If any of the loaded wheels or suspension
components are damaged or the vehicle
is being towed with the front wheels on
the ground, use a towing dolly under the
front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial tow
truck and wheel dollies are not used,
the front of the vehicle should always be
lifted, not the rear.
7-27
Emergency situations
Removable towing hook
CAUTION
• Do not tow the vehicle with the front
wheels on the ground as this may
cause damage to the vehicle.
OOS067021
• Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use wheel lift or flatbed
equipment.
OOSH079024L
1. Open the tailgate, and remove the
towing hook from the tool case.
Front
OOS067022
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
1. Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position.
2. Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
3. Release the parking brake.
OOSH079025L
Rear
CAUTION
Failure to place the shift lever in N
(Neutral) may cause internal damage to
the transmission.
OOSH079026L
2. Remove the hole cover by pressing
the lower part of the cover on the
bumper.
7-28
07
3. Install the towing hook by turning it
clockwise into the hole until it is fully
secured.
4. Remove the towing hook and install
the cover after use.
Emergency towing
Towing in this manner may be done
only on hard-surfaced roads for a short
distance and at low speeds. Also, the
wheels, axles, power train, steering and
brakes must all be in good condition.
CAUTION
Front
The driver must be in the vehicle for
steering and braking operations when
the vehicle is being towed. Passengers
other than the driver must not be in the
vehicle.
OOSH079027L
Rear
OOSH079028L
If towing is necessary, we recommend
you have it done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial tow
truck service.
If a towing service is not available in
an emergency, your vehicle may be
temporarily towed using a cable or chain
secured to the emergency towing hook
at the front (or rear) of the vehicle.
Use extreme caution when towing the
vehicle with a cable or chain. A driver
must be in the vehicle to steer it and
operate the brakes.
Always follow these emergency towing
precautions:
• Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position so the steering wheel is not
locked.
• Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
• Release the parking brake.
• Depress the brake pedal with more
force than normal as you will have
reduced braking performance.
• More steering effort will be required
because the power steering system
will be disabled.
• Use a vehicle heavier than your own to
tow your vehicle.
• The drivers of both vehicles should
communicate with each other
frequently.
• Before emergency towing, check that
the hook is not broken or damaged.
• Fasten the towing cable or chain
securely to the hook.
• Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady
and even force.
7-29
Emergency situations
NOTICE
Accelerate or decelerate the vehicle
in a slow and gradual manner while
maintaining tension on the tow rope
or chain to start or drive the vehicle,
otherwise tow hooks and the vehicle
may be damaged.
NOTICE
OOSH079029L
• Use a towing cable or chain less than
5 m (16 feet) long. Attach a white or
red cloth (about 30 cm (12 inches)
wide) in the middle of the cable or
chain for easy visibility.
• Drive carefully so the towing cable or
chain remains tight during towing.
• Before towing, check the dual clutch
transmission for fluid leaks under your
vehicle. If the dual clutch transmission
fluid is leaking, flatbed equipment or a
towing dolly must be used.
7-30
To avoid damage to your vehicle and
vehicle components when towing:
• Always pull straight ahead when
using the towing hooks. Do not pull
from the side or at a vertical angle.
• Do not use the towing hooks to pull
a vehicle out of mud, sand or other
conditions from which the vehicle
cannot be driven out under its own
power.
• Limit the vehicle speed to 15 km/h
(10 mph) and drive less than 1.5
km (1 mile) when towing to avoid
serious damage to the dual clutch
transmission.
07
EMERGENCY COMMODITY (IF EQUIPPED)
Your vehicle is equipped with emergency
commodities to help you respond to
emergency situation.
Fire extinguisher
If there is small fire and you know how
to use the fire extinguisher, follow these
steps carefully.
1. Pull out the safety pin at the top of the
extinguisher that keeps the handle
from being accidentally pressed.
2. Aim the nozzle towards the base of
the fire.
3. Stand approximately 2.5 m (8 ft) away
from the fire and squeeze the handle
to discharge the extinguisher. If you
release the handle, the discharge will
stop.
4. Sweep the nozzle back and forth
at the base of the fire. After the fire
appears to be out, watch carefully
since it may re-ignite.
First aid kit
Supplies for use in giving first aid such
as scissors, bandage and adhesive tape,
etc. are provided.
Triangle reflector
Place the triangle reflector on the road
to warn oncoming vehicles during
emergencies, such as when the vehicle is
parked by the roadside due to problems.
Tire pressure gauge (if equipped)
Tires normally lose some air in day-today use, and you may have to add a air
periodically and usually it is not a sign of
a leaking tire, but of normal wear. Always
check tire pressure when the tires are
cold because tire pressure increases with
temperature.
To check the tire pressure, take the
following steps:
1. Unscrew the inflation valve cap that is
located on the rim of the tire.
2. Press and hold the gauge against the
tire valve. Some air will leak as you
begin and more will leak if you don’t
press the gauge in firmly.
3. A firm non-leaking push will activate
the gauge.
4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge
to see whether the tire pressure is low
or high.
5. Adjust the tire pressure to the
specified pressure. Refer to “Tires and
Wheels” section in chapter 2.
6. Reinstall the inflation valve cap.
7-31
8. Maintenance
Engine compartment......................................................................................... 8-3
Maintenance services........................................................................................ 8-4
Owner’s responsibility................................................................................................. 8-4
Owner maintenance precautions............................................................................... 8-4
Owner maintenance.......................................................................................... 8-5
Owner maintenance schedule.....................................................................................8-5
Scheduled maintenance services......................................................................8-7
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe (except Russia)................................... 8-8
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - For Europe (except Russia)........... 8-12
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe (but include Russia).................... 8-14
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - Except Europe
(but include Russia)..................................................................................................... 8-18
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.............................................. 8-20
Engine oil.......................................................................................................... 8-22
Checking the engine oil level.....................................................................................8-22
Checking the engine oil and filter..............................................................................8-22
Engine coolant/inverter coolant..................................................................... 8-23
Checking the coolant level.........................................................................................8-23
Changing coolant........................................................................................................8-25
Hybrid Starter & Generator (HSG) belt........................................................... 8-26
Checking the Hybrid Starter & Generator (HSG) belt...............................................8-26
Brake fluid........................................................................................................ 8-26
Checking the brake fluid level....................................................................................8-26
Washer fluid......................................................................................................8-27
Checking the washer fluid level................................................................................. 8-27
Air cleaner........................................................................................................ 8-28
Filter replacement.......................................................................................................8-28
Cabin air filter................................................................................................... 8-29
Filter inspection...........................................................................................................8-29
Wiper blades....................................................................................................8-30
Blade inspection......................................................................................................... 8-30
Blade replacement..................................................................................................... 8-30
8
Tires and wheels.............................................................................................. 8-33
Tire care.......................................................................................................................8-33
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures.............................................................8-33
Check tire inflation pressure......................................................................................8-34
Tire rotation.................................................................................................................8-35
Wheel alignment and tire balance............................................................................ 8-36
Tire replacement........................................................................................................ 8-36
Wheel replacement.....................................................................................................8-37
Tire traction.................................................................................................................8-37
Tire maintenance........................................................................................................8-37
Tire sidewall labeling.................................................................................................. 8-38
Low aspect ratio tires.................................................................................................. 8-41
Fuses................................................................................................................. 8-42
Instrument panel fuse replacement......................................................................... 8-43
Engine compartment panel fuse replacement........................................................ 8-45
Fuse/relay panel description..................................................................................... 8-46
Light bulbs........................................................................................................ 8-55
Headlamp, daytime running light (DRL), position lamp,
turn signal lamp and static lamp bulb replacement................................................ 8-56
Front fog lamp replacement...................................................................................... 8-59
Headlamp aiming (For Europe)................................................................................. 8-60
Side repeater lamp replacement.............................................................................. 8-65
Rear combination lamp bulb replacement.............................................................. 8-65
High mounted stop lamp bulb replacement.............................................................8-67
License plate light bulb replacement....................................................................... 8-68
Interior light bulb replacement................................................................................. 8-68
Appearance care.............................................................................................. 8-70
8
Exterior care................................................................................................................8-70
Interior care................................................................................................................. 8-74
Emission control system..................................................................................8-77
Crankcase emission control system.......................................................................... 8-77
Evaporative emission control system........................................................................ 8-77
Exhaust emission control system...............................................................................8-78
Procedure for entering forced engine activation mode................................8-80
08
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OOSH089001L
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Engine oil filler cap
Engine oil dipstick
Engine coolant cap
Engine coolant reservoir
Inverter coolant reservoir
6.
7.
8.
9.
Brake fluid reservoir
Air cleaner
Windshield washer fluid reservoir
Fuse box
8-3
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle and
injury to yourself whenever performing
any maintenance or inspection
procedures.
We recommend you have your
vehicle maintained and repaired by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. An
authorized HYUNDAI dealer meets
HYUNDAI’s high service quality
standards and receives technical support
from HYUNDAI in order to provide you
with a high level of service satisfaction.
Owner’s responsibility
Maintenance service and record
retention are the owner’s responsibility.
You should retain documents that show
proper maintenance has been performed
on your vehicle in accordance with
the scheduled maintenance service
charts shown on the following pages.
You need this information to establish
your compliance with the servicing
and maintenance requirements of your
vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is
provided in your Service Passport.
Repairs and adjustments required as a
result of improper maintenance or a lack
of required maintenance are not covered.
8-4
Owner maintenance precautions
Inadequate, incomplete or insufficient
servicing may result in operational
problems with your vehicle that could
lead to vehicle damage, an accident, or
personal injury. This chapter provides
instructions only for the maintenance
items that are easy to perform. Several
procedures can be done only by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer with special
tools.
Your vehicle should not be modified
in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety
or durability of your vehicle and may, in
addition, violate conditions of the limited
warranties covering the vehicle.
NOTICE
Improper owner maintenance during
the warranty period may affect
warranty coverage. For details, read
the separate Service Passport provided
with the vehicle. If you’re unsure about
any service or maintenance procedure,
have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
08
OWNER MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Performing maintenance work on a
vehicle can be dangerous. If you lack
sufficient knowledge and experience
or the proper tools and equipment
to do the work, have it done by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. ALWAYS
follow these precautions for performing
maintenance work:
• Park your vehicle on level ground,
move the shift lever into the P (Park)
position, apply the parking brake,
and place the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF position.
• Block the tires (front and back) to
prevent the vehicle from moving.
Remove loose clothing or jewelry
that can become entangled in
moving parts.
• If you must run the engine during
maintenance, do so out doors or in
an area with plenty of ventilation.
• Keep flames, sparks, or smoking
materials away from the battery and
fuel-related parts.
The following lists are vehicle checks and
inspections that should be performed
by the owner or an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer at the frequencies indicated to
help ensure safe, dependable operation
of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer as
soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance vehicle
checks are generally not covered by
warranties and you may be charged for
labor, parts and lubricants used.
Owner maintenance schedule
When you stop for fuel:
• Check the engine oil level.
• Check the coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
• Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
• Check for low or under-inflated tires.
WARNING
Be careful when checking your engine
coolant/inverter coolant level when the
engine is hot. This may result in coolant
being blown out of the opening and
cause serious burns and other injuries.
8-5
Maintenance
While operating your vehicle:
At least monthly:
• Note any changes in the sound of the
exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumes
in the vehicle.
• Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice if there is any increased
steering effort or looseness in the
steering wheel, or change in its
straight-ahead position.
• Notice if your vehicle constantly turns
slightly or “pulls” to one side when
traveling on smooth, level road.
• When stopping, listen and check for
unusual sounds, pulling to one side,
increased brake pedal travel or “hardto-push” brake pedal.
• If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your transmission occurs,
check the transmission fluid level.
• Check the dual clutch transmission P
(Park) function.
• Check the parking brake.
• Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
• Check coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
• Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the stoplights, turn
signals and hazard warning flashers.
• Check the inflation pressures of all
tires including the spare for tires that
are worn, show uneven wear, or are
damaged.
• Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
At least twice a year: (i.e., every
Spring and Autumn)
• Check radiator, heater and air
conditioning hoses for leaks or
damage.
• Check windshield washer spray and
wiper operation. Clean wiper blades
with a clean cloth dampened with
washer fluid.
• Check headlamp alignment.
• Check muffler, exhaust pipes, shields
and clamps.
• Check the seat belts for wear and
function.
At least once a year:
• Clean body and door drain holes.
• Lubricate door hinges and hood
hinges.
• Lubricate door and hood locks and
latches.
• Lubricate door rubber weather strips.
• Check the air conditioning system.
• Inspect and lubricate dual clutch
transmission linkage and controls.
• Clean the battery and terminals.
• Check the brake fluid level.
8-6
08
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES
Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where none of
the following conditions apply. If any of the following conditions apply, you must follow
the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions.
• Repeated driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles) in normal temperature or
less than 16 km (10miles) in freezing temperature
• Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances
• Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads
• Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
• Driving in heavy dust conditions
• Driving in heavy traffic area
• Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain road repeatedly
• Towing a trailer or using a camper, or roof rack
• Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use of vehicle towing
• Driving over 170 km/h (106 miles/h)
• Frequently driving in stop-and-go condition
If your vehicle is operated under the above conditions, you should inspect, replace
or refill more frequently than the following Normal Maintenance Schedule. After the
periods or distance shown in the chart, continue to follow the prescribed maintenance
intervals.
8-7
8-8
15
R
I
Engine oil and engine oil filter *1
Air cleaner filter
I
R
I
R
60
40
48
I
R
75
50
60
R
R
90
60
72
Add every 15,000 km (10,000 miles) or 12 months
R
R
45
30
36
I
R
105
70
84
I
R
120
80
96
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*1 : Check the engine oil level and leak every 500 km (350 miles) or before starting a long trip.
*2 : If good quality gasolines meet Europe Fuel standards (EN228) or equivalents including fuel additives is not available, one bottle
of additive is recommended. Additives are available from your authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to
use them. Do not mix other additives.
Fuel additives *2
20
30
10
24
12
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
The following maintenance services must be performed to ensure good emission control and performance.
Keep receipts for all vehicle emission services to protect your warranty. Where both mileage and time are shown, the frequency of
service is determined by whichever occurs first.
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe (except Russia)
Maintenance
36
48
60
40
72
90
60
I
I
I
I
105
70
84
96
I
I
I
I
I
120
80
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*3 : For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*4 : The fuel filter is considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this maintenance schedule
depends on fuel quality. If there are some important matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting
problem etc, we recommend replacing the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule and consulting with an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.
*5 : Inspect HSG belt for evidence of cuts, crocks, excessive wear or oil saturation and replace if necessary. If drive belt noise
occurred, readjust drive belt tension before replace.
Inspect every 15,000 km (10,000 miles) or 12 months, and replace every 105,000 km
(70,000 miles) or 48 months
I
Fuel lines, hoses and connections
I
Vacuum hose
Fuel filter *4
I
I
I
HSG (Hybrid Starter & Generator) belt *5
75
50
60
Replace every 165,000 km (102,500 miles)
45
30
Fuel tank air filter
I
30
15
I
24
20
12
10
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Vapor hose and fuel filler cap
Spark plugs
*3
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe (except Russia)
08
8-9
8-10
20
30
10
15
45
30
36
60
40
48
75
50
60
90
60
72
105
70
84
I
Brake discs and pads
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
R
I
120
80
96
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*6 : When adding coolant, use only deionized water or soft water for your vehicle and never mix hard water in the coolant filled at
the factory. An improper coolant mixture can result in serious malfunction or engine damage.
*7 : For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*8 : Dual Clutch Transmission (DCT) fluid should be changed anytime it has been submerged in water.
I
I
R
I
Parking brake
Brake fluid
I
Brake pedal
I
I
I
Brake lines, hoses and connections
I
I
Engine clutch actuator hose and line
I
I
I
R
R
I
Dual clutch transmission fluid *8
At first, replace 210,000 km (140,000 miles) or 120 months after that,
replace every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months *7
At first, inspect 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 48 months after that,
inspect every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months
Inspect “Coolant level adjustment and leak” every day
24
12
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Engine clutch actuator fluid
Engine coolant / Inverter coolant *6
Cooling system
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe (except Russia)
Maintenance
30
I
I
15
I
I
I
I
I
I
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
Driveshaft and boots
Tire (pressure & tread wear)
Front suspension ball joints
Bolt and nuts on chassis and body
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
I
Exhaust system
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
R
Cabin air filter
I
I
I
I
I
24
20
12
10
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
I
I
I
I
I
I
45
30
36
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
60
40
48
I
I
I
I
I
I
75
50
60
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
90
60
72
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Normal maintenance schedule - For Europe (except Russia)
I
I
I
I
I
I
105
70
84
96
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
120
80
08
8-11
Maintenance
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - For Europe (except
Russia)
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under severe
driving conditions. Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance Intervals
Driving condition
Engine oil and filter
R
Replace every 7,500
km (5,000 miles) or 6
months
A, B, C, D, E, F, G,
H, I, J, K
Air cleaner filter
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, E
Spark plugs
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the
condition
A, B, H, I
R
Every 45,000 km (30,000
miles) or 24 months
I
Every 15,000 km (10,000
miles) or 12 months
Dual clutch transmission
fluid
R
Every 120,000 km
(80,000 miles)
C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J
Steering gear rack,
linkage and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G
Front suspension ball
joints
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G
Maintenance item
HSG (Hybrid Starter &
Generator) belt
8-12
C, D, E, K
08
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - For Europe (except
Russia)
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance Intervals
Driving condition
Disc brakes and pads,
calipers and rotors
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, G, H
Parking brake
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, G, H
Driveshaft and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J
Cabin air filter
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, E
Maintenance item
Severe driving conditions
A. Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles) in normal temperature
or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperature
B. Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances
C. Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt spread roads
D. Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
E. Driving in heavy dust conditions
F. Driving in heavy traffic area
G. Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
H. Towing a trailer, or using a camper or roof rack
I. Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle towing
J. Driving over 170 km/h (106 mile/h)
K. Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
8-13
8-14
60
75
50
60
72
90
60
105
70
84
R
R
R
R
R
R
I
R
I
For Middle East *2
Except Middle East *2
R
R
R
R
I
R
R
I
R
R
R
R
R
I
R
R
Replace every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 12 months
R
R
R
Except Middle East *2,
Central & South America
For Middle East *2,
Central & South America
Except Middle East *2,
Central & South America
45
48
40
Replace every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 12 months
30
15
36
30
96
I
R
R
R
120
80
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*1 : Check the engine oil level and leak every 500 km (350 miles) or before starting a long trip.
*2 : Middle East includes Libya, Algeria, Morocco, Tunisia, Sudan, Egypt and Iran.
*3 : If good quality gasolines meet Europe Fuel standards (EN228) or equivalents including fuel additives is not available, one bottle
of additive is recommended. Additives are available from your authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to
use them. Do not mix other additives.
Air cleaner filter
Fuel additives *3
Engine oil and engine oil filter *1
24
20
12
10
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
For Middle East *2,
Central & South America
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
The following maintenance services must be performed to ensure good emission control and performance.
Keep receipts for all vehicle emission services to protect your warranty. Where both mileage and time are shown, the frequency of
service is determined by whichever occurs first.
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe (but include Russia)
Maintenance
30
15
36
48
60
40
72
90
60
I
I
I
I
I
96
I
R
I
R
I
120
80
Inspect every 15,000 km (10,000 miles) or 12 months, and replace every 105,000 km
(70,000 miles) or 48 months
I
R
I
105
70
84
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*4 : For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*5 : The fuel filter is considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this maintenance schedule
depends on fuel quality. If there are some important matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting
problem etc, we recommend replacing the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule and consulting with an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.
*6 : Inspect HSG belt for evidence of cuts, crocks, excessive wear or oil saturation and replace if necessary. If drive belt noise
occurred, readjust drive belt tension before replace.
HSG (Hybrid Starter & Generator) belt *6
Fuel lines, hoses and connections
I
I
Vacuum hose
I
I
R
I
Fuel filter *5
75
50
60
Replace every 165,000 km (102,500 miles)
45
30
Fuel tank air filter
I
24
20
12
10
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Vapor hose and fuel filler cap
Spark plugs
*4
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe (but include Russia)
08
8-15
8-16
45
30
60
40
48
75
50
60
90
60
72
105
70
84
I
I
R
I
I
Brake fluid
Brake discs and pads
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
120
80
96
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*7 : When adding coolant, use only deionized water or soft water for your vehicle and never mix hard water in the coolant filled at
the factory.
*8 : For your convenience, it can be replaced prior to it’s interval when you do maintenance of other items.
*9 : Dual Clutch Transmission (DCT) fluid should be changed anytime it has been submerged in water.
I
I
Parking brake
I
Replace every 40,000 km (26,000 miles) or 24 months
I
At first, replace 210,000 km (140,000 miles) or 120 months after that,
replace every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months*8
At first, inspect 60,000 km (40,000 miles) or 48 months after that,
inspect every 30,000 km (20,000 miles) or 24 months
Brake pedal
I
I
15
Engine clutch actuator hose and line
20
30
10
36
Inspect “Coolant level adjustment and leak” every day
24
12
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Brake lines, hoses and connections
Engine clutch actuator fluid
Dual clutch transmission fluid *9
Engine coolant / Inverter coolant *7
Cooling system
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe (but include Russia)
Maintenance
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
Driveshaft and boots
Tire (pressure & tread wear)
Front suspension ball joints
Bolt and nuts on chassis and body
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
Cabin air filter
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
Exhaust system
30
15
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
24
20
12
10
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS Months
MAINTENANCE
Miles×1,000
ITEM
Km×1,000
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
45
30
36
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
60
40
48
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
75
50
60
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
90
60
72
Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first
Normal maintenance schedule - Except Europe (but include Russia)
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
105
70
84
96
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
120
80
08
8-17
Maintenance
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - Except Europe (but
include Russia)
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars mainly used under severe
driving conditions. Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
R : Replace
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance Intervals
R
Replace every 5,000
km (3,000 miles) or 6
months
R
Replace every 7,500
km (5,000 miles) or 6
months
Air cleaner filter
R
Replace more
frequently depending
on the condition
C, E
Spark plugs
R
Replace more
frequently depending
on the condition
A, B, H, I
R
Every 30,000 km
(20,000 miles) or 24
months
I
Every 10,000 km (6,000
miles) or 12 months
R
Every 45,000 km
(30,000 miles) or 24
months
I
Every 15,000 km
(10,000 miles) or 12
months
R
Every 120,000 km
(80,000 miles)
Maintenance item
Engine oil
and engine
oil filter
HSG
(Hybrid
Starter &
Generator)
belt
For Middle East
Central &
South America
*1,
Except Middle
East *1, Central &
South America
For Middle East
*1, Central &
South America
Except Middle
East *1, Central &
South America
Dual clutch transmission fluid
*1 :
Driving
condition
A, B, C, D, E, F,
G, H, I, J, K
C, D, E, K
C, D, E, F, G,
H, I, J
Middle East includes Libya, Algeria, Morocco, Tunisia, Sudan, Egypt and Iran.
8-18
08
Maintenance under severe usage conditions - Except Europe (but
include Russia)
Maintenance
operation
Maintenance Intervals
Driving condition
Steering gear rack,
linkage and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G
Front suspension ball
joints
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G
Disc brakes and pads,
calipers and rotors
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, G, H
Parking brake
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, G, H
Driveshaft and boots
I
Inspect more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J
Cabin air filter
R
Replace more frequently
depending on the
condition
C, E
Maintenance item
Severe driving conditions
A. Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles) in normal temperature
or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperature
B. Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances
C. Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt spread roads
D. Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather
E. Driving in heavy dust conditions
F. Driving in heavy traffic area
G. Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roads repeatedly
H. Towing a trailer, or using a camper or roof rack
I. Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle towing
J. Driving over 170 km/h (106 mile/h)
K. Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
8-19
Maintenance
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Engine oil and filter
Vapor hose and fuel filler cap
The engine oil and filter should be
changed at the intervals specified in the
maintenance schedule. If the vehicle
is being driven in severe conditions,
more frequent oil and filter changes are
required.
The vapor hose and fuel filler cap should
be inspected at those intervals specified
in the maintenance schedule. Make sure
a new vapor hose or fuel filler cap is
correctly replaced.
HSG (Hybrid Starter & Generator)
belt
The HSG belt should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections
Air cleaner filter
A genuine HYUNDAI air cleaner filter
is recommended when the filter is
replaced.
Spark plugs
Make sure to install new spark plugs of
the correct heat range.
Check the fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
We recommend an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer replace any damaged or leaking
parts immediately.
Cooling system
Fuel filter
Engine coolant/inverter coolant
A clogged filter can limit the speed
at which the vehicle may be driven,
damage the emission system and cause
multiple issues such as hard starting. If
an excessive amount of foreign matter
accumulates in the fuel tank, the
filter may require replacement more
frequently. After installing a new filter,
run the engine for several minutes,
and check for leaks at the connections.
Fuel filters should be installed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-20
Check cooling system components, such
as radiator, coolant reservoir, hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
The coolant should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Dual clutch transmission fluid
The dual clutch transmission fluid should
be inspected according to the intervals
specified in the maintenance schedule.
Engine clutch actuator fluid
The engine clutch actuator fluid level
should be inspected or replaced to the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
08
Brake hoses and lines
Exhaust pipe and muffler
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and any
leakage. Replace any deteriorated or
damaged parts immediately.
Visually inspect the exhaust pipes,
muffler and hangers for cracks,
deterioration, or damage. Start
the engine and listen carefully for
any exhaust gas leakage. Tighten
connections or replace parts as
necessary.
Brake fluid
Check the brake fluid level in the brake
fluid reservoir. The level should be
between the MIN and the MAX marks
on the side of the reservoir. Use only
hydraulic brake fluid conforming to DOT
4 specification.
Parking brake
Inspect the parking brake system.
Brake discs, pads, calipers and
rotors
Check the pads, the disc, and the rotor
for any excessive wear-out. Inspect
calipers for any fluid leakage
For more information on checking the
pads or lining wear limit, refer to the
HYUNDAI web site.
(http://service.hyundai-motor.com)
Suspension mounting bolts
Check the suspension connections for
looseness or damage. Retighten to the
specified torque.
Steering gear box, linkage &
boots/lower arm ball joint
With the vehicle stopped and the hybrid
system off, check for excessive free-play
in the steering wheel. Check the linkage
for bends or damage. Check the dust
boots and ball joints for deterioration,
cracks, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Drive shafts and boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and clamps
for cracks, deterioration, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts and, if
necessary, repack the grease.
Air conditioning refrigerant
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
8-21
Maintenance
ENGINE OIL
Checking the engine oil level
1. Follow all of the oil manufacturer’s
precautions.
2. Be sure the vehicle is on the level
ground in P (Park) with the parking
brake set and the wheels blocked.
3. Turn the engine on and allow the
engine to reach normal operating
temperature.
4. Turn the engine off and wait about
five minutes for the oil to return to the
oil pan.
5. Pull the dipstick out, wipe it clean, and
re-insert it fully.
Use only the specified engine oil (Refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” section in chapter 2).
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your engine:
• Do not overfill with engine oil. Add oil
in small quantities and recheck level
to ensure engine is not overfilled.
• Do not spill engine oil when adding
or changing engine oil. Use a funnel
to help prevent oil from being spilled
on engine components. Wipe off
spilled oil immediately.
Checking the engine oil and
filter
OOSH089002L
6. Pull the dipstick out again and check
the level. The level should be between
F (Full) and L (Low).
OOSH089003L
7. If it is near or at L, add enough oil to
bring the level to F.
8-22
We recommend that the engine oil
and filter be changed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer according to the
Maintenance Schedule at the beginning
of this chapter.
08
ENGINE COOLANT/INVERTER COOLANT
The high-pressure cooling system has a
reservoir filled with year-round antifreeze
coolant. The reservoir is filled at the
factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at
the beginning of the winter season and
before traveling to a colder climate.
If the coolant level is low, add enough
distilled (deionized) water to bring the
level to the MAX mark, but do not overfill.
If frequent additions are required, we
recommend that you see an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for a cooling system
inspection.
Engine coolant cap
Checking the coolant level
Engine coolant
OOSH089008L
Inverter coolant cap
OOSH089005L
Inverter coolant
OOSH089007L
OOSH089006L
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen or
deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between the MAX and the MIN marks on
the side of the coolant reservoir when
the engine is cool.
WARNING
Never remove the engine
coolant cap and/or inverter
coolant cap or the drain plug
while the engine and radiator
are hot. Hot coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure,
causing serious injury.
8-23
Maintenance
Turn the vehicle off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the engine coolant
cap and/or inverter coolant cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure is
released from the cooling system. When
you are sure all the pressure has been
released, press down on the cap, using
a thick towel, and continue turning
counterclockwise to remove it.
WARNING
Make sure the coolant cap is properly
closed after refilling coolant. Otherwise
the engine could be overheated while
driving.
Engine compartment front view
Information
The engine coolant and/or inverter coolant
level is influenced by the hybrid system
temperature. Before checking or refilling
the engine coolant and/or inverter coolant,
turn the hybrid vehicle off.
WARNING
The electric motor for the
cooling fan may continue to
operate or start up when the
engine is not running and can
cause serious injury. Keep
hands, clothing and tools away
from the rotating fan blades of
the cooling fan.
Keep hands, clothing and tools away
from the rotating fan blades of the
cooling fan.
Always turn off the vehicle unless the
vehicle has to be inspected with the
engine on. Be cautious as the cooling
fan may operate if the negative (-)
battery terminal is not disconnected.
8-24
OOSH089010L
1. Check if the coolant cap label is
straight In front.
Engine compartment rear view
OOSH089009L
2. Make sure that the tiny protrusions
inside the coolant cap is securely
interlocked.
08
Recommended coolant
• When adding coolant, use only
deionized water, distilled water or soft
water for your vehicle and never mix
hard water in the coolant filled at the
factory.
• An incorrect coolant mixture can
result in severe malfunction or
engine/hybrid system damage.
• The engine in your vehicle has
aluminum engine parts and must be
protected by an phosphate-based
ethylene glycol coolant to prevent
corrosion and freezing.
• Do not use alcohol or methanol
coolant or mix them with the specified
coolant.
• Do not use a solution that contains
more than 60% antifreeze or less than
35% antifreeze, which would reduce
the effectiveness of the solution.
For mixing percentage, refer to the
following table:
Ambient
Temperature
Mixture Percentage
(volume)
Antifreeze
Water
-15°C (5°F)
35
65
-25°C (-31°F)
40
60
-35°C (31°F)
50
50
-45°C (-49°F)
60
40
Information
If in doubt about the mix ratio, a 50%
water and 50% antifreeze mix is the
easiest to mix together as it will be the
same quantity of each. It is suitable to
use for most temperature ranges of -35°C
(-31°F) and higher.
Changing coolant
We recommend that coolant be changed
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
according to the Maintenance Schedule
at the beginning of this chapter.
WARNING
Do not use engine coolant or antifreeze
in the washer fluid reservoir.
Engine coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Engine coolant may also cause damage
to paint and body trim.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to engine parts, put
a thick towel around the engine coolant
cap and/or inverter coolant cap before
refilling the coolant to prevent the
coolant from overflowing into engine
parts, such as the alternator.
8-25
Maintenance
HYBRID STARTER &
GENERATOR (HSG) BELT
BRAKE FLUID
Checking the brake fluid level
Checking the Hybrid Starter &
Generator (HSG) belt
We recommend that you have the
Hybrid Starter & Generator (HSG) belt
inspected or replaced according to the
Maintenance Schedule in this chapter by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
CAUTION
When the HSG belt is worn out or
damaged, replace the belt.
Otherwise, it may cause engine
overheating or battery discharge.
WARNING
• Turn the vehicle off while you inspect
the engine or Hybrid Starter &
Generator (HSG) belt. Otherwise it
may result in serious injury.
• Keep hands, clothing etc. away from
the Hybrid Starter & Generator (HSG)
belt.
OOSH089011L
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX and MIN marks on the side
of the reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap and
adding brake fluid, clean the area around
the reservoir cap thoroughly to prevent
brake fluid contamination.
If the level is low, add the specified
brake fluid to the MAX level. The level
will fall with accumulated mileage. This
is a normal condition associated with
the wear of the brake linings. If the fluid
level is excessively low, we recommend
that the brake system be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
If the brake system requires frequent
additions of fluid this could indicate
a leak in the brake system. We
recommend that the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
8-26
08
WASHER FLUID
WARNING
Checking the washer fluid level
Do not allow brake fluid to come in
contact with your eyes. If brake fluid
comes in contact with your eyes, flush
your eyes with clean water for at least
15 minutes and get immediate medical
attention.
NOTICE
• Do not allow brake fluid to contact
the vehicle’s body paint, as paint
damage will result.
• Brake fluid, which has been exposed
to open air for an extended time
should NEVER be used as its quality
cannot be guaranteed. It should be
disposed of properly.
• Do not use the wrong kind of brake
fluid. A few drops of mineral based
oil, such as engine oil, in your brake
system can damage brake system
parts.
Information
Use only the specified brake fluid (refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” section in chapter 2).
OOSH089012L
Check the fluid level in the washer fluid
reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain
water may be used if washer fluid is not
available. However, use washer solvent
with antifreeze characteristics in cold
climates to prevent freezing.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury or death, take
the following safety precautions when
using washer fluid:
• Do not use engine coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir. Engine coolant can
severely obscure visibility when
sprayed on the windshield and
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident or damage to
paint and body trim.
• Do not allow sparks or flame to
contact the washer fluid or the
washer fluid reservoir. Washer fluid
may contain alcohol and can be
flammable.
• Do not drink washer fluid and avoid
contact with skin. Washer fluid is
harmful to humans and animals.
• Keep washer fluid away from
children and animals.
8-27
Maintenance
AIR CLEANER
Filter replacement
OOSH089015L
OOSH089013L
Do not attempt to wash or to rinse it, as
water will damage the filter.
If soiled, the air cleaner filter must be
replaced.
Replace the filter according to the
Maintenance Schedule.
2. Wipe the inside of the air cleaner.
3. Replace the air cleaner filter.
4. Lock the cover with the cover
attaching clips.
5. Check that the cover is firmly
installed.
Information
If the vehicle is operated in extremely
dusty or sandy areas, replace the air
cleaner filter more often than the
usual recommended intervals (Refer
to “Maintenance Under Severe Usage
Conditions” section in this chapter).
NOTICE
OOSH089014L
1. Loosen the air cleaner cover attaching
clips and open the cover.
8-28
• Do not drive with the air cleaner filter
removed. This will result in excessive
engine wear.
• When removing the air cleaner filter,
be careful that dust or dirt does not
enter the air intake, or damage may
result.
• Use HYUNDAI genuine parts. Use of
non-genuine parts could damage the
air flow sensor.
08
CABIN AIR FILTER
Filter inspection
The cabin air filter should be replaced
according to the Maintenance Schedule.
If the vehicle is operated in severely airpolluted cities or on dusty rough roads
for a long period, it should be inspected
more frequently and replaced sooner.
Replace the cabin air filter by following
the procedure below and be careful to
avoid damaging other components.
OOSH089017L
2. Press and hold the lock (1) on the right
side of the cover.
3. Pull out (2) the cover
OOSH089016L
1. With the glove box open, remove
the stoppers on both sides to allow
the glove box to hang freely on the
hinges.
OOSH089018L
4. Replace the cabin air filter.
5. Reassemble in the reverse order of
disassembly.
NOTICE
Install a new cabin air filter in the
correct direction with the arrow symbol
(↓) facing downwards, to prevent noise
and reduce effectiveness.
8-29
Maintenance
WIPER BLADES
Blade inspection
Contamination of either the windshield
or the wiper blades with foreign matter
can reduce the effectiveness of the
windshield wipers.
Common sources of contamination are
insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments
used by some commercial car washes. If
the blades are not wiping properly, clean
both the window and the blades with a
good cleaner or mild detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with clean water.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper blades,
arms or other components, do not:
• Use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or near
them.
• Attempt to move the wipers
manually.
• Use non-specified wiper blades.
Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by
automatic car washes have been known to
make the windshield difficult to clean.
8-30
Information
Wiper blades are consumable items.
Normal wear of the wipers may not be
covered by your vehicle warranty.
Blade replacement
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn or
cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
• In order to prevent damage to the
hood and the wiper arms, the wiper
arms should only be lifted when in
the top wiping position.
• Always return the wiper arms to the
windshield before driving.
08
Front windshield wiper blade
replacement
Type A
OOSH089021L
OOSH089019L
1. Raise the wiper arm and slightly rotate
the wiper blade assembly to expose
the plastic locking clip.
3. Lift it off the arm.
4. Install the blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
5. Return the wiper arm on the
windshield.
Type B
OOSH089020L
2. Press the clip (1) and slide the blade
assembly downward (2).
OOSH089022L
1. Raise the wiper arm.
8-31
Maintenance
Rear window wiper blade
replacement
OOSH089023L
2. Lift up the wiper blade clip (1).
Then pull down the blade assembly
and remove it (2).
OOSH089025L
1. Raise the wiper arm and then rotate
the wiper blade assembly (1).
2. Pull out the wiper blade assembly (2).
OOSH089024L
3. Install the new blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
4. Return the wiper arm on the
windshield.
8-32
OOSH089026L
3. Install the new blade assembly by
inserting the center part into the slot
in the wiper arm until it clicks into
place (3).
4. Make sure the blade assembly is
installed firmly by trying to pull it
slightly.
5. Rotate back the blade assembly so
that it aligns with the wiper arm.
To prevent damage to the wiper arms or
other components, we recommend that
you have the wiper blades replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
08
TIRES AND WHEELS
WARNING
Tire failure may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident. To
reduce risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
• Inspect your tires monthly for proper
inflation as well as wear and damage.
• The recommended cold tire pressure
for your vehicle can be found in this
manual and on the tire label located
on the driver’s side center pillar.
Always use a tire pressure gauge to
measure tire pressure. Tires with
too much or too little pressure wear
unevenly causing poor handling.
• Check the pressure of the spare
every time you check the pressure of
the other tires on your vehicle.
• Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of braking
effectiveness, steering control, or
traction.
• ALWAYS replace tires with the
same size, type, construction and
tread pattern as each tire that was
originally supplied with this vehicle.
Using tires and wheels other than
the recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics,
poor vehicle control, or negatively
affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) resulting in a serious
accident.
Tire care
For proper maintenance, safety, and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended tire
inflation pressures and stay within the
load limits and weight distribution
recommended for your vehicle.
OOSH019023L
All specifications (sizes and pressures)
can be found on a label attached to the
driver’s side center pillar.
Recommended cold tire inflation
pressures
All tire pressures (including the spare)
should be checked when the tires are
cold. “Cold tires” means the vehicle has
not been driven for at least three hours
or driven less than 1.6 km (one mile).
Warm tires normally exceed
recommended cold tire pressures by 28
to 41 kPa (4 to 6 psi). Do not release air
from warm tires to adjust the pressure
or the tires will be under-inflated. For
recommended inflation pressure, refer to
“Tire and Wheels” section in chapter 2.
8-33
Maintenance
WARNING
Recommended pressures must be
maintained for the best ride, vehicle
handling, and minimum tire wear.
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire failure
that could result in loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Severe under-inflation can lead to
severe heat build-up, causing blowouts,
tread separation and other tire failures
that can result in the loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident. This
risk is much higher on hot days and
when driving for long periods at high
speeds.
CAUTION
• Under-inflation results in excessive
wear, poor handling and reduced
fuel economy. Wheel deformation
is also possible. Keep your tire
pressures at the proper levels. If a
tire frequently needs refilling, we
recommend it be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Over-inflation produces a harsh ride,
excessive wear at the center of the
tire tread, and a greater possibility of
damage from road hazards.
8-34
Check tire inflation pressure
Check your tires, including the spare tire,
once a month or more.
How to check
Use a good quality tire pressure gauge
to check tire pressure. You can not tell
if your tires are properly inflated simply
by looking at them. Radial tires may look
properly inflated when they are underinflated.
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve
stem. Press the tire gauge firmly onto the
valve to get a pressure measurement. If
the cold tire inflation pressure matches
the recommended pressure on the
tire and loading information label, no
further adjustment is necessary. If the
pressure is low, add air until you reach
the recommended pressure. Make sure
to put the valve caps back on the valve
stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or
moisture could get into the valve core
and cause air leakage. If a valve cap is
missing, install a new one as soon as
possible.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the tire
pressure with the tire gauge. Be sure
to put the valve caps back on the valve
stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or
moisture could get into the valve core
and cause air leakage. If a valve cap is
missing, install a new one as soon as
possible.
08
Tire rotation
To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI
recommends that the tires be rotated
every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or sooner
if irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for uneven
wear and damage. Abnormal wear is
usually caused by incorrect tire pressure,
improper wheel alignment, out-ofbalance wheels, severe braking or severe
cornering. Look for bumps or bulges in
the tread or side of the tire. Replace the
tire if you find any of these conditions.
Replace the tire if fabric or cord is visible.
After rotation, be sure to bring the front
and rear tire pressures to specification
and check lug nut tightness (proper
torque is 11~13 kgf·m [79~94 lbf·ft]).
Information
The outside and inside of the
unsymmetrical tire is distinguishable.
When installing an unsymmetrical tire, be
sure to install the side marked “outside”
face the outside. If the side marked
“inside” is installed on the outside, it
will have a negative effect on vehicle
performance.
WARNING
• Do not use the compact spare tire for
tire rotation.
• Do not mix bias ply and radial ply
tires under any circumstances.
This may cause unusual handling
characteristics that may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
OHI078078
Disc brake pads should be inspected for
wear whenever tires are rotated.
8-35
Maintenance
Wheel alignment and tire
balance
WARNING
The wheels on your vehicle were aligned
and balanced carefully at the factory to
give you the longest tire life and best
overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to have
your wheels aligned again. However,
if you notice unusual tire wear or your
vehicle pulling one way or the other, the
alignment may need to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when
driving on a smooth road, your wheels
may need to be rebalanced.
NOTICE
Incorrect wheel weights can damage
your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use
only approved wheel weights.
Tire replacement
Tread wear indicator
OHI078080
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear
indicator will appear as a solid band
across the tread. This shows there is less
than 1.6 mm (1/16 in.) of tread left on the
tire. Replace the tire when this happens.
Do not wait for the band to appear across
the entire tread before replacing the tire.
8-36
To reduce the risk of DEATH or SERIOUS
INJURY:
• Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of braking
effectiveness, steering control, and
traction.
• Always replace tires with the same
size as each tire that was originally
supplied with this vehicle. Using
tires and wheels other than the
recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics,
poor vehicle control, or negatively
affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) resulting in a serious
accident.
• When replacing tires (or wheels), it
is recommended to replace the two
front or two rear tires (or wheels)
as a pair. Replacing just one tire
can seriously affect your vehicle’s
handling.
• Tires degrade over time, even when
they are not being used. Regardless
of the remaining tread, HYUNDAI
recommends that tires be replaced
after six (6) years of normal service.
• Heat caused by hot climates or
frequent high loading conditions can
accelerate the aging process. Failure
to follow this warning may cause
sudden tire failure, which could lead
to a loss of vehicle control resulting
in an accident.
08
Compact spare tire replacement
(if equipped)
A compact spare tire has a shorter
tread life than a regular size tire.
Replace it when you can see the tread
wear indicator bars on the tire. The
replacement compact spare tire should
be the same size and design tire as the
one provided with your new vehicle
and should be mounted on the same
compact spare tire wheel. The compact
spare tire is not designed to be mounted
on a regular size wheel, and the compact
spare tire wheel is not designed for
mounting a regular size tire.
WARNING
The original tire should be repaired or
replaced as soon as possible to avoid
failure of the spare and loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.The
compact spare tire is for emergency
use only. Do not operate your vehicle
over 80 km/h (50 mph) when using the
compact spare tire.
Wheel replacement
When replacing the metal wheels for any
reason, make sure the new wheels are
equivalent to the original factory units in
diameter, rim width and offset.
Tire traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you drive
on worn tires, tires that are improperly
inflated or on slippery road surfaces.
Tires should be replaced when tread
wear indicators appear. To reduce the
possibility of losing control, slow down
whenever there is rain, snow or ice on
the road.
Tire maintenance
In addition to proper inflation, correct
wheel alignment helps to decrease tire
wear. If you find a tire is worn unevenly,
have your dealer check the wheel
alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This will
increase vehicle ride comfort and tire
life. Additionally, a tire should always
be rebalanced if it is removed from the
wheel.
8-37
Maintenance
Tire sidewall labeling
This information identifies and describes
the fundamental characteristics of
the tire and also provides the tire
identification number (TIN) for safety
standard certification. The TIN can be
used to identify the tire in case of a
recall.
OHI078081
1. Manufacturer or brand name
Manufacturer or brand name is shown.
2. Tire size designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tire
size designation. You will need this
information when selecting replacement
tires for your car. The following explains
what the letters and numbers in the tire
size designation mean.
8-38
Example tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as an
example only; your tire size designator
could vary depending on your vehicle.)
205/60R16 92H
205 - Tire width in millimeters.
60 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section
height as a percentage of its width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
16 - Rim diameter in inches.
92 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum load
the tire can carry.
H - Speed Rating Symbol. See the
speed rating chart in this section for
additional information.
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with important
information that you need if you ever
have to replace one. The following
explains what the letters and numbers in
the wheel size designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
6.5JX16
6.5 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
16 - Rim diameter in inches.
08
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the
different speed ratings currently being
used for passenger vehicle tires. The
speed rating is part of the tire size
designation on the sidewall of the tire.
This symbol corresponds to that tire’s
designed maximum safe operating
speed.
Speed Rating
Symbol
Maximum Speed
S
180 km/h (112 mph)
T
190 km/h (118 mph)
H
210 km/h (130 mph)
V
240 km/h (149 mph)
W
270 km/h (168 mph)
Y
300 km/h (186 mph)
3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
Any tires that are over six years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
(including the spare tire) should be
replaced by new ones. You can find the
manufacturing date on the tire sidewall
(possibly on the inside of the wheel),
displaying the DOT Code. The DOT Code
is a series of numbers on a tire consisting
of numbers and English letters. The
manufacturing date is designated by the
last four digits (characters) of the DOT
code.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
The front part of the DOT shows a plant
code number, tire size and tread pattern
and the last four numbers indicate week
and year manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 1519 represents that the
tire was produced in the 15th week of
2019.
4. Tire ply composition and material
The number of layers or plies of
rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include steel,
nylon, polyester, and others. The letter
“R” means radial ply construction; the
letter “D“ means diagonal or bias ply
construction; and the letter “B” means
belted-bias ply construction.
5. Maximum permissible inflation
pressure
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer to
the Tire and Loading Information label
for recommended inflation pressure.
6. Maximum load rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that can be
carried by the tire. When replacing the
tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that
has the same load rating as the factory
installed tire.
7. Uniform tire quality grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall between
tread shoulder and maximum section
width.
For example:
TREADWEAR 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
8-39
Maintenance
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative
rating based on the wear rate of the tire
when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would
wear one-and-a-half times (1½) as well
on the government course as a tire
graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service
practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the
sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires. The
tires available as standard or optional
equipment on your vehicle may vary with
respect to grade.
Traction - AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those grades
represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet
pavement as measured under controlled
conditions on specified government
test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction
performance.
8-40
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this
tire is based on straightahead braking
traction tests, and does not include
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning,
or peak traction characteristics.
Temperature - A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C representing the tire’s
resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat when
tested under controlled conditions on a
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can cause
the material of the tire to degenerate
and reduce tire life, and excessive
temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. Grades B and A represent higher
levels of performance on the laboratory
test wheel than the minimum required
by law.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly
inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, under-inflation, over-inflation,
or excessive loading, either separately
or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible sudden tire failure.
This may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
08
Low aspect ratio tires
The aspect ratio is lower than 50 on low
aspect ratio tires.
Because low aspect ratio tires are
optimized for handling and braking, their
sidewall is a little stiffer than a standard
tire. Also low aspect ratio tires tend to be
wider and consequently have a greater
contact patch with the road surface. In
some instances they may generate more
road noise compared with standard tires.
CAUTION
The side wall of a low aspect ratio
tire is shorter than the normal one.
Thus, the low-aspect wheel and tire
are easily damaged. Follow the below
instructions.
• When driving on a rough road or
driving off a road, be careful not to
damage the tires and wheels. After
driving, inspect the tires and wheels.
• When passing over a pothole, speed
bump, manhole, or curb stone,
drive the vehicle slowly so as not to
damage the tires and wheels.
• When there is an impact on a tire,
inspect the tire condition. Or, contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 3,000 km (1,800
miles) to prevent tire damage.
• It is difficult to recognize a tire
damage only with your eyes. When
there is a slight hint of a tire damage,
check and replace the tire to prevent
the damage caused by air leakage.
• When a tire is damaged while
driving on a rough road, off a road,
or over obstacles, such as a pothole,
manhole, or curb stone, your
warranty does not cover the damage.
• The tire information is specified on
the tire side wall.
8-41
Maintenance
FUSES
■ Blade type
Normal
Blown
■ Cartridge type
Normal
■ Multi fuse
Blown
Normal
Normal
Blown
Blown
OLF074075
8-42
A vehicle’s electrical system is protected
from electrical overload damage by
fuses.
This vehicle has 2 (or 3) fuse panels, one
located in the driver’s side panel bolster,
the other in the engine compartment.
If any of your vehicle’s lights,
accessories, or controls do not work,
check the appropriate circuit fuse. If a
fuse has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
If the electrical system does not work,
first check the driver’s side fuse panel.
Before replacing a blown fuse, turn the
engine and all switches off, and then
disconnect the negative battery cable.
Always replace a blown fuse with one of
the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this
indicates an electrical problem.
Avoid using the system involved and
immediately consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
08
Information
Three kinds of fuses are used: blade type
for lower amperage rating, cartridge
type, and multi fuse for higher amperage
ratings.
Instrument panel fuse
replacement
WARNING
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but
another fuse of the same rating.
• A higher capacity fuse could cause
damage and possibly cause a fire.
• Do not install a wire or aluminum
foil instead of the proper fuse even as a temporary repair. It may
cause extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
NOTICE
Do not use a screwdriver or any other
metal object to remove fuses because
it may cause a short circuit and damage
the system.
OOSH089027L
1.
2.
3.
4.
Turn the vehicle off.
Turn all other switches off.
Open the fuse panel cover.
Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
OOSH089028L
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight out.
Use the removal tool provided in the
engine compartment fuses panel
cover.
8-43
Maintenance
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it if
it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in
the instrument panel fuse panels (or in
the engine compartment fuse panel).
7. Push in a new fuse of the same rating,
and make sure it fits tightly in the
clips. If it fits loosely, we recommend
that you consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
In an emergency, if you do not have
a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same
rating from a circuit you may not need
for operating the vehicle, such as the
cigarette lighter fuse.
If the headlamps or other electrical
components do not work and the fuses
are undamaged, check the fuse panel
in the engine compartment. If a fuse is
blown, it must be replaced with the same
rating.
Fuse switch
Information
OOSH089030L
If the fuse switch is OFF, “Turn on FUSE
SWITCH” message will appear.
The fuse switch is turned OFF to minimize
battery draw when the vehicle is in storage
or in transportation where the vehicle will
not be operated for some time.
Under normal conditions, the fuse switch
should be set to the ON position.
NOTICE
Do not move the transportation fuse
switch repeatedly. The fuse switch may
be damaged.
OOSH089029L
Always, place the fuse switch to the ON
position.
If you move the switch to the OFF
position, some items such as the audio
system and digital clock must be reset
and the smart key may not work properly.
8-44
08
Engine compartment panel fuse
replacement
Blade type fuse
NOTICE
After checking the fuse panel in the
engine compartment, securely
install the fuse panel cover. You may
hear a clicking sound if the cover is
securely latched. If it is not securely
latched, electrical failure may occur
from water contact.
Multi fuse
OOSH089031L
Cartridge type fuse
OOSH089033L
OOSH089032L
If the multi fuse is blown, we recommend
that you consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches off.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tap and pulling up.
4. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. To remove or insert the
fuse, use the fuse puller in the engine
compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly in
the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-45
Maintenance
Fuse/relay panel description
Instrument panel fuse panel
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse box on
your vehicle, refer to the fuse box label.
OOSH089034L
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OOSH089042L
8-46
08
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
5
10A
Electro Chromic Mirror, A/V & Navigation Head
Unit, Audio, A/T Shift Lever Indicator, A/C
Control Module, Rear Seat Warmer Module,
Console Switch LH/RH, Head Lamp Leveling
Device Actuator LH/RH, Front Air Ventilation
Seat Control Module, Front Seat Warmer Control
Module, AMP
4
10A
Lane Departure Warning Unit, Crash Pad Switch,
EPB Switch, BMS Control Module, Active Air
Flap, VESS Unit, Electric Water Pump (HEV),
Blind-Spot Collision Warning Radar LH/RH
Interior Lamp
10A
Front Vanity Lamp LH/RH, Room Lamp,
Overhead Console Lamp, Wireless Charger Unit,
Luggage Lamp
Air bag
15A
SRS Control Module
Fuse Name
Symbol
Module 5
MODULE
Module 4
MODULE
Ignition 1
IG1
25A
PCB Block
Cluster
CLUSTER
Module 3
Memory 2
Air bag
Indicator
Start
10A
Instrument Cluster, Head Up Display Unit
3
10A
BCM, DCT Shift Lever, Stop Lamp Switch
2
7.5A
VESS Unit
7.5A
A/C Control Module, Instrument Cluster
7.5A
Burglar Alarm Relay, Transaxle Range Switch
MODULE
MEMORY
IND
8-47
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
10A
E/R Junction Block, Wireless Charger Unit, BCM,
USB Charging Connector, Smart Key Control
Module, Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit,
Power Outside Mirror Switch, AMP, BMS Control
Module
7.5A
Immobilizer Module, Smart Key Control Module,
BMS Control Module
MEMORY
10A
Wireless Charger Unit, Instrument Cluster, Rain
Sensor, BCM, A/C Control Module, Auto Light
& Photo Sensor, ICM Relay Box (Outside Mirror
Folding/Unfolding Relay), Head Up Display Unit
Multi Media
MULTI
MEDIA
10A
Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit
Electric Water
Pump
EWP
10A
Electric Water Pump (HEV)
Electric Power
Steering 1
1
7.5A
EPS Unit
10A
Tail Gate Relay
15A
Smart Key Control Module
7.5A
Front Seat Warmer Control Module, Front Air
Ventilation Seat Control Module, Rear Seat
Warmer Module, BLDC Cooling Fan
Heated
Steering
15A
BCM
Sunroof
20A
Sunroof Motor
25A
Power Window (RH) Relay, Power Window Main
Switch, Passenger Power Window Switch (LHD),
Rear Power Window Switch (RH), Driver Safety
Power Window Module (RHD), Passenger Safety
Power Window Module (LHD)
Fuse Name
Module 2
Symbol
2
MODULE
3
Button Start 3
Memory 1
1
Tailgate
1
Button Start 1
Module 7
Power
Window
Right-hand
8-48
7
MODULE
RH
08
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Power Window
Left-hand
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
LH
25A
Power Window (LH) Relay, Power Window
Main Switch, Passenger Power Window Switch
(RHD), Rear Power Window Switch (LH),
Driver Safety Power Window Module (LHD),
Passenger Safety Power Window Module (RHD)
2
7.5A
Immobilizer Module, Smart Key Control
Module, Start/Stop Button Switch
Symbol
Button Start 2
Brake Switch
BRAKE
SWITCH
7.5A
Stop Lamp Switch, Smart Key Control Module
Air conditioner
A/C
7.5A
Ionizer, A/C Control Module, Electronic A/C
Compressor, E/R Junction Block
15A
Multifunction Switch
25A
Rear Seat Warmer Module
10A
BMS Control Module
DRV
30A
Driver Seat Manual Switch
AMP
30A
AMP
MODULE
10A
Hazard Switch, Active Air Flap
20A
Door Lock/Unlock Relay, ICM Relay Box (Dead
Lock Relay)
Washer
Seat Heater
Rear
Battery
Management
System
RR
BATTERY
MANAGEMENT
Power Seat
Driver
AMP
Module 1
Door Lock
1
8-49
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
Fuse
Rating
Circuit Protected
10A
Wiper Motor, PCB Block (Front Wiper (Low)
Relay)
7.5A
BCM, Smart Key Control Module
25A
Front Seat Warmer Control Module, Front Air
Ventilation Seat Control Module
Heated Mirror
10A
Driver Power Outside Mirror, Passenger Power
Outside Mirror, A/C Control Module
Rear Heated
25A
Rear Defogger (+) (Upper)
Wiper Front 1
25A
Wiper Motor, PCB Block (Front Wiper (Low)
Relay)
Wiper Rear
15A
Rear Wiper Relay, BCM, Rear Wiper Motor
FCA Unit
10A
FCA Unit
Passenger
Power Seat
25A
Passenger Seat Manual Switch
Burglar Alarm
Horn
10A
Burglar Alarm Horn Relay
Wiper Front 2
Module 6
Seat Heater
Front
8-50
6
MODULE
FRT
08
Engine compartment fuse panel
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse panel
in your vehicle, refer to the fuse panel
label.
OOSH089035L
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OOSH089043L
8-51
Maintenance
Engine compartment fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
Fuse
Rating
MAIN
150A
Low Voltage DC-DC Converter, E/R Junction
Block
60A
PCB Block
60A
IGPM
60A
IGPM
50A
IGPM
60A
Engine Room Junction Block
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
IG1
40A
Without Smart Key : Ignition Switch With Smart
Key : E/R Junction Block
IG2
40A
Without Smart Key : Ignition Switch With Smart
Key : E/R Junction Block
80A
EPS Unit
50A
Engine Room Junction Block
PTC
HEATER
50A
Engine Room Junction Block
CLUTCH
ACTUATOR
40A
Clutch Actuator
80A
IEB Motor
80A
Cooling Fan BLDC (Trailer option)
5
2
3
4
1
Multi Fuse
1
1
PTC
HEATER
2
8-52
Circuit Protected
08
Engine compartment fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
3
Circuit Protected
15A
TCM
10A
HPCU
10A
Electric Water Pump (HEV)
40A
IGPM
DCT
40A
TCM
DCT
40A
TCM
10A
Engine Room Junction Block
POWER
OUTLET
40A
Engine Room Junction Block
B/UP
LAMP
10A
Audio, Rear Combination Lamp (IN) LH/RH,
Electro Chromic Mirror
POWER
OUTLET
20A
Cigarette Lighter
20A
Power Outlet
10A
Engine Room Junction Block, Purge Control
Solenoid Valve, Mass Air Flow Sensor, Canister
Close Valve
20A
ECM
DCT
EWP
1
2
1
Fuse
Fuse
Rating
1
3
2
POWER
OUTLET
S2
E1
8-53
Maintenance
Engine compartment fuse panel
Fuse Name
Symbol
S1
Circuit Protected
15A
Oxygen Sensor (Up), Oxygen Sensor (Down)
20A
Ignition Coil #1~#4
10A
ECM
15A
ECM
15A
HPCU, Clutch Actuator (HEV)
15A
DCT Shift Lever, TCM, Transaxle Range Switch
10A
Fuel Pump Relay, Camshaft Position Sensor #1
(Intake), Camshaft Position Sensor #2 (Exhaust),
Oil Control Valve #1 (Intake), Oil Control Valve #2
(Exhaust)
BATTERY
C/FAN
15A
Engine Room Junction Block
FUEL
PUMP
20A
Fuel Pump Relay
15A
Horn Relay.
40A
IEB Unit
40A
IEB Unit
10A
IEB Unit
40A
Trailer Unit
IGN
COIL
E2
E3
4
DCT
S3
Fuse
8-54
Fuse
Rating
08
LIGHT BULBS
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
to replace most vehicle light bulbs. It is
difficult to replace vehicle light bulbs
because other parts of the vehicle must
be removed before you can get to the
bulb. This is especially true for removing
the headlamp assembly to get to the
bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlamp
assembly can result in damage to the
vehicle.
WARNING
• Prior to working on a light, depress
the foot brake, shift to P (Park), apply
the parking brake, set the ignition
switch to the LOCK/OFF position
and take the key with you when
leaving the vehicle to avoid sudden
movement of the vehicle and to
prevent possible electric shock.
• Be aware the bulbs may be hot and
may burn your fingers.
NOTICE
Be sure to replace the burned-out bulb
with one of the same wattage rating.
Otherwise, it may cause damage to the
fuse or electrical wiring system.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, do not clean the
headlamp lens with chemical solvents
or strong detergents.
Information
The headlamp and tail lamp lenses could
appear frosty if the vehicle is washed after
driving or the vehicle is driven at night
in wet weather. This condition is caused
by temperature difference between the
lamp inside and outside and, it does not
indicate a problem with your vehicle.
When moisture condenses in the lamp,
it will be removed after driving with the
headlamp on. The removable level may
differ depending on lamp size, lamp
position and environmental condition.
However, if moisture is not removed, we
recommend that your vehicle is inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
• A normally functioning lamp may
flicker momentarily to stabilize the
vehicle’s electrical control system.
However, if the lamp goes out after
flickering momentarily, or continues to
flicker, we recommend the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
• The position lamp may not turn on
when the position lamp switch is turned
on, but the position lamp and headlamp
switch may turn on when the headlamp
switch is turned on. This may be caused
by network failure or vehicle electrical
control system malfunction. If this
occurs, we recommend the system be
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Information
The headlamp aiming should be adjusted
after an accident or after the headlamp
assembly is reinstalled at an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
8-55
Maintenance
High beam
Information
Traffic Change (For Europe)
The low beam light distribution is
asymmetric. If you go abroad to a country
with opposite traffic direction, this
asymmetric part will dazzle oncoming car
driver. To prevent dazzle, ECE regulation
demand several technical solutions (ex.
automatic change system, adhesive
sheet, down aiming). This headlamps are
designed not to dazzle opposite drivers. So,
you need not change your headlamps in a
country with opposite traffic direction.
OOSH089037L
Low beam
Headlamp, daytime running
light (DRL), position lamp, turn
signal lamp and static lamp bulb
replacement
Type A
OOSH089038L
OOSH089036L
(1) Headlamp (High)
(2) Headlamp (Low)
(3) Daytime running light (DRL)/ Position
lamp
(4) Turn signal lamp
8-56
Headlamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the bulb cover by turning it
counterclockwise.
3. Remove the bulb socket from the
headlamp assembly by turning it
counterclockwise
4. Disconnect the bulb socketconnector.
5. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
08
Daytime running light (DRL)/Position
lamp
If the lamp (LED) does not operate, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
WARNING
OOSH089039L
• Handle halogen bulbs with care.
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces
of glass that could cause injuries if
broken.
• Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
• Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
• Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
• A bulb should be operated only when
installed in a headlamp.
• If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
OOSH089040L
Turn signal lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
3. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
4. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
5. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly.
6. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
8-57
Maintenance
Type B
WARNING
OOSH089041L
(1) Static lamp (Low beam assist)
(2) Headlamp (Low/High)
(3) Daytime running light (DRL)/ Position
lamp
(4) Turn signal lamp
OOSH089044L
Static lamp (Low beam assist)
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the bulb cover by turning it
counterclockwise.
3. Remove the bulb socket from the
headlamp assembly by turning it
counterclockwise
4. Disconnect the bulb socketconnecter.
5. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
8-58
OOSH089039L
• Handle halogen bulbs with care.
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces
of glass that could cause injuries if
broken.
• Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
• Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
• Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
• A bulb should be operated only when
installed in a headlamp.
• If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
08
Front fog lamp replacement
(if equipped)
OOSH089040L
Turn signal lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
3. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
4. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
5. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly.
6. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
Headlamp (Low/High) and Daytime
running light (DRL)/Position lamp
If the lamp (LED) does not operate, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
OOSH089045L
OOSH089046L
1. Loosen the pin-type retainers of the
under cover and then remove the
undercover.
2. Reach your hand into the back of the
front bumper.
3. Disconnect the power connector from
the socket.
4. Remove the bulb-socket from
the housing by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots of the
housing.
5. Install a new bulb-socket into the
housing by aligning the tabs on the
socket with the slots in the housing.
Push the socket into the housing and
turn the socket clockwise.
8-59
Maintenance
Headlamp aiming (For Europe)
Headlamp aiming
Halogen type
OOSH089047L
LED type
3. Draw vertical lines (Vertical lines
passing through respective head
lamp centers) and a horizontal line
(Horizontal line passing through
center of head lamps) on the screen.
4. With the headlamp and battery in
normal condition, aim the headlamps
so the brightest portion falls on the
horizontal and vertical lines.
5. To aim the low beam left or right,
turn the driver clockwise or
counterclockwise. To aim the low
beam up or down, turn the driver
clockwise or counterclockwise.
To aim the high beam up or
down, turn the driver clockwise or
counterclockwise.
Front fog lamp aiming
OOSH089048L
1. Inflate the tires to the specified
pressure and remove any loads from
the vehicle except the driver, spare
tire, and tools.
2. The vehicle should be placed on a flat
floor.
8-60
OOSH089049L
The front fog lamp can be aimed as the
same manner of the headlamps aiming.
With the front fog lamps and battery
in normal condition, aim the front fog
lamps. To aim the front fog lamp up
or down, turn the driver clockwise or
counterclockwise.
08
Aiming point
Halogen lamp
LED lamp
OOS077063L
H1 : Height between the head lamp bulb center and ground (Low beam)
H2 : Height between the head lamp bulb center and ground (High beam)
H3 : Height between the fog lamp bulb center and ground
W1 : Distance between the two head lamp bulbs centers (Low beam)
W2 : Distance between the two head lamp bulbs centers (High beam)
W3 : Distance between the two fog lamp bulbs centers
Vehicle condition
Without driver
With driver
mm (in)
With driver
H1
H2
Halogen
625 (24.6)
617 (24.28)
LED
Halogen
mm (in)
Vehicle condition
Without driver
Lamp type
mm (in)
LED
617 (24.28)
608
(23.93)
W1
W2
Halogen
1506
(59.27)
1320
(51.95)
LED
LED
332 (13.06)
323 (12.71)
620 (24.4)
Lamp type
Halogen
mm (in)
628 (24.71)
H3
1503 (59.15)
1504
(59.15)
1320
(51.95)
W3
880 (34.63)
1503 (59.15)
8-61
Maintenance
Headlamp low beam (LHD side)
Based on 10m screen
Car axis
Vertical line of left
headlamp bulb center
Vertical line of right
headlamp bulb center
Horizontal line of
headlamp bulb center
Cut-off line
100
W1
(Low beam)
H1
(Low beam)
GROUND
OPDE076082
1. Turn the low beam on without driver aboard.
2. The cut-off line should be projected in the cut-off line shown in the picture.
3. When aiming the low beam, vertical aiming should be adjusted after adjusting the
horizontal aiming.
4. If headlamp leveling device is equipped, adjust the head lamp leveling device
switch to “0”.
8-62
08
Headlamp low beam (RHD side)
Based on 10m screen
Car axis
Vertical line of left
headlamp bulb center
Vertical line of right
headlamp bulb center
Horizontal line of
headlamp bulb center
Cut-off line
100
W1
(Low beam)
H1
(Low beam)
GROUND
OPDE076083
1. Turn the low beam on without driver aboard.
2. The cut-off line should be projected in the cut-off line shown in the picture.
3. When aiming the low beam, vertical aiming should be adjusted after adjusting the
horizontal aiming.
4. If headlamp leveling device is equipped, adjust the head lamp leveling device
switch to “0”.
8-63
Maintenance
Front fog lamp
Based on 10m screen
OOS077065L
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Vertical line of the left fog lamp bulb center
Horizontal line of fog lamp bulb center
Cut-off line
Car axis
W3 (Front fog)
Vertical line of the right fog lamp bulb center
H3 (Front fog)
Ground
1. Turn the front fog lamp on without the driver aboard.
2. The cut-off line should be projected in the allowable range (shaded region).
8-64
08
Side repeater lamp replacement
Rear combination lamp bulb
replacement
Type A
OOSH089050L
If the lamp (LED) (1) does not operate, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
OOSH089056L
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Stop/Tail lamp
Tail lamp
Turn signal lamp
Fog lamp
(LHD : Left side, RHD : Right side)
(5) Backup lamp
(LHD : Right side, RHD : Left side)
OOSH089051L
Stop and Tail lamp
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Loosen the lamp assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screw-driver.
8-65
Maintenance
OOSH089052L
4. Remove the rear combination lamp
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
OOSH089054L
Tail lamp
1. Turn off the vehicle.
2. Open the tailgate.
3. Remove the service cover using a flatblade screw-driver.
OOSH089053L
5. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
6. - Stop lamp (A)
Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
- Tail lamp (B)
Remove the bulb from the socket by
pulling out the bulb.
7. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
8-66
OOSH089055L
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
5. Remove the bulb from the socket by
pulling out the bulb.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
Turn signal lamp, fog lamp and backup
lamp
If the lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
08
High mounted stop lamp bulb
replacement
Type B
OOSH089056L
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Stop/tail lamp
Stop/tail lamp
Turn signal lamp
Fog lamp
(LHD : Left side, RHD : Right side)
(5) Backup lamp
(LHD : Right side, RHD : Left side)
Stop/tail lamp
If the lamp (LED) does not operate, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
OOSH089057L
If the lamp (LED) (1) does not operate, we
recommend that the system be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LED lamps cannot be replaced as
a single unit because it is an integrated
unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced
with the unit.
A skilled technician should check or
repair the LED lamp, for it may damage
related parts of the vehicle.
Turn signal lamp, fog lamp and backup
lamp
If the lamp does not operate, we
recommend that you have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
8-67
Maintenance
License plate light bulb
replacement
Interior light bulb replacement
Map lamp, room lamp, vanity mirror
lamp and luggage compartment
lamp
Map lamp
••
Type A
OOSH089058L
1. Loosen the lens retaining screws with
a philips head screw-driver.
2. Remove the lens.
3. Remove the socket by turning it
counterclockwise.
4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
5. Install a new bulb.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
OOSH089059L
••
Type B
OOSH089060L
8-68
08
Room lamp
••
Type A
Luggage compartment lamp
OOSH089061L
••
Type B
OOSH089065L
1. Using a flat-head screw-driver, gently
pry the lens from the interior light
housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
3. Install a new bulb into the socket.
4. Align the lens tabs with the interior
light housing notches and snap the
lens into place.
OOSH089063L
Vanity mirror lamp
NOTICE
Use care not to dirty or damage lenses,
lens tabs, and plastic housings.
OOSH089062L
8-69
Maintenance
APPEARANCE CARE
Exterior care
Exterior general caution
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning and
caution statements that appear on the
label.
Finish maintenance
Washing
To help protect your vehicle’s finish from
rust and deterioration, wash it thoroughly
and frequently at least once a month
with lukewarm or cold water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to the
removal of any accumulation of salt, dirt,
mud, and other foreign materials. Make
sure the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors and rocker panels are kept
clear and clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar deposits
can damage your vehicle’s finish if not
removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain water
may not completely remove all these
deposits. A mild soap, safe for use on
painted surfaces, should be used.
After washing, rinse the vehicle
thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
8-70
High-pressure washing
• When using high-pressure washers,
make sure to maintain sufficient
distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
• Do not spray the camera, sensors or
its surrounding area directly with a
high pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may cause
the device to not operate normally.
• Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged
if they come into contact with high
pressure water.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see
if they have been affected by water
before getting on the road. If braking
performance is impaired, dry the
brakes by applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward speed.
08
NOTICE
• Do not use strong soap, chemical
detergents or hot water, and do not
wash the vehicle in direct sunlight
or when the body of the vehicle is
warm.
• Be careful when washing the side
windows of your vehicle.
• Especially, with high-pressure water,
water may leak through the windows
and wet the interior.
• To prevent damage to the plastic
parts, do not clean with chemical
solvents or strong detergents.
• To prevent damage to the charging
door, make sure to close and lock the
vehicle doors when washing (highpressure washing, automatic car
washing, etc.) the vehicle.
Waxing
A good coat of wax is a barrier between
your paint and contaminate. Keeping
a good coat of wax on your vehicle will
help protect it.
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle before
waxing. Use a good quality liquid or
paste wax, and follow the manufacturer’s
instructions. Wax all metal trim to protect
it and to maintain its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials
with a spot remover will usually strip the
wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax
these areas even if the rest of the vehicle
does not yet need waxing.
NOTICE
• Wiping dust or dirt off the body with
a dry cloth will scratch the finish.
• Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or
caustic agents on chrome-plated or
anodized aluminum parts. This may
result in damage to the protective
coating and cause discoloration or
paint deterioration.
NOTICE
Finish damage repair
OOSH089066L
• Water washing in the engine
compartment including high
pressure water washing may cause
the failure of electrical circuits
located in the engine compartment.
• Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major repair
expense.
NOTICE
If your vehicle is damaged and requires
any metal repair or replacement,
be sure the body shop applies anticorrosion materials to the parts
repaired or replaced.
8-71
Maintenance
Bright-metal maintenance
WARNING
• To remove road tar and insects, use
a tar remover, not a scraper or other
sharp object.
• To protect the surfaces of brightmetal
parts from corrosion, apply a coating
of wax or chrome preservative and rub
to a high luster.
• During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see if
they have been affected by water. If
braking performance is impaired, dry
the brakes by applying them lightly
while maintaining a slow forward
speed.
Underbody maintenance
• Do not use abrasive cleaner,
polishing compound, solvent, or wire
brushes on aluminum wheels.
• Clean the wheel when it has cooled.
• Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly with
water. Also, clean the wheels after
driving on salted roads.
• Do not wash the wheels with highspeed car wash brushes.
• Do not use any cleaners containing
acid or alkaline detergents.
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated
rusting can occur on underbody parts
such as the fuel lines, frame, floor pan
and exhaust system, even though they
have been treated with rust protection.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody
and wheel openings with lukewarm or
cold water once a month, after off-road
driving and at the end of each winter. Pay
special attention to these areas because
it is difficult to see all the mud and dirt.
It will do more harm than good to wet
down the road grime without removing
it. The lower edges of doors, rocker
panels, and frame members have drain
holes that should not be allowed to clog
with dirt; trapped water in these areas
can cause rusting.
8-72
Aluminum wheel maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated with a
clear protective finish.
NOTICE
08
Corrosion protection
Protecting your vehicle from corrosion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, HYUNDAI produces vehicles
of the highest quality. However, this is
only part of the job. To achieve the longterm corrosion resistance your vehicle
can deliver, the owner’s cooperation and
assistance is also required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion
on your vehicle are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath
the vehicle.
• Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion
or minor scrapes and dents which
leave unprotected metal exposed to
corrosion.
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle is
regularly exposed to corrosive materials,
corrosion protection is particularly
important. Some of the common causes
of accelerated corrosion are road salts,
dust control chemicals, ocean air and
industrial pollution.
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to occur.
For example, corrosion is accelerated
by high humidity, particularly when
temperatures are just above freezing. In
such conditions, the corrosive material is
kept in contact with the vehicle surfaces
by moisture that is slow to evaporate.
Mud is particularly corrosive because
it is slow to dry and holds moisture in
contact with the vehicle. Although the
mud appears to be dry, it can still retain
moisture and promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate
corrosion of parts that are not properly
ventilated so the moisture can be
dispersed. For all these reasons, it is
particularly important to keep your
vehicle clean and free of mud or
accumulations of other materials. This
applies not only to the visible surfaces
but particularly to the underside of the
vehicle.
8-73
Maintenance
To help prevent corrosion
Keep your vehicle clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free of
corrosive materials. Attention to the
underside of the vehicle is particularly
important.
• If you live in a high-corrosion area —
where road salts are used, near the
ocean, areas with industrial pollution,
acid rain, etc.—, you should take extra
care to prevent corrosion. In winter,
hose off the underside of your vehicle
at least once a month and be sure to
clean the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
• When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, pay particular attention to the
components under the fenders and
other areas that are hidden from view.
Do a thorough job; just dampening
the accumulated mud rather than
washing it away will accelerate
corrosion rather than prevent it. Water
under high pressure and steam are
particularly effective in removing
accumulated mud and corrosive
materials.
• When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members, be
sure that drain holes are kept open so
that moisture can escape and not be
trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
8-74
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your vehicle in a damp,
poorly ventilated garage. This creates
a favorable environment for corrosion.
This is particularly true if you wash your
vehicle in the garage or drive it into the
garage when it is still wet or covered with
snow, ice or mud. Even a heated garage
can contribute to corrosion unless it is
well ventilated so moisture is dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish should
be covered with “touch-up” paint as
soon as possible to reduce the possibility
of corrosion. If bare metal is showing
through, the attention of a qualified body
and paint shop is recommended.
Bird droppings are highly corrosive and
may damage painted surfaces in just a
few hours. Always remove bird droppings
as soon as possible.
Interior care
Interior general precautions
Prevent caustic solutions such as
perfume and cosmetic oil, from
contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage or discoloration.
If they do contact the interior parts,
wipe them off immediately. See the
instructions for the proper way to clean
vinyl.
08
NOTICE
• Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
• When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use
neutral detergents or low alcohol
content solutions. If you use high
alcohol content solutions or acid/
alkaline detergents, the color of the
leather may fade or the surface may
get stripped off.
Cleaning the upholstery and interior
trim
Vinyl (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.
Clean vinyl surfaces with a vinyl cleaner.
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
fabric with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solution
recommended for upholstery or carpets.
Remove fresh spots immediately with
a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do
not receive immediate attention, the
fabric can be stained and its color can be
affected. Also, its fire-resistant properties
can be reduced if the material is not
properly maintained.
NOTICE
Leather (if equipped)
• Features of seat leather
-- Leather is made from the outer skin
of an animal, which goes through a
special process to be available for
use. Since it is a natural product,
each part differs in thickness or
density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature and
humidity.
-- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
-- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving
comfort and stability.
-- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
NOTICE
• Wrinkles or abrasions which appear
naturally from usage are not covered
by warranty.
• Belts with metallic accessories,
zippers or keys inside the back
pocket may damage the seat fabric.
• Make sure not to wet the seat. It may
change the nature of natural leather.
• Jeans or clothes which could bleach
may contaminate the surface of the
seat covering fabric.
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may affect the
fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant
properties.
8-75
Maintenance
• Caring for the leather seats
-- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the seat. It
will prevent abrasion or damage of
the leather and maintain its quality.
-- Wipe the natural leather seat cover
often with dry or soft cloth.
-- Use of proper leather protector may
prevent abrasion of the cover and
helps maintain the color. Be sure to
read the instructions and consult
a specialist when using leather
coating or protective agent.
-- Light colored (beige, cream beige)
leather is easily contaminated and
the stain is noticeable. Clean the
seats frequently.
-- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
• Cleaning the leather seats
-- Remove all contaminations
instantly. Refer to instructions below
for removal of each contaminant.
-- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminated spot.
Wipe off the cream with a wet cloth
and remove water with a dry cloth.
-- Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until
contaminations do not smear.
-- Oil
Remove oil instantly with
absorbable cloth and wipe with
stain remover used only for natural
leather.
-- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and
remove gradually.
Cleaning the seat belt webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any
mild soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the soap.
Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing
because this may weaken the seat belt.
Cleaning the interior window glass
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become fogged (that is, covered
with an oily, greasy or waxy film), they
should be cleaned with glass cleaner.
Follow the directions on the glass cleaner
container.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the inside of
the rear window. This may result in
damage to the rear window defroster
grid.
8-76
08
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
The emission control system of your
vehicle is covered by a written limited
warranty. Please see the warranty
information contained in the Service
Passport in your vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emission control system to meet all
applicable emission regulations. There
are three emission control systems, as
follows.
(1) Crankcase emission control system
(2) Evaporative emission control system
(3) Exhaust emission control system
In order to ensure the proper function
of the emission control systems, it
is recommended that you have your
vehicle inspected and maintained
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in
accordance with the maintenance
schedule in this manual.
NOTICE
For the Inspection and Maintenance
Test (with Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system)
• To prevent the vehicle from misfiring
during dynamometer testing, turn
the Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system off by pressing the ESC
switch (ESC OFF light illuminated).
• After dynamometer testing is
completed, turn the ESC system back
on by pressing the ESC switch again.
1. Crankcase emission control
system
The positive crankcase ventilation system
is employed to prevent air pollution
caused by blow-by gases being emitted
from the crankcase. This system supplies
fresh filtered air to the crankcase through
the air intake hose. Inside the crankcase,
the fresh air mixes with blow-by gases,
which then pass through the PCV valve
into the induction system.
2. Evaporative emission control
system
The Evaporative Emission Control System
is designed to prevent fuel vapors from
escaping into the atmosphere.
Canister
Fuel vapors generated inside the fuel
tank are absorbed and stored in the
onboard canister. When the engine is
running, the fuel vapors absorbed in the
canister are drawn into the surge tank
through the purge control solenoid valve.
Purge Control Solenoid Valve (PCSV)
The purge control solenoid valve
is controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM); when the engine coolant
temperature is low during idling, the
PCSV closes so that evaporated fuel
is not taken into the engine. After the
engine warms-up during ordinary
driving, the PCSV opens to introduce
evaporated fuel to the engine.
8-77
Maintenance
3. Exhaust emission control
system
The Exhaust Emission Control System is
a highly effective system which controls
exhaust emissions while maintaining
good vehicle performance.
When the engine starts or fails to start,
excessive attempts to restart the engine
may cause damage to the emission
system.
Engine exhaust (carbon monoxide)
precautions
• Carbon monoxide can be present
with other exhaust fumes. If you smell
exhaust fumes of any kind in your
vehicle, drive with all the windows
fully open. Have your vehicle checked
and repaired immediately.
WARNING
Engine exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide (CO). Though colorless and
odorless, it is dangerous and could be
lethal if inhaled. Follow the instructions
on this page to avoid CO poisoning.
• Do not operate the engine in confined
or closed areas (such as garages) any
more than what is necessary to move
the vehicle in or out of the area.
• When the vehicle is stopped in an
open area for more than a short time
with the engine running, adjust the
ventilation system (as needed) to draw
outside air into the vehicle.
• Never sit in a parked or stopped
vehicle for any extended time with the
engine running.
• When the engine stalls or fails to
start, excessive attempts to restart
the engine may cause damage to the
emission control system.
8-78
Operating precautions for catalytic
converters (if equipped)
WARNING
The exhaust system and catalytic
converter are very hot during and
immediately after the engine has been
running. To avoid SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH:
• Do not park, idle, or drive the vehicle
over or near flammable objects, such
as grass, vegetation, paper, leaves,
etc. A hot exhaust system can ignite
flammable items under your vehicle.
• Keep away from the exhaust system
and catalytic converter or you may
get burned.
Also, Do not remove the heat sink
around the exhaust system, do not
seal the bottom of the vehicle, and
do not coat the vehicle for corrosion
control. It may present a fire risk
under certain conditions.
Your vehicle is equipped with a catalytic
converter emission control device.
To prevent damage to the catalytic
converter and to your vehicle, take the
following precautions:
• Use only UNLEADED FUEL for
gasoline engines.
• Do not operate the vehicle when
there are signs of engine malfunction,
such as misfire or a noticeable loss of
performance.
• Do not misuse or abuse the engine.
Examples of misuse are coasting with
the hybrid system off and descending
steep grades in gear with the hybrid
system off.
• Do not operate the engine at high
idle speed for extended periods (5
minutes or more).
08
• Do not modify or tamper with any
part of the engine or emission
control system. All inspections and
adjustments must be made by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level.
Running out of fuel could cause the
engine to misfire, damaging the
catalytic converter.
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
(if equipped)
The Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
system removes the soot in the exhaust
gas.
The GPF system automatically burns
(or oxidizes) the accumulated soot in
accordance with driving situations,
unlike a disposable air filter.
In other words, the accumulated soot is
automatically purged out by the engine
control system and by the high exhaustgas temperature at normal/ high driving
speeds.
However, when the vehicle is continually
driven at repeated short distances or
driven at low speed for a long time,
the accumulated soot may not be
automatically removed because of low
exhaust gas temperature. In this case,
the accumulated soot may reach a
certain amount regardless of the soot
oxidization process, then the GPF lamp
) will illuminate.
(
The Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)
Lamp stops illuminating, when the
driving speed exceeds 80 km/h (50 mph)
with engine rpm 1,500 ~ 4,000 and the
gear in the 3rd position or above for
approximately 30 minutes.
When the GPF lamp starts to blink or
the warning message “Check exhaust
system” pops up even though the
vehicle was driven as mentioned above,
we recommend that you have the
GPF system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
With GPF lamp blinking for an extended
period of time, it may damage the GPF
system and lower the fuel economy.
CAUTION
Gasoline Fuel
(if equipped with GPF)
We recommend you to use only the
regulated gasoline fuels, when your
vehicle is equipped with the GPF
system.
When you use other gasoline fuels
which contain unspecified additives,
they may damage the GPF system and
cause exhaust emission problems.
8-79
Maintenance
PROCEDURE FOR ENTERING FORCED ENGINE ACTIVATION
MODE
If the engine needs to be kept running
while the vehicle is stopped to inspect
emission gas or perform vehicle
maintenance, follow below procedure to
enter forced engine activation mode.
1. Place the shift lever in P (Park)
position with the vehicle stopped.
Engage the parking brake. Then,
follow the steps (1) to (5).
Below steps from (1) to (5) must be
completed within 60 sec. If not, the
process is reset and you must start
again from step (1).
(1) Turn the ignition switch to the ON
position. Vehicles equipped with the
smart key, press the Engine Start/
Stop button twice without depressing
the brake pedal.
(2) Place the shift lever in P (Park)
position and depress the accelerator
pedal twice.
(3) Place the shift lever in N (Neutral)
position and depress the accelerator
pedal twice.
(4) Place the shift lever in P (Park)
position and depress the accelerator
pedal twice.
(5) With the brake pedal depressed, start
the engine, and maintain idling state.
The engine remains in idle state and
the forced engine activation mode
is maintained even when the gear is
shifted to a different position.
8-80
2. “ ” indicator on the instrument
cluster blinks when the vehicle is in
forced engine activation mode. Check
the “ ” indicator blinking to ensure
that the forced engine activation
mode is correctly entered.
The “ ” indicator continues blinking
until the forced engine activation
mode is cancelled. When the mode is
cancelled the “ ” indicator will stop
blinking.
3. To cancel the forced engine activation
mode, turn the vehicle off.
Appendix
Шофиране през зимата (Bulgarian)............................................................... 9-2
Téli vezetés (Hungarian).................................................................................... 9-5
Vetrarakstur (Icelandic).....................................................................................9-8
Jazda zimą (Polish)............................................................................................9-11
A
Appendix
ШОФИРАНЕ ПРЕЗ ЗИМАТА (BULGARIAN)
Тежките атмосферни условия през
зимата предизвикват по-бързо
износване на нашите гуми и други
проблеми. За да сведете до минимум
проблемите, свързани с шофирането
през зимата, трябва да следвате
препоръките по-долу:
Условия на сняг или
поледица
Трябва да спазвате достатъчна
дистанция между Вашия автомобил и
автомобила пред Вас.
Натискайте спирачката леко.
Ускоряването, бързото наби ране
на скорост, рязкото натискане на
спирачката, както и резките завои
са практики за шофиране, при които
може да възникне опасна ситуация.
Когато забавяте скоростта, при
спирането използвайте възможно
повече двигателя. Внезапното
натискане на спирачки назаледена
пътна настилка може да предизвика
занасяне на автомобила.
За шофиране на Вашия автомобил
в дълбок сняг може да е нужно да
използвате гуми за движение по сняг
или да поставите вериги за гуми върху
Вашите гуми.
Винаги носете със себе си оборудване
за аварийни ситуации. Някои от
нещата, които можете да решите
да носите, включват вериги за гуми,
сапани или вериги за теглене, мигаща
рампа, сигнална ракета, пясък,
лопата, кабели за стартиране от
външен акумулатор, стъргалка за лед,
ръкавици, постелка за земята, работно
облекло, одеяло и др.
9-2
Гуми за сняг
ПРЕДУПРЕЖДЕНИЕ
Гумите за сняг трябва да отговарят
по размер и тип на стандартните
гуми на автомобила. В противния
случай безопасността и
управлението на Вашия автомобил
може да се влошат.
Ако монтирате гуми за сняг на
Вашия автомобил, непременно
използвайте радиални гуми със
същия размер и товарен индекс
като тези на оригиналните гуми.
Монтирайте гуми за сняг и на
четирите колела, за да балансирате
експлоатацията на Вашия автомобил
при всякакви атмосферни условия.
Предоставяното сцепление от
гумите за сняг върху суха пътна
настилка може да не е толкова
високо, колкото предоставяното
сцепление от оригиналните гуми,
с които е оборудван автомобилът.
Консултирайте се с доставчика на
гумите за допустимата максимална
скорост.
Информация
Не монтирайте гуми с шипове, преди да
сте проверили местните и общинските
разпоредби за възможни ограничения в
тяхната употреба.
A
Вериги за гуми
ПРЕДУПРЕЖДЕНИЕ
OOSH069128L
Тъй като страниците на радиалните
гуми са по-тънки в сравнение с
другите типове гуми, те могат да се
повредят, ако върху тях се монтират
някои видове вериги за сняг. Ето
защо се препоръчва използването на
гуми за сняг, а не на вериги за сняг.
Ако се налага да бъдат използвани
вериги, използвайте оригинални
части от HYUNDAI и монтирайте
веригите за гуми, след като сте се
запознали с инструкциите, доставени
с веригите за гуми. Щетите на
Вашия автомобил, предизвикани от
употреба на неподходящи вериги за
гуми, не се покриват от гаранцията,
предоставяна от производителя на
Вашия автомобил.
Използването на вериги за сняг
може да влоши управляемостта на
Вашия автомобил:
• Шофирайте с не повече от
30 км/ч (20 мили в час) или с
препоръчаната от производителя
на веригите скорост, използвайки
по-ниската от двете стойности.
• Шофирайте внимателно и
избягвайте издатини върху
настилката, дупки, остри завои
и други опасности на пътя,
които може да предизвикват
подскачане на автомобила.
• Избягвайте остри завои или
спиране, при което колелата се
блокират.
Информация
• Винаги поставяйте веригите по две
и върху предните колела. Следва
да се отбележи, че поставянето на
веригите върху гумите ще позволи
прилагането на по-голяма движеща
сила, но няма да предотврати
занасянето встрани.
• Не монтирайте гуми с шипове,
преди да сте проверили местните и
общинските разпоредби за възможни
ограничения в тяхната употреба.
9-3
Appendix
Поставяне на веригите
Когато поставяте вериги на
гумите, спазвайте инструкциите на
производителя и монтирайте веригите
възможно по-стегнато. С поставени
вериги шофирайте бавно (с не повече
от 30 км/ч (20 мили в час)). Ако чуете,
че веригите са в контакт с каросерията
или шасито, спрете и ги обтегнете.
Ако те все още са в контакт, намалете
скоростта до преустановяване на
шума. Свалете веригите веднага, щом
започнете да се движите по почистени
пътища.
С поставени вериги за сняг паркирайте
автомобила на равно място далеч
от пътното движение. Включете
аварийните светлини на автомобила
и поставете светлоотразителния
предупредителен триъгълник зад
автомобила (ако имате такъв).
Винаги паркирайте автомобила в
положението за паркинг P (Паркинг),
дръпнете ръчната спирачка и
изключете двигателя, преди да
поставите веригите за сняг.
9-4
БЕЛЕЖКА
Когато използвате вериги за гуми:
• Ако веригите са с неправилен
размер или са поставени
неправилно, възможно е
да повредят маркучите на
спирачната система, окачването,
каросерията или колелата.
• Използвайте вериги клас S
според класификацията на
Дружеството на автомобилните
инженери (SAE) или телени
вериги.
• Ако чуете шум, предизвикан
от контакт на веригите с
каросерията, обтегнете ги, за
да не докосват каросерията на
автомобила.
• За избягване на повреди по
каросерията, след като изминете
0,5~1,0 километра (0,3~0,6 мили),
повторно обтегнете веригите.
• Не поставяйте вериги за гуми,
ако автомобилът е оборудван с
алуминиеви джанти на колелата.
Ако се налага използване на
вериги, използвайте телени
вериги.
• Използвайте телени вериги с
дебелина на телта под 12 mm
(0,47 инча), за да се избегне
повреждането на връзката на
веригата.
A
TÉLI VEZETÉS (HUNGARIAN)
A télen jellemző nehéz vezetési
körülmények miatt a gumik gyorsan
elhasználódnak és egyéb problémák
is jelentkezhetnek. A téli vezetési
problémák minimalizálása érdekében
tartsa be az alábbi tanácsokat:
Havas vagy jeges körülmények
Tartson kellő távolságot a jármű és az ön
előtt lévő jármű között.
Finoman fékezzen. A gyorshajtás, a
túlzott mértékű gyorsulás, a hirtelen
fékezés és az élesen történő kanyarodás
rendkívül kockázatos.Lassuláskor amíg
csak lehet, motorfékkel fékezzen. A havas
vagyjeges úton történő hirtelen fékezés
esetén a jármű megcsúszhat.
A jármű mély hóban történő
használatához szükség lehet téli gumira
vagy arra, hogy hóláncot szereljen az
abroncsokra.
Mindig vigyen magával vészhelyzeti
felszerelést. Ezek közé tartozik többek
között a hólánc, a vontatókötél vagy
-lánc, a villogó fény, vészfáklya, homok,
lapát, bikakábel, jégkaparó, kesztyű,
ponyva, takaró stb.
Téli gumik
FIGYELEM
A téli gumik méretének és típusának
meg kell egyeznie a jármű nyári
gumijával. Ellenkező esetben a
jármű biztonsága és kezelhetősége
kérdésessé válhat.
Ha téli gumit szerel a járműre, ügyeljen
arra, hogy az eredeti abroncsokkal
egyező méretű és terhelési tartományú
radiál abroncsokat használjon. Szereljen
téli gumit mind a négy kerékre, hogy
a jármű minden idejárási helyzetben
egyformán kezelhető legyen. A téli
gumik által száraz úton biztosított
vonóerő nem biztos, hogy akkora, mint
az eredeti abroncsoké. Ellenőrizze
az abroncskereskedővel a maximális
sebességre vonatkozó javaslatokat.
Információ
Szöges gumik felszerelése előtt ellenőrizze
a helyi és önkormányzati szabályzásban
az ezek használatra vonatkozó esetleges
korlátozásokat.
9-5
Appendix
Hóláncok
FIGYELEM
OOSH069128L
Mivel a radiál abroncsok oldalfala
vékonyabb a többi típusú abroncsnál,
ezért azok a hólánc felszerelése során
megsérülhetnek. Ezért a hóláncok helyett
téli gumi használata javasolt. Ha muszáj
hóláncot használni, használjon eredeti
HYUNDAI alkatrészeket és a hóláncot
csak a mellékelt utasítások áttekintését
követően szerelje fel. A járműnek a
hólánc helytelen használatából adódó
sérülése nem tartozik a jármű gyártója
által biztosított garancia hatálya alá.
9-6
A hóláncok használata hátrányosan
érintheti a jármű kezelhetőségét:
• Vezessen 30 km/h (20 mph)
sebességgel vagy a lánc gyártója
által javasolt sebességgel, amelyik az
alacsonyabb.
• Vezessen óvatosan és kerülje
el a bukkanókat, lyukakat, éles
kanyarokat és az úton lévő egyéb
veszélyeket, melyek jármű
megugrását okozhatják.
• Kerülje az éles kanyarodást és a
blokkolásos fékezést.
Információ
• A hóláncokat csak párban és az első
abroncsokra szerelje fel. Itt jegyeznénk
meg, hogy a hóláncok abroncsra
történő felszerelése nagyobb tapadóerőt
biztosít, azonban nem akadályozza meg
az oldalirányú csúszást.
• Szöges gumik felszerelése előtt
ellenőrizze a helyi és önkormányzati
szabályzásban az ezek használatra
vonatkozó esetleges korlátozásokat.
A
A lánc felszerelése
A hóláncok felszerelésekor kövesse
a gyártó utasításait és a lehető
legszorosabban szerelje fel azokat.
Felszerelt hólánccal lassan (30 km/h
(20 mph) sebességnél lassabban)
közlekedjen. Ha azt hallja, hogy a láncok
hozzáérnek a karosszériához vagy az
alvázhoz, álljon meg és húzza meg
azokat. Ha továbbra is érintkeznek,
lassítson le, amíg a zaj meg nem
szűnik. Amint tiszta útra ér, szerelje le a
hóláncot.
a hóláncok felszerelésekor a járművel
vízszintes, a forgalomtól távol eső
helyen parkoljon. Kapcsolja be a jármű
vészvillogóját és helyezzen elakadásjelző
háromszöget a jármű mögé (ha van).
Mindig helyezze a járművet P (Parkolás)
helyzetbe, húzza be a rögzítőféket és
állítsa le a motort a hóláncok felszerelése
előtt.
ÉRTESÍTÉS
Hóláncok használata esetén
• A helytelen méretű vagy helytelenül
felszerelt láncok károsíthatják a
jármű fékvezetékeit, felfüggesztését,
karosszériáját és abroncsait.
• SAE “S” osztályú láncot vagy drótos
hóláncot használjon.
• ha olyan zajt hall, ami arra utal,
hogy a láncok hozzáérnek a
karosszériához, húzza meg a
láncokat, hogy megakadályozza
a láncok karosszériához történő
hozzáérését.
• A karosszéria károsodásának
elkerülése érdekében húzza meg
a láncokat 0,5 -1,0 km (0,3 - 0,6
mérföld) vezetést követően.
• Ne használjon hóláncot alufelnivel
szerelt járműveken. Ha ez
elkerülhetetlen, drótos hóláncot
használjon.
• Legfeljebb 12 mm (0,47 in) vastag
drótos hóláncot használjon a
lánccsatlakozások károsodásának
megelőzése érdekében.
9-7
Appendix
VETRARAKSTUR (ICELANDIC)
Hörð veðurskilyrði að vetri slíta
hjólbörðum hratt og valda öðrum
vandamálum. Til að lágmarka vandamál
í vetrarakstri ættir þú að taka eftirfarandi
ábendingum:
Snjór eða hálka
Þú þarft að halda nægilegri fjarlægð á
milli ökutækisins þíns og ökutækisins
fyrir framan þig.
Beittu hemlunum varlega. Hraðakstur,
snögg hröðun, skyndileg beiting hemla
og krappar beygjur eru hugsanlega mjög
hættuleg iðja. Á meðan hægt er niður
skal nota hreyfil hemilinn til hins ýtrasta.
Skyndileg beiting hemla á snævi þöktum
eðaísuðum vegum kunna að valda því að
ökutækið renni til.
Til að aka ökutækinu þínu í djúpum
snjó kann að vera nauðsynlegt að nota
snjó hjólbarða eða setja snjókeðjur á
hjólbarðana.
Hafðu alltaf með þér neyðar búnað.
Sumir þeirra hluta sem þú kannt að vilja
hafa með þér eru snjókeðjur, dráttarólar
eða -keðjur, vasaljós, neyðarblys, sandur,
skófla, ræsikaplar, rúðuskafa, hanskar,
jarðdúkur, samfestingur, teppi, o.s.frv.
9-8
Snjóhjólbarðar
VIÐVÖRUN
Snjóhjólbarðar ættu að vera jafngildir
venjulegum hjólbörðum ökutækisins
að stærð og tegund. Að öðrum kosti
kann það að hafa slæm áhrif á öryggi og
stjórnun ökutækisins þíns.
Ef þú setur snjóhjólbarða á ökutækið
þitt skaltu gæta þess að nota þverbanda
hjólbarða af sömu stærð og álagssviði
og upprunalegu hjólbarðarnir. Settu
snjóhjólbarða á öll fjögur hjólin til að
jafna út meðhöndlun ökutækisins við öll
veðurskilyrði. Ekki er víst að gripið sem
snjóhjólbarðar veita á þurrum vegum
sé jafnmikið og upprunalegir hjólbarðar
ökutækisins veita. Athugaðu hjá
hjólbarðasalanum varðandi ráðleggingar
um hámarkshraða.
Upplýsingar
Settu ekki upp neglda hjólbarða án þess
að athuga fyrst staðbundnar reglugerðir
og reglugerðir sveitarfélagsins varðandi
mögulega takmarkanir á notkun þeirra.
A
Snjókeðjur
VIÐVÖRUN
OOSH069128L
Þar sem hliðarnar á þverbanda
hjólbörðum eru þynnri en á öðrum
tegundum hjólbarða kunna þeir að
skemmast ef sumar tegundir snjókeðja
eru settar á þá. Þar af leiðandi er mælt
með notkun snjó hjólbarða í stað
snjókeðja. Ef nauðsynlegt er að nota
snjókeðjur skal nota ósvikna HYUNDAIvarahluti og setja snjókeðjurnar upp
eftir að hafa skoðað leiðbeiningarnar
sem fylgdu með keðjunum. Skemmdir
á ökutækinu þínu af völdum rangrar
notkunar snjókeðja falla ekki undir
ökutækis ábyrgð framleiðanda.
Notkun snjókeðja kann að hafa alvarleg
áhrif á stjórnun ökutækisins:
• Aktu á undir 30 km/klst (20 m/klst)
hraða, eða samkvæmt ráðlögðum
hraðatakmörkunum framleiðanda
keðjanna, hvort sem er hægara.
• Aktu varlega og forðastu ójöfnur,
holur, krappar beygjur og aðrar
vegahættur, sem kunna að valda því
að ökutækið skoppi.
• Forðastu krappar beygjur eða að læsa
hjólunum þegar þú hemlar.
Upplýsingar
• Settu snjókeðjurnar aðeins á í pörum
og á framhjólin. Taka skal fram að
uppsetning snjókeðja á hjólbarðana
mun veita meiri aksturskraft en kemur
ekki í veg fyrir hliðarskrik.
• Settu ekki upp neglda hjólbarða án
þess að athuga fyrst staðbundnar
reglugerðir og reglugerðir
sveitarfélagsins varðandi mögulega
takmarkanir á notkun þeirra.
9-9
Appendix
Uppsetning keðja
Þegar þú setur upp snjó keðjur skaltu
fylgja leiðbeiningum framleiðandans
og setja þær eins þétt á og mögulegt
er. Aktu hægt (undir 30 km/klst (20 m/
klst)) með uppsettar keðjur. Ef þú heyrir
keðjurnar snerta yfirbygginguna eða
undirvagninn skaltu stöðva og herða þær.
Ef þær snerta enn skaltu hægja á þar til
hávaðinn hættir. Taktu snjókeðjurnar af
um leið og þú ferð að aka á hreinsuðum
vegum.
Þegar þú setur snjókeðjur á skaltu
leggja ökutækinu á jafnsléttu utan við
umferðina. Kveiktu á hættuljósunum
og settu neyðarviðvörunarþríhyrning
fyrir aftan ökutækið (ef til staðar).
Settu ökutækið alltaf í P (Park), settu
stöðuhemilinn á og slökktu á hreyflinum
áður en þú setur upp snjókeðjur.
9-10
ATHUGASEMD
Þegar snjókeðjur eru notaðar:
• Röng stærð á keðjum eða rangt
uppsettar keðjur geta skemmt
hemlaborða ökutækisins, fjöðrun,
yfirbyggingu og hjól.
• Notaðu keðjur í SAE „S“ flokki eða
vírkeðjur.
• Ef þú heyrir hljóð af völdum þess
að keðjurnar snerta yfirbygginguna
skaltu herða keðjurnar aftur til
að koma í veg fyrir snertingu við
yfirbyggingu ökutækisins.
• Til að koma í veg fyrir skemmdir á
yfirbyggingu skaltu herða keðjurnar
aftur eftir að hafa ekið 0,5~1,0 km
(0,3~0,6 mílur).
• Notaðu ekki snjókeðjur á ökutækjum
sem búin eru álfelgum. Ef ekki er
komist hjá því skal nota vírkeðjur.
• Notaðu vírkeðjur sem eru þynnri en
12 mm (0,47 til) að koma í veg fyrir
skemmdir á tengingu keðjunnar.
A
JAZDA ZIMĄ (POLISH)
Trudne warunki pogodowe zimą
powodują szybsze zużycie opon i inne
problemy. Aby ograniczyć problemy
podczas jazdy zimą, należy stosować się
do następujących zaleceń:
Opady śniegu lub mróz
Należy utrzymywać odpowiednią
odległość od pojazdu poprzedzającego.
Hamować łagodnie. Jazda z nadmierną
prędkością, gwałtowne przyśpieszanie,
nagłe hamowanie i pokonywanie
zakrętów z wysoką prędkością są
potencjalnie bardzo niebezpiecznymi
zachowaniami. Zwalniając, należy w jak
największym stopniu hamować silnikiem.
Nagłe hamowanie na zaśnieżonej
luboblodzonej nawierzchni może
skutkować wpadnięciem pojazdu w
poślizg.
W celu jazdy w głębokim śniegu
może być konieczne zamontowanie
opon zimowych lub założenie na koła
łańcuchów śniegowych.
Należy zawsze wozić wyposażenie
na wypadek sytuacji awaryjnych. Do
przydatnych elementów wyposażenia
zaliczają się: łańcuchy śniegowe, lina
lub łańcuch holowniczy, latarka, flary
sygnalizacyjne, piasek, łopata, przewody
rozruchowe, skrobaczka do szyb,
rękawice, mata, kombinezon, koc itp.
Opony zimowe
OSTRZEŻENIE
Opony zimowe muszą być tego samego
rozmiaru i typu jak standardowe
opony pojazdu. W przeciwnym
razie mogą negatywnie wpływać na
bezpieczeństwo i prowadzenie pojazdu.
Montując opony zimowe w pojeździe,
należy zamontować opony radialne
w takim samym rozmiarze i o takim
samym indeksie nośności jak oryginalne
opony. Zamontować opony zimowe
na wszystkich czterech kołach, aby
uzyskać stabilne prowadzenie pojazdu w
każdych warunkach. Przyczepność opon
zimowych na suchej nawierzchni może
być gorsza w porównaniu z oponami
będącymi oryginalnym wyposażeniem
pojazdu. Sprawdzić zalecenia dotyczące
maksymalnej prędkości u sprzedawcy
opon.
Informacja
Nie wolno montować opon z kolcami bez
uprzedniego zapoznania się z lokalnymi
i regionalnymi przepisami mogącymi
zabraniać ich używania.
9-11
Appendix
Łańcuchy śniegowe
OSTRZEŻENIE
OOSH069128L
Ponieważ ścianki boczne opon radialnych
są cieńsze w porównaniu z innymi typami
opon, mogą one ulec uszkodzeniu
wskutek zamontowania pewnych typów
łańcuchów. W związku z tym zaleca
się montaż opon zimowych zamiast
używania łańcuchów śniegowych. W
razie konieczności użycia łańcuchów,
należy używać oryginalnych części
HYUNDAI i zamontować łańcuchy
śniegowe po zapoznaniu się z
dołączonymi do nich instrukcjami.
Gwarancja producenta pojazdu nie
obejmuje uszkodzeń spowodowanych
niewłaściwym użytkowaniem łańcuchów
śniegowych.
9-12
Łańcuchy śniegowe mogą pogorszyć
właściwości jezdne pojazdu:
• Nie wolno przekraczać prędkości
30 km/h (20 mph) lub maksymalnej
prędkości zalecanej przez
producenta, zależnie od tego, która
wartość jest niższa.
• Należy prowadzić ostrożnie i unikać
nierówności, dziur, ostrych zakrętów
i innych zagrożeń na drodze, które
mogłyby spowodować podbicie
pojazdu.
• Należy unikać gwałtownego
pokonywania zakrętów i hamowania
z zablokowanymi kołami.
Informacja
• Montować łańcuchy śniegowe tylko
parami na kołach przednich. Należy
pamiętać, że łańcuchy śniegowe
powoduję zwiększenie siły napędowej,
ale nie zapobiegają poślizgom bocznym.
• Nie wolno montować opon z kolcami
bez uprzedniego zapoznania się z
lokalnymi i regionalnymi przepisami
mogącymi zabraniać ich używania.
A
Montaż łańcuchów
Montując łańcuchy śniegowe, należy
stosować się do instrukcji producenta i
zamontować je, zwracając uwagę na ich
właściwe naprężenie. Z zamontowanymi
łańcuchami należy jechać powoli (poniżej
30 km/h (20 mph)). W razie usłyszenia
odgłosu łańcuchów uderzających w
nadwozie lub podwozie należy zatrzymać
pojazd i naprężyć łańcuchy. Jeśli nadal
dochodzi do kontaktu, należy zmniejszyć
prędkość, aż odgłosy ustaną. Zdjąć
łańcuchy jak najszybciej po wjechaniu na
odśnieżoną drogę.
Aby zamontować łańcuchy śniegowe,
należy zaparkować pojazd na równej
nawierzchni z dala od ruchu. Włączyć
światła awaryjne i ustawić za pojazdem
trójkąt ostrzegawczy (jeśli jest dostępny).
Przed przystąpieniem do montażu
łańcuchów śniegowych należy ustawić
dźwignię zmiany biegów w położeniu P
(postój), włączyć hamulec postojowy i
wyłączyć silnik.
UWAGA
W przypadku używania łańcuchów
śniegowych:
• Łańcuchy w nieprawidłowym
rozmiarze lub nieprawidłowo
zamontowane mogą spowodować
uszkodzenie przewodów
hamulcowych, zawieszenia,
nadwozia i kół pojazdu.
• Należy używać łańcuchów
śniegowych SAE klasy „S” lub
łańcuchów z linki stalowej.
• W razie usłyszenia hałasu
spowodowanego kontaktem
łańcuchów z nadwoziem, należy je
naprężyć, aby temu zapobiec.
• Aby uniknąć uszkodzenia nadwozia,
łańcuchy należy naprężyć po
przejechaniu 0,5~1,0 km (0,3~0,6
mili).
• Nie wolno używać łańcuchów
śniegowych w pojazdach
wyposażonych w aluminiowe
obręcze kół. Jeśli nie można tego
uniknąć, należy użyć łańcuchów z
linki stalowej.
• Używać łańcuchów z linki stalowej
o grubości mniejszej niż 12 mm
(0,47 in), aby nie uszkodzić ogniwa
łańcucha.
9-13
Index
I
Index
A
Air bag warning labels..........................................................................................3-59
Air bags.................................................................................................................3-41
Additional safety precautions........................................................................... 3-59
Air bag collision sensors.................................................................................. 3-53
Air bag inflation conditions............................................................................. 3-55
Air bag non-inflation conditions...................................................................... 3-56
Air bag warning labels..................................................................................... 3-59
Curtain air bags................................................................................................ 3-48
Do not install a child restraint on the front passenger seat.............................. 3-52
Driver’s air bag................................................................................................ 3-44
How does the air bags system operate?........................................................... 3-49
Passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF switch....................................................... 3-45
Passenger’s front air bag.................................................................................. 3-44
Side air bags..................................................................................................... 3-46
SRS Care.......................................................................................................... 3-58
SRS components and functions........................................................................ 3-49
SRS warning light............................................................................................ 3-49
What to expect after an air bag inflates............................................................ 3-52
Why didn’t my air bag go off in a collision..................................................... 3-53
Air cleaner............................................................................................................8-28
Air conditioner compressor label.........................................................................2-16
Air Conditioning refrigerant label........................................................................5-73
Air ventilation seats..............................................................................................3-18
Airconditioning system.........................................................................................5-63
Alarm system........................................................................................................5-18
Antenna.................................................................................................................5-91
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)............................................................................6-32
Appearance care...................................................................................................8-70
Exterior care..................................................................................................... 8-70
Interior care...................................................................................................... 8-74
Armrest................................................................................................................. 3-11
Auto defogging system.........................................................................................5-76
AUTO headlamp position.....................................................................................5-42
Auto Hold.............................................................................................................6-29
I-2
I
Automatic climate control system........................................................................5-63
Air conditioning............................................................................................... 5-70
Air Conditioning refrigerant label.................................................................... 5-73
Air intake control............................................................................................. 5-68
Automatic heating and air conditioning........................................................... 5-64
Driver only....................................................................................................... 5-70
Fan speed control............................................................................................. 5-69
Manual heating and air conditioning............................................................... 5-65
Mode selection................................................................................................. 5-66
OFF mode........................................................................................................ 5-70
System maintenance......................................................................................... 5-72
Temperature control......................................................................................... 5-68
Automatic door lock and unlock features.............................................................5-16
Air bag deployment.......................................................................................... 5-17
Auto LOCK - Enable on shift.......................................................................... 5-16
Auto LOCK - Enable on speed........................................................................ 5-16
Auto UNLOCK - On Shift to P........................................................................ 5-17
Auto UNLOCK - Vehicle off (with Smart key)............................................... 5-17
Auto UNLOCK- On key out (with Remote key)............................................. 5-17
Automatic ventilation...........................................................................................5-78
Aux, USB and iPod..............................................................................................5-91
B
Battery (High voltage battery and 12V lithium ion polymer battery)..................1-14
Battery saver function...........................................................................................5-48
Before driving.........................................................................................................6-5
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) system......................................................6-50
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology hands-free.......................................................5-93
Bottle holder.........................................................................................................5-81
Brake fluid............................................................................................................8-26
Brake system.........................................................................................................6-23
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)........................................................................ 6-32
Auto Hold......................................................................................................... 6-29
Disc brakes wear indicator............................................................................... 6-24
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)...................................................................... 6-24
Electronic Stability Control (ESC).................................................................. 6-34
I-3
Index
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS)......................................................................... 6-38
Good braking practices.................................................................................... 6-39
Hill-start Assist Control (HAC)....................................................................... 6-38
Power brakes.................................................................................................... 6-23
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)............................................................. 6-36
Bulb replacement..................................................................................................8-55
Daytime running lamp..................................................................................... 8-56
Front fog lamp.................................................................................................. 8-59
Front position lamp.......................................................................................... 8-56
Front turn signal lamp...................................................................................... 8-56
Headlamp......................................................................................................... 8-56
Headlamp aiming............................................................................................. 8-60
High mounted stop lamp.................................................................................. 8-67
Interior light bulb............................................................................................. 8-68
License plate light bulb.................................................................................... 8-68
Rear combination lamp bulb............................................................................ 8-65
Rear fog lamp................................................................................................... 8-65
Side repeater lamp ........................................................................................... 8-65
Static lamp........................................................................................................ 8-56
Bulb wattage.........................................................................................................2-10
Button start/stop, see engine start/stop button........................................................6-9
C
Cabin air filter.......................................................................................................8-29
Capacities (Lubricants).........................................................................................2-13
Care
Exterior care..................................................................................................... 8-70
Interior care...................................................................................................... 8-74
Tire care............................................................................................................ 8-33
Cargo area cover...................................................................................................5-89
Center console storage..........................................................................................5-79
Central door lock switch.......................................................................................5-15
Certification label.................................................................................................2-15
Chains
Tire chains...................................................................................................... 6-132
Checking tire inflation pressure............................................................................8-34
I-4
I
Child restraint system (CRS)................................................................................3-29
Booster seats.................................................................................................... 3-30
Children always in the rear.............................................................................. 3-29
Forward-facing child restraint system.............................................................. 3-30
Installing a child restraint system (CRS)......................................................... 3-32
ISOFIX anchorage and top-tether anchorage for children............................... 3-37
Rearward-facing child restraint system............................................................ 3-30
Securing a child restraint system seat with “Top-tether Anchorage” system... 3-38
Securing a child restraint system with a lap/shoulder belt............................... 3-39
Securing a child restraint system with the “ISOFIX Anchorage System”....... 3-37
Selecting a child restraint system (CRS).......................................................... 3-30
Child-protector rear door lock..............................................................................5-17
Clock.....................................................................................................................5-86
Coasting guide......................................................................................................6-22
Coat hook..............................................................................................................5-87
Combined instrument, see instrument cluster.........................................................4-4
Compact spare tire replacement...........................................................................8-37
Compressor lubricant volume...............................................................................2-12
Coolant..................................................................................................................8-23
Cooling fluid, see engine coolant/inverter coolant...............................................8-23
Crankcase emission control system......................................................................8-77
Cruise control.....................................................................................................6-105
Cup holder............................................................................................................5-81
Curtain air bags.....................................................................................................3-48
D
Dashboard illumination, see instrument panel illumination...................................4-5
Dashboard, see instrument cluster..........................................................................4-4
Day/night rearview mirror....................................................................................5-22
Daytime Running Light (DRL)............................................................................5-42
Defogging (Windshield).......................................................................................5-74
Defrosting (Windshield).......................................................................................5-74
Dimensions.............................................................................................................2-9
Display illumination, see instrument panel illumination........................................4-5
Displays, see instrument cluster.............................................................................4-4
Distance to empty...................................................................................................4-7
I-5
Index
Door locks.............................................................................................................5-13
Automatic door lock and unlock features........................................................ 5-16
Central door lock switch.................................................................................. 5-15
Child-protector rear door lock.......................................................................... 5-17
Drinks holders, see cup holders............................................................................5-81
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system............................................................6-92
Driver’s air bag.....................................................................................................3-44
Driving at night...................................................................................................6-129
Driving in flooded areas.....................................................................................6-130
Driving in the rain...............................................................................................6-129
Driving the hybrid vehicle....................................................................................1-12
Economical and safe operation of hybrid system............................................ 1-12
Starting the vehicle with remote key................................................................ 1-12
Starting the vehicle with smart key.................................................................. 1-12
Dual clutch transmission......................................................................................6-13
DCT warning messages.................................................................................... 6-15
ECO mode........................................................................................................ 6-18
Good driving practices..................................................................................... 6-21
Ignition key interlock system........................................................................... 6-19
Manual shift mode........................................................................................... 6-18
Paddle shifter.................................................................................................... 6-20
Shift lock system.............................................................................................. 6-19
Shift-lock release.............................................................................................. 6-19
SPORT mode.................................................................................................... 6-18
Transmission ranges......................................................................................... 6-17
Dual clutch transmission shift indicator.................................................................4-7
E
ECO mode............................................................................................................6-18
Electric Chromic Mirror (ECM)...........................................................................5-22
Electric Power Steering (EPS)..............................................................................5-19
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)...........................................................................6-24
Electronic Stability Control (ESC).......................................................................6-34
Emergency commodity.........................................................................................7-31
Emergency Stop Signal (ESS)..............................................................................6-38
Emergency towing................................................................................................7-29
I-6
I
Emission control system.......................................................................................8-77
Crankcase emission control system................................................................. 8-77
Evaporative emission control System.............................................................. 8-77
Exhaust emission control system..................................................................... 8-78
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF)..................................................................... 8-79
Engine compartment....................................................................................... 2-8, 8-3
Engine compartment panel fuse replacement.......................................................8-45
Engine coolant......................................................................................................8-23
Engine number......................................................................................................2-16
Engine oil..............................................................................................................8-22
Engine specification...............................................................................................2-9
Engine Start/Stop button.........................................................................................6-9
Evaporative emission control System...................................................................8-77
Exhaust emission control system..........................................................................8-78
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.......................................................8-20
Exterior care.........................................................................................................8-70
Exterior overview
Front view.......................................................................................................... 2-2
Rear view........................................................................................................... 2-3
F
Flat tire..................................................................................................................7-14
Changing tires.................................................................................................. 7-15
EC Declaration of conformity for Jack............................................................ 7-20
Jack and tools................................................................................................... 7-14
Jack label.......................................................................................................... 7-19
Tire Mobility Kit (TMK).................................................................................. 7-21
Use of compact spare tires............................................................................... 7-17
Floor mat anchor(s)..............................................................................................5-87
Fluid
Brake fluid........................................................................................................ 8-26
Washer fluid..................................................................................................... 8-27
Forced engine activation mode.............................................................................7-80
Forward Collision – Avoidance Assist (FCA) system..........................................6-40
I-7
Index
Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW)...........................................5-59
Front fog lamp......................................................................................................5-47
Front seat adjustment..............................................................................................3-6
Lumbar support.................................................................................................. 3-9
Manual adjustment............................................................................................. 3-6
Power adjustment............................................................................................... 3-8
Fuel filler door......................................................................................................5-36
Fuel gauge...............................................................................................................4-6
Fuel requirements...................................................................................................1-4
Do not use methanol.......................................................................................... 1-6
Fuel Additives.................................................................................................... 1-6
Gasoline containing alcohol and methanol........................................................ 1-5
Leaded................................................................................................................ 1-4
Operation in foreign countries........................................................................... 1-6
Other fuels ......................................................................................................... 1-5
Unleaded............................................................................................................ 1-4
Use of MTBE..................................................................................................... 1-6
Fuse switch...........................................................................................................8-44
Fuse/relay panel description
Instrument panel fuse panel............................................................................. 8-46
Engine compartment fuse panel....................................................................... 8-51
Fuses.....................................................................................................................8-42
Engine compartment panel fuse replacement.................................................. 8-45
Fuse switch....................................................................................................... 8-44
Fuse/relay panel description............................................................................. 8-46
Instrument panel fuse replacement.................................................................. 8-43
Multi fuse......................................................................................................... 8-45
G
Gasoline Particulate Filter (GPF).........................................................................8-79
Gauges and meters..................................................................................................4-5
Glove box.............................................................................................................5-79
Gross vehicle weight............................................................................................2-12
I-8
I
H
Hazard warning flasher...........................................................................................7-2
Hazardous driving conditions.............................................................................6-128
Headlamp bulb replacement.................................................................................8-55
Headlamp delay function......................................................................................5-48
Headlamp position................................................................................................5-43
Headlight leveling device.....................................................................................5-49
Headrest................................................................................................................3-12
Front seat headrests.......................................................................................... 3-12
Rear seat headrests........................................................................................... 3-15
Head-up display....................................................................................................5-39
Head-up display information........................................................................... 5-41
Head-up display ON/OFF button..................................................................... 5-40
Head-up display setting.................................................................................... 5-41
Heated steering wheel...........................................................................................5-21
Heater....................................................................................................................5-63
Height adjustment.................................................................................................3-23
High Beam Assist (HBA).....................................................................................5-44
High beam operation............................................................................................5-43
Highway driving.................................................................................................6-130
Hill-start Assist Control (HAC)............................................................................6-38
Hood.....................................................................................................................5-33
Horn......................................................................................................................5-20
How to use this manual..........................................................................................1-3
Hybrid battery cooling duct..................................................................................1-26
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge.........................................................4-6
Hybrid Starter&Generator (HSG) belt.................................................................8-26
I
If the 12 volt battery is discharged.........................................................................7-4
Before jump starting........................................................................................... 7-4
Jump starting...................................................................................................... 7-5
Using the 12V battery reset switch.................................................................... 7-4
If the engine overheats............................................................................................7-7
If the engine stalls at a crossroad or crossing.........................................................7-2
If the engine stalls while driving............................................................................7-2
If the engine will not start.......................................................................................7-3
If you have a flat tire while driving........................................................................7-3
I-9
Index
Ignition key interlock system...............................................................................6-19
Ignition switch........................................................................................................6-6
Key ignition switch............................................................................................ 6-6
Engine Start/Stop button.................................................................................... 6-9
Immobilizer system..............................................................................................5-12
In case of emergency while driving........................................................................7-2
Indicator light.........................................................................................................4-9
Infotainment system.............................................................................................5-91
USB Port.......................................................................................................... 5-91
Antenna............................................................................................................ 5-91
Steering wheel audio control............................................................................ 5-92
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology.................................................................... 5-93
Inside rearview mirror..........................................................................................5-21
Instrument cluster...................................................................................................4-4
Distance to empty .............................................................................................. 4-7
Dual clutch transmission shift indicator............................................................. 4-7
Fuel gauge.......................................................................................................... 4-6
Gauges and meters............................................................................................. 4-5
Hybrid battery SOC (State of Charge) gauge.................................................... 4-6
Instrument panel illumination............................................................................ 4-5
LCD display control......................................................................................... 4-27
LCD display messages..................................................................................... 4-21
LCD display modes.......................................................................................... 4-28
Odometer............................................................................................................ 4-7
Outside temperature gauge................................................................................. 4-7
Power gauge....................................................................................................... 4-5
Speedometer....................................................................................................... 4-5
Trip computer................................................................................................... 4-40
User settings mode........................................................................................... 4-31
Warning and indicator lights.............................................................................. 4-9
Instrument panel fuse replacement.......................................................................8-43
Instrument panel illumination.................................................................................4-5
Instrument panel overview.....................................................................................2-7
Intelligent Speed Linit Warning (ISLW)..............................................................6-97
Interior care...........................................................................................................8-74
I-10
I
Interior features
Bottle holder..................................................................................................... 5-81
Cargo area cover.............................................................................................. 5-89
Clock................................................................................................................ 5-86
Coat hook......................................................................................................... 5-87
Cup holder........................................................................................................ 5-81
Floor mat anchor(s).......................................................................................... 5-87
Luggage net holder........................................................................................... 5-88
Luggage tray.................................................................................................... 5-89
Power outlet..................................................................................................... 5-82
Sunvisor........................................................................................................... 5-82
USB charger .................................................................................................... 5-83
Wireless cellular phone charging system......................................................... 5-84
Interior lamp AUTO cut........................................................................................5-50
Interior lights........................................................................................................5-50
Front lamps...................................................................................................... 5-50
Interior lamp AUTO cut................................................................................... 5-50
Luggage compartment lamp............................................................................. 5-51
Rear lamp......................................................................................................... 5-51
Vanity mirror lamp........................................................................................... 5-51
Interior overview....................................................................................................2-4
Inverter coolant.....................................................................................................8-23
J
Jack and tools........................................................................................................7-14
L
Label
Air conditioner compressor label..................................................................... 2-16
Refrigerant label............................................................................................... 2-16
Tire sidewall labeling....................................................................................... 8-38
Tire specification and pressure label................................................................ 2-16
Vehicle certification label................................................................................. 2-15
Lane Following Assist (LFA) system...................................................................6-78
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system.....................................................................6-84
Lap/shoulder belt..................................................................................................3-22
LCD display control.............................................................................................4-27
LCD display messages..........................................................................................4-21
LCD display modes..............................................................................................4-28
I-11
Index
Leading vehicle departure alert..........................................................................6-127
Light bulbs............................................................................................................8-55
Lighting................................................................................................................5-42
AUTO headlamp position................................................................................ 5-42
Battery saver function...................................................................................... 5-48
Daytime Running Light (DRL)........................................................................ 5-42
Front fog lamp ................................................................................................. 5-47
Headlamp delay function................................................................................. 5-48
Headlamp position........................................................................................... 5-43
Headlight leveling device................................................................................. 5-49
High Beam Assist (HBA)................................................................................. 5-44
High beam operation........................................................................................ 5-43
Low beam assist-static light............................................................................. 5-49
Position lamp position...................................................................................... 5-43
Rear fog lamp................................................................................................... 5-47
Turn signals...................................................................................................... 5-46
Load and speed capacty tires................................................................................2-12
Low beam assist-static light.................................................................................5-49
Lubricants and capacities......................................................................................2-13
Luggage compartment lamp.................................................................................5-51
Luggage net holder...............................................................................................5-88
Luggage tray.........................................................................................................5-89
Luggage volume...................................................................................................2-12
M
Maintenance
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.................................................. 8-20
Maintenance services......................................................................................... 8-4
Maintenance under severe usage conditions.............................................. 8-12, 18
Normal maintenance service........................................................................ 8-8, 14
Owner maintenance............................................................................................ 8-5
Scheduled maintenance services........................................................................ 8-7
Tire maintenance.............................................................................................. 8-37
Maintenance services..............................................................................................8-4
Manual shift mode................................................................................................6-18
I-12
I
Mirrors..................................................................................................................5-21
Adjusting the outside rearview mirrors............................................................ 5-23
Day/night rearview mirror............................................................................... 5-22
Electric Chromic Mirror (ECM)...................................................................... 5-22
Folding outside rearview mirrors..................................................................... 5-24
Inside rearview mirror...................................................................................... 5-21
Outside rearview mirrors................................................................................. 5-23
Moonroof, see sunroof..........................................................................................5-29
Multi box..............................................................................................................5-80
Multi fuse..............................................................................................................8-45
N
Normal maintenance service
For Europe.......................................................................................................... 8-8
Except Europe.................................................................................................. 8-14
O
Odometer................................................................................................................4-7
Oil (Engine)..........................................................................................................8-22
Outside rearview mirrors......................................................................................5-23
Outside temperature gauge.....................................................................................4-7
Owner maintenance................................................................................................8-5
P
Paddle shifter........................................................................................................6-20
Passenger’s front air bag ON/OFF switch............................................................3-45
Passenger’s front air bag.......................................................................................3-44
Position lamp position..........................................................................................5-43
Power brakes.........................................................................................................6-23
Power gauge...........................................................................................................4-5
Power outlet..........................................................................................................5-82
Power steering......................................................................................................5-19
Power window lock button...................................................................................5-28
Pre-tensioner seat belt...........................................................................................3-24
I-13
Index
R
Rear center seatbelt...............................................................................................3-24
Rear Cross – Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) system....................................6-65
Rear fog lamp.......................................................................................................5-47
Rear seat adjustment
Armrest............................................................................................................. 3-11
Seat folding...................................................................................................... 3-10
Rear seat headrests................................................................................................3-15
Rear seat warmers.................................................................................................3-17
Rear View Monitor...............................................................................................5-55
Rear window defroster..........................................................................................5-77
Rear window wiper and washer............................................................................5-54
Auto rear wiper................................................................................................ 5-54
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures..........................................................8-33
Recommended lubricants and capacities..............................................................2-13
Recommended SAE viscosity number............................................................. 2-14
Refrigerant label...................................................................................................2-16
Refrigerant volume...............................................................................................2-12
Regenrative braking..............................................................................................1-14
Remote key.............................................................................................................5-5
Mechanical key.................................................................................................. 5-6
Battery replacement........................................................................................... 5-7
Removable towing hook.......................................................................................7-28
Replacement light bulb.........................................................................................8-55
Returning used vehicles..........................................................................................1-7
Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW)..........................................................5-56
Rocking the vehicle............................................................................................6-128
Roof side rails.......................................................................................................5-90
Rotation (Tire)......................................................................................................8-35
S
Safety messages......................................................................................................1-3
Safety precautions.................................................................................................1-23
High voltage battery system............................................................................. 1-23
Service plug...................................................................................................... 1-26
Hybrid battery cooling duct............................................................................. 1-26
If an accident occurs........................................................................................ 1-27
When the hybrid vehicle shuts off................................................................... 1-28
I-14
I
Scheduled maintenance services............................................................................8-7
Seat belt warning light..........................................................................................3-20
Seat belts...............................................................................................................3-19
Additional seat belt safety precautions............................................................ 3-26
Care of seat belts.............................................................................................. 3-28
Do not lie down................................................................................................ 3-28
Height adjustment............................................................................................ 3-23
Keep belts clean and dry.................................................................................. 3-28
Lap/shoulder belt.............................................................................................. 3-22
One person per belt.......................................................................................... 3-28
Periodic inspection........................................................................................... 3-28
Pre-tensioner seat belt...................................................................................... 3-24
Rear center seatbelt.......................................................................................... 3-24
Seat belt restraint system.................................................................................. 3-22
Seat belt safety precautions.............................................................................. 3-19
Seat belt use and children................................................................................. 3-26
Seat belt use and injured people....................................................................... 3-27
Seat belt use during pregnancy........................................................................ 3-26
Seat belt warning light..................................................................................... 3-20
When to replace seat belts................................................................................ 3-28
Seat warmers
Front................................................................................................................. 3-16
Rear.................................................................................................................. 3-17
Seats........................................................................................................................3-3
Air ventilation seats......................................................................................... 3-18
Front seat adjustment......................................................................................... 3-6
Headrest........................................................................................................... 3-12
Rear seat adjustment........................................................................................ 3-10
Rear seat warmers............................................................................................ 3-17
Safety precautions.............................................................................................. 3-5
Seat warmers.................................................................................................... 3-16
Seatback pocket.................................................................................................. 3-9
Service plug..........................................................................................................1-26
Shift lock system..................................................................................................6-19
Shift-lock release..................................................................................................6-19
Side air bags..........................................................................................................3-46
Smart cruise control with stop & go................................................................... 6-110
I-15
Index
Smart key................................................................................................................5-8
Battery replacement......................................................................................... 5-11
Mechanical key................................................................................................ 5-10
Smooth cornering...............................................................................................6-129
Snow tires...........................................................................................................6-131
Spare tire
Compact spare tire replacement....................................................................... 8-37
Special driving conditions
Driving at night.............................................................................................. 6-129
Driving in flooded areas................................................................................. 6-130
Driving in the rain.......................................................................................... 6-129
Hazardous driving conditions........................................................................ 6-128
Highway driving............................................................................................ 6-130
Rocking the vehicle........................................................................................ 6-128
Smooth cornering........................................................................................... 6-129
Speed limit control..............................................................................................6-103
Speedometer...........................................................................................................4-5
SPORT mode........................................................................................................6-18
Steering wheel......................................................................................................5-19
Electric Power Steering (EPS)......................................................................... 5-19
Heated steering wheel...................................................................................... 5-21
Horn................................................................................................................. 5-20
Power steering.................................................................................................. 5-19
Tilt steering / Telescopic steering..................................................................... 5-20
Steering wheel audio controls...............................................................................5-92
Storage compartment............................................................................................5-79
Center console storage..................................................................................... 5-79
Glove box......................................................................................................... 5-79
Multi box.......................................................................................................... 5-80
Sunglass holder................................................................................................ 5-80
Sunglass holder.....................................................................................................5-80
Sunroof.................................................................................................................5-29
Automatic reverse............................................................................................ 5-30
Resetting the sunroof....................................................................................... 5-31
Sliding the sunroof........................................................................................... 5-30
Sunroof open warning...................................................................................... 5-32
Sunroof opening and closing............................................................................ 5-30
Sunshade.......................................................................................................... 5-31
Tilting the sunroof............................................................................................ 5-30
I-16
I
Sunroof inside air recirculation............................................................................5-78
Sunvisor................................................................................................................5-82
T
Tailgate.................................................................................................................5-34
Theft-alarm system...............................................................................................5-18
Tilt steering / Telescopic steering.........................................................................5-20
Tire and wheels (size and pressure)...................................................................... 2-11
Tire chains..........................................................................................................6-132
Tire Mobility Kit (TMK)......................................................................................7-21
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).............................................................7-9
Tire rotation..........................................................................................................8-35
Tire specification and pressure label....................................................................2-16
Tires and wheels...................................................................................................8-33
Checking tire inflation pressure....................................................................... 8-34
Compact spare tire replacement....................................................................... 8-37
Low aspect ratio tires....................................................................................... 8-41
Recommended cold tire inflation pressures..................................................... 8-33
Tire care............................................................................................................ 8-33
Tire maintenance.............................................................................................. 8-37
Tire replacement............................................................................................... 8-36
Tire rotation...................................................................................................... 8-35
Tire sidewall labeling....................................................................................... 8-38
Tire traction...................................................................................................... 8-37
Wheel alignment and tire balance.................................................................... 8-36
Wheel replacement........................................................................................... 8-37
Towing..................................................................................................................7-27
Trailer towing.....................................................................................................6-135
Trip computer.......................................................................................................4-40
Turn signals..........................................................................................................5-46
U
USB charger..........................................................................................................5-83
User settings mode................................................................................................4-31
I-17
Index
V
Vanity mirror lamp................................................................................................5-51
Vehicle break-in process.........................................................................................1-7
Vehicle certification label.....................................................................................2-15
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)...................................................................2-15
Vehicle modification...............................................................................................1-7
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM).................................................................6-36
Vehicle weight....................................................................................................6-143
Virtual Engine Sound System (VESS).................................................................1-14
W
Warning and indicator lights...................................................................................4-9
Warning and indicator lights...................................................................................4-9
Warning light..........................................................................................................4-9
Washer fluid..........................................................................................................8-27
Wheel alignment and tire balance........................................................................8-36
Wheel replacement...............................................................................................8-37
Windows...............................................................................................................5-25
Power window lock switch.............................................................................. 5-28
Windshield defrosting and defogging...................................................................5-74
Windshield washers..............................................................................................5-52
Windshield wipers................................................................................................5-52
Winter driving.....................................................................................................6-131
Snow tires....................................................................................................... 6-131
Tire chains...................................................................................................... 6-132
Wiper blade replacement......................................................................................8-30
Wipers and washers..............................................................................................5-52
AUTO (Automatic) control.............................................................................. 5-52
Rear window wiper and washer....................................................................... 5-54
Windshield washers ......................................................................................... 5-52
Windshield wipers ........................................................................................... 5-52
Wireless cellular phone charging system..............................................................5-84
I-18